Table of Contents

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 40-F

 

o REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

OR

 

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13(a) OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018

 

Commission File Number 001-15144

 

TELUS Corporation

(Exact Name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

British Columbia, Canada

(Province or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

 

4812

(Primary Standard Industrial Classification Code Number (if applicable))

 

7 th  Floor – 510 West Georgia Street
Vancouver, British Columbia  V6B 0M3, Canada
(604) 697-8044

(Address and telephone number of Registrant’s principal executive offices)

 

CT Corporation System, 28 Liberty Street
New York, New York 10005

(212) 590-9200

(Name, address (including zip code) and telephone number (including area code) of agent

for service in the United States)

 

Securities registered pursuant to section 12(b) of the Act.

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

New York Stock Exchange

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

 

None

(Title of Class)

 

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

 

None

(Title of Class)

 

For annual reports, indicate by check mark the information filed with this Form:

 

x Annual information form      x Audited annual financial statements

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of December 31, 2018:

 

598,674,024 Common Shares

 

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

 

Yes   x

No   o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to submit such files).

 

Yes   x

No   o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is an emerging growth company as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Emerging Growth Company ¨

 

If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if the Registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.

 

¨

 

†The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.

 

The annual report on Form 40-F shall be incorporated by reference into or as an exhibit to, as applicable, each of the following of the Registrant’s Registration Statements under the Act: Form S-8s (File Nos. 333-125486 and 333-181463), Form F-3 (File No. 333-186874), and Form F-10 (File No. 333-224895).

 

 

 


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

1

IDENTIFICATION OF THE AUDIT COMMITTEE

1

AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

2

CODE OF ETHICS

2

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

2

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

3

TABULAR DISCLOSURE OF CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

3

MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE

3

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT DIFFERENCES FROM NYSE CORPORATE GOVERNANCE RULES

3

UNDERTAKING AND CONSENT TO SERVICE OF PROCESS

4

EXHIBIT INDEX

5

SIGNATURES

6

 


Table of Contents

 

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

 

Based on the evaluation by TELUS Corporation (“TELUS” or the “Registrant”) as of December 31, 2018 of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures under the supervision of the Audit Committee, including the Registrant’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that the Registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”) are effective to a reasonable level of assurance to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Registrant in reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the United States Securities and Exchange Commission’s (the “SEC”) rules and forms, and to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Registrant in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to the Registrant’s management, including the Registrant’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

 

It should be noted that while TELUS’ Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer believe that TELUS’ disclosure controls and procedures provide a reasonable level of assurance that they are effective, they do not expect that TELUS’ disclosure controls and procedures or internal control over financial reporting will prevent all errors and fraud.  A control system, no matter how well conceived or operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met.

 

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

 

The report of management on our internal control over financial reporting is located under the heading “Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting” in our audited consolidated financial statements, which are filed as Exhibit 99.4 to this annual report on Form 40-F, and is incorporated by reference herein.

 

Attestation Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

The attestation report on our internal control over financial reporting is located under the heading “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in our audited consolidated financial statements, which are filed as Exhibit 99.4 to this annual report on Form 40-F, and is incorporated by reference herein.

 

Changes in Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting

 

There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting identified in connection with the above evaluation that occurred during the period covered by this annual report on Form 40-F that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

IDENTIFICATION OF THE AUDIT COMMITTEE

 

TELUS has a separately designated standing Audit Committee established in accordance with section 3(a)(58)(A) of the Exchange Act.  The current members of the Audit Committee are David Mowat (Chair), Bill MacKinnon, Christine Magee, Sabi Marwah, Claude Mongeau and Denise Pickett.  All members of the Audit Committee are “independent” as such term is defined under applicable securities laws and applicable New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) rules.

 

1


Table of Contents

 

AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

 

The Board of Directors (the “Board”) of TELUS has determined that David Mowat, the Audit Committee Chair and Claude Mongeau are “audit committee financial experts” as such term is defined by U.S. securities laws and “independent” as noted above.  The information contained under the heading “Audit Committee” starting on page 19 of TELUS’ year-end 2018 Annual Information Form, filed as Exhibit 99.3 to this annual report on Form 40-F, is incorporated by reference herein.

 

CODE OF ETHICS

 

The Registrant has adopted a Code of Ethics and Conduct (the “Code”) that applies to all directors, officers, including the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer, and employees.  The Code has been posted on the Registrant’s Internet website at https://www.telus.com/en/about/policies-and-disclosures/code-of-ethics-and-conduct.   The Code is also available to any person, upon request, without charge by contacting TELUS Investor Relations by telephone at 1-800-667-4871 or by mail at 510 W. Georgia Street, 8 th  Floor, Vancouver, B.C. V6B 0M3 . The Board amended the Code in February 2019 to make minor clarifications to existing provisions.

 

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

 

The following table is a summary of billing by Deloitte LLP, as external auditor of TELUS (the “External Auditor”), during the period from January 1, 2018 to December 31, 2018 (all amounts are in Canadian dollars):

 

Type of work

 

$ (millions)

 

%

 

Audit fees (1)

 

5.584

 

93.9

%

Audit-related fees (2)

 

0.139

 

2.3

%

Tax fees (3)

 

0.207

 

3.5

%

All other fees (4)

 

0.015

 

0.3

%

Total

 

5.945

 

100.0

%

 


(1) Includes fees for services rendered by the External Auditor in relation to the audit and review of our financial statements and in connection with our statutory and regulatory filings.

(2) Includes fees for translation services rendered by the External Auditor in relation to the audit or review of our financial statements that were not part of audit fees.

(3) Relates to tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning.

(4) Includes fees for services rendered by the External Auditor that were not in relation to the audit or review of our financial statements, such the Telecom pricing gazette.

 

The following table is a summary of billing by the External Auditor, during the period from January 1, 2017 to December 31, 2017 (all amounts are in Canadian dollars):

 

Type of work

 

$ (millions)

 

%

 

Audit fees (1)

 

5.016

 

91.9

%

Audit-related fees (2)

 

0.133

 

2.4

%

Tax fees (3)

 

0.045

 

0.8

%

All other fees (4)

 

0.268

 

4.9

%

Total

 

5.462

 

100.0

%

 


(1) Includes fees for services rendered by the External Auditor in relation to the audit and review of our financial statements and in connection with our statutory and regulatory filings.

(2) Includes fees for translation services rendered by the External Auditor in relation to the audit or review of our financial statements that were not part of audit fees.

(3) Relates to tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning.

 

2


Table of Contents

 

(4) Includes fees for services rendered by the External Auditor that were not in relation to the audit or review of our financial statements, such as privacy data insights and the Telecom pricing gazette.

 

All requests for non-prohibited audit, audit-related and non-audit services provided by the External Auditor and its affiliates to TELUS are required to be pre-approved by the Audit Committee of the Board.  To enable this, TELUS has implemented a process by which all requests for services involving the External Auditor are routed for review by the VP Risk Management and Chief Internal Auditor to validate that the requested service is a non-prohibited service and to verify that there is a compelling business reason for the request.  If the request passes this review, it is then forwarded to the Chief Financial Officer for further review.  Pending the Chief Financial Officer’s affirmation, the request is then presented to the Audit Committee for its review, evaluation and pre-approval or denial at its next scheduled quarterly meeting.  If the timing of the request is urgent, it is provided to the Audit Committee Chair for his review, evaluation and pre-approval or denial on behalf of the Audit Committee (with the Audit Committee’s review at the next scheduled quarterly meeting).  Throughout the year, the Audit Committee monitors the actual versus approved expenditure for each of the approved requests. During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018, the Audit Committee did not approve any of the fees captioned in the table above subject to waiver of pre-approval provisions set forth in Rule 2-01(c)(7)(i)(C) of Regulation S-X.

 

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

 

The Registrant has no off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on the financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources that is material to investors.

 

TABULAR DISCLOSURE OF CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

 

The information provided under the heading “Commitments and contingent liabilities - Contractual obligations as at December 31, 2018 set forth on page 56 of the Management’s Discussion and Analysis filed as Exhibit 99.4 to this annual report on Form 40-F, is incorporated by reference herein.

 

MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE

 

Not applicable.

 

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT DIFFERENCES FROM NYSE CORPORATE GOVERNANCE RULES

 

A summary of significant ways in which corporate governance practices followed by TELUS differ from the corporate governance practices required to be followed by U.S. domestic companies under the New York Stock Exchange’s Listing Standards (disclosure required by section 303A.11 of the NYSE Listed Company Manual) is available on the Registrant’s corporate governance website at https://www.telus.com/en/about/investor-relations/corporate-governance/statement-of-our-governance-practices

 

3


Table of Contents

 

UNDERTAKING AND CONSENT TO SERVICE OF PROCESS

 

A .                                     Undertaking

 

The Registrant undertakes to make available, in person or by telephone, representatives to respond to inquiries made by the SEC staff, and to furnish promptly, when requested to do so by the SEC staff, information relating to: the securities registered pursuant to Form 40-F; the securities in relation to which the obligation to file an annual report on Form 40-F arises; or transactions in said securities.

 

B.                                     Consent to Service of Process

 

A Form F-X signed by the Registrant and its agent for service of process was previously filed with the SEC.

 

4


Table of Contents

 

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

The following documents are filed as exhibits to this annual report on Form 40-F:

 

Exhibit

 

Number

 

Document

 

 

 

99.1

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act

 

 

 

99.2

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act

 

 

 

99.3

 

Annual Information Form for the year ended December 31, 2018, dated February 14, 2019

 

 

 

99.4

 

Audited Consolidated Financial Statements as at and for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 and Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

 

 

99.5

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

 

 

99.6

 

Amended 2019 Code of Ethics and Conduct

 

 

 

101.INS

 

XBRL Instance Document

 

 

 

101.SCH

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema

 

 

 

101.CAL

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Scheme Calculation Linkbase

 

 

 

101.DEF

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Scheme Definition Linkbase

 

 

 

101.LAB

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Scheme Label Linkbase

 

 

 

101.PRE

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Scheme Presentation Linkbase

 

5


Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Exchange Act, the Registrant certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 40-F and has duly caused this annual report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereto duly authorized.

 

Registrant:                                      TELUS Corporation

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Andrea Wood

 

 

Andrea Wood

 

 

Chief Legal and Governance Officer

 

 

 

 

 

Date:

February 14, 2019

 

 

6


Exhibit 99.1:

 

Certification

 

I, Darren Entwistle, certify that:

 

1.             I have reviewed this annual report on Form 40-F of TELUS Corporation;

 

2.                                       Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3.                                       Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the issuer as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4.                                       The issuer’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the issuer and have:

 

(a)                                  Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the issuer, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

(b)                                  Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

(c)                                   Evaluated the effectiveness of the issuer’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(d)                                  Disclosed in this report any change in the issuer’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the issuer’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5.                                       The issuer’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the issuer’s auditors and the audit committee of the issuer’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

(a)                                  All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the issuer’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

(b)                                  Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the issuer’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Date: February 14, 2019.

 

 

 

/s/ Darren Entwistle

 

Darren Entwistle

 

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 


 

Certification

 

I, Doug French, certify that:

 

1.                                       I have reviewed this annual report on Form 40-F of TELUS Corporation;

 

2.                                       Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3.                                       Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the issuer as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4.                                       The issuer’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the issuer and have:

 

(a)                                  Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the issuer, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

(b)                                  Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

(c)                                   Evaluated the effectiveness of the issuer’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(d)                                  Disclosed in this report any change in the issuer’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the issuer’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5.                                       The issuer’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the issuer’s auditors and the audit committee of the issuer’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

(a)                                  All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the issuer’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

(b)                                  Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the issuer’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Date: February 14, 2019.

 

 

 

/s/ Doug French

 

Doug French

 

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

 

 


Exhibit 99.2:

 

Certifications

 

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, each of the undersigned officers of TELUS Corporation (“TELUS”) hereby certifies that to his knowledge, (a) the annual report for the period ended December 31, 2018 (the “Report”) fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d), as applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and (b) the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of TELUS.

 

Date: February 14, 2019.

 

 

 

/s/ Darren Entwistle

 

Darren Entwistle

 

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

Date: February 14, 2019.

 

 

 

/s/ Doug French

 

Doug French

 

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

 

 


Exhibit 99.3:

 

Annual Information Form for the year ended December 31, 2018, dated February 14, 2019

 

[previously filed on SEDAR]

 


 

 

TELUS Corporation

Annual Information Form for the year ended
December 31, 2018

 

February 14, 2019

 

 


 

1.               CAUTION REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

The terms TELUS, the Company, we, us and our refer to TELUS Corporation and, where the context of the narrative permits or requires, its subsidiaries.

 

This document contains forward-looking statements about expected events and our financial and operating performance. Forward-looking statements include any statements that do not refer to historical facts. They include, but are not limited to, statements relating to our objectives and our strategies to achieve those objectives, our targets, outlook, updates, and our multi-year dividend growth program. Forward-looking statements are typically identified by the words assumption, goal, guidance, objective, outlook, strategy, target and other similar expressions, or future or conditional verbs such as aim, anticipate, believe, could, expect, intend, may, plan, predict, seek, should, strive and will . These statements are made pursuant to the “safe harbour” provisions of applicable securities laws in Canada and the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 .

 

By their nature, forward-looking statements are subject to inherent risks and uncertainties and are based on assumptions, including assumptions about future economic conditions and courses of action. These assumptions may ultimately prove to have been inaccurate and, as a result, our actual results or events may differ materially from expectations expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements.

 

Risks and uncertainties that could cause actual performance or events to differ materially from the forward-looking statements made herein and in other TELUS filings include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

·                   Regulatory decisions and developments including changes to our regulatory regime or the outcomes of proceedings, cases or inquiries relating to its application, such as: the potential of government intervention to further increase wireless competition and any new regulatory requirements as a result of the CRTC’s planned review to be commenced in 2019 of the wholesale wireless regulatory framework; the potential for government intervention concerning the CRTC’s decision on lower-cost data-only plans; changes to the cost burden associated with CRTC-mandated network interconnections; disputes with certain municipalities regarding rights-of-way bylaws, and other potential threats to unitary federal regulatory authority over telecommunications, including provincial wireless and consumer protection legislation; the impact of the CRTC’s wireline wholesale services review, with a review of rates and configurations for wholesale access currently in progress for TELUS; the CRTC’s forthcoming report on the retail practices of Canada’s large telecommunications carriers, as directed by the Governor in Council; the Competition Bureau’s market study on competition in broadband services; the CRTC’s phase-out of the local service subsidy regime and corresponding establishment of a broadband funding regime to support the enhancement of high-speed Internet services focusing on underserved areas in Canada; the CRTC’s review of the price cap and local forbearance regimes; the CRTC’s proceeding to create a mandatory code of conduct to address the clarity and content of contracts for retail fixed Internet access and related issues; broadcasting-related issues, such as: the CRTC’s implementation of new initiatives discussed in its May 2018 report “Harnessing Change: The Future of Programming Distribution in Canada”; the federal government’s review of the Broadcasting Act , Telecommunications Act and Radiocommunication Act as announced on June 5, 2018; the review of the Copyright Act , which began in early 2018; spectrum and compliance with licences, including our compliance with licence conditions, changes to spectrum licence fees, spectrum policy determinations such as restrictions on the purchase, sale and transfer of spectrum licences, and the amount of spectrum TELUS is able to acquire and its cost under the Technical, Policy and Licensing Framework for Spectrum in the 600 MHz Band auction , as well as cost and availability of spectrum in the 3500 MHz and mmWave bands; the impact on us and other Canadian telecommunications carriers of government or regulatory actions with respect to certain countries or suppliers; restrictions on non-Canadian ownership and control of TELUS Common Shares and the ongoing monitoring and compliance with such restrictions; and our ability to comply with complex and changing regulation of the healthcare and medical devices industry in the provinces of Canada in which we operate, including as an operator of health clinics.

 

·                   Competitive environment including: our ability to continue to retain customers through an enhanced customer service experience, including through the deployment and operation of evolving wireless and wireline infrastructure; intense wireless competition, including the ability of industry competitors to successfully combine a mix of high-speed Internet access (HSIA) and, in some cases, wireless services under one bundled and/or discounted monthly rate, along with their existing broadcast or satellite-based TV services; the success of new products, new services and supporting systems, such as home automation security, and Internet of Things (IoT) services for Internet-connected devices; wireline voice and data competition including continued intense rivalry across all services among wireless and wireline telecommunications companies, cable-TV providers, other communications companies and over-the-top (OTT) services, which, among other things, places pressures on current and future average billing per subscriber unit per month (ABPU), average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU), cost of acquisition, cost of retention and churn rate for all services, as do customer usage patterns, increased data bucket sizes or flat-rate pricing trends for voice and data, inclusive rate plans for voice and data and availability of Wi-Fi networks for data; mergers and acquisitions of industry competitors; pressures on high-speed Internet and TV ARPU and churn rate resulting from market conditions, government actions and customer usage patterns; residential and business network access line (NAL) losses; subscriber additions and retention volumes, and associated costs for wireless, TV and high-speed Internet services; our ability to obtain and offer content on a timely basis across multiple devices on wireless and TV platforms at a reasonable cost; vertical integration in the broadcasting industry resulting in competitors owning broadcast content services, and timely and effective enforcement or related regulatory safeguards; our ability to compete successfully in customer care and business services (CCBS) given our competitors’ brand recognition, consolidation and strategic alliances as well as technology development and, in our TELUS Health business, our ability to compete with other providers of electronic medical records and pharmacy management products, systems integrators and health service providers including those that own a vertically integrated mix of health services delivery, IT solutions, and related services, and global providers that could achieve expanded Canadian footprints.

 

 

2


 

·                   Technological substitution including: reduced utilization and increased commoditization of traditional wireline voice local and long distance services from impacts of OTT applications and wireless substitution, a declining overall market for paid TV services, including as a result of content piracy and signal theft and as a result of a rise in OTT direct to consumer video offerings and virtual multichannel video programming distribution platforms; the increasing number of households that have only wireless and/or Internet-based telephone services; potential wireless ABPU and ARPU declines as a result of, among other factors, substitution to messaging and OTT applications; substitution to increasingly available Wi-Fi services; and disruptive technologies, such as OTT IP services, including Network as a Service in the business market, that may displace or re-rate our existing data services.

 

·                   Technology including: high subscriber demand for data that challenges wireless networks and spectrum capacity levels and may be accompanied by increases in delivery cost; our reliance on information technology and our need to streamline our legacy systems; the roll-out and evolution of wireless broadband technologies and systems including video distribution platforms and telecommunications network technologies (broadband initiatives, such as fibre to the premises (FTTP), wireless small-cell deployment, 5G wireless and availability of resources and ability to build out adequate broadband capacity); our reliance on wireless network access agreements, which have facilitated our deployment of wireless technologies; choice of suppliers and those suppliers’ ability to maintain and service their product lines, which could affect the success of upgrades to, and evolution of, technology that we offer; supplier limitations and concentration and market power for network equipment, TELUS TV ®  and wireless handsets; the performance of wireless technology; our expected long-term need to acquire additional spectrum capacity through future spectrum auctions and from third parties to address increasing demand for data; deployment and operation of new wireline broadband network technologies at a reasonable cost and availability and success of new products and services to be rolled out using such network technologies; network reliability and change management; self-learning tools and automation that may change the way we interact with customers; and uncertainties around our strategy to replace certain legacy wireline network technologies, systems and services to reduce operating costs.

 

·                   Capital expenditure levels and potential outlays for spectrum licences in spectrum auctions or from third parties , due to: our broadband initiatives, including connecting more homes and businesses directly to fibre; our ongoing deployment of newer wireless technologies, including wireless small cells to improve coverage and capacity and prepare for a more efficient and timely evolution to 5G wireless services; utilizing acquired spectrum; investments in network resiliency and reliability; subscriber demand for data; evolving systems and business processes; implementing efficiency initiatives; supporting large complex deals; and future wireless spectrum auctions held by Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada (ISED) including the 600 MHz spectrum auction scheduled to take place in March 2019 which will result in increased expenditures. Our capital expenditure levels could be impacted if we do not achieve our targeted operational and financial results.

 

·                   Operational performance and business combination risks including: our reliance on legacy systems and ability to implement and support new products and services and business operations in a timely manner; our ability to implement effective change management for system replacements and upgrades, process redesigns and business integrations (such as our ability to successfully integrate acquisitions, complete divestitures or establish partnerships in a timely manner, and realize expected strategic benefits, including those following compliance with any regulatory orders); our ability to identify and manage new risks inherent to new service offerings that we may provide, including as a result of acquisitions, which could result in damage to our brand, our business in the relevant area or as a whole, additional exposure to litigation or regulatory proceedings; and real estate joint venture risks.

 

·                   Data protection including risks that malfunctions or unlawful acts could result in the unauthorized access to, change, loss, or distribution of data, which may compromise the privacy of individuals and could result in financial loss and harm to our reputation and brand.

 

·                   Security threats including intentional damage or unauthorized access to our physical assets or our IT systems and networks, which could prevent us from providing reliable service or result in unauthorized access to our information or that of our customers.

 

·                   Ability to successfully implement cost reduction initiatives and realize planned savings, net of restructuring and other costs, without losing customer service focus or negatively affecting business operations . Examples of these initiatives are: our operating efficiency and effectiveness program to drive improvements in financial results; business integrations; business product simplification; business process outsourcing; offshoring and reorganizations, including any full-time equivalent (FTE) employee reduction programs; procurement initiatives; and real estate rationalization.

 

·                   Implementation of large enterprise deals , which may be adversely impacted by available resources, system limitations and degree of co-operation from other service providers.

 

·                   Foreign operations and our ability to successfully manage operations in foreign jurisdictions, including managing risks such as currency fluctuations.

 

·                   Business continuity events including: our ability to maintain customer service and operate our network in the event of human error or human-caused threats, such as cyberattacks and equipment failures that could cause various degrees of network outages; supply chain disruptions, delays and economics including as a result of government restrictions or trade actions; natural disaster threats; epidemics; pandemics; political instability in certain international locations; information security and privacy breaches, including data loss or theft of data; and the completeness and effectiveness of business continuity and disaster recovery plans and responses.

 

·                   Human resource matters including: recruitment, retention and appropriate training in a highly competitive industry, and the level of employee engagement.

 

·                   Financing and debt requirements including: our ability to carry out financing activities, our ability to refinance our maturing debt, our ability to maintain investment grade credit ratings in the range of BBB+ or the equivalent. Our business plans and growth could be negatively affected if existing financing is not sufficient to cover our funding requirements.

 

 

3


 

·                   Lower than planned free cash flow could constrain our ability to invest in operations, reduce debt or return capital to shareholders, and could affect our ability to sustain our dividend growth program through 2019 . This program may be affected by factors such as the competitive environment, economic performance in Canada, our earnings and free cash flow, our levels of capital expenditures and spectrum licence purchases, acquisitions, the management of our capital structure, and regulatory decisions and developments. Quarterly dividend decisions are subject to assessment and determination by our Board of Directors (Board) based on our financial position and outlook. Shares may be purchased under our normal course issuer bid (NCIB) when and if we consider it opportunistic, based on our financial position and outlook, and the market price of TELUS shares. There can be no assurance that our dividend growth program or any NCIB will be maintained, not changed and/or completed through 2019.

 

·                   Taxation matters including: interpretation of complex domestic and foreign tax laws by the relevant tax authorities that may differ from our interpretations; the timing and character of income and deductions, such as tax depreciation and operating expenses; tax credits or other attributes; changes in tax laws, including tax rates; tax expenses being materially different than anticipated, including the taxability of income and deductibility of tax attributes; elimination of income tax deferrals through the use of different tax year-ends for operating partnerships and corporate partners; and changes to the interpretation of tax laws, including as a result of changes to applicable accounting standards or tax authorities adopting more aggressive auditing practices, tax reassessments or adverse court decisions impacting the tax payable by us.

 

·                   Litigation and legal matters including: our ability to successfully respond to investigations and regulatory proceedings; our ability to defend against existing and potential claims and lawsuits (including intellectual property infringement claims and class actions based on consumer claims, data, privacy or security breaches and secondary market liability), or to negotiate and execute upon indemnity rights or other protections in respect of such claims and lawsuits; and the complexity of legal compliance in domestic and foreign jurisdictions, including compliance with competition, anti-bribery and foreign corrupt practices laws.

 

·                   Health, safety and the environment including: lost employee work time resulting from illness or injury, public concerns related to radio frequency emissions, environmental issues affecting our business including climate change, waste and waste recycling, risks relating to fuel systems on our properties, and changing government and public expectations regarding environmental matters and our responses.

 

·                   Economic growth and fluctuations including: the state of the economy in Canada, which may be influenced by economic and other developments outside of Canada, including potential outcomes of yet unknown policies and actions of foreign governments; future interest rates; inflation; unemployment levels; effects of fluctuating oil prices; effects of low business spending (such as reducing investments and cost structure); pension investment returns, funding and discount rates; and fluctuations in foreign exchange rates of the currencies in the regions in which we operate, and the impact of tariffs on trade between Canada and the U.S. as well as global implications of a trade conflict between the U.S. and China.

 

These risks are described in additional detail in Section 9 General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings and Section 10 Risks and risk management in our 2018 Management’s discussion and analysis (MD&A). Those descriptions are incorporated by reference in this cautionary statement but are not intended to be a complete list of the risks that could affect the Company.

 

Many of these factors are beyond our control or our current expectations or knowledge. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial may also have a material adverse effect on our financial position, financial performance, cash flows, business or reputation. Except as otherwise indicated in this document, the forward-looking statements made herein do not reflect the potential impact of any non-recurring or special items or any mergers, acquisitions, dispositions or other business combinations or transactions that may be announced or that may occur after the date of this document.

 

Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements in this document describe our expectations and are based on our assumptions as at the date of this document and are subject to change after this date. Except as required by law, we disclaim any intention or obligation to update or revise any forward-looking statements.

 

This cautionary statement qualifies all of the forward-looking statements in this Annual Information Form.

 

 

4


 

2 .               TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

Page reference

 

 

 

 

Incorporated by reference
from the 2018 annual

Item

 

Annual
Information
Form

 

Management’s
discussion
and analysis 
1

 

Financial
statements 
1

1                  CAUTION REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

2

 

 

 

 

2                  TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

5

 

 

 

 

3                  CORPORATE STRUCTURE

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.1                  Name, address and incorporation

 

6

 

 

 

 

3.2                  Intercorporate relationships

 

6

 

 

 

 

4                  GENERAL DEVELOPMENT OF BUSINESS

 

 

 

 

 

 

4.1                  Three-year history

 

6

 

6, 15, 16,
36, 40

 

 

5                  DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS

 

 

 

 

 

 

5.1                  Who we are

 

10

 

 

 

 

(a)                    Organization

 

10

 

28

 

 

(b)                    Our strategy

 

10

 

15

 

 

(c)                     Business overview

 

10

 

6, 19, 22, 30, 36, 40, 58, 67

 

 

(d)                    Competitive environment

 

10

 

19, 78

 

 

(e)                     Corporate social responsibility

 

10

 

95

 

 

(f)                      Employee relations

 

11

 

22

 

 

5.2                  Risk factors

 

11

 

75

 

 

5.3                  Regulation

 

11

 

72, 76

 

 

6                  DIVIDENDS AND DISTRIBUTIONS

 

11

 

49

 

Note 13, pg. 43

7                  DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STRUCTURE

 

 

 

 

 

 

7.1                  General description of capital structure

 

12

 

25, 76

 

 

7.2                  Constraints

 

13

 

78

 

 

7.3                  Ratings

 

14

 

49, 52

 

 

8                  MARKET FOR SECURITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

8.1                  Trading price and volume

 

16

 

 

 

 

8.2                  Prior sales

 

16

 

 

 

Note 26, pg. 64

9                  DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

 

 

 

 

 

 

9.1                  Name, occupation and security holding

 

17

 

 

 

 

9.2                  Cease trade orders, bankruptcies, penalties or sanctions

 

18

 

 

 

 

10           LEGAL PROCEEDINGS AND REGULATORY ACTIONS

 

19

 

93

 

Note 29, pg. 68

11           INTEREST OF MANAGEMENT AND OTHERS IN MATERIAL TRANSACTIONS

 

19

 

 

 

 

12           TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR

 

19

 

 

 

 

13           MATERIAL CONTRACTS

 

19

 

 

 

 

14           INTERESTS OF EXPERT

 

19

 

 

 

 

15           AUDIT COMMITTEE

 

19

 

 

 

 

16           ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

21

 

 

 

 

APPENDIX A: TERMS OF REFERENCE FOR THE AUDIT COMMITTEE

 

22

 

 

 

 

 


(1) As filed on SEDAR on February 14, 2019

 

Each Section of the Management’s Discussion and Analysis for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018 ( 2018 annual MD&A), referred to in this Annual Information Form (AIF) is incorporated by reference and filed on SEDAR at sedar.com. For greater certainty, notwithstanding references to TELUS’ information circular, consolidated financial statements, sustainability report and the telus.com website, these documents and website are not incorporated into this AIF.

 

In this AIF, except where otherwise indicated, all references to dollars or $ are to Canadian dollars.

 

 

5


 

3 .               CORPORATE STRUCTURE

 

3.1        Name, address and incorporation

 

TELUS was incorporated under the Company Act (British Columbia) (the B.C. Company Act) on October 26, 1998, under the name BCT.TELUS Communications Inc. (BCT). On January 31, 1999, pursuant to a court-approved plan of arrangement under the Canada Business Corporations Act among BCT, BC TELECOM Inc. (BC TELECOM) and the former Alberta-based TELUS Corporation (TC), BCT acquired all of the shares of BC TELECOM and TC in exchange for common shares, and non-voting shares of BCT and BC TELECOM were dissolved. On May 3, 2000, BCT changed its name to TELUS Corporation and in February 2005, the Company transitioned under the Business Corporations Act (British Columbia), successor to the B.C. Company Act. On February 4, 2013, in accordance with the terms of a court approved plan of arrangement under the Business Corporations Act (British Columbia), TELUS exchanged all of its issued and outstanding Non-Voting Shares into Common Shares on a one-for-one basis. On April 16, 2013, TELUS subdivided its Common Shares on a two-for-one basis.

 

TELUS maintains its registered office at Floor 7, 510 West Georgia, Vancouver, British Columbia (B.C.) and its executive office at Floor 23, 510 West Georgia, Vancouver, B.C.

 

3.2        Intercorporate relationships and TELUS subsidiaries

 

TELUS’ wireless and wireline businesses are primarily operated through TELUS Communications Inc (TCI).

 

TCI is the only subsidiary that owned assets constituting more than 10% of the consolidated assets of TELUS and that generated sales and operating revenues that exceeded 10% of the consolidated sales and operating revenues of TELUS for the year ended December 31, 2018. In addition, all of the assets, sales and operating revenues of TELUS’ other subsidiaries (other than TCI), together did not exceed 20% of TELUS’ total consolidated assets or 20% of TELUS’ total consolidated sales and operating revenues as at December 31, 2018.

 

The following organization chart sets forth the relationships between the major subsidiaries, as well as their respective jurisdictions of incorporation or establishment and TELUS ownership as at December 31, 2018.

 

 

4.               GENERAL DEVELOPMENT OF THE BUSINESS

 

4.1        Three-year history

 

During the three-year period ended on December 31, 2018, we continued to advance our national growth strategy, guided by our six strategic imperatives and our corporate priorities.

 

Focusing relentlessly on growth markets of data, IP and wireless

 

External wireless revenues and wireline data revenues were $12.9 billion in 2018, up by $1.0 billion or 8.3% from 2017. The results for 2017, excluding the effects of IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers , had increased by $622 million or 5.6% from 2016. In total, 2018 external wireless revenues and wireline data revenues, excluding the effects of IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers , have grown by 13.8% since 2016. Excluding the effects of IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers , wireless and wireline data revenues combined represented 90% of TELUS’ consolidated revenues in 2018, up from 89% in 2017, and 87% in 2016.The trend in wireless network revenue reflects growth in our subscriber base, as well as higher-value smartphones in the gross additions and retention mix. The general trend of year-over-year increases in subscriber net additions resulted from continuous improvements in the speed and quality of our networks, success of our promotions, including marketing efforts focused on higher-value postpaid loading, coupled with the effects of market growth arising from a growing population, changing population demographics and an increasing number of customers with multiple devices, combined with our focus on executing customers first initiatives. For further detail on our wireless growth trends, see Section 5.4 - Wireless segment of our 2018 annual MD&A.

 

The trend of increasing wireline service revenue reflects growth in high-speed Internet and enhanced data services, customer care and business services (CCBS) (formerly business process outsourcing), TELUS TV

 

 

6


 

revenues, TELUS Health revenues, and home and business security revenues.  That trend is partly offset by declining wireline voice revenues and equipment revenues and inherently lower margins within some of our newer products and services. The increases in Internet and TV service revenues are being generated by subscriber growth and higher Internet revenue per customer from upgrades to faster speeds and larger data usage rate plans. The general trend of increasing TELUS Health revenues has been driven by organic growth and through business acquisitions. The trend of declining wireline voice revenues is due to technological substitution, greater use of inclusive long distance coupled with lower long distance minutes used, and intensification of competition in the small and medium-sized business market. For further detail on our wireline growth trends, see Section 5.5 - Wireline segment of our 2018 annual MD&A .

 

The following discussion relates to 2016 and 2017 events and conditions.

For a review of the events and conditions that influenced our general development during 2018, and how our business has continued to evolve, please see Section 1.2 - The environment in which we operate , Section 2.2 - Strategic imperatives , as well as progress on our corporate priorities in Section 3 - Corporate priorities of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

Providing integrated solutions that differentiate TELUS from our competitors

 

In 2016, we began offering high-speed Internet access over wireless LTE to customers in select rural areas in our Western wireline markets, a significant speed and experience upgrade from dial-up Internet.

 

We launched Optik TV® 4K in mid-2016 and were the first carrier in Western Canada to offer 4K programming to customers with an Optik TV 4K set-top box. Those customers who also have a Netflix Premium subscription can stream Netflix 4K content directly through their 4K set-top box.

 

In 2016, we launched Premium Plus wireless plans — allowing customers to get more affordable high-end devices, which results in a greater subsidy but higher ARPU over time, and further extended Easy Roam to over one hundred international destinations.

 

In 2016, we made a significant investment in our corporate stores, transforming over one hundred locations to a new “digital life” format, featuring connected accessories and devices, and opening five “Connected Experience” flagship-style stores. These stores showcase TELUS’ innovative products and services and strategically align to evolving retail needs and user experiences.

 

Growth continued for TELUS International in 2017, TELUS’ global CCBS and digital services provider. TELUS International now has more than 32,000 team members in 10 countries across North and Central America, Asia and Europe supporting customers in more than 40 languages.  TELUS International offers voice and non-voice customer interaction services and designs, builds and delivers next-generation digital solutions covering digital transformation, IT lifecycle, advisory and digital consulting, risk management, and back-office support.   This is provided across fast-growing technology, financial services, communications, gaming, travel/hospitality and healthcare industries.

 

In May 2017, we launched Pik TV™, which provides customers with access to 23 basic local and regional cable channels and a choice of five specialty channels, as well as sports and movie theme pack options, through a self-install media box, Apple TV, or through an Internet browser or our Android or iOS mobile applications. On demand channels, as well as popular over-the-top (OTT) services and certain other apps, are also available. The Pik TV app lets customers watch certain channels on the go on their tablet or smartphone. Pik TV was created to embrace the changing environment where content is available from many alternatives by providing a streamlined offer for customers who may have otherwise ceased and/or never subscribed for TV services.

 

In 2017, we expanded our cloud communications solutions with the launch of TELUS Business Connect Mobile ® , an all-in-one integrated mobile solution designed to drive productivity and cost savings for businesses.

 

We launched Network as a Service (NaaS) in 2017, further solidifying our position in the Canadian business telecom market. NaaS makes it easy for Canadian businesses to deploy and optimize their own secure and reliable software defined networks quickly, easily and cost-effectively through a flexible self-serve cloud-based platform.

 

In 2017, we made YouTube available on all Optik TV 4K digital boxes. As a result, a subscription to 4K content or a 4K-capable TV is no longer required to access the YouTube app on Optik TV.

 

Building national capabilities across data, IP, voice and wireless

 

In 2016, we concluded a spectrum licence assignment and rationalization agreement with Xplornet Communications Inc., a Canadian-based broadband Internet provider. Under this agreement, we transferred 3500 MHz fixed wireless access spectrum licences in select secondary and tertiary regions, as well as monetary consideration, in exchange for Xplornet’s 2300 MHz spectrum licences in similar regions. This spectrum licence exchange will allow for more robust mobile and fixed wireless broadband access for Canadians, as each party in the transaction can more effectively utilize these licences within its respective network. The 2300 MHz spectrum has a robust ecosystem of network infrastructure and devices, and complements our existing 2300 MHz spectrum holdings in Montreal, Quebec City and key markets in Western Canada, giving us use of the spectrum in this band in nearly every market.

 

 

7


 

Throughout 2017 , we continued our long-term strategy of investing in urban and rural communities with commitments to deliver broadband network capabilities to as many Canadians as possible. We expanded our TELUS PureFibre™ footprint by connecting more homes and businesses directly to fibre-optic cable and delivering faster broadband Internet speeds.

 

Highlights include:

 

·                       In January 2017, we announced an investment of $250 million in the city of Surrey, B.C. to connect more than 90% of homes and businesses to the TELUS PureFibre network before the end of 2018.

·                       In February 2017, we announced investments of $55 million and $150 million in the cities of Chilliwack, B.C. and Burnaby, B.C., respectively, to connect more than 90% of homes and businesses to the TELUS PureFibre network before the end of 2018 and 2019, respectively.

·                       In April 2017, we announced fibre-optic investments in the province of Quebec, including $80 million in the Quebec City region, $30 million in the Lower St. Lawrence region, $30 million in the Gaspé Peninsula and $15 million in the North Shore region, and we expect to connect 99% of Eastern Quebec before the end of 2021.

·                       In October 2017, we announced an investment of $60 million in the Alberta towns of Okotoks, Black Diamond and Turner Valley to connect more than 90% of homes and businesses to the TELUS PureFibre network before the end of 2019.

·                       In 2017, we completed our previously announced investment to connect the city of Kitimat, B.C. to the TELUS PureFibre network.

 

In June 2017, we completed our initiative in Ontario and Quebec to update our radio access technology to the latest wireless technologies, improving network performance for our customers and enabling advanced capabilities.

 

During 2017, we made network enhancement investments in Manitoba to improve coverage, speed and capacity in order to significantly enhance our customer experience and supplement the business acquisition of MTS subscribers, dealers and network.

 

In 2017, together with our lead vendor, we successfully completed a 5G wireless connection using the global 3GPP technology standards platform in our 5G Living Lab in Vancouver.

 

In 2017, we successfully completed Canada’s first test of licensed assisted access (LAA) on indoor and outdoor live networks. The test delivered wireless download speeds of 970 Mbps indoors and 966 Mbps outdoors using 80MHz of aggregated spectrum in a live, dynamic production network. LAA technology will enhance the TELUS network as it continues to evolve towards next-generation 5G speeds, bringing customers higher throughput and a better overall network experience as we deploy the technology into our network in the coming years.

 

We successfully completed a live-environment mobile broadband test using 3.5 GHz spectrum and achieved download speeds eclipsing 2 Gbps in suburban northwest Edmonton in 2017. The 3.5 GHz spectrum will enable future 5G networks to deliver faster speeds in more places.

 

We expanded our voice over LTE (VoLTE) coverage nationally, excluding the province of Saskatchewan and some parts of Manitoba as at the end of 2017.

 

Partnering, acquiring and divesting to accelerate the implementation of our strategy and focus our resources on core business

 

In March 2016, the Canada Green Building Council awarded leadership in energy and environmental design (LEED) platinum certification to our TELUS Garden TM  office tower in Vancouver, housing our global headquarters as well as other tenants. This is the highest LEED rating a building can receive, demonstrating our commitment to technological innovation and environmental stewardship. In partnership with Westbank Projects Corp., the one-million-square-foot TELUS Garden development includes 450,000 square feet of office space, 65,000 square feet of retail space, and a 53-storey residential tower that was officially opened in June 2016.

 

In 2016, we partnered with Microsoft and Avanade, a leading global provider of innovative digital business and technology services in the Microsoft ecosystem, to offer Skype for Business. Powered by TELUS, Skype for Business offers a full suite of enterprise-grade communication and collaboration tools that includes voice and video calls, instant messaging and online meetings. This service is delivered as a fully managed private cloud solution over our network of intelligent Internet data centres located across Canada, and is available through a single interface on almost all devices.

 

In 2016, the Company announced an agreement with BCE Inc. (“BCE”), pursuant to which we would acquire a portion of Manitoba Telecom Services Inc.’s (“MTS”) postpaid wireless subscribers and dealer locations in Manitoba, dependent on the successful completion of BCE’s acquisition of MTS, and subject to regulatory approvals. On February 15, 2017, BCE announced that it had received approval from the Competition Bureau and on April 1, 2017, we acquired certain assets of Manitoba Telecom Services Inc. (MTS) from BCE Inc. These assets included postpaid wireless subscribers, certain network assets and rights to 15 retail locations in Manitoba. Pursuant to this acquisition, in the second quarter of 2017, we commenced the migration of postpaid wireless subscribers to TELUS. The final price of the transactions with BCE Inc. varied depending upon the actual number of qualifying postpaid wireless subscribers acquired, with a total migration of approximately 74,000 postpaid subscribers concluded by March 31, 2018.

 

 

8


 

In 2016, we announced the completion of an agreement with Baring Private Equity Asia (Baring Asia), under which it has acquired an initial 35% non-controlling interest in TELUS International (Cda) Inc. (TELUS International), a global provider of customer service, information technology (IT) and business process outsourcing services.

 

During the past three years, we continued to advance our position in healthcare information management with the following acquisitions:

 

·                   In 2016, we acquired the Canadian business operations of Nightingale Informatix Corp., including its customer base and proprietary EMR software.

·                   In 2016, we acquired the business operations of Osler Systems Management, including its customer base and proprietary EMR software.

 

In 2017, we completed the acquisition of Kroll Computer Systems Inc. to enhance our geographic reach and the quality of our product offering as a national pharmacy management services provider. In 2017, we acquired 55% of Voxpro and approximately 2,700 Voxpro team members joined us through our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. subsidiary upon acquisition. The Ireland-headquartered company now operates as Voxpro — powered by TELUS International.

 

Going to market as one team under a common brand, executing a single strategy

 

Our team works together to implement our top corporate priority: putting customers first, as we strive to consistently deliver exceptional client experiences and become the most recommended company in the markets we serve. The Commission for Complaints for Telecom-television Services (CCTS) annual reports have indicated the successful results of this strategy.

 

In the November 2016 CCTS report for the 12-month period ended July 31, 2016, TELUS once again received the fewest customer complaints among all national carriers. TELUS, Koodo® and Public Mobile were the subjects of 7.0%, 2.5% and 0.6% of the total customer complaints submitted to the CCTS, respectively, or 10.1% of total customer complaints in the aggregate. In addition, we recorded the lowest postpaid churn among our peers of 0.95% in 2016.

 

In the November 2017 CCTS report for the 12-month period ended July 31, 2017, TELUS continued to receive the fewest customer complaints of the national carriers, while Koodo® continued to receive the fewest customer complaints of the national flanker brands. TELUS, Koodo and Public Mobile were the subjects of 6.9%, 2.9% and 1.1% of the total customer complaints accepted by the CCTS, respectively, or 10.9% of total customer complaints, in aggregate, when we have approximately 28% of Canadian wireless customers.

 

Investing in internal capabilities to build a high-performance culture and efficient operation

 

In the fourth quarter of 2016, we recorded an expense of $305 million in respect of immediately vesting transformative compensation (transformative compensation) paid to substantially all of our existing unionized and non-unionized Canadian-situated workforces; a portion of the after-tax value for certain lump-sum recipients was paid in Common Shares purchased in the market for that purpose under our normal course issuer bid (NCIB) by an employee benefit plan trust. The one-time payment to unionized employees in the fourth quarter of 2016 represents both a one-time payment in lieu of wage increases for the period July 1, 2016 to December 31, 2018 (a period of 30 months) and a one-time payment as compensation for reductions in certain premium payments and paid time-off provisions that underpin future productivity improvements. A similar approach with respect to salary increases was adopted for management employees. For most of our current Canadian-situated management employees, there was a one-time payment in the fourth quarter of 2016 in lieu of general salary increases for 2017 and 2018. For the unionized and non-unionized workforces, approximately 40% of the after-tax value of such qualifying lump-sum payments was paid in our Common Shares.

 

Each year, we conduct team member Pulsecheck engagement surveys, administered by Aon Hewitt, to gather confidential team member feedback about TELUS as a place to work and measure our progress in establishing a high-performance culture. Following each survey, business units and departments make use of their Pulsecheck results to review their current action plans and prioritize their ongoing actions. In 2016, our employee engagement score placed us within the top quartile of all employers surveyed on a global basis. In 2017, our employee engagement score increased to 84%, elevating our high-performance culture and placing our Company within the top 10% of all employers surveyed on a global basis.

 

In 2017, our Work Styles® program saw nearly 70% of eligible team members work outside TELUS offices at least part of the week.

 

In 2017, TELUS was named one of Canada’s Top 100 Employers and one of Canada’s Best Diversity Employers for the eighth consecutive year.

 

 

9


 

5.               DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS

 

5.1        Who we are

 

TELUS is one of Canada’s largest telecommunications companies, providing a wide range products and services, including wireless and wireline voice and data. Data services include: Internet protocol (IP); television; hosting, managed information technology and cloud-based services; healthcare solutions; CCBS; and home and business security. In 2018, we generated $14.4 billion in revenue and had 13.4 million subscriber connections. This included 9.2 million wireless subscribers, 1.9 million high-speed Internet subscribers, 1.2 million wireline residential network access lines, and 1.1 million TELUS TV subscribers.

 

(a)   Organization

 

Please see Section 5 - Discussion of Operations of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference and describes our operating segments — wireless and wireline.

 

(b)          Our strategy

 

Please see Section 2 - Core business and strategy of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

(c)           Business overview

 

Please see Section 4 - Capabilities of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference which describes our principal markets, products and services and our distribution channels.

 

Our assets and resources, including employees, brand and distribution methods, tangible properties (such as our telecommunications networks and network facilities), intangible properties (such as brand and wireless spectrum licences) and an overview of foreign operations are discussed in Section 4.2 - Operational resources in the 2018 annual MD&A .

 

For revenue and other financial information on the two most recently completed financial years with respect to our wireless and wireline businesses, see Section 5.4 Wireless segment and Section 5.5 Wireline segment in the 2018 annual MD&A .

 

An overview of the Canadian economic environment and the telecommunications industry can be found in Section 1.2 The environment in which we operate and Section 9 General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings in the 2018 annual MD&A . Seasonal trends that have impacted us are described in Section 5.2 Summary of consolidated quarterly results, trends and fourth quarter recap and in Section 5.4 Wireless segment in the 2018 annual MD&A .

 

(d)          Competitive environment

 

Please see Sections 4.1 - Principal markets addressed and competition and 10.2 Competitive environment of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

(e)           Corporate social responsibility and environment

 

We are committed to following sustainable and responsible business practices and to making decisions that balance economic growth with social and environmental benefits. More information about corporate social responsibility and environmental compliance at TELUS can be found in our annual Sustainability Reports.

 

TELUS has a strong foundation of sustainability governance which supports our commitment to environmental stewardship and responsible corporate citizenship. This governance includes developing and implementing effective strategies, assessing and managing risks (including climate-related risks), setting targets and objectives as well as reporting on our progress and performance.

 

We offer a number of technology solutions and programs that address social opportunities within our communities including Mobility for Good™, Internet for Good™, Health for Good™, Assistive Tech for Good™, TELUS Wise® and TELUS Days of Giving®. Details can be found at community.telus.com.

 

We understand our operations can have an impact on the environment and our Environmental Policy and Environmental Management System, certified to the ISO 14001:2015 standard, act as a guide and framework in which we manage and report on environmental risk.

 

We also understand there can be a financial impact on our operations from climate-related risks and opportunities. Therefore, we have disclosed relevant governance practices, strategies, risk management activities and targets in our Sustainability Report and in summary herein.

 

Governance

 

The Corporate Governance Committee of the Board of Directors has an expanded risk oversight role, which includes corporate social responsibility and environment matters, including impacts of climate change. Included in this

 

 

10


 

mandate are quarterly reviews of our Enterprise Risk Management and Governance practices and outcomes, as well as reviews of corporate social responsibility and environmental compliance reports.

 

Our management team regularly assesses and manages climate-related risks in a variety of ways including:

 

·                   Having a sustainability index, including environmental and social metrics, on our corporate scorecard;

·                   Benchmarking through formal and informal materiality assessments; and

·                   Data and scenario analysis processes.

 

Strategy

 

Our climate-related risk strategy includes a mitigation component focusing on absolute energy use and carbon dioxide emission (CO2e) equivalent reduction, an adaptation component focusing on business continuity planning and readiness for the potential physical risks of a changing climate on our operations and an innovation component to help customers realize their climate change targets through product and service solutions such as video conferencing.

 

Risk Management

 

Climate-related risks are assessed in our Enterprise Risk Governance and Management processes, which includes Board and Executive Leadership Team oversight, and are described in Section 10.1 Overview of our 2018 annual MD&A and updated in our quarterly MD&A as required.

 

Metrics and Targets

 

To demonstrate our commitment to reducing our impact on climate change, we have the following goals:

 

·                   reduce our absolute domestic energy consumption by 10 per cent from 2010 levels by 2020

·                   reduce our absolute domestic greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions by 25 per cent from 2010 levels by 2020.

 

We support the United Nations Global Compact (UNGC) Principles on the environment, and our targets are aligned in support of UN Sustainable Development Goal 13.

 

Disclosure of our Scope 1, Scope 2 and Scope 3 GHG emissions, as well as data and performance details can be found in our Sustainability Report.

 

(f)            Employee relations

 

Please see Section 4.2 - Operational resources of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

5.2        Risk factors

 

Please see Section 10 - Risks and risk management of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

5.3        Regulation

 

Please see Sections 9.4 - Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings and 10.2 - Regulatory Matters of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

6.               DIVIDENDS AND DISTRIBUTIONS

 

The dividends per Common Share declared with respect to each quarter by TELUS, during the three-year period ended December 31, 2018, are shown below:

 

Quarter ended  1

 

2018

 

2017

 

2016

 

March 31

 

$

0.5050

 

$

0.4800

 

$

0.44

 

June 30

 

$

0.5250

 

$

0.4925

 

$

0.46

 

September 30

 

$

0.5250

 

$

0.4925

 

$

0.46

 

December 31

 

$

0.5450

 

$

0.5050

 

$

0.48

 

Total

 

$

2.10

 

$

1.97

 

$

1.84

 

 


(1)          Paid on or about the first business day of the next month.

 

Our shareholders received a total of $2.10 per share in declared dividends in 2018, an increase of 6.6% from 2017. Our Board reviews the dividend rate quarterly. Our quarterly dividend rate will depend on an ongoing assessment of free cash flow generation and financial indicators including leverage, dividend yield and payout ratio. On February 13, 2019, a first quarter dividend of $0.5450 per share was declared, payable on April 1, 2019, to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 11, 2019. The first quarter dividend for 2019 reflects a cumulative increase of $0.04 per share from the $0.5050 per share dividend paid in April 2018, consistent with our multi-year dividend growth program.

 

11


 

We first announced our dividend growth program in May 2011. In May 2016, we announced our intention to target ongoing semi-annual dividend increases, with the annual increase in the range of 7 to 10% from 2017 through to the end of 2019, thereby extending the policy first announced in May 2011. Notwithstanding this target, dividend decisions will continue to be subject to our Board’s assessment and the determination of our financial position and outlook on a quarterly basis. Our Board’s assessments resulted in 12 semi-annual dividend increases from 2011 to 2017, with annual increases being approximately 7-10%. Our long-term dividend payout ratio guideline is 65 to 75% of prospective net earnings per share. See Section 7.5 - Liquidity and capital resources measures of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.  Based on dividends announced as of February 14, 2019, and 599 million shares outstanding at December 31, 2018, dividend declarations would total approximately $1.3 billion in 2019, before taking into account any Common Shares purchased and cancelled under our 2019 NCIB. There can be no assurance that we will maintain a dividend growth program through 2019.

 

7.               DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STRUCTURE

 

7.1 General description of capital structure

 

The authorized capital of TELUS consists of 4,000,000,000 shares, divided into: (1) 2,000,000,000 Common Shares without par value; (2) 1,000,000,000 First Preferred shares without par value, issuable in series and; (3) 1,000,000,000 Second Preferred shares without par value, issuable in series. The Common Shares are listed for trading on the Toronto Stock Exchange (TSX) and the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE).

 

Common Shares

 

Subject to the prior rights of the holders of First Preferred shares and Second Preferred shares, the Common Shares are entitled to participate with respect to the payment of dividends as declared by the Board and the distribution of assets of TELUS on the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of TELUS.

 

The holders of the Common Shares are entitled to receive notice of, attend, be heard and vote at any general meeting of the shareholders of TELUS on the basis of one vote per Common Share held. Holders of Common Shares are entitled to vote by a separate resolution for each director rather than a slate.

 

The Common Shares are subject to constraints on transfer to ensure our ongoing compliance with the Canadian ownership and control requirements of the Telecommunications Act and the Direction to the CRTC (Ineligibility of Non-Canadians) under the Broadcasting Act as noted in Constraints — Canadian ownership and control requirements on page 13.

 

Please see Sections 9.4 - Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings and 10.2 - Regulatory Matters of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

First Preferred shares

 

The First Preferred shares may be issued from time to time in one or more series, each series comprising the number of shares, and having attached thereto the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions which the Board determines by resolution and subject to filing an amendment to the Notice of Articles and Articles of TELUS. No series of First Preferred shares may have attached thereto the right to vote at any general meeting of TELUS or the right to be convertible into or exchangeable for Common Shares. Except as required by law, the TELUS holders of the First Preferred shares as a class are not entitled to receive notice of, attend or vote at any meeting of the shareholders of TELUS. The First Preferred shares rank prior to the Second Preferred shares and Common Shares with respect to priority in payment of dividends and in the distribution of assets in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of TELUS.

 

Second Preferred shares

 

The Second Preferred shares may be issued from time to time in one or more series, each series comprising the number of shares, and having attached thereto the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions, which the Board determines by resolution and subject to filing an amendment to the Notice of Articles and Articles of TELUS. No series of Second Preferred shares may have attached thereto the right to vote at any general meeting of TELUS or the right to be convertible into or exchangeable for Common Shares. Except as required by law, the holders of the Second Preferred shares as a class are not entitled to receive notice of, attend or vote at any meeting of the shareholders of TELUS. The Second Preferred shares rank, subject to the prior rights of the holders of the First Preferred shares, prior to the Common Shares with respect to priority in payment of dividends and in the distribution of assets in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of TELUS.

 

A s of February 14, 2019 there are not any preferred shares outstanding.

 

Shareholder rights plan

 

We first adopted a shareholder rights plan in March 2000.  That plan expired on March 20, 2010. The Board adopted a substantially similar shareholder rights plan (Rights Plan) on March 12, 2010 (Effective Date).  That plan was ratified by

 

 

12


 

shareholders of both share classes at the May 2010 annual and special meeting. On May 9, 2013, the holders of the Common Shares approved the amendment of, and reconfirmation of, the Rights Plan, which among other things, reflected the elimination of the Non-Voting Share class from TELUS’ authorized share structure, and at the annual general meeting held on May 5, 2016, the holders of the Common Shares approved the reconfirmation of the Rights Plan. The Rights Plan has a term expiring upon the conclusion of the Company’s annual meeting in 2019

 

Under the current Rights Plan, TELUS issued one right (Right) in respect of each Common Share outstanding as at the Effective Date. The Rights Plan has a term of just over nine years, subject to shareholder confirmation every three years. Each Right, other than those held by an Acquiring Person (as defined in the Rights Plan) and certain of its related parties, entitles the holder in certain circumstances following the acquisition by an Acquiring Person of 20% or more of the Common Shares of TELUS (otherwise than through the “Permitted Bid” requirements of the Rights Plan) to purchase from TELUS $320 worth of Common Shares for $160 (i.e. at a 50% discount) respectively.

 

Normal course issuer bid and shelf prospectus

 

Please see Section 4.3 - Liquidity and capital resources of our 2018 annual MD&A which is hereby incorporated by reference.

 

7.2        Constraints

 

Canadian ownership and control requirements

 

Certain subsidiaries of TELUS Corporation are Canadian carriers, holders of radio authorizations and holders of broadcasting licences, and are required by the Telecommunications Act (Canada) (Telecommunications Act) and the Direction to the CRTC (Ineligibility of Non-Canadians) issued pursuant to the Broadcasting Act (Canada) (Broadcasting Act) to be Canadian-owned and controlled. Under the Telecommunications Act, a Canadian carrier, such as TCI is considered to be Canadian-owned and controlled if:

 

(i)              not less than 80% of the members of its board of directors are individual Canadians;

(ii)           Canadians beneficially own not less than 80% of its voting interests; and

(iii)        it is not otherwise controlled in fact by persons who are not Canadians.

 

Substantially the same rules apply in relation to broadcasting undertakings but an additional requirement set out in the Direction to the CRTC (Ineligibility of Non-Canadians) is that the chief executive officer of a company that is a licensed broadcasting undertaking must be a Canadian citizen or a permanent resident of Canada. TELUS Corporation has filed with the CRTC the requisite documentation affirming TCI’s status as a Canadian carrier. We further intend that TCI will remain controlled by TELUS Corporation and that it will remain “Canadian” for the purposes of Canadian ownership requirements.

 

The Canadian Telecommunications Common Carrier Ownership and Control Regulations (Ownership and Control Regulations), made pursuant to the Telecommunications Act, further provide that in order for a company that holds shares in a carrier (carrier holding corporation) to be considered Canadian, not less than 66-2/3% of the issued and outstanding voting shares of that company must be beneficially owned by Canadians and that such company must not otherwise be controlled in fact by non-Canadians. To the best of our knowledge, Canadians beneficially own and control in the aggregate not less than 66-2/3% of the issued and outstanding Common Shares of TELUS Corporation and TELUS Corporation is not otherwise controlled in fact by non-Canadians. For the purposes of these regulations, “Canadian” means among other things:

 

(i)              a Canadian citizen who is ordinarily resident in Canada;

(ii)           a permanent resident of Canada who is ordinarily resident in Canada and has been so for not more than one year after the date he or she was eligible to apply for Canadian citizenship;

(iii)        a corporation with not less than 66-2/3% of the issued and outstanding voting shares of which are beneficially owned and controlled by Canadians and which is not otherwise controlled in fact by non-Canadians; or

(iv)       a pension fund society the majority of whose members of its board of directors are individual Canadians, and that is established under applicable federal legislation or any provincial legislation relating to the establishment of pension fund societies.

 

The Direction to the CRTC (Ineligibility of Non-Canadians) provides a similar definition of “Canadian” but also includes a “qualified corporation” which can be a subsidiary corporation whose parent corporation or its directors do not exercise control or influence over any programming decisions of the subsidiary corporation where

 

(a)          Canadians beneficially own and control less than 80 per cent of the issued and outstanding voting shares of the parent corporation and less than 80 per cent of the votes,

(b)          the chief executive officer is a non-Canadian, or

(c)           less than 80 per cent of the directors of the parent corporation are Canadian.

 

On August 10, 2017, in response to levels of foreign ownership of shares exceeding 20% and in order to meet the requirements of a “qualified corporation” in accordance with the Direction to the CRTC (Ineligibility of Non-Canadians) , the Board appointed an independent programming committee to make all programming decisions relating to its licensed broadcasting undertakings.

 

 

13


 

The Ownership and Control Regulations provide Canadian carriers and carrier holding corporations, such as TELUS Corporation, with the time and ability to rectify ineligibility resulting from insufficient Canadian ownership of voting interests. Under the Ownership and Control Regulations, such corporations may refuse the subscription, issuance, transfer or purchase of voting interests, if necessary, to ensure that they and their subsidiaries remain eligible under such legislation. For such purposes, in particular but without limitation, a company may, in accordance with the provisions contained in the Ownership and Control Regulations:

 

(i)              refuse to accept any subscription for voting shares;

(ii)           refuse to allow any transfer of voting shares to be recorded in its share register;

(iii)        suspend the rights of a holder of voting shares to vote at a meeting of its shareholders; and

(iv)       sell, repurchase or redeem excess voting shares.

 

To ensure that TELUS Corporation remains Canadian and that any subsidiary of TELUS Corporation, including TCI, is and continues to be eligible to operate as a Canadian carrier under the Telecommunications Act, to be issued radio authorizations under the Radiocommunication Act (Canada) (Radiocommunication Act), or to be issued broadcasting licences under the Broadcasting Act, provisions substantially similar to the foregoing have been incorporated into the Articles of TELUS Corporation permitting its directors to make determinations to effect any of the foregoing actions.

 

In addition, TELUS has systems in place to monitor the level of Canadian ownership of its Common Shares. For registered shareholders and shares trading on the Toronto Stock Exchange, a reservation and declaration system requires non-Canadian purchasers of Common Shares to obtain a reservation number from our transfer agent and registrar, Computershare Trust Company and to declare whether or not the purchaser is a Canadian or non-Canadian. For Common Shares trading on the New York Stock Exchange, non-Canadian ownership is monitored by utilizing the Depository Trust & Clearing Corporation’s SEG-100 Account program. All TELUS Common Shares held by non-Canadians must be transferred to this account (no reservation application is required).

 

The Telecommunications Act was amended in June 2012 to remove foreign ownership restrictions for telecommunications common carriers that hold less than a 10% share of the total Canadian telecommunications services revenues. This change was made to enable non-Canadian owned entities to start up or acquire Canadian carriers that hold less than a 10% share of total Canadian telecommunications services revenues. However, given that TELUS and its affiliates exceed this 10% threshold, we remain subject to the pre-existing Canadian ownership and control restrictions outlined above. Canadian ownership requirements for licensees under the Broadcasting Act remain unchanged.

 

See Section 10.2 Regulatory matters in the 2018 annual MD&A for further details related to regulation generally and specifically in relation to Canadian ownership requirements applicable to Canadian common carriers (Restrictions on foreign ownership).

 

7.3        Ratings

 

The following information relating to our credit ratings is provided as it relates to our financing costs, liquidity and operations. Additional information relating to credit ratings is contained in Section 7.5 - Liquidity and capital resource measures to Section 7.8 - Credit ratings in the 2018 annual MD&A.

 

Credit ratings are important to our borrowing costs and ability to obtain short-term and long-term financing and the cost of such financing. Credit ratings are intended to provide investors with an independent measure of the credit quality of an issue of securities and are indicators of the likelihood of payment and of the capacity of a company to meet its financial commitment on the rated obligation in accordance with the terms of the rated obligation. A reduction in the current rating on our debt by rating agencies, particularly a downgrade below investment grade ratings or a negative change in ratings outlook could adversely affect our cost of financing and our access to sources of liquidity and capital. We believe our investment grade credit ratings, coupled with our efforts to maintain constructive relationships with banks, investors and credit rating agencies, continue to provide TELUS with reasonable access to capital markets. In addition, credit ratings may be important to customers or counterparties when we compete in certain markets and when we seek to engage in certain transactions including transactions involving over-the-counter derivatives. As at December 31, 2018, TCI is a party to an agreement expiring in December 2021, with an arm’s-length securitization trust associated with a major Schedule I bank, under which TCI is able to sell an interest in certain trade receivables up to a maximum of $500 million. TCI is required to maintain at least a BB credit rating by DBRS Ltd. (DBRS) or the securitization trust may require the sale program to be wound down.

 

The rating agencies regularly evaluate TELUS and TCI, and their ratings of our long-term and short-term debt are based on a number of factors, including our financial strength as well as factors not entirely within our control, including conditions affecting the telecommunications industry generally, and the wider state of the economy . The Company’s credit ratings are outlined in the chart below. Credit ratings are not recommendations to purchase, hold or sell securities and do not address the market price or suitability of a specific security for a particular investor. In addition, real or anticipated changes in the rating assigned to a security will generally affect the market value of that security. There can be no assurance that a rating will remain in effect for any given period of time or that a rating will not be revised or withdrawn entirely by a rating agency in the future.

 

 

14


 

Credit rating summary

 

DBRS Ltd.

 

Standard
& Poor’s
Rating
Services

 

Moody’s
Investor
Services

 

FitchRatings

TELUS Corporation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Notes

 

BBB (high)

 

BBB+

 

Baa1

 

BBB+

Commercial paper

 

R-2 (high)

 

A-2

 

P-2

 

TELUS Communications Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Debentures

 

BBB (high)

 

BBB+

 

 

BBB+

 

Institution

 

Rating

DBRS

 

The DBRS® long-term rating scale provides an opinion on the risk of default. That is, the risk that an issuer will fail to satisfy its financial obligations in accordance with the terms under which an obligation has been issued. Ratings are based on quantitative and qualitative considerations relevant to the issuer, and the relative ranking of claims. All rating categories, other than “AAA” and “D”, also contain subcategories “(high)” and “(low)”. The absence of either a “(high)” or “(low)” designation indicates the rating is in the middle of the category.

A “BBB” rating denotes adequate credit quality. The capacity for the payment of financial obligations is considered acceptable. May be vulnerable to future events.

 

 

 

S&P

 

A S&P issue credit rating is a forward-looking opinion about the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to a specific financial obligation, a specific class of financial obligations, or a specific financial program (including ratings on medium-term note programs and commercial paper programs). It takes into consideration the creditworthiness of guarantors, insurers, or other forms of credit enhancement on the obligation and takes into account the currency in which the obligation is denominated. The opinion reflects S&P’s view of the obligor’s capacity and willingness to meet its financial commitments as they come due, and may assess terms, such as collateral security and subordination, which could affect ultimate payment in the event of default.

An obligation rated “BBB” exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity of the obligor to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

The ratings from “AA” to “CCC” may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

 

 

 

Moody’s

 

Moody’s long-term ratings are assigned to issuers or obligations with an original maturity of one year or more and reflect both on the likelihood of a default on contractually promised payments and the expected financial loss suffered in the event of default.

Obligations rated “Baa” are judged to be medium-grade and subject to moderate credit risk and as such may possess certain speculative characteristics.

Moody’s appends numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 to each generic rating classification from “Aa” through “Caa”. The modifier 1 indicates that the obligation ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a mid-range ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates a ranking in the lower end of that generic rating category.

A Moody’s rating outlook is an opinion regarding the likely rating direction over the medium term. A stable outlook indicates a low likelihood of a rating change over the medium term. A negative, positive or developing outlook indicates a higher likelihood of a rating change over the medium term.

 

 

15


 

Institution

 

Rating

Fitch

 

Rated entities in a number of sectors, including financial and non-financial corporations, sovereigns and insurance companies are generally assigned issuer default ratings (“IDRs”). IDRs opine on an entity’s relative vulnerability to default on financial obligations. The “threshold” default risk addressed by the IDR is generally that of the financial obligations whose non-payment would best reflect the uncured failure of that entity. As such, IDRs also address relative vulnerability to bankruptcy, administrative receivership or similar concepts, although the agency recognizes that issuers may also make pre-emptive and therefore voluntary use of such mechanisms. In aggregate, IDRs provide an ordinal ranking of issuers based on the agency’s view of their relative vulnerability to default, rather than a prediction of a specific percentage likelihood of default.

“BBB” ratings indicate that expectations of default risk are currently low. The capacity for payment of financial commitments is considered adequate but adverse business or economic conditions are more likely to impair this capacity.

The modifiers “+” or “-” may be appended to a rating to denote relative status within major rating categories. Such suffixes are not added to the “AAA” Long-Term IDR category, or to Long-Term IDR categories below “B”.

 

As is common practice, during the last two years, each of the above-noted credit rating agencies charged TELUS for their rating services which include annual surveillance fees covering our outstanding long-term and short-term debt securities, in addition to one-time rating fees for certain agencies when debt is initially issued. We reasonably expect that such payments will continue to be made for rating services in the future.

 

8 .               MARKET FOR SECURITIES

 

8.1 Trading Price and Volume

 

TELUS’ Common Shares are listed on the TSX under the symbol “T” and on the NYSE under the symbol “TU”. Monthly share prices and volumes for 2018 are listed below:

 

 

 

TSX — Common Shares

 

NYSE — Common Shares

 

Month

 

High ($)

 

Low ($)

 

Volume

 

High ($U.S.)

 

Low ($U.S.)

 

Volume

 

January

 

47.60

 

45.63

 

19,583,774

 

38.20

 

36.96

 

7,902,762

 

February

 

46.99

 

44.23

 

23,821,218

 

37.54

 

35.06

 

9,011,711

 

March

 

47.49

 

44.18

 

22,698,555

 

36.74

 

34.28

 

9,948,939

 

April

 

46.48

 

44.14

 

14,756,507

 

36.23

 

34.37

 

6,785,814

 

May

 

46.47

 

45.21

 

21,373,899

 

36.08

 

34.93

 

7,034,288

 

June

 

47.15

 

45.52

 

22,682,111

 

35.84

 

34.60

 

7,040,413

 

July

 

48.38

 

46.20

 

13,908,025

 

36.77

 

35.19

 

5,837,417

 

August

 

49.15

 

46.50

 

18,693,677

 

37.70

 

35.83

 

7,636,016

 

September

 

49.11

 

46.80

 

16,321,289

 

37.46

 

36.14

 

7,430,761

 

October 

 

47.75

 

43.88

 

23,435,014

 

37.24

 

33.64

 

10,379,559

 

November

 

47.86

 

44.45

 

26,127,572

 

36.16

 

33.86

 

7,825,552

 

December

 

48.37

 

44.32

 

26,398,725

 

36.49

 

32.46

 

8,333,994

 

 

8.2 Prior Sales

 

On March 1, 2018, under a short form base shelf prospectus filed on August 30, 2016, with securities regulatory authorities in Canada and the United States, TELUS completed two debt offerings: 1) a $600 million offering of 3.625% Notes, Series CX, due March 1, 2028; and 2) a $150 million offering of 4.70% Notes, Series CW, due March 6, 2048.

TELUS renewed its short form base shelf prospectus on May 17, 2018. On June 7, 2018, under the short form base shelf prospectus filed on May 17, 2018, with securities regulatory authorities in Canada and the United States, TELUS issued US$750 million aggregate principal amount of 4.60% notes due November 16, 2048.

Please refer to TELUS Corporation’s 2018 year-end audited consolidated financial statements - Note 26(b) TELUS Corporation Notes for details on our past debt offerings.

In addition, in the ordinary course of business, the Company has the capability to issue commercial paper with maturities of less than 12 months. As at December 31, 2018, the Company had $774 million of commercial paper outstanding, all of which was denominated in U.S. dollars (US$569 million).

 

 

16


 

9 .               DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

 

9.1 Name, occupation and security holding

 

Directors

 

The names, municipalities of residence and principal occupations of the directors of TELUS as at February 14, 2019, the date each such person became a director of TELUS and committee membership are as set out below. Currently, there are 15 directors on the Board. Each was elected at TELUS’ annual general meeting on May 10, 2018, except for Christine Magee and Denise Pickett who were appointed by the Board on August 2, 2018 and November 1, 2018, respectively. Each director’s term of office will expire immediately before the election of directors at the upcoming annual general meeting on May 11, 2019.  They have, however, all been nominated for re-election at the upcoming meeting except for Bill MacKinnon and Sabi Marwah who have decided to retire and will not be seeking re-election at the 2019 annual general meeting. There will be 13 directors nominated for election to the Board at the 2019 annual general meeting.

 

Directors of TELUS
(Name and municipality of residence)

 

Director
since

 

Principal occupation

R.H. (Dick) Auchinleck
Victoria, B.C.

 

2003

 

Chair, TELUS Corporation

Raymond T. Chan 2, 4
Calgary, Alberta

 

2013

 

Independent Lead Director, Baytex Energy Corp.
(oil and natural gas corporation)

Stockwell Day 2, 4 — Chair
Vancouver, B.C.

 

2011

 

Advisor and Consultant

Lisa de Wilde 3,4

Toronto, Ontario

 

2015

 

CEO, Ontario Educational Communications Authority (TVO)

Darren Entwistle
Vancouver, B.C.

 

2000

 

President and Chief Executive Officer, TELUS Corporation

Mary Jo Haddad 2 - Chair
Oakville, Ontario

 

2014

 

Founder and President, MJH & Associates
(strategic leadership and healthcare advisory services)

Kathy Kinloch 2,3

Vancouver, B.C.

 

2017

 

President, British Columbia Institute of Technology

William (Bill) MacKinnon 1
Toronto, Ontario

 

2009

 

Corporate Director

Christine Magee 1

Toronto, Ontario

 

2018

 

Co-Founder and Co-Chair, Sleep Country Canada

John Manley 3 — Chair, 4
Ottawa, Ontario

 

2012

 

Corporate Director

Sabi Marwah 1,3
Toronto, Ontario

 

2015

 

Senator, Senate of Canada

Claude Mongeau 1, 3

Montreal, Quebec

 

2017

 

Corporate Director

David Mowat 1 — Chair, 4

Edmonton, Alberta

 

2016

 

Corporate Director

Marc Parent 2,4
Montreal, Quebec

 

2017

 

President and Chief Executive Officer, CAE Inc.

Denise Pickett 1
Toronto, Ontario

 

2018

 

Chief Risk Officer and President, Global Risk, Banking & Compliance, American Express

 


(1)          Member of Audit Committee

(2)          Member of Human Resources and Compensation Committee

(3)          Member of Corporate Governance Committee

(4)          Member of Pension Committee

 

All of the directors of TELUS have held the principal occupations set forth above or executive positions with the same companies or firms referred to, or with affiliates or predecessors thereof, for the past five years except as follows: David

 

 

17


 

Mowat was President and CEO of ATB Financial from June 2007 to June 2018; Ray Chan was Chair of Baytex Energy Corp from 2014 to 2018; Christine Magee was President of Sleep Country Canada from 1994 to 2014; John Manley was President and Chief Executive Officer of the Business Council of Canada from 2010 to 2018;Sabi Marwah was Vice Chairman and Chief Operating Officer of the Bank of Nova Scotia from 2008 until 2014; and Claude Mongeau was President and Chief Executive Officer of Canadian National Railway Company from 2010 to 2016.

 

Executive officers

 

The name, municipality of residence and principal occupations of each of the executive officers of TELUS, as of February 14, 2019, are as follows:

 

Executive Officers of TELUS
(Name and municipality of residence)

 

Position held with TELUS

Darren Entwistle
Vancouver, B.C.

 

President and Chief Executive Officer

Doug French
Vancouver, B.C.

 

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

Josh Blair
Vancouver, B.C.

 

Executive Vice President, Group President and Chief Corporate Officer

Tony Geheran
Vancouver, B.C.

 

Executive Vice President and Chief Customer Officer

Francois Gratton
Montreal, Quebec

 

Executive Vice President, Group President and Chair TELUS Québec

Stephen Lewis
Vancouver, B.C.

 

Senior Vice President and Treasurer

Zainul Mawji
Edmonton, Alberta

 

President, Home and Small Business Solutions

Sandy McIntosh
Toronto, Ontario

 

Executive Vice President, People and Culture and Chief Human Resources Officer

Jim Senko

Toronto, Ontario

 

President, Mobility Solutions

Eros Spadotto
Oakville, Ontario

 

Executive Vice President, Technology Strategy and Business Transformation

Andrea Wood
Toronto, Ontario

 

Chief Legal and Governance Officer

 

All of the executive officers of TELUS have held their present positions or other executive positions with the Company during the past five years or more.

 

TELUS shares held by directors and executive officers

 

As at February 8, 2019, the directors and executive officers of TELUS, as a group, beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, or exercised control or direction over 784,628 Common Shares, which represented approximately 0.13% of the outstanding Common Shares.

 

9.2 Cease trade orders, bankruptcies, penalties or sanctions

 

Other than as disclosed below, for the 10 years ended February 14, 2019, we are not aware that any current director or executive officer of TELUS had been a director or executive officer of any issuer which, while that person was acting in that capacity, or within a year of that person ceasing to act in that capacity, became bankrupt or made a proposal under any legislation relating to bankruptcy or insolvency or was subject to or instituted any proceedings, arrangement or compromise with creditors or had a receiver, receiver manager or trustee appointed to hold its assets.

 

·                   John Manley and Claude Mongeau were directors of Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks Limited (together, the Nortel Companies) when the Nortel Companies and certain other Canadian subsidiaries initiated creditor protection proceedings under the Companies’ Creditors Arrangement Act in Canada on January 14, 2009. Certain U.S. subsidiaries filed voluntary petitions in the United States under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, and certain European, Middle Eastern and African subsidiaries made consequential filings in Europe and the Middle East. These proceedings are ongoing. Mr. Manley and Mr. Mongeau resigned as directors of the Nortel Companies on August 10, 2009.

 

 

18


 

For the 10 years ended February 14, 2019, we are not aware that any current director or executive officer of TELUS had been a director, chief executive officer or chief financial officer of any issuer which was the subject of a cease trade or similar order while that person was acting in that capacity, or was subject to such an order issued after the director or executive officer ceased to be a director, chief executive officer or chief financial officer and resulted from an event that occurred while that person was acting in that capacity, or any order which denied such company access to any exemption under securities legislation for a period of more than 30 consecutive days.

 

10 .             LEGAL PROCEEDINGS AND REGULATORY ACTIONS

 

 

Legal proceedings are described in Section 10.9 - Litigation and legal matters in the 2018 annual MD&A and in the Company’s December 31, 2018, consolidated financial statements Note 29(a) Claims and lawsuits.

 

From time to time, in the ordinary course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are assessed fees or fines by securities regulatory authorities in relation to administrative matters, including late filing fees or reporting, which may be considered penalties or sanctions pursuant to Canadian securities regulations but which are not, individually or in the aggregate, material to the Company. In addition, the Company and its subsidiaries are subject to numerous regulatory authorities around the world, and fees, administrative penalties, settlement agreements and sanctions may be categorized differently by each regulator. However, during the most recently completed financial year, the Company is not aware of any material (i) penalties or sanctions imposed against us by a court relating to securities legislation or by a securities regulatory authority; (ii) penalties or sanctions imposed by a court or regulatory body against us that would likely be considered important to a reasonable investor in making an investment decision; or (iii) settlement agreements entered into by us before a court relating to securities legislation or with a securities regulatory authority.

 

11 .        INTEREST OF MANAGEMENT AND OTHERS IN MATERIAL TRANSACTIONS

 

To the best of our knowledge, there were no directors or executive officers, or any associate or affiliate of a director or executive officer with a material interest in any transaction within the three most recently completed financial years or during the current financial year that has materially affected or is reasonably expected to materially affect us.

 

12 .        TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR

 

Our transfer agent and registrar is Computershare Trust Company of Canada. Computershare maintains the Company’s registers at 600, 530 - 8th Avenue SW, Calgary, Alberta T2P 3S8.

 

13 .        MATERIAL CONTRACTS

 

TCI is a party to a three-year agreement (expiry December 31, 2021) with an arm’s-length securitization trust associated with a major Schedule I bank, under which TCI is able to sell an interest in certain of its trade receivables up to a maximum of $500 million. TCI is required to maintain at least a BB credit rating by DBRS Ltd. or the securitization trust may require the sale program to be wound down. The necessary credit rating was exceeded throughout its term. This agreement was amended and restated on November 1, 2018 prior to the expiry of the previous term of December 31, 2018.

 

On May 7, 2018, TELUS entered into a replacement five-year $2.25 billion unsecured credit facility (2018 Credit Facility) with a syndicate of financial institutions. The 2018 Credit Facility replaces TELUS’ previous $2.25 billion facility which would have matured in May 2021. The 2018 Credit Facility may be used for general corporate purposes including the backstop of commercial paper. The material terms of the 2018 Credit Facility are substantively the same as TELUS’ previous credit facility other than an extension of the term to May 2023.

 

TELUS has also entered into material contracts in connection with various financings, with the most recent financing on June 7, 2018 in relation to the issuance of US$750 million aggregate principal amount of 4.60% Notes due November 16, 2048.  The applicable trust indenture and supplemental indenture documents in relation to these notes have been filed on SEDAR at www.sedar.com and on EDGAR at www.sec.gov. The terms of the indenture are fully described in our final short form base shelf prospectus dated May 17, 2018 and the terms of the 4.60% Notes and the applicable supplemental indenture are as set forth in the shelf prospectus supplement dated June 7, 2018.

 

14.        INTERESTS OF EXPERT

 

Deloitte LLP, Chartered Professional Accountants, is the auditor of the Company and is independent of the Company within the meaning of the Rules of Professional Conduct of the Chartered Professional Accountants of British Columbia.

 

15.        AUDIT COMMITTEE

 

The Audit Committee of the Company supports the Board in fulfilling its oversight responsibilities regarding the integrity of our accounting and financial reporting, internal controls and disclosure controls, legal and regulatory compliance, ethics policy and timeliness of filings with regulatory authorities, the independence and performance of our external and internal auditors, the management of our risk, credit worthiness, treasury plans and financial policy and whistleblower and complaint procedures. A copy of the Audit Committee’s Terms of Reference is attached as Appendix A to this AIF.

 

GRAPHIC

 

19


 

The current members of the Audit Committee are David Mowat (Chair), Bill MacKinnon, Christine Magee, Sabi Marwah, Claude Mongeau, and Denise Pickett. Each member of the Audit Committee is independent and financially literate within the meaning of Multilateral Instrument 52-110 “Audit Committees” and the Board has determined that David Mowat and Claude Mongeau are the audit committee financial experts and both have accounting or related financial management expertise. The following lists the relevant education and experience of the members of TELUS’ Audit Committee that is relevant to their role on the committee.

 

David Mowat is the Chair of the Audit Committee.  He is the former President and CEO of ATB Financial, a position he has held from June 2007 to June 2018. Prior to that, he was the CEO of Vancouver City Savings Credit Union from 2000 until 2007. In 2015, he was named chair of the Alberta Royalty Review panel. David holds a Bachelor of Commerce from the University of British Columbia. In 2015, he received an Honorary Bachelor of Business Administration from the Southern Alberta Institute of Technology and in 2017 he received an honorary doctorate of laws from the University of Alberta.

 

Bill MacKinnon is the former chair of the Audit Committee. He is the former Chief Executive Officer of KPMG Canada, serving from April 1999, to December 31, 2008. He first joined KPMG Canada in 1971, serving the company in numerous roles of increasing leadership for 37 years, including his membership on the Board of Directors of each of KPMG Canada, KPMG International and KPMG Americas. Mr. MacKinnon obtained a Bachelor of Commerce with Honours from the University of Manitoba in 1967. He is a Chartered Professional Accountant and holds his FCPA designation from the Institute of Chartered Professional Accountants of Ontario.

 

Christine Magee is the Co-Founder and Co-Chair of Sleep Country Canada, a company she co-founded in 1994. From 1982 to 1994 Christine held positions at the National Bank of Canada and Continental Bank of Canada. Christine earned an Honours Degree in Business and Administration from the University of Western Ontario and holds an Honorary Doctorate from Ryerson University.

 

Sabi Marwah retired as the Vice Chairman and Chief Operating Officer of the Bank of Nova Scotia (Scotiabank) in 2014, a position he held since 2008. As Vice Chairman, Sabi was responsible for many of Scotiabank’s corporate financial and administrative functions and was actively involved in developing the bank’s strategic plans and priorities, including acquisitions both in Canada and internationally. His career with Scotiabank spanned 35 years, during which he held several senior positions including Senior Vice-President and Comptroller and Executive Vice-President. He was appointed Chief Financial Officer (CFO) in 1998 and Senior Executive Vice-President and CFO in 2002. Sabi holds a Bachelor of Arts (Economics - Honours) from the University of Calcutta, a Master of Economics from the University of Delhi and an MBA (Finance) from the University of California, Los Angeles (UCLA). He received an Honorary Doctorate of Laws from Ryerson University in 2012 and the University of Ontario Institute Of Technology in 2017. In November 2017, Sabi was appointed as a Senator at the Senate of Canada.

 

Claude Mongeau served as President and Chief Executive Officer of Canadian National Railway Company (CN) from 2010 to 2016. During his 22-year career at CN, he also served as Executive Vice-President and Chief Financial Officer from 2000 to 2009; Senior Vice-President and Chief Financial Officer from 1999 to 2000, Vice-President, Strategic and Financial Planning from 1995 to 1999, and Assistant Vice-President, Corporate Development from 1994 to 1995. Claude holds a Bachelor in Psychology from the University of Quebec and an MBA from McGill University.

 

Denise Pickett is the Chief Risk Officer and President, Global Risk, Banking and Compliance, American Express, a position she has held since February 2018. From 1992 to the present, Denise has held a series of progressively senior roles throughout American Express. She was Country Manager for American Express Canada and President and CEO of Amex Bank of Canada. Denise subsequently relocated to the United States where most recently she served as the President of American Express OPEN, the small business division, followed by the President of U.S. Consumer Services. Denise holds an MBA in marketing from the Schulich School of Business at York University and earned her Honours BA in Human Biology and Physiology from the University of Toronto.

 

Audit, audit-related and non-audit services

 

All requests for non-prohibited audit, audit-related and non-audit services provided by TELUS’ external auditor and its affiliates to TELUS are required to be pre-approved by TELUS’ Audit Committee. To enable this, we have implemented a process by which all requests for services involving the external auditor are routed for review by the VP Risk Management and Chief Internal Auditor to validate that the requested service is a non-prohibited service and to verify that there is a compelling business reason for the request. If the request passes this review, it is then forwarded to the Chief Financial Officer for further review. Pending the Chief Financial Officer’s affirmation, the request is then presented to the Audit Committee for its review, evaluation and pre-approval or denial at its next scheduled quarterly meeting. If the timing of the request is urgent, it is provided to the Audit Committee Chair for his or her review, evaluation and pre-approval or denial on behalf of the Audit

 

GRAPHIC

 

20


 

Committee (with the full committee’s review at the next scheduled quarterly meeting). Throughout the year, the Audit Committee monitors the actual versus approved expenditure for each of the approved requests.

 

The following table is a summary of billings by Deloitte LLP (Deloitte), as external auditor of TELUS, during each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2018

 

Year ended December 31, 2017

 

Type of work

 

$ millions

 

%

 

$ millions

 

%

 

Audit fees 1

 

5.584

 

93.9

 

5.016

 

91.9

 

Audit-related fees 2

 

0.139

 

2.3

 

0.133

 

2.4

 

Tax fees 3

 

0.207

 

3.5

 

0.045

 

0.8

 

All other fees 4

 

0.015

 

0.3

 

0.268

 

4.9

 

Total

 

5.945

 

100.0

 

5.462

 

100.0

 

 


(1) Includes fees for services rendered by Deloitte in relation to the audit and review of our financial statements and in connection with our statutory and regulatory filings.

(2) Includes fees for translation services rendered by Deloitte in relation to the audit or review of our financial statements that were not part of audit fees.

(3) Relates to tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning.

(4) Includes fees for services rendered by Deloitte that were not in relation to the audit or review of our financial statements, such as privacy data insights (2017/2018) and the Telecom pricing gazette (2017).

 

16.        ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

Additional information relating to TELUS may be found on SEDAR at sedar.com and EDGAR at sec.gov. Additional information regarding directors’ and officers’ remuneration, and securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans, will be contained in TELUS’ information circular for the annual meeting to be held on May 9, 2019. Additional financial information is provided in the Company’s consolidated financial statements and MD&A for the year ended December 31, 2018. All of the above information can also be found at telus.com.

 

GRAPHIC

21


 

APPENDIX A: TERMS OF REFERENCE FOR THE AUDIT COMMITTEE

 

The Board has established an Audit Committee (the “Committee”) to assist the Board in fulfilling its oversight responsibilities regarding the integrity of the Company’s accounting and financial reporting, the Company’s internal controls and disclosure controls, the Company’s legal and regulatory compliance, the Company’s Code of Ethics and Conduct and timeliness of filings with regulatory authorities, the independence and performance of the Company’s external and internal auditors, the identification and management of the Company’s risks, the Company’s credit worthiness, treasury plans and financial policy and the Company’s whistleblower and complaint procedures.

 

1 .               MEMBERSHIP

 

1.1        The Committee will have a minimum of three members, including the chair of the Committee.  The Board, upon the recommendation of the Corporate Governance Committee, will appoint and remove the members of the Committee by a majority vote.  The members will sit on the Committee at the pleasure of the Board.

1.2        The Board, upon the recommendation of the Corporate Governance Committee, will appoint the chair of the Committee from the Committee’s members by a majority vote.  The chair of the Committee will hold such position at the pleasure of the Board.

1.3        All members of the Committee will be Independent Directors.

1.4        All members of the Committee will be financially literate, as defined in accordance with applicable securities laws and standards of the stock exchanges on which the Company’s securities are listed.

1.5        At least one member of the Committee will be an audit committee financial expert, as defined in accordance with applicable securities laws, and at least one member of the Committee will have accounting or related financial management expertise, as defined in accordance with applicable securities laws.

 

2 .               MEETINGS

 

2.1        The Committee will meet at least once each quarter and otherwise as necessary.  Any member of the Committee may call meetings of the Committee.

2.2        All directors of the Company, including management directors, may attend meetings of the Committee provided, however, that no director is entitled to vote at such meetings and is not counted as part of the quorum for the Committee if he or she is not a member of the Committee.

2.3        Notwithstanding section 2.2 above, the Committee will, as a regular feature of each regularly scheduled meeting, hold an in-camera session with the external auditors and separately with the internal auditors, and an in-camera session without management or management directors present at each meeting.   The Committee may, however, hold other in-camera sessions with such members of management present as the Committee deems appropriate.

2.4        The Chief Governance Officer or his or her nominee will act as Secretary to the Committee.

2.5        The Committee will report to the Board on its meetings and each member of the Board will have access to the minutes of the Committee’s meetings, regardless of whether the director is a member of the Committee.

2.6        The external auditors of the Company will receive notice of every meeting of the Committee and may request a meeting of the Committee be called by notifying the chair of the Committee of such request.

 

3 .               QUORUM

 

The quorum necessary for the transaction of business at Committee meetings will be a majority of the members of the Committee.  A quorum once established is maintained even if members of the Committee leave the meeting prior to conclusion.

 

4 .               DUTIES

 

The Board hereby delegates to the Committee the following duties to be performed by the Committee on behalf of and for the Board:

 

4.1        Financial Reporting

 

Prior to public disclosure, the Committee will review and recommend to the Board, and where applicable, to the boards of the Company’s subsidiaries which are reporting issuers, for approval:

 

(a)          the annual audited consolidated financial statements and interim unaudited consolidated financial statements of the Company and those of its subsidiaries that are reporting issuers, as defined in accordance with applicable securities laws;

(b)          the interim and annual management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations (MD&A) of the Company and those of its subsidiaries that are reporting issuers, as defined in accordance with applicable securities laws;

(c)           earnings press releases and earnings guidance, if any; and

(d)          all other material financial public disclosure documents of the Company and those of its subsidiaries that are reporting issuers, including prospectuses, press releases with financial results and the annual information form.

 

GRAPHIC

 

22


 

4.2        External Auditors

 

The external auditors will report directly to the Committee and the Committee will:

 

(a)          appoint the external auditors, subject to the approval of the shareholders, and determine the compensation of the external auditors;

(b)          conduct an annual review of the external auditors;

(c)           oversee the work of the external auditors and review and approve the annual audit plan of the external auditors, including the scope of the audit to be performed and the degree of co-ordination between the plans of the external and internal auditors. The Committee will discuss with the internal auditors, the external auditors and management, the adequacy and effectiveness of the disclosure controls and internal controls over financial reporting of the Company and elicit recommendations for the improvement of such controls or particular areas where new or more detailed controls or procedures are desirable.  Particular emphasis will be given to the adequacy of internal controls to prevent, identify or detect fraud, or any payments, transactions or procedures that might be deemed illegal or otherwise improper;

(d)          meet regularly with the external auditors without management present and ask the external auditors to report any significant disagreements with management regarding financial reporting, the resolution of such disagreements and any restrictions imposed by management on the scope and extent of the audit examinations conducted by the external auditors;

(e)           pre-approve all audit, audit-related and non-audit services to be provided to the Company or any of its subsidiaries, by the external auditors (and its affiliates), in accordance with applicable securities laws.  The Committee may also delegate the pre-approval of audit, audit-related and non-audit services to any one member of the Committee, provided, however, a report is made to the Committee on any pre-approval of such services at the Committee’s first scheduled meeting following the pre-approval;

(f)            annually review the qualifications, expertise and resources and the overall performance of the external audit team and, if necessary, recommend to the Board the termination of the external auditors or the rotation of the audit partner in charge;

(g)           at least annually, obtain and review a report by the external auditors describing: the firm’s internal quality-control procedures; any material issues raised by the most recent internal quality control review, or peer review of the firm, or by any inquiry or investigation by governmental or professional authorities, within the preceding five years, respecting one or more independent audits carried out by the firm, and any steps taken to deal with such issues; and  all relationships between the external auditors and the Company;

(h)          annually assess and confirm the independence, objectivity and professional skepticism of the external auditors and require the external auditors to deliver an annual report to the Committee regarding its independence, such report to include disclosure regarding all engagements (and fees related thereto) by the Company and relationships which may impact the objectivity and independence of the external auditors;

(i)              require the external auditors to deliver an annual acknowledgement in writing to the Committee that the shareholders, as represented by the Board and the Committee, are its primary client;

(j)             review post-audit or management letters, containing recommendations of the external auditors and management’s response;

(k)          review reports of the external auditors; and

(l)              pre-approve the hiring of employees and former employees of current and former auditors in accordance with applicable securities laws and TELUS policies.

 

4.3        Internal Auditors

 

The internal auditors will report functionally to the Committee and administratively to the Chief Financial Officer and the Committee will:

 

(a)          review and approve management’s appointment, termination or replacement of the Chief Internal Auditor;

(b)          review and consider the annual performance objectives, performance evaluation and compensation treatment of the Chief Internal Auditor;

(c)           oversee the work of the internal auditors including reviewing and approving the annual internal audit plan and updates thereto;

(d)          review the report of the internal auditors on the status of significant internal audit findings, recommendations and management’s responses and review any other reports of the internal auditors;

(e)           review the scope of responsibilities and effectiveness of the internal audit team, its reporting relationships, activities, organizational structure and resources, its independence from management, its credentials and its working relationship with the external auditors; and

(f)            review and approve the internal audit charter and updates thereto at a minimum on a biennial basis.

 

The internal auditors will report quarterly to the Committee on the results of internal audit activities and will also have direct access to the chair of the Committee when the internal auditors determine it is necessary.

 

GRAPHIC

23


 

4.4        Whistleblower, Ethics and Internal Controls Processes

 

The Committee will ensure that the Company has in place adequate procedures for:

 

(a)          the receipt, retention and treatment of complaints received by the Company regarding accounting, internal controls or auditing matters; and

(b)          the confidential, anonymous submission by employees of the Company of concerns regarding questionable accounting or auditing matters.

 

The CEO or CFO will report to the Committee, and the Committee will review such reports, on any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Company’s internal controls.  Where the CEO, CFO and/or the Chief Internal Auditor are named in a complaint, the Director of Ethics will speak directly with the Chair of the Committee.

 

The Committee will review:

 

(a)          annually and recommend to the Board for approval, together with the Human Resources and Compensation Committee, the Code of Ethics and Conduct and material changes thereto;

(b)          quarterly reports on ethics breaches pertaining to internal controls over financial reporting or  fraud involving management or other employees who have a role in the Company’s internal controls over financial reporting;

 

The Chief Internal Auditor will report to the Committee, and the Committee will consider such reports, on the results of the investigation of whistleblower, ethics and internal controls complaints.

 

4.5        Accounting and Financial Management

 

The Committee will review:

 

(a)          with management and the external auditors, the Company’s major accounting policies, including the impact of alternative accounting policies and key management estimates, risks and judgments that could materially affect the financial results and whether they should be disclosed in the MD&A;

(b)          emerging accounting issues and their potential impact on the Company’s financial reporting;

(c)           significant judgments, assumptions and estimates made by management in preparing financial statements;

(d)          the evaluation by either the internal or external auditors of management’s internal control systems, and management’s responses to any identified weaknesses;

(e)           the evaluation by management of the adequacy and effectiveness in the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and internal controls for financial reporting;

(f)            audits designed to report on management’s representations on the effectiveness and efficiency of selected projects, processes, programs or departments;

(g)           management’s approach for safeguarding corporate assets, data and information systems, the adequacy of staffing of key financial functions and their plans for improvements; and

(h)          internal interim and post implementation reviews of major capital projects.

 

4.6        Credit Worthiness, Treasury Plans and Financial Policy

 

The Committee will review with management:

 

(a)          the Company’s financial policies and compliance with such policies;

(b)          the credit worthiness of the Company;

(c)           the liquidity of the Company; and

(d)          important treasury matters including financing plans.

 

4.7        Legal/Regulatory Matters

 

The Committee will review:

 

(a)          with management, the external auditors and legal counsel, any litigation, claim or other contingency, including any tax assessment, that could have a material effect upon the financial position or operating results of the Company;

(b)          annually, management’s relationships with regulators, and the accuracy and timeliness of filings with regulatory authorities;

(c)           quarterly reports from the Chief Legal Officer on compliance with laws and regulations;

(d)          quarterly reports from the Vice-President, Chief Data and Trust Officer (“Chief Compliance Officer”) on legal, privacy and regulatory compliance activities; and

(e)           the anti-bribery and corruption policy and recommend to the Board for approval any material changes thereto.

 

4.8        Risk Management

 

The Committee will:

 

(a)          consider reports on the annual enterprise risk assessment and updates thereto;

(b)          except to the extent that responsibility is reserved to the Board or delegated to another Board committee, review management’s implementation of risk policies and procedures, and assess the appropriateness and comprehensiveness of those policies and procedures;

(c)           consider reports on security;

(d)          consider reports on financial risk management including derivative exposure and policies;

(e)           consider reports on tax risk management and governance;

 

GRAPHIC

 

24


 

(f)            consider reports on business continuity disaster recovery plan(s) for the Company including reports on external threats and hazards; and

(g)           review other risk management matters from time to time as the Committee may consider suitable or the Board may specifically direct.

 

4.9        Other

 

The Committee will review:

 

(a)          the expenses of the Chair of the Board;

(b)          significant related party transactions and actual and potential conflicts of interest relating thereto to verify their propriety and that disclosure is appropriate;

(c)           the disclosure policy of the Company and recommend any material changes thereto to the Board for approval;

(d)          and evaluate, at least once annually, the adequacy of these Terms of Reference and the Committee’s performance, and report its evaluation and any recommendations for change to the Corporate Governance Committee.

 

The Committee will also have such other duties and responsibilities as are delegated to it and review such other matters as, from time to time, are referred to it by the Board.

 

5 .               AUTHORITY

 

The Committee, in fulfilling its mandate, will have the authority to:

 

(a)           engage and set compensation for independent counsel and other advisors;

(b)           communicate directly with the Chief Financial Officer, internal and external auditors, Chief Compliance Officer,  Chief Legal Officer and Chief Governance Officer and any other member of management the Committee deems appropriate;

(c)           delegate tasks to Committee members or subcommittees of the Committee; and access appropriate funding as determined by the Committee.

 

GRAPHIC

25


Exhibit 99.4:

 

Audited Consolidated Financial Statements as at and for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 and Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

[previously filed on SEDAR]

 


 

TELUS CORPORATION

 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

DECEMBER 31, 2018

 


 

report of management on internal control over financial reporting

 

Management of TELUS Corporation (TELUS, or the Company) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting.

 

TELUS’ President and Chief Executive Officer and Executive Vice-President and Chief Financial Officer have assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, in accordance with the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the President and Chief Executive Officer and the Executive Vice-President and Chief Financial Officer and effected by the Board of Directors, management and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

 

Due to its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Based on the assessment referenced in the preceding paragraph, management has determined that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective as of December 31, 2018. In connection with this assessment, no material weaknesses in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting were identified by management as of December 31, 2018.

 

Deloitte LLP, an Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, audited the Company’s Consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2018, and as stated in the Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, they have expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018.

 

/s/ “Doug French”

 

/s/ “Darren Entwistle”

 

 

 

Doug French

 

Darren Entwistle

Executive Vice-President

 

President

and Chief Financial Officer

 

and Chief Executive Officer

February 14, 2019

 

February 14, 2019

 

 

2


 

report of independent registered public accounting firm

 

To the Shareholders and Board of Directors of TELUS Corporation

 

Opinion on the Financial Statements

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial position of TELUS Corporation and subsidiaries (the Company) as at December 31, 2018 and 2017, the related consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income, changes in owners’ equity and cash flows, for the years then ended, and the related notes, (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and its financial performance and its cash flows for each of the years then ended, in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 14, 2019, expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Change in Accounting Principle

 

As discussed in Note 2 to the financial statements, the Company has changed its method of accounting for revenue from contracts with customers due to the adoption of IFRS 15 on January 1, 2018, and has retrospectively adjusted the 2017 financial statements, including the disclosure of the January 1, 2017 retrospectively adjusted consolidated statement of financial position.

 

Basis for Opinion

 

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

/s/ “Deloitte LLP”

 

 

 

Chartered Professional Accountants

 

February 14, 2019

 

Vancouver, Canada

 

 

 

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2002.

 

 

3


 

report of independent registered public accounting firm

 

To the Shareholders and Board of Directors of TELUS Corporation

 

Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

 

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of TELUS Corporation and subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2018 of the Company and our report dated February 14, 2019, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements and included an explanatory paragraph regarding the Company’s change in accounting for revenue from contracts with customers in the year ended December 31, 2018 due to the adoption of IFRS 15.

 

Basis for Opinion

 

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

 

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

/s/ “Deloitte LLP”

 

 

 

Chartered Professional Accountants

 

February 14, 2019

 

Vancouver, Canada

 

 

 

4


 

consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income

 

Years ended December 31 (millions except per share amounts) 

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

(Note 2(c))

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

OPERATING REVENUES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service

 

 

 

$

11,882

 

$

11,332

 

Equipment

 

 

 

2,213

 

1,973

 

Revenues arising from contracts with customers

 

6

 

14,095

 

13,305

 

Other operating income

 

7

 

273

 

103

 

 

 

 

 

14,368

 

13,408

 

OPERATING EXPENSES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased

 

 

 

6,368

 

5,904

 

Employee benefits expense

 

8

 

2,896

 

2,594

 

Depreciation

 

17

 

1,669

 

1,617

 

Amortization of intangible assets

 

18

 

598

 

552

 

 

 

 

 

11,531

 

10,667

 

OPERATING INCOME

 

 

 

2,837

 

2,741

 

Financing costs

 

9

 

661

 

573

 

INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES

 

 

 

2,176

 

2,168

 

Income taxes

 

10

 

552

 

590

 

NET INCOME

 

 

 

1,624

 

1,578

 

OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

 

11

 

 

 

 

 

Items that may subsequently be reclassified to income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Change in unrealized fair value of derivatives designated as cash flow hedges

 

 

 

(18

)

19

 

Foreign currency translation adjustment arising from translating financial statements of foreign operations

 

 

 

(30

)

5

 

 

 

 

 

(48

)

24

 

Items never subsequently reclassified to income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Change in measurement of investment financial assets

 

 

 

(1

)

(12

)

Employee defined benefit plan re-measurements

 

 

 

333

 

(172

)

 

 

 

 

332

 

(184

)

 

 

 

 

284

 

(160

)

COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

 

 

 

$

1,908

 

$

1,418

 

NET INCOME ATTRIBUTABLE TO:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

 

 

$

1,600

 

$

1,559

 

Non-controlling interests

 

 

 

24

 

19

 

 

 

 

 

$

1,624

 

$

1,578

 

COMPREHENSIVE INCOME ATTRIBUTABLE TO:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

 

 

$

1,898

 

$

1,395

 

Non-controlling interests

 

 

 

10

 

23

 

 

 

 

 

$

1,908

 

$

1,418

 

NET INCOME PER COMMON SHARE

 

12

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 

 

$

2.68

 

$

2.63

 

Diluted

 

 

 

$

2.68

 

$

2.63

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TOTAL WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON SHARES OUTSTANDING

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 

 

597

 

593

 

Diluted

 

 

 

597

 

593

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

 

5


 

consolidated statements of financial position

 

As at (millions)

 

Note

 

December 31,
2018

 

December 31,
2017

 

January 1,
2017

 

 

 

 

 

(Note 2(c))

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

(Note 2(c))

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

 

 

$

414

 

$

509 

 

$

432 

 

Accounts receivable

 

6(b)

 

1,600

 

1,614 

 

1,462 

 

Income and other taxes receivable

 

 

 

3

 

96 

 

 

Inventories

 

1(l)

 

376

 

380 

 

320 

 

Contract assets

 

6(c)

 

860

 

757 

 

700 

 

Prepaid expenses

 

20

 

539

 

493 

 

443 

 

Current derivative assets

 

4(h)

 

49

 

18 

 

11 

 

 

 

 

 

3,841

 

3,867 

 

3,377 

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

17

 

12,091

 

11,368 

 

10,464 

 

Intangible assets, net

 

18

 

10,956

 

10,658 

 

10,364 

 

Goodwill, net

 

18

 

4,733

 

4,236 

 

3,787 

 

Contract assets

 

6(c)

 

458

 

396 

 

352 

 

Other long-term assets

 

20

 

986

 

528 

 

733 

 

 

 

 

 

29,224

 

27,186 

 

25,700 

 

 

 

 

 

$

33,065

 

$

31,053 

 

$

29,077 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND OWNERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Short-term borrowings

 

22

 

$

100

 

$

100 

 

$

100 

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

23

 

2,570

 

2,460 

 

2,330 

 

Income and other taxes payable

 

 

 

218

 

34 

 

37 

 

Dividends payable

 

13

 

326

 

299 

 

284 

 

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

24

 

653

 

632 

 

584 

 

Provisions

 

25

 

129

 

78 

 

124 

 

Current maturities of long-term debt

 

26

 

836

 

1,404 

 

1,327 

 

Current derivative liabilities

 

4(h)

 

9

 

33 

 

12 

 

 

 

 

 

4,841

 

5,040 

 

4,798 

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

25

 

728

 

511 

 

395 

 

Long-term debt

 

26

 

13,265

 

12,256 

 

11,604 

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

27

 

738

 

847 

 

736 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

10

 

3,152

 

2,941 

 

2,511 

 

 

 

 

 

17,883

 

16,555 

 

15,246 

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

22,724

 

21,595 

 

20,044 

 

Owners’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common equity

 

28

 

10,259

 

9,416 

 

9,014 

 

Non-controlling interests

 

 

 

82

 

42 

 

19 

 

 

 

 

 

10,341

 

9,458 

 

9,033 

 

 

 

 

 

$

33,065

 

$

31,053 

 

$

29,077 

 

Contingent Liabilities

 

29

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

Approved by the Directors:

 

/s/ “David L. Mowat”

 

/s/ “R.H. Auchinleck”

 

 

 

David L. Mowat

 

R.H. Auchinleck

Director

 

Director

 

 

6


 

 

consolidated statements of changes in owners’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

Common equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity contributed

 

 

 

Accumulated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares  (Note 28)

 

 

 

 

 

other

 

 

 

Non-

 

 

 

(millions)

 

Note

 

Number
of shares

 

Share
capital

 

Contributed
surplus

 

Retained
earnings

 

comprehensive
income

 

Total

 

controlling
interests

 

Total

 

Balance as at January 1, 2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

 

 

590

 

$

5,029

 

$

372

 

$

2,474

 

$

42

 

$

7,917

 

$

19

 

$

7,936

 

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments transitional amount

 

2(a), 11

 

 

 

 

3

 

(3

)

 

 

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers transitional amount

 

2(c)

 

 

 

 

1,097

 

 

1,097

 

 

1,097

 

As adjusted

 

 

 

590

 

5,029

 

372

 

3,574

 

39

 

9,014

 

19

 

9,033

 

Net income

 

2(c)

 

 

 

 

1,559

 

 

1,559

 

19

 

1,578

 

Other comprehensive income

 

11

 

 

 

 

(172

)

8

 

(164

)

4

 

(160

)

Dividends

 

13

 

 

 

 

(1,167

)

 

(1,167

)

 

(1,167

)

Dividends reinvested and optional cash payments

 

13(b), 14(c)

 

2

 

71

 

 

 

 

71

 

 

71

 

Share option award net-equity settlement feature

 

14(d)

 

1

 

2

 

(2

)

 

 

 

 

 

Issue of shares in business combination

 

 

 

2

 

100

 

 

 

 

100

 

 

100

 

Other

 

 

 

 

3

 

 

 

 

3

 

 

3

 

Balance as at December 31, 2017

 

 

 

595

 

$

5,205

 

$

370

 

$

3,794

 

$

47

 

$

9,416

 

$

42

 

$

9,458

 

Balance as at January 1, 2018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

 

 

595

 

$

5,205

 

$

370

 

$

2,595

 

$

51

 

$

8,221

 

$

42

 

$

8,263

 

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments transitional amount

 

2(a), 11

 

 

 

 

4

 

(4

)

 

 

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers transitional amount

 

2(c)

 

 

 

 

1,195

 

 

1,195

 

 

1,195

 

As adjusted

 

 

 

595

 

5,205

 

370

 

3,794

 

47

 

9,416

 

42

 

9,458

 

Net income

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,600

 

 

1,600

 

24

 

1,624

 

Other comprehensive income

 

11

 

 

 

 

333

 

(35

)

298

 

(14

)

284

 

Dividends

 

13

 

 

 

 

(1,253

)

 

(1,253

)

 

(1,253

)

Dividends reinvested and optional cash payments

 

13(b), 14(c)

 

2

 

86

 

 

 

 

86

 

 

86

 

Treasury shares acquired

 

16(c), 28(b)

 

(2

)

(100

)

 

 

 

(100

)

 

(100

)

Shares settled from Treasury

 

16(c), 28(b)

 

2

 

100

 

 

 

 

100

 

 

100

 

Share option award net-equity settlement feature

 

14(d)

 

 

1

 

(1

)

 

 

 

 

 

Issue of shares in business combination

 

18(b)

 

2

 

98

 

 

 

 

98

 

 

98

 

Change in ownership interests of subsidiary

 

31(a)

 

 

 

14

 

 

 

14

 

30

 

44

 

Balance as at December 31, 2018

 

 

 

599

 

$

5,390

 

$

383

 

$

4,474

 

$

12

 

$

10,259

 

$

82

 

$

10,341

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

 

7


 

consolidated statements of cash flows

 

Years ended December 31 (millions) 

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

(Note 2(c))

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

 

 

$

1,624

 

$

1,578

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

 

2,267

 

2,169

 

Deferred income taxes

 

10

 

74

 

467

 

Share-based compensation expense, net

 

14(a)

 

6

 

17

 

Net employee defined benefit plans expense

 

15(b)

 

95

 

82

 

Employer contributions to employee defined benefit plans

 

 

 

(53

)

(67

)

Non-current contract assets

 

 

 

(62

)

(44

)

Income from equity accounted investments

 

7, 21

 

(170

)

(4

)

Shares settled from Treasury

 

16(c)

 

100

 

 

Other

 

 

 

(79

)

(32

)

Net change in non-cash operating working capital

 

31(a)

 

256

 

(219

)

Cash provided by operating activities

 

 

 

4,058

 

3,947

 

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences

 

31(a)

 

(2,874

)

(3,081

)

Cash payment for spectrum licences

 

18(a)

 

(1

)

 

Cash payments for acquisitions, net

 

18(b)

 

(280

)

(564

)

Real estate joint ventures advances

 

21(c)

 

(22

)

(26

)

Real estate joint venture receipts

 

21(c)

 

184

 

18

 

Proceeds on dispositions

 

 

 

38

 

28

 

Other

 

 

 

(22

)

(18

)

Cash used by investing activities

 

 

 

(2,977

)

(3,643

)

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

 

31(b)

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends paid to holders of Common Shares

 

13(a)

 

(1,141

)

(1,082

)

Treasury shares acquired

 

 

 

(100

)

 

Issue (repayment) of short-term borrowings, net

 

 

 

(67

)

 

Long-term debt issued

 

26

 

5,500

 

6,367

 

Redemptions and repayment of long-term debt

 

26

 

(5,377

)

(5,502

)

Issue of shares by subsidiary to non-controlling interests

 

31(a)

 

24

 

(1

)

Other

 

 

 

(15

)

(9

)

Cash used by financing activities

 

 

 

(1,176

)

(227

)

CASH POSITION

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and temporary investments, net

 

 

 

(95

)

77

 

Cash and temporary investments, net, beginning of period

 

 

 

509

 

432

 

Cash and temporary investments, net, end of period

 

 

 

$

414

 

$

509

 

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF OPERATING CASH FLOWS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest paid

 

 

 

$

(608

)

$

(539

)

Interest received

 

 

 

$

9

 

$

7

 

Income taxes paid, net

 

 

 

$

(197

)

$

(191

)

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

 

8


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

DECEMBER 31, 2018

 

TELUS Corporation is one of Canada’s largest telecommunications companies, providing a wide range of telecommunications services and products, including wireless and wireline voice and data. Data services include: Internet protocol; television; hosting, managed information technology and cloud-based services; healthcare solutions; customer care and business services (formerly business process outsourcing); and home and business security.

 

TELUS Corporation was incorporated under the Company Act (British Columbia) on October 26, 1998, under the name BCT.TELUS Communications Inc. (BCT). On January 31, 1999, pursuant to a court-approved plan of arrangement under the Canada Business Corporations Act among BCT, BC TELECOM Inc. and the former Alberta-based TELUS Corporation (TC), BCT acquired all of the shares of BC TELECOM Inc. and TC in exchange for Common Shares and Non-Voting Shares of BCT, and BC TELECOM Inc. was dissolved. On May 3, 2000, BCT changed its name to TELUS Corporation and in February 2005, TELUS Corporation transitioned under the Business Corporations Act (British Columbia), successor to the Company Act (British Columbia). TELUS Corporation maintains its registered office at Floor 7, 510 West Georgia Street, Vancouver, British Columbia, V6B 0M3.

 

The terms “TELUS”, “we”, “us”, “our” or “ourselves” are used to refer to TELUS Corporation and, where the context of the narrative permits or requires, its subsidiaries.

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Page

General application

 

 

1.

Summary of significant accounting policies

 

10

2.

Accounting policy developments

 

20

3.

Capital structure financial policies

 

27

4.

Financial instruments

 

29

Consolidated results of operations focused

 

 

5.

Segment information

 

36

6.

Revenue from contracts with customers

 

38

7.

Other operating income

 

39

8.

Employee benefits expense

 

39

9.

Financing costs

 

40

10.

Income taxes

 

40

11.

Other comprehensive income

 

42

12.

Per share amounts

 

43

13.

Dividends per share

 

43

14.

Share-based compensation

 

43

15.

Employee future benefits

 

46

16.

Restructuring and other costs

 

52

Consolidated financial position focused

 

 

17.

Property, plant and equipment

 

53

18.

Intangible assets and goodwill

 

54

19.

Leases

 

59

20.

Other long-term assets

 

59

21.

Real estate joint ventures

 

60

22.

Short-term borrowings

 

62

23.

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

62

24.

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

62

25.

Provisions

 

63

26.

Long-term debt

 

64

27.

Other long-term liabilities

 

67

28.

Common Share capital

 

67

29.

Contingent liabilities

 

68

Other

 

 

30.

Related party transactions

 

70

31.

Additional statement of cash flow information

 

71

 

 

9


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

1                  summary of significant accounting policies

 

Our consolidated financial statements are expressed in Canadian dollars. The generally accepted accounting principles that we use are International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IFRS-IASB) and Canadian generally accepted accounting principles.

 

Generally accepted accounting principles require that we disclose the accounting policies we have selected in those instances where we have been obligated to choose from among various accounting policies that comply with generally accepted accounting principles. In certain other instances, including those in which no selection among policies is allowed, we are also required to disclose how we have applied certain accounting policies. In the selection and application of accounting policies we consider, among other factors, the fundamental qualitative characteristics of useful financial information, namely relevance and faithful representation. In our assessment, our required accounting policy disclosures are not all equally significant for us, as set out in the accompanying table; their relative significance for us will evolve over time as we do.

 

These consolidated financial statements for each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, were authorized by our Board of Directors for issue on February 14, 2019.

 

 

 

Accounting policy requiring a more
significant choice among policies and/or
a more significant application of judgment

 

Accounting policy

 

Yes

 

No

 

General application

 

 

 

 

 

(a)               Consolidation

 

 

 

X

 

(b)               Use of estimates and judgments

 

X

 

 

 

(c)                Financial instruments — recognition and measurement

 

 

 

X

 

(d)               Hedge accounting

 

 

 

X

 

Results of operations focused

 

 

 

 

 

(e)                Revenue recognition

 

X

 

 

 

(f)                 Depreciation, amortization and impairment

 

X

 

 

 

(g)                Translation of foreign currencies

 

 

 

X

 

(h)               Income and other taxes

 

X

 

 

 

(i)                   Share-based compensation

 

 

 

X

 

(j)                  Employee future benefit plans

 

X

 

 

 

Financial position focused

 

 

 

 

 

(k)               Cash and temporary investments, net

 

 

 

X

 

(l)                   Inventories

 

 

 

X

 

(m)           Property, plant and equipment; intangible assets

 

X

 

 

 

(n)               Leases

 

 

 

X

 

(o)               Investments

 

 

 

X

 

 

(a)          Consolidation

 

Our consolidated financial statements include our accounts and the accounts of all of our subsidiaries, the principal one of which is TELUS Communications Inc., in which we have a 100% equity interest. TELUS Communications Inc. includes substantially all of our wireless and wireline operations.

 

Our financing arrangements and those of our wholly owned subsidiaries do not impose restrictions on inter-corporate dividends.

 

On a continuing basis, we review our corporate organization and effect changes as appropriate so as to enhance the value of TELUS Corporation. This process can, and does, affect which of our subsidiaries are considered principal subsidiaries at any particular point in time.

 

(b)          Use of estimates and judgments

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates, assumptions and judgments that affect: the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements; the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements; and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

10


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Estimates

 

Examples of the significant estimates and assumptions that we make, and their relative significance and degree of difficulty, are set out in the graphic at right.

 

 

Judgments

 

Examples of our significant judgments, apart from those involving estimation, include the following:

 

·                   Assessments about whether line items are sufficiently material to warrant separate presentation in the primary financial statements and, if not, whether they are sufficiently material to warrant separate presentation in the notes to the financial statements. In the normal course, we make changes to our assessments regarding materiality for presentation so that they reflect current economic conditions. Due consideration is given to the view that it is reasonable to expect differing opinions of what is, and is not, material.

 

·                   In respect of revenue-generating transactions, we must make judgments that affect the timing of the recognition of revenue. See Note 2(a)  for significant changes to IFRS-IASB which significantly affect the timing of the recognition of revenue and the classification of revenues presented as either service or equipment revenues.

 

·                   We must make judgments about when we have satisfied our performance obligations to our customers, either over a period of time or at a point in time. Service revenues are recognized based upon customers’ access to, or usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure; we believe that this method faithfully depicts the transfer of the services, and thus the revenues are recognized as the services are made available and/or rendered. We consider our performance obligations arising from the sale of equipment to have been satisfied when the equipment has been delivered to, and accepted by, the end-user customers (see (e)  following).

 

·                   Principally in the context of revenue-generating transactions involving wireless handsets, we must make judgments about whether third-party re-sellers that deliver equipment to our customers are acting in the transactions as principals or as our agents. Upon due consideration of the relevant indicators, we believe that the decision to consider the re-sellers to be acting, solely for accounting purposes, as our agents is more representative of the economic substance of the transactions, as we are the primary obligor to the end-user customers. The effect of this judgment is that no equipment revenue is recognized upon the transfer of inventory to third-party re-sellers.

 

·                   We compensate third-party re-sellers and our employees for generating revenues, and we must exercise judgment as to whether such sales-based compensation amounts are costs incurred to obtain contracts with customers that should be capitalized (see Note 20 ). We believe that compensation amounts tangentially attributable to obtaining a contract with a customer, because the amount of such compensation could be affected in ways other than by simply obtaining that contract, should be expensed as incurred; compensation amounts directly attributable to obtaining a contract with a customer should be capitalized and subsequently amortized on a systematic basis, consistent with the satisfaction of our associated performance obligations.

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

11


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Judgment must also be exercised in the capitalization of costs incurred to fulfill revenue-generating contracts with customers. Such fulfilment costs are those incurred to set up, activate or otherwise implement services involving access to, or usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure that would not otherwise be capitalized as property, plant and equipment and intangible assets (see Note 20 ).

 

·                   The decision to depreciate and amortize any property, plant, equipment and intangible assets that are subject to amortization on a straight-line basis, as we believe that this method reflects the consumption of resources related to the economic lifespan of those assets better than an accelerated method and is more representative of the economic substance of the underlying use of those assets.

 

·                   The preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make judgments that affect the financial statement disclosure of information regularly reviewed by our chief operating decision-maker used to make resource allocation decisions and to assess performance (segment information, Note 5 ). A significant judgment we make is in respect of distinguishing between our wireless and wireline operations and cash flows (and this extends to allocations of both direct and indirect expenses and capital expenditures). The clarity of such distinction has been increasingly affected by the convergence and integration of our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure technology and operations. Less than one-half of the operating expenses included in the segment performance measure reported to our chief operating decision-maker during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, are direct costs; judgment, largely based upon historical experience, is applied in apportioning indirect expenses which are not objectively distinguishable between our wireless and wireline operations.

 

Recently, our judgment was that our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure technology and operations had not experienced sufficient convergence to objectively make their respective operations and cash flows practically indistinguishable. The continued build-out of our technology-agnostic fibre-optic infrastructure, in combination with converged edge network technology, has significantly affected this judgment, as has the commercialization of fixed-wireless telecommunications solutions for customers and the consolidation of our non-customer facing operations.

 

As a result, it has become increasingly difficult and impractical to objectively and clearly distinguish between our wireless and wireline operations and cash flows, and the assets from which those cash flows arise. Our judgment as to whether these operations can continue to be judged to be individual components of the business and discrete operating segments may change.

 

The increasing impracticality of objectively distinguishing between our wireless and wireline cash flows, and the assets from which those cash flows arise, is evidence of their increasing interdependence; this may result in the unification of the wireless cash-generating unit and the wireline cash-generating unit as a single cash-generating unit for impairment testing purposes in the future. As our business continues to evolve, new cash-generating units may develop.

 

·                   The view that our spectrum licences granted by Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada will likely be renewed; that we intend to renew them; that we believe we have the financial and operational ability to renew them; and thus, that they have an indefinite life, as discussed further in Note 18(e) .

 

·                   In connection with the annual impairment testing of intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill, there are instances in which we must exercise judgment in allocating our net assets, including shared corporate and administrative assets, to our cash-generating units when determining their carrying amounts. These judgments are necessary because of the convergence that our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure technology and operations have experienced to date, and because of our continuous development. There are instances in which similar judgments must also be made in respect of future capital expenditures in support of both wireless and wireline operations, which are a component of the determination of recoverable amounts used in the annual impairment testing, as discussed further in Note 18(f) .

 

·                   In respect of claims and lawsuits, as discussed further in Note 29(a) , the determination of whether an item is a contingent liability or whether an outflow of resources is probable and thus needs to be accounted for as a provision.

 

(c)           Financial instruments — recognition and measurement

 

In respect of the recognition and measurement of financial instruments, we have adopted the following policies:

 

·                   Regular-way purchases or sales of financial assets or financial liabilities (purchases or sales that require actual delivery of financial assets or financial liabilities) are recognized on the settlement date. We have selected this

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

12


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

method as the benefits of using the trade date method were not expected to exceed the costs of selecting and implementing that method.

 

·                   Transaction costs, other than in respect of items held for trading, are added to the initial fair value of the acquired financial asset or financial liability. We have selected this method as we believe that it results in a better matching of the transaction costs with the periods in which we benefit from the transaction costs.

 

(d)          Hedge accounting

 

General

 

We apply hedge accounting to the financial instruments used to: establish designated currency hedging relationships for certain U.S. dollar-denominated future purchase commitments and debt repayments, as set out in Note 4(a)  and (d) ; and fix the compensation cost arising from specific grants of restricted stock units, as set out in Note 4(f)  and discussed further in Note 14(b) .

 

Hedge accounting

 

The purpose of hedge accounting, in respect of our designated hedging relationships, is to ensure that counterbalancing gains and losses are recognized in the same periods. We have chosen to apply hedge accounting as we believe this is more representative of the economic substance of the underlying transactions.

 

In order to apply hedge accounting, a high correlation (which indicates effectiveness) is required in the offsetting changes in the risk-associated values of the financial instruments (the hedging items) used to establish the designated hedging relationships and all, or a part, of the asset, liability or transaction having an identified risk exposure that we have taken steps to modify (the hedged items). We assess the anticipated effectiveness of designated hedging relationships at inception and their actual effectiveness for each reporting period thereafter. We consider a designated hedging relationship to be effective if the following critical terms match between the hedging item and the hedged item: the notional amount of the hedging item and the principal amount of the hedged item; maturity dates; payment dates; and interest rate index (if, and as, applicable). As set out in Note 4(i) , any ineffectiveness, such as would result from a difference between the notional amount of the hedging item and the principal amount of the hedged item, or from a previously effective designated hedging relationship becoming ineffective, is reflected in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as Financing costs if in respect of long-term debt, as Goods and services purchased if in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated future purchase commitments, or as Employee benefits expense if in respect of share-based compensation.

 

Hedging assets and liabilities

 

In the application of hedge accounting, an amount (the hedge value) is recorded in the Consolidated statements of financial position in respect of the fair value of the hedging items. The net difference, if any, between the amounts recognized in the determination of net income and the amounts necessary to reflect the fair value of the designated cash flow hedging items recorded in the Consolidated statements of financial position is recognized as a component of Other comprehensive income, as set out in Note 11 .

 

In the application of hedge accounting to the compensation cost arising from share-based compensation, the amount recognized in the determination of net income is the amount that counterbalances the difference between the quoted market price of our Common Shares at the statement of financial position date and the price of our Common Shares in the hedging items.

 

(e)           Revenue recognition

 

See Note 2(a)  for significant changes to IFRS-IASB which significantly affect the timing of the recognition of revenue and the classification of revenues presented as either service or equipment revenues.

 

General

 

We earn the majority of our revenues (wireless: network revenues (voice and data); wireline: data revenues (which include: Internet protocol; television; hosting, managed information technology and cloud-based services; business process outsourcing; certain healthcare solutions; and home and business security) and voice revenues) from access to, and usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure. The majority of the balance of our revenues (wireless equipment and other) arises from providing services and products facilitating access to, and usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure.

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

13


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

We offer complete and integrated solutions to meet our customers’ needs. These solutions may involve deliveries of multiple services and products (our performance obligations) that occur at different points in time and/or over different periods of time; as referred to in  (b) , this is a significant judgment for us. As required, the performance obligations of these multiple element arrangements are identified, the transaction price for the entire multiple element arrangement is determined and allocated among the performance obligations based upon our relative stand-alone selling prices for each of them, and our relevant revenue recognition policies are then applied, so that revenue is recognized when, or as, we satisfy the performance obligations. (We estimate that approximately two-thirds of our revenues arise from multiple element arrangements.) To the extent that variable consideration is included in determining the minimum transaction price, it is constrained to the “minimum spend” amount required in a contract with a customer. Service revenues arising from contracts with customers typically have variable consideration, because customers have the ongoing ability to both add and remove features and services, and because customer usage of our telecommunications infrastructure may exceed the base amounts provided for in their contracts.

 

Our contracts with customers do not have a significant financing component. Excepting both equipment-related upfront payments that may be required under the terms of contracts with customers and in-store “cash and carry” sales of equipment and accessories, payments are typically due 30 days from the billing date. Billings are typically rendered on a monthly basis.

 

Multiple contracts with a single customer are normally accounted for as separate arrangements. In instances where multiple contracts are entered into with a customer in a short period of time, the contracts are reviewed as a group to ensure that, as with multiple element arrangements, their relative transaction prices are appropriate.

 

Lease accounting is applied to an accounting unit if it conveys to a customer the right to use a specific asset but does not convey the risks and/or benefits of ownership.

 

Our revenues are recorded net of any value-added and/or sales taxes billed to the customer concurrent with a revenue-generating transaction.

 

We use the following revenue accounting practical expedients provided for in IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers :

 

·                   No adjustment of the contracted amount of consideration for the effects of financing components when, at the inception of a contract, we expect that the effect of the financing component is not significant at the individual contract level.

 

·                   No deferral of contract acquisition costs when the amortization period for such costs would be one year or less.

 

·                   When estimating minimum transaction prices allocated to any remaining unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, performance obligations, exclusion of amounts arising from contracts originally expected to have a duration of one year or less, as well as amounts arising from contracts under which we may recognize and bill revenue in an amount that corresponds directly with our completed performance obligations.

 

Contract assets

 

Many of our multiple element arrangements arise from bundling the sale of equipment ( e.g. a wireless handset) with a contracted service period. Although the customer receives the equipment at contract inception and the revenue from the associated completed performance obligation is recognized at that time, the customer’s payment for the equipment will effectively be received rateably over the contracted service period to the extent it is not received as a lump-sum amount at contract inception. The difference between the equipment revenue recognized and the associated amount cumulatively billed to the customer is recognized on the Consolidated statements of financial position as a contract asset.

 

Contract assets may also arise in instances where we give consideration to a customer. When we receive no identifiable, separable benefit for consideration given to a customer, the amount of the consideration is recorded as a reduction of revenue rather than as an expense. Such amounts are included in the determination of transaction prices for allocation purposes in multiple element arrangements.

 

·                   Some forms of consideration given to a customer, effectively at contract inception, such as rebates (including prepaid non-bank cards) and/or equipment, are considered to be performance obligations in a multiple element arrangement. Although the performance obligation is satisfied at contract inception, the customer’s payment associated with the performance obligation will effectively be received rateably over the associated contracted service period. The difference between the revenue arising from the satisfied performance obligation and the associated amount

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

14


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

cumulatively reflected in billings to the customer is recognized on the Consolidated statements of financial position as a contract asset.

 

·                   Other forms of consideration given to a customer, either at contract inception or over a period of time, such as discounts (including prepaid bank cards), may result in us receiving no identifiable, separable benefit and thus are not considered performance obligations. Such consideration is recognized as a reduction of revenue rateably over the term of the contract. The difference between the consideration provided and the associated amount recognized as a reduction of revenue is recognized on the Consolidated statements of financial position as a contract asset.

 

Contract liabilities

 

Advance billings are recorded when billing occurs prior to provision of the associated services; such advance billings are recognized as revenue in the period in which the services and/or equipment are provided (see Note 24 ). Similarly, and as appropriate, upfront customer activation and connection fees are deferred and recognized over the average expected term of the customer relationship.

 

Costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment

 

Costs of contract acquisition (typically commissions) and contract fulfilment costs are capitalized and recognized as an expense, generally over the life of the contract on a systematic and rational basis consistent with the pattern of the transfer of goods or services to which the asset relates. The amortization of such costs is included in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as a component of Goods and services purchased, with the exception of amounts paid to our employees, which are included as Employee benefits expense.

 

The total cost of wireless equipment sold to customers and advertising and promotion costs related to initial customer acquisition are expensed as incurred; the cost of equipment we own that is situated at customers’ premises and associated installation costs are capitalized as incurred. Costs of advertising production, advertising airtime and advertising space are expensed as incurred.

 

Voice and data

 

We recognize revenues on an accrual basis and include an estimate of revenues earned but unbilled. Wireless and wireline service revenues are recognized based upon access to, and usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure and upon contract fees.

 

Advance billings are recorded when billing occurs prior to provision of the associated services; such advance billings are recognized as revenue in the period in which the services are provided. Similarly, and as appropriate, upfront customer activation and connection fees are deferred and recognized over the average expected term of the customer relationship.

 

We use the liability method of accounting for the amounts of our quality of service rate rebates that arise from the jurisdiction of the Canadian Radio-television and Telecommunications Commission (CRTC).

 

The CRTC has established a mechanism to subsidize local exchange carriers, such as ourselves, that provide residential basic telephone service to high cost serving areas. The CRTC has determined the per network access line/per band subsidy rate for all local exchange carriers. We recognize the subsidy on an accrual basis by applying the subsidy rate to the number of residential network access lines we provide in high cost serving areas, as discussed further in Note 7 . Differences, if any, between interim and final subsidy rates set by the CRTC are accounted for as a change in estimate in the period in which the CRTC finalizes the subsidy rate.

 

Other and wireless equipment

 

We recognize product revenues, including amounts related to wireless handsets sold to re-sellers and customer premises equipment, when the products are both delivered to and accepted by the end-user customers, irrespective of which supply channel delivers the product. With respect to wireless handsets sold to re-sellers, we consider ourselves to be the principal and primary obligor to the end-user customers. Revenues from operating leases of equipment are recognized on a systematic and rational basis (normally a straight-line basis) over the term of the lease.

 

Non-high cost serving area deferral account

 

In an effort to foster competition for residential basic service in non-high cost serving areas, the concept of a deferral account mechanism was introduced by the CRTC in 2002 as an alternative to mandating price reductions. We use the liability method of accounting for the deferral account. We discharge the deferral account liability by undertaking qualifying actions. We recognize the amortization (over a period no longer than three years) of a proportionate share of the deferral account as qualifying actions are completed. Such amortization is included as a component of government assistance in Other operating income, as set out in Note 7 .

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

15


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(f)            Depreciation, amortization and impairment

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

Assets are depreciated on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives as determined by a continuing program of asset life studies. Depreciation includes amortization of assets under finance leases and amortization of leasehold improvements. Leasehold improvements are normally amortized over the lesser of their expected average service life or the term of the lease. Intangible assets with finite lives (intangible assets subject to amortization) are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, which are reviewed at least annually and adjusted as appropriate. As referred to in  (b) , the use of a straight-line basis of depreciation and amortization is a significant judgment for us.

 

Estimated useful lives for the majority of our property, plant and equipment subject to depreciation are as follows:

 

 

 

Estimated useful lives  1

 

Network assets

 

 

 

Outside plant

 

17 to 40 years

 

Inside plant

 

4 to 25 years

 

Wireless site equipment

 

5 to 7 years

 

Balance of depreciable property, plant and equipment

 

3 to 40 years

 

 


(1)                        The composite depreciation rate for the year ended December 31, 2018, was 5.0% (2017 – 5.0%). The rate is calculated by dividing depreciation expense by an average of the gross book value of depreciable assets over the reporting period.

 

Estimated useful lives for the majority of our intangible assets subject to amortization are as follows:

 

 

 

Estimated useful lives

 

Wireline subscriber base

 

25 years

 

Customer contracts and related customer relationships

 

4 to 10 years

 

Software

 

2 to 10 years

 

Access to rights-of-way and other

 

5 to 30 years

 

 

Impairment — general

 

Impairment testing compares the carrying values of the assets or cash-generating units being tested with their recoverable amounts (the recoverable amount being the greater of an asset’s or a cash-generating unit’s value in use or its fair value less costs to sell); as referred to in (b) , this is a significant estimate for us. Impairment losses are immediately recognized to the extent that the carrying value of an asset or a cash-generating unit exceeds its recoverable amount. Should the recoverable amounts for impaired assets or cash-generating units subsequently increase, the impairment losses previously recognized (other than in respect of goodwill) may be reversed to the extent that the reversal is not a result of “unwinding of the discount” and that the resulting carrying values do not exceed the carrying values that would have been the result if no impairment losses had been recognized previously.

 

Impairment — property, plant and equipment; intangible assets subject to amortization

 

The continuing program of asset life studies considers such items as the timing of technological obsolescence, competitive pressures and future infrastructure utilization plans; these considerations could also indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable. If the carrying value of an asset were not considered to be recoverable, an impairment loss would be recorded.

 

Impairment — intangible assets with indefinite lives; goodwill

 

The carrying values of intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill are periodically tested for impairment. The frequency of the impairment testing is generally the reciprocal of the stability of the relevant events and circumstances, but intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill must, at a minimum, be tested annually; we have selected December as the time of our annual test.

 

We assess our intangible assets with indefinite lives by comparing the recoverable amounts of our cash-generating units to their carrying values (including the intangible assets with indefinite lives allocated to a cash-generating unit, but excluding any goodwill allocated to a cash-generating unit). To the extent that the carrying value of a cash-generating unit (including the intangible assets with indefinite lives allocated to the cash-generating unit, but excluding any goodwill allocated to the cash-generating unit) exceeds its recoverable amount, the excess amount would be recorded as a reduction in the carrying value of intangible assets with indefinite lives.

 

Subsequent to assessing intangible assets with indefinite lives, we assess goodwill by comparing the recoverable amounts of our cash-generating units to their carrying values (including the intangible assets with indefinite lives and the goodwill allocated to a cash-generating unit). To the extent that the carrying value of a cash-generating unit (including the

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

16


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

intangible assets with indefinite lives and the goodwill allocated to the cash-generating unit) exceeds its recoverable amount, the excess amount would first be recorded as a reduction in the carrying value of goodwill and any remainder would be recorded as a reduction in the carrying values of the assets of the cash-generating unit on a pro-rated basis.

 

(g)          Translation of foreign currencies

 

Trade transactions completed in foreign currencies are translated into Canadian dollars at the rates of exchange prevailing at the time of the transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated into Canadian dollars at the rate of exchange in effect at the statement of financial position date, with any resulting gain or loss recorded in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as a component of Financing costs, as set out in Note 9 . Hedge accounting is applied in specific instances, as discussed further in (d)  preceding.

 

We have foreign subsidiaries that do not have the Canadian dollar as their functional currency. Foreign exchange gains and losses arising from the translation of these foreign subsidiaries’ accounts into Canadian dollars subsequent to January 1, 2010, the date of our transition to IFRS-IASB, are reported as a component of other comprehensive income, as set out in Note 11 .

 

(h)          Income and other taxes

 

We follow the liability method of accounting for income taxes; as referred to in (b) , this is a significant estimate for us. Under this method, current income taxes are recognized for the estimated income taxes payable for the current year. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences between the tax and accounting bases of assets and liabilities, and also for any benefits of losses and Investment Tax Credits available to be carried forward to future years for tax purposes that are more likely than not to be realized. The amounts recognized in respect of deferred income tax assets and liabilities are based upon the expected timing of the reversal of temporary differences or the usage of tax losses and the application of the substantively enacted tax rates at the time of reversal or usage.

 

We account for any changes in substantively enacted income tax rates affecting deferred income tax assets and liabilities in full in the period in which the changes are substantively enacted. We account for changes in the estimates of tax balances for prior years as estimate revisions in the period in which changes in the estimates arise; we have selected this approach as its emphasis on the statement of financial position is more consistent with the liability method of accounting for income taxes.

 

Our operations are complex and the related domestic and foreign tax interpretations, regulations, legislation and jurisprudence are continually changing. As a result, there are usually some tax matters in question that result in uncertain tax positions. We only recognize the income tax benefit of an uncertain tax position when it is more likely than not that the ultimate determination of the tax treatment of the position will result in that benefit being realized; however, this does not mean that tax authorities cannot challenge these positions. We accrue an amount for interest charges on current tax liabilities that have not been funded, which would include interest and penalties arising from uncertain tax positions. We include such charges in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as a component of Financing costs.

 

Our research and development activities may be eligible to earn Investment Tax Credits, for which the determination of eligibility is a complex matter. We only recognize Investment Tax Credits when there is reasonable assurance that the ultimate determination of the eligibility of our research and development activities will result in the Investment Tax Credits being received, at which time they are accounted for using the cost reduction method, whereby such credits are deducted from the expenditures or assets to which they relate, as set out in Note 10(c) .

 

(i)             Share-based compensation

 

General

 

When share-based compensation vests in its entirety at one future point in time (cliff vesting), we recognize the expense on a straight-line basis over the vesting period. When share-based compensation vests in tranches (graded vesting), we recognize the expense using the accelerated expense attribution method. An estimate of forfeitures during the vesting period is made at the date of grant of such share-based compensation; this estimate is adjusted to reflect actual experience.

 

Restricted stock units

 

In respect of restricted stock units without market performance conditions, as set out in Note 14(b) , we accrue a liability equal to the product of the number of vesting restricted stock units multiplied by the fair market value of the corresponding Common Shares at the end of the reporting period (unless hedge accounting is applied, as set out in (d)  preceding). Similarly, we accrue a liability for the notional subset of our restricted stock units with market performance

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

17


 

 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

conditions using a fair value determined using a Monte Carlo simulation. The expense for restricted stock units that do not ultimately vest is reversed against the expense that was previously recorded in their respect.

 

Share option awards

 

A fair value for share option awards is determined at the date of grant and that fair value is recognized in the financial statements. Proceeds arising from the exercise of share option awards are credited to share capital, as are the recognized grant-date fair values of the exercised share option awards.

 

Share option awards that have a net-equity settlement feature, as set out in Note 14(d) , are accounted for as equity instruments. We have selected the equity instrument fair value method of accounting for the net-equity settlement feature as it is consistent with the accounting treatment afforded to the associated share option awards.

 

(j)             Employee future benefit plans

 

Defined benefit plans

 

We accrue amounts for our obligations under employee defined benefit plans and the related costs, net of plan assets. The cost of pensions and other retirement benefits earned by employees is actuarially determined using the accrued benefit method pro-rated on service and management’s best estimates of salary escalation and the retirement ages of employees. In the determination of net income, net interest for each plan, which is the product of the plan’s surplus (deficit) multiplied by the discount rate, is included as a component of Financing costs, as set out in Note 9 .

 

An amount reflecting the effect of differences between the discount rate and the actual rate of return on plan assets is included as a component of employee defined benefit plan re-measurements within Other comprehensive income, as set out in Note 11 and Note 15 . We determine the maximum economic benefit available from the plans’ assets on the basis of reductions in future contributions to the plans.

 

On an annual basis, at a minimum, the defined benefit plan key assumptions are assessed and revised as appropriate; as referred to in (b) , these are significant estimates for us. When the defined benefit plan key assumptions fluctuate significantly relative to their immediately preceding year-end values, actuarial gains (losses) arising from such significant fluctuations are recognized on an interim basis.

 

Defined contribution plans

 

We use defined contribution accounting for the Telecommunication Workers Pension Plan and the British Columbia Public Service Pension Plan, which cover certain of our employees and provide defined benefits to their members. In the absence of any regulations governing the calculation of the share of the underlying financial position and plan performance attributable to each employer-participant, and in the absence of contractual agreements between the plans and the employer-participants related to the financing of any shortfall (or distribution of any surplus), we account for these plans as defined contribution plans in accordance with International Accounting Standard 19, Employee Benefits .

 

(k)          Cash and temporary investments, net

 

Cash and temporary investments, which may include investments in money market instruments that are purchased three months or less from maturity, are presented net of outstanding items, including cheques written but not cleared by the related banks as at the statement of financial position date. Cash and temporary investments, net, are classified as a liability in the statement of financial position when the total amount of all cheques written but not cleared by the related banks exceeds the amount of cash and temporary investments. When cash and temporary investments, net, are classified as a liability, they may also include overdraft amounts drawn on our bilateral bank facilities, which revolve daily and are discussed further in Note 22 .

 

(l)             Inventories

 

Our inventories primarily consist of wireless handsets, parts and accessories totalling $320 million at year-end (December 31, 2017 — $322 million ( adjusted — Note 2(c) ); January 1, 2017 — $268 million ( Note 2(c) ) and communications equipment held for resale. Costs of goods sold for the year ended December 31, 2018, totalled $2,144 million (2017 — $1,975 million ( adjusted — Note 2(c) ).

 

(m)      Property, plant and equipment; intangible assets

 

General

 

Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets are recorded at historical cost, which for self-constructed property, plant and equipment includes materials, direct labour and applicable overhead costs. For internally developed, internal-

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

18


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

use software, the historical cost recorded includes materials, direct labour and direct labour-related costs. Where property, plant and equipment construction projects are of sufficient size and duration, an amount is capitalized for the cost of funds used to finance construction, as set out in Note 9 . The rate for calculating the capitalized financing cost is based on the weighted average cost of borrowing we experience during the reporting period.

 

When we sell property, plant and/or equipment, the net book value is netted against the sale proceeds and the difference, as set out in Note 7 , is included in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as Other operating income.

 

Asset retirement obligations

 

Provisions for liabilities, as set out in Note 25 , are recognized for statutory, contractual or legal obligations, normally when incurred, associated with the retirement of property, plant and equipment (primarily certain items of outside plant and wireless site equipment) when those obligations result from the acquisition, construction, development and/or normal operation of the assets; as referred to in (b) , this is a significant estimate for us. The obligations are measured initially at fair value, which is determined using present value methodology, and the resulting costs are capitalized as a part of the carrying value of the related asset. In subsequent periods, the provisions for these liabilities are adjusted for the accretion of discount, for any changes in the market-based discount rate and for any changes in the amount or timing of the underlying future cash flows. The capitalized asset retirement cost is depreciated on the same basis as the related asset and the discount accretion, as set out in Note 9 , is included in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as a component of Financing costs.

 

(n)          Leases

 

Leases are classified as finance or operating depending upon the terms and conditions of the contracts. See Note 2 for significant changes to IFRS-IASB which are not yet effective, but which we will apply in fiscal 2019 and which, on an individual lease basis, will significantly affect the timing of the recognition of operating lease expenses and their recognition in the Consolidated statement of financial position, as well as their classification in both the Consolidated statement of income and other comprehensive income and the Consolidated statement of cash flows.

 

Where we are the lessee, asset values recorded under finance leases are amortized on a straight-line basis over the period of expected use. Obligations recorded under finance leases are reduced by lease payments net of imputed interest.

 

(o)          Investments

 

We account for our investments in companies over which we have significant influence using the equity method of accounting, whereby the investments are initially recorded at cost and subsequently adjusted to recognize our share of earnings or losses of the investee companies and any earnings distributions received. The excess of the cost of an equity investment over its underlying book value at the date of acquisition, except for goodwill, is amortized over the estimated useful lives of the underlying assets to which the excess cost is attributed.

 

Similarly, we account for our interests in the real estate joint ventures, discussed further in Note 21 , using the equity method of accounting. Unrealized gains and losses from transactions with (including contributions to) the real estate joint ventures are deferred in proportion to our remaining interest in the real estate joint ventures.

 

We account for our other investments as available-for-sale at their fair values unless they are investment securities that do not have quoted market prices in an active market or do not have other clear and objective evidence of fair value. When we do not account for our available-for-sale investments at their fair values, we use the cost basis of accounting, whereby the investments are initially recorded at cost and earnings from those investments are recognized only to the extent received or receivable. The costs of investments sold or the amounts reclassified from other comprehensive income to earnings are determined on a specific-identification basis.

 

Unless there is a significant or prolonged decline in the value of an available-for-sale investment, the carrying values of available-for-sale investments are adjusted to their estimated fair values, and the amount of any such adjustment is included in the Consolidated statement of income and other comprehensive income as a component of other comprehensive income. When there is a significant or prolonged decline in the value of an investment, the carrying value of any such investment accounted for using the equity, available-for-sale or cost method is reduced to its estimated fair value, and the amount of any such reduction is included in the Consolidated statement of income and other comprehensive income as Other operating income.

 


Denotes accounting policy requiring, for us, a more significant choice among accounting policies and/or a more significant application of judgment.

 

 

19


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

2                  accounting policy developments

 

(a)          Initial application of standards, interpretations and amendments to standards and interpretations in the reporting period

 

·                   Amendments to standards arising from Annual Improvements to IFRSs 2015-2017 Cycle were required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2019; such application has had no effect on our financial performance or disclosure.

 

·                   Amendments to standards arising from Annual Improvements to IFRSs 2014-2016 Cycle were required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2017 (for IFRS 12, Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities ), and January 1, 2018 (for the balance of the amendments); such application has had no effect on our financial performance or disclosure.

 

·                   IFRS 9, Financial Instruments , is required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2018, with retrospective application. The new standard includes a model for the classification and measurement of financial instruments, a single forward-looking “expected loss” impairment model and a reformed approach to hedge accounting. Our financial performance is currently not materially affected by the retrospective application of the standard, nor is our financial position, as set out in (c)  following.

 

The previous measurement category and carrying amount of our portfolio investments (see Note 20 ) determined in accordance with IAS 39, Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement and the measurement category and carrying amount determined under the new standard are as follows:

 

 

 

December 31, 2017

 

January 1, 2017

 

As at (millions)

 

As previously
reported

 

IFRS 9
effects

 

As currently
reported

 

As previously
reported

 

IFRS 9
effects

 

As currently
reported

 

Classified as

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Available-for-sale financial assets

 

$

41 

 

$

(41

)

$

 

$

62 

 

$

(62

)

$

 

Fair value through net income 1

 

 

20

 

20

 

 

41

 

41

 

Fair value through other comprehensive income

 

 

21

 

21

 

 

21

 

21

 

 

 

$

41 

 

$

 

$

41 

 

$

62 

 

$

 

$

62 

 

 


(1)          Arising from the classification of investments as accounted for at fair value through net income under the new standard, as at December 31, 2017, $4 (January 1, 2017 — $3), net of income tax effects of $1 (January 1, 2017 — $1), has been adjusted to retained earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income.

 

·                   IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers , is required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2018. The International Accounting Standards Board and the Financial Accounting Standards Board of the United States worked on this joint project to clarify the principles for the recognition of revenue. The new standard was released in May 2014 and supersedes existing standards and interpretations, including IAS 18, Revenue . We have applied the standard retrospectively to prior reporting periods, subject to permitted and elected practical expedients.

 

The effects of the new standard and the materiality of those effects vary by industry and entity; the effects of our retrospective application are set out in (c)  following. Like many other telecommunications companies, we are materially affected by its application, primarily in respect of the timing of revenue recognition, the classification of revenue, the capitalization of the costs of obtaining a contract with a customer and the capitalization of the costs of contract fulfilment (as defined by the new standard).

 

Revenue — timing of recognition; classification

 

The timing of revenue recognition and the classification of our revenues as either service revenues or equipment revenues are affected, since the allocation of consideration in multiple element arrangements (solutions for our customers that may involve deliveries of multiple services and products that occur at different points in time and/or over different periods of time) is no longer affected by the limitation cap methodology previously required by generally accepted accounting principles.

 

The effects of the timing of revenue recognition and the classification of revenue are most pronounced in our wireless results. Although the measurement of the total revenue recognized over the life of a contract is largely unaffected by the new standard, the prohibition of the use of the limitation cap methodology accelerates the recognition of total contract revenue, relative to both the associated cash inflows from customers and our previous practice (using the limitation cap methodology); as set out in (c)  following, cash inflows are unaffected. The acceleration of the recognition of contract revenue relative to the associated cash inflows also results in the

 

 

20


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

recognition of an amount reflecting the resulting difference as a contract asset. Although the underlying transaction economics do not differ, during periods of sustained growth in the number of wireless subscriber connection additions, assuming comparable contract-lifetime per unit cash inflows, revenues would appear to be greater than under the previous practice (using the limitation cap methodology). Wireline results arising from transactions that include the initial provision of subsidized equipment or promotional pricing plans will be similarly affected.

 

We have applied the new standard retrospectively, subject to associated decisions in respect of transitional provisions and permitted practical expedients. The contract asset initially recorded upon transition to the new standard represents revenues that will not be, and have not been, reflected at any time in our periodic results of operations, but that would have been if not for the transition to the new standard; the effect of this “pulling forward” of revenues is expected to be somewhat muted by the composite ongoing inception, maturation and expiration of millions of multi-year contracts with our customers.

 

Costs of contract acquisition; costs of contract fulfilment — timing of recognition

 

Similarly, the measurement of the total costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment over the life of a contract is unaffected by the new standard, but the timing of recognition is. The new standard results in our costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment, to the extent that they are material, being capitalized and subsequently recognized as an expense over the life of a contract on a rational, systematic basis consistent with the pattern of the transfer of goods or services to which the asset relates. Although the underlying transaction economics would not differ, during periods of sustained growth in the number of customer connection additions, assuming comparable per unit costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment, absolute profitability measures would appear to be greater than under the previous practice (immediate expensing of such costs).

 

Implementation

 

Our operations and associated systems are complex and our accounting for millions of multi-year contracts with our customers was affected. Significantly, in order to give effect to the new accounting methodology, incremental compilation of historical data was necessary for our millions of already existing multi-year contracts with our customers that were in-scope for purposes of transitioning to the new standard.

 

After a multi-year expenditure of time and effort, we developed the accounting policies, estimates, judgments and processes necessary to transition to the new standard. Upon completion of the implementation of these items, which included the critical incremental requirements of our information technology systems, we completed the incremental compilation of historical data and the related accounting for that data, all of which is necessary to transition to the new standard.

 

We are using the following practical expedients provided for in, and transitioning to, the new standard:

 

·                   No restatement for contracts that were completed as at January 1, 2017, or earlier.

·                   No restatement for contracts that were modified prior to January 1, 2017. The aggregate effect of all such modifications will be reflected when identifying satisfied and unsatisfied performance obligations and the transaction prices to be allocated thereto, and when determining the transaction prices.

·                   No disclosure of the aggregate transaction prices allocated to remaining unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, performance obligations for all periods ending prior to January 1, 2018.

 

(b)          Standards, interpretations and amendments to standards not yet effective and not yet applied

 

·                   In January 2016, the International Accounting Standards Board released IFRS 16, Leases , which is required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2019, and which supersedes IAS 17, Leases . The International Accounting Standards Board and the Financial Accounting Standards Board of the United States worked together to modify the accounting for leases, generally by eliminating lessees’ classification of leases as either operating leases or finance leases and, for IFRS-IASB, introducing a single lessee accounting model.

 

The most significant effect of the new standard will be the lessee’s recognition of the initial present value of unavoidable future lease payments as right-of-use lease assets and lease liabilities on the statement of financial position, including those for most leases that would currently be accounted for as operating leases. Both leases with durations of 12 months or less and leases for low-value assets may be exempted.

 

The measurement of the total lease expense over the term of a lease will be unaffected by the new standard. However, the new standard will result in an acceleration of the timing of lease expense recognition for leases that would currently be accounted for as operating leases; the International Accounting Standards Board expects that this effect may be muted by a lessee having a portfolio of leases with varying maturities and lengths of term, and we

 

 

21


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

expect that we will be similarly affected. The presentation on the statement of income and other comprehensive income required by the new standard will result in the presentation of most non-executory lease expenses as depreciation of right-of-use lease assets and financing costs arising from lease liabilities, rather than as a part of goods and services purchased (executory lease expenses will remain a part of goods and services purchased); reported operating income would thus be higher under the new standard.

 

Relative to the results of applying the current standard, although actual cash flows will be unaffected, the lessee’s statement of cash flows will reflect increases in cash flows from operating activities offset equally by decreases in cash flows from financing activities. This is the result of the presentation of the payments of the “principal” component of leases that would currently be accounted for as operating leases as a cash flow use within financing activities under the new standard.

 

We will be applying the standard retrospectively, with the cumulative effect of the initial application of the new standard recognized at the date of initial application, January 1, 2019, subject to permitted and elected practical expedients; such method of application would not result in the retrospective adjustment of amounts reported for periods prior to fiscal 2019. The nature of the transition method selected is such that the lease population as at January 1, 2019, and the discount rates determined contemporaneously, will be the basis for the cumulative effects recorded as of that date.

 

Implementation

 

As a transitional practical expedient permitted by the new standard, we will not reassess whether contracts are, or contain, leases as at January 1, 2019, applying the criteria of the new standard; as at January 1, 2019, only contracts that were previously identified as leases applying IAS 17, Leases , and IFRIC 4, Determining whether an Arrangement contains a Lease , will be a part of the transition to the new standard. Only contracts entered into (or changed) after January 1, 2019, will be assessed for being, or containing, leases applying the criteria of the new standard.

 

IFRS 16, Leases , will affect the fiscal 2019 opening amounts to be reported in our fiscal 2019 Consolidated statements of financial position as follows:

 

As at January 1, 2019 (billions)

 

Excluding
effects of
IFRS 16

 

IFRS 16
effects

 

Pro forma

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

$

12.1

 

$

1.0

 

$

13.1

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

$

0.1

 

$

*

 

$

0.1

 

Current maturities of long-term debt

 

$

0.8

 

$

0.2

 

$

1.0

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

$

0.7

 

$

*

 

$

0.7

 

Long-term debt

 

$

13.3

 

$

1.1

 

$

14.4

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

$

0.7

 

$

*

 

$

0.7

 

Deferred income taxes

 

$

3.2

 

$

(0.1

)

$

3.1

 

Owners’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Retained earnings

 

$

4.5

 

$

(0.2

)

$

4.3

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income

 

$

*

 

$

*

 

$

*

 

Non-controlling interests

 

$

0.1

 

$

*

 

$

0.1

 

 


* Amounts less than $0.1 billion.

 

The weighted average discount rate reflected in the lease liability recognized on transition was 4.55%. The difference between the total of the minimum lease payments set out in Note 19 and the additions to long-term debt set out in the table above arises because of the effect of discounting the minimum lease payments (approximately two-thirds of the difference) and because the minimum lease payments set out in Note 19 include payments for leases that have commencement dates subsequent to December 31, 2018 (approximately one-third of the difference).

 

·                   In October 2018, the International Accounting Standards Board amended IFRS 3, Business Combinations , seeking to clarify whether an acquisition transaction results in the acquisition of an asset or the acquisition of a business. The amendments are effective for acquisition transactions on or after January 1, 2020, although earlier application is permitted. The amended standard has a narrower definition of a business, which could result in the recognition of fewer business combinations than under the current standard; the implication of this is that amounts which may have been recognized as goodwill in a business combination under the current standard may now be recognized as allocations to net identifiable assets acquired under the amended standard (with an associated effect in an entity’s results of operations that would differ from the effect of goodwill having been recognized). We are currently

 

 

22


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

assessing the impacts and transition provisions of the amended standard; however, we expect that we will apply the standard prospectively from January 1, 2020. The effects, if any, of the amended standard on our financial performance and disclosure will be dependent on the facts and circumstances of any future acquisition transactions.

 

(c)           Impacts of application of new standards in fiscal 2018

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, affected our Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as follows:

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Years ended December 31 (millions except per share
amounts)

 

Excluding
effects of
IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15
effects

 

As currently
reported

 

Excluding
effects of
IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15
effects

 

As currently
reported

 

Operating revenues

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service

 

$

13,130

 

$

(1,248

)

$

11,882

 

$

12,478

 

$

(1,146

)

$

11,332

 

Equipment

 

792

 

1,421

 

2,213

 

724

 

1,249

 

1,973

 

Revenues arising from contracts with customers

 

13,922

 

173

 

14,095

 

13,202

 

103

 

13,305

 

Other operating income 1

 

273

 

 

273

 

103

 

 

103

 

 

 

14,195

 

173

 

14,368

 

13,305

 

103

 

13,408

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased

 

6,388

 

(20

)

6,368

 

5,935

 

(31

)

5,904

 

Employee benefits expense

 

2,906

 

(10

)

2,896

 

2,595

 

(1

)

2,594

 

Depreciation

 

1,669

 

 

1,669

 

1,617

 

 

1,617

 

Amortization of intangible assets

 

598

 

 

598

 

552

 

 

552

 

 

 

11,561

 

(30

)

11,531

 

10,699

 

(32

)

10,667

 

Operating income

 

2,634

 

203

 

2,837

 

2,606

 

135

 

2,741

 

Financing costs

 

661

 

 

661

 

573

 

 

573

 

Income before income taxes

 

1,973

 

203

 

2,176

 

2,033

 

135

 

2,168

 

Income taxes

 

497

 

55

 

552

 

553

 

37

 

590

 

Net income

 

1,476

 

148

 

1,624

 

1,480

 

98

 

1,578

 

Other comprehensive income 1

 

284

 

 

284

 

(160

)

 

(160

)

Comprehensive income 1

 

$

1,760

 

$

148

 

$

1,908

 

$

1,320

 

$

98

 

$

1,418

 

Net income attributable to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

$

1,452

 

$

148

 

$

1,600

 

$

1,461

 

$

98

 

$

1,559

 

Non-controlling interests

 

24

 

 

24

 

19

 

 

19

 

 

 

$

1,476

 

$

148

 

$

1,624

 

$

1,480

 

$

98

 

$

1,578

 

Comprehensive income attributable to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

$

1,750

 

$

148

 

$

1,898

 

$

1,297

 

$

98

 

$

1,395

 

Non-controlling interests

 

10

 

 

10

 

23

 

 

23

 

 

 

$

1,760

 

$

148

 

$

1,908

 

$

1,320

 

$

98

 

$

1,418

 

Net income per Common Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

2.43

 

$

0.25

 

$

2.68

 

$

2.46

 

$

0.17

 

$

2.63

 

Diluted

 

$

2.43

 

$

0.25

 

$

2.68

 

$

2.46

 

$

0.17

 

$

2.63

 

 


(1)          For the year ended December 31, 2017, other operating income and the change in measurement of investment financial assets included within other comprehensive income increased and decreased, respectively, by $1 arising from the designation of financial assets as being accounted for either at fair value through net income or at fair value through other comprehensive income. Such designation of financial assets is required due to the retrospective implementation of IFRS 9, Financial Instruments .

 

 

23


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The effects of the transition to IFRS 15 on the line items in the preceding table are set out below:

 

 

 

Amount of IFRS 15 effect (increase (decrease) in millions except per share amounts)

 

 

 

Allocation of transaction price (affecting timing of revenue recognition)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract with a customer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

Operating revenues

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service

 

$

(1,248

)

$

(1,146

)

$

 

$

 

$

(1,248

)

$

(1,146

)

Equipment

 

$

1,421

 

$

1,249

 

$

 

$

 

$

1,421

 

$

1,249

 

Goods and services purchased

 

$

 

$

5

 

$

(20

)

$

(36

)

$

(20

)

$

(31

)

Employee benefits expense

 

$

 

$

 

$

(10

)

$

(1

)

$

(10

)

$

(1

)

Income taxes

 

$

47

 

$

27

 

$

8

 

$

10

 

$

55

 

$

37

 

Net income attributable to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

$

126

 

$

71

 

$

22

 

$

27

 

$

148

 

$

98

 

Net income per Common Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

0.21

 

$

0.12

 

$

0.04

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.25

 

$

0.17

 

Diluted

 

$

0.21

 

$

0.12

 

$

0.04

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.25

 

$

0.17

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Previously, costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract with a customer were expensed as incurred. The new standard requires that such costs be capitalized and subsequently recognized as an expense over the life of the contract on a rational, systematic basis consistent with the pattern of the transfer of goods or services to which the asset relates.

 

This has the effect of reducing the costs recognized in the period arising from contracts with customers entered into during the period, offset by the amortization of capitalized costs arising from contracts with customers entered into in previous periods.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Previously, a “limitation cap” constrained the recognition of revenue in a multiple element arrangement to an amount that was not contingent upon either delivering additional items or meeting other specified performance conditions. The new standard requires that amounts contingently billable and collectible in the future be recognized currently as revenue to the extent we have currently satisfied our performance obligations to the customer; this is the new standard’s most significant effect on us.

 

For a contract with a customer, this has the effect of allocating more of the consideration to equipment revenue, which is recognized at the inception of the contract, and less to future service revenue.

 

 

24


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, affected our Consolidated statements of financial position as follows:

 

 

 

December 31, 2018

 

December 31, 2017  1

 

January 1, 2017

 

As at (millions)

 

Excluding effects
of IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15 
effects

 

As currently 
reported

 

Excluding effects
of IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15 
effects

 

As currently
reported

 

Excluding effects
of IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15
effects

 

As currently
reported

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

$

414

 

$

 

$

414

 

$

509

 

$

 

$

509

 

$

432

 

$

 

$

432

 

Accounts receivable

 

1,609

 

(9

)

1,600

 

1,623

 

(9

)

1,614

 

1,471

 

(9

)

1,462

 

Income and other taxes receivable

 

3

 

 

3

 

96

 

 

96

 

9

 

 

9

 

Inventories

 

374

 

2

 

376

 

378

 

2

 

380

 

318

 

2

 

320

 

Contract assets

 

 

860

 

860

 

 

757

 

757

 

 

700

 

700

 

Prepaid expenses

 

278

 

261

 

539

 

260

 

233

 

493

 

233

 

210

 

443

 

Current derivative assets

 

49

 

 

49

 

18

 

 

18

 

11

 

 

11

 

 

 

2,727

 

1,114

 

3,841

 

2,884

 

983

 

3,867

 

2,474

 

903

 

3,377

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

12,091

 

 

12,091

 

11,368

 

 

11,368

 

10,464

 

 

10,464

 

Intangible assets, net

 

10,956

 

 

10,956

 

10,658

 

 

10,658

 

10,364

 

 

10,364

 

Goodwill, net

 

4,733

 

 

4,733

 

4,236

 

 

4,236

 

3,787

 

 

3,787

 

Contract assets

 

 

458

 

458

 

 

396

 

396

 

 

352

 

352

 

Other long-term assets

 

876

 

110

 

986

 

421

 

107

 

528

 

640

 

93

 

733

 

 

 

28,656

 

568

 

29,224

 

26,683

 

503

 

27,186

 

25,255

 

445

 

25,700

 

 

 

$

31,383

 

$

1,682

 

$

33,065

 

$

29,567

 

$

1,486

 

$

31,053

 

$

27,729

 

$

1,348

 

$

29,077

 

LIABILITIES AND OWNERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Short-term borrowings

 

$

100

 

$

 

$

100

 

$

100

 

$

 

$

100

 

$

100

 

$

 

$

100

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

2,570

 

 

2,570

 

2,460

 

 

2,460

 

2,330

 

 

2,330

 

Income and other taxes payable

 

218

 

 

218

 

34

 

 

34

 

37

 

 

37

 

Dividends payable

 

326

 

 

326

 

299

 

 

299

 

284

 

 

284

 

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

810

 

(157

)

653

 

782

 

(150

)

632

 

737

 

(153

)

584

 

Provisions

 

129

 

 

129

 

78

 

 

78

 

124

 

 

124

 

Current maturities of long-term debt

 

836

 

 

836

 

1,404

 

 

1,404

 

1,327

 

 

1,327

 

Current derivative liabilities

 

9

 

 

9

 

33

 

 

33

 

12

 

 

12

 

 

 

4,998

 

(157

)

4,841

 

5,190

 

(150

)

5,040

 

4,951

 

(153

)

4,798

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

728

 

 

728

 

511

 

 

511

 

395

 

 

395

 

Long-term debt

 

13,265

 

 

13,265

 

12,256

 

 

12,256

 

11,604

 

 

11,604

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

738

 

 

738

 

847

 

 

847

 

736

 

 

736

 

Deferred income taxes

 

2,656

 

496

 

3,152

 

2,500

 

441

 

2,941

 

2,107

 

404

 

2,511

 

 

 

17,387

 

496

 

17,883

 

16,114

 

441

 

16,555

 

14,842

 

404

 

15,246

 

Liabilities

 

22,385

 

339

 

22,724

 

21,304

 

291

 

21,595

 

19,793

 

251

 

20,044

 

Owners’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common equity

 

8,916

 

1,343

 

10,259

 

8,221

 

1,195

 

9,416

 

7,917

 

1,097

 

9,014

 

Non-controlling interests

 

82

 

 

82

 

42

 

 

42

 

19

 

 

19

 

 

 

8,998

 

1,343

 

10,341

 

8,263

 

1,195

 

9,458

 

7,936

 

1,097

 

9,033

 

 

 

$

31,383

 

$

1,682

 

$

33,065

 

$

29,567

 

$

1,486

 

$

31,053

 

$

27,729

 

$

1,348

 

$

29,077

 

 


(1)        Goodwill and non-current provisions have been adjusted as set out in Note 18(c) .

 

 

25


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The effects of the transition to IFRS 15 on the line items in the preceding table are set out below:

 

 

 

Amount of IFRS 15 effect (increase (decrease) in millions)

 

 

 

Allocation of transaction price (affecting timing of revenue recognition)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract with a customer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

As at

 

Dec. 31,
2018

 

Dec. 31,
2017

 

Jan. 1,
2017

 

Dec. 31,
2018

 

Dec. 31,
2017

 

Jan. 1,
2017

 

Dec. 31,
2018

 

Dec. 31,
2017

 

Jan. 1,
2017

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

$

(9

)

$

(9

)

$

(9

)

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

(9

)

$

(9

)

$

(9

)

Inventories

 

$

2

 

$

2

 

$

2

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

2

 

$

2

 

$

2

 

Contract assets, net

 

$

860

 

$

757

 

$

700

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

860

 

$

757

 

$

700

 

Prepaid expenses and other

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

261

 

$

233

 

$

210

 

$

261

 

$

233

 

$

210

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Contract assets, net

 

$

458

 

$

396

 

$

352

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

458

 

$

396

 

$

352

 

Other long-term assets

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

110

 

$

107

 

$

93

 

$

110

 

$

107

 

$

93

 

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

$

(157

)

$

(150

)

$

(153

)

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

(157

)

$

(150

)

$

(153

)

Deferred income taxes

 

$

396

 

$

349

 

$

322

 

$

100

 

$

92

 

$

82

 

$

496

 

$

441

 

$

404

 

Retained earnings

 

$

1,072

 

$

947

 

$

876

 

$

271

 

$

248

 

$

221

 

$

1,343

 

$

1,195

 

$

1,097

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Previously, costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract with a customer were expensed as incurred. The new standard requires that such costs be capitalized and subsequently recognized as an expense over the life of the contract on a rational, systematic basis consistent with the pattern of the transfer of goods or services to which the asset relates.

 

Increases in the amount of costs capitalized in the period arising from contracts with customers entered into during the period are offset by the amortization of capitalized costs arising from contracts with customers entered into in previous periods.

 

 

 

 

 

Previously, a “limitation cap” constrained the recognition of revenue in a multiple element arrangement to an amount that was not contingent upon either delivering additional items or meeting other specified performance conditions. The new standard requires that amounts contingently billable and collectible in the future be recognized currently as revenue to the extent we have currently satisfied our performance obligations to the customer; this is the new standard’s most significant effect on us.

 

The difference between the revenue recognized currently and the amount currently collected/collectible is recognized on the statement of financial position as a contract asset.

 

The contract asset recorded at January 1, 2017, represents revenues that will not be, and have not been, reflected at any time in our periodic results of operations, but would have been if not for the transition to the new standard; the effect of this “pulling forward” of revenues is expected to be somewhat muted by the composite ongoing inception, maturation and expiration of millions of multi-year contracts with our customers.

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, affected our Consolidated statements of cash flows as follows:

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Excluding 
effects of 
IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15 
effects

 

As currently 
reported

 

Excluding 
effects of 
IFRS 15

 

IFRS 15 
effects

 

As currently 
reported

 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income 1

 

$

1,476

 

$

148

 

$

1,624

 

$

1,480

 

$

98

 

$

1,578

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

2,267

 

 

2,267

 

2,169

 

 

2,169

 

Deferred income taxes

 

19

 

55

 

74

 

430

 

37

 

467

 

Share-based compensation expense, net

 

6

 

 

6

 

17

 

 

17

 

Net employee defined benefit plans expense

 

95

 

 

95

 

82

 

 

82

 

Employer contributions to employee defined benefit plans

 

(53

)

 

(53

)

(67

)

 

(67

)

Non-current contract assets

 

 

(62

)

(62

)

 

(44

)

(44

)

Income from equity accounted investments

 

(170

)

 

(170

)

(4

)

 

(4

)

Shares settled from Treasury

 

100

 

 

100

 

 

 

 

Other 1

 

(76

)

(3

)

(79

)

(18

)

(14

)

(32

)

Net change in non-cash operating working capital

 

394

 

(138

)

256

 

(142

)

(77

)

(219

)

Cash provided by operating activities

 

$

4,058

 

$

 

$

4,058

 

$

3,947

 

$

 

$

3,947

 

 


(1)          For the year ended December 31, 2017, net income and other increased and decreased, respectively, by $1 arising from the designation of financial assets as being accounted for either at fair value through net income or at fair value through other comprehensive income. Such designation of financial assets is required due to the retrospective implementation of IFRS 9, Financial Instruments .

 

 

26


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

3                  capital structure financial policies

 

General

 

Our objective when managing capital is to maintain a flexible capital structure that optimizes the cost and availability of capital at acceptable risk.

 

In the management of capital and in its definition, we include common equity (excluding accumulated other comprehensive income), long-term debt (including long-term credit facilities, commercial paper backstopped by long-term credit facilities and any hedging assets or liabilities associated with long-term debt items, net of amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income), cash and temporary investments, and short-term borrowings arising from securitized trade receivables.

 

We manage our capital structure and make adjustments to it in light of changes in economic conditions and the risk characteristics of our business. In order to maintain or adjust our capital structure, we may adjust the amount of dividends paid to holders of Common Shares, purchase Common Shares for cancellation pursuant to normal course issuer bids, issue new shares, issue new debt, issue new debt to replace existing debt with different characteristics and/or increase or decrease the amount of trade receivables sold to an arm’s-length securitization trust.

 

During 2018, our financial objectives, which are reviewed annually, were unchanged from 2017. We believe that our financial objectives are supportive of our long-term strategy.

 

We monitor capital utilizing a number of measures, including: net debt to earnings before interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization (EBITDA * ) — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio; coverage ratios; and dividend payout ratios.

 

Debt and coverage ratios

 

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs is calculated as net debt at the end of the period, divided by 12-month trailing EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs. This measure, historically, is substantially similar to the leverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities. Net debt and EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs are measures that do not have any standardized meanings prescribed by IFRS-IASB and are therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other companies. The calculation of these measures is set out in the following table. Net debt is one component of a ratio used to determine compliance with debt covenants.

 

As at, or for the 12-month periods ended, December 31 ($ in millions)

 

Objective

 

2018

 

2017

 

Components of debt and coverage ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net debt  1

 

 

 

$

13,770

 

$

13,422

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs  2

 

 

 

$

5,421

 

$

5,027

 

Net interest cost  3

 

 

 

$

644

 

$

567

 

Debt ratio

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs

 

2.00 – 2.50  4

 

2.54

 

2.67

 

Coverage ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings coverage  5

 

 

 

4.4

 

4.8

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage  6

 

 

 

8.4

 

 

8.9

 

 


(1)          Net debt is calculated as follows:

 

As at December 31

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Long-term debt

 

26

 

$

14,101

 

$

13,660

 

Debt issuance costs netted against long-term debt

 

 

 

93

 

73

 

Derivative (assets) liabilities, net

 

 

 

(73

)

93

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income amounts arising from financial instruments used to manage interest rate and currency risks associated with U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt — excluding tax effects

 

 

 

(37

)

5

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

 

 

(414

)

(509

)

Short-term borrowings

 

22

 

100

 

100

 

Net debt

 

 

 

$

13,770

 

$

13,422

 

 


*  EBITDA does not have any standardized meaning prescribed by IFRS-IASB and is therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers; we define EBITDA as operating revenues less goods and services purchased and employee benefits expense. We have issued guidance on, and report, EBITDA because it is a key measure that management uses to evaluate the performance of our business, and it is also utilized in measuring compliance with certain debt covenants.

 

 

27


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(2)          EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs is calculated as follows:

 

Years ended December 31

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

EBITDA

 

5

 

$

5,104

 

$

4,910

 

Restructuring and other costs

 

16

 

317

 

117

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs

 

 

 

$

5,421

 

$

5,027

 

 

(3)          Net interest cost is defined as financing costs, excluding employee defined benefit plans net interest, recoveries on long-term debt prepayment premium and repayment of debt, calculated on a 12-month trailing basis (expenses recorded for long-term debt prepayment premium, if any, are included in net interest cost).

(4)          Our long-term objective range for this ratio is 2.00 — 2.50 times. The ratio as at December 31, 2018, is outside the long-term objective range. We may permit, and have permitted, this ratio to go outside the objective range (for long-term investment opportunities), but we will endeavour to return this ratio to within the objective range in the medium term, as we believe that this range is supportive of our long-term strategy. We are in compliance with the leverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities, which states that we may not permit our net debt to operating cash flow ratio to exceed 4.00:1.00 (see Note 26(d) ); the calculation of the debt ratio is substantially similar to the calculation of the leverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities.

(5)          Earnings coverage is defined as net income before borrowing costs and income tax expense, divided by borrowing costs (interest on long-term debt; interest on short-term borrowings and other; long-term debt prepayment premium), and adding back capitalized interest.

(6)          EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage is defined as EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs, divided by net interest cost. This measure is substantially similar to the coverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities.

 

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs was 2.54 times as at December 31, 2018, down from 2.67 times one year earlier. The effect of the increase in net debt was exceeded by the effect of growth in EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs. The earnings coverage ratio for the twelve-month period ended December 31, 2018, was 4.4 times, down from 4.8 times one year earlier. Higher borrowing costs reduced the ratio by 0.6 and an increase in income before borrowing costs and income taxes increased the ratio by 0.1. The EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage ratio for the twelve-month period ended December 31, 2018, was 8.4 times, down from 8.9 times one year earlier. Growth in EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs increased the ratio by 0.6, while an increase in net interest costs reduced the ratio by 1.1.

 

Dividend payout ratio

 

The dividend payout ratio presented is a historical measure calculated as the sum of the last four quarterly dividends declared per Common Share, as recorded in the financial statements, divided by the sum of basic earnings per share for the most recent four quarters for interim reporting periods (divided by annual basic earnings per share if the reported amount is in respect of a fiscal year). The dividend payout ratio of adjusted net earnings presented, also a historical measure, differs in that it excludes the gain on exchange of wireless spectrum licences, net gains and equity income from real estate joint ventures, provisions related to business combinations, immediately vesting transformative compensation expense, long-term debt prepayment premium and income tax-related adjustments.

 

For the 12-month periods ended December 31 ($ in millions)

 

Objective

 

2018

 

2017

 

Dividend payout ratio

 

65%–75%  1

 

78

%

80

%

Dividend payout ratio of adjusted net earnings  

 

 

 

81

%

80

%

 


(1)          Our objective range for the dividend payout ratio is 65%—75% of sustainable earnings on a prospective basis; we currently expect that we will be within our target guideline on a prospective basis within the medium term. Adjusted net earnings attributable to Common Shares is calculated as follows:

 

12-month periods ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

$

1,600

 

$

1,559

 

Gain and net equity income related to real estate redevelopment project, after income taxes

 

(150

)

(1

)

Business combination-related provisions, after income taxes

 

(17

)

(22

)

Income tax-related adjustments

 

(7

)

21

 

Long-term debt prepayment premium, after income taxes

 

25

 

 

Initial and committed donation to TELUS Future Friendly Foundation, after income taxes

 

90

 

 

Adjusted net earnings attributable to Common Shares

 

$

1,541

 

$

1,557

 

 

 

28


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

4                  financial instruments

 

(a)          Risks — overview

 

Our financial instruments, their accounting classification and the nature of certain risks to which they may be subject are set out in the following table.

 

 

 

 

 

Risks

 

 

 

Accounting 

 

 

 

 

 

Market risks

 

Financial instrument

 

classification

 

Credit

 

Liquidity

 

Currency

 

Interest rate

 

Other price

 

Measured at amortized cost

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

AC 1

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

Contract assets

 

AC 1

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction credit facilities advances to real estate joint venture

 

AC 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

Short-term obligations

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions (including restructuring accounts payable)

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

Long-term debt

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

Measured at fair value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and temporary investments

 

FVTPL 2

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

Long-term investments (not subject to significant influence) 3

 

FVTPL/FVOCI 3

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

Foreign exchange derivatives 4

 

FVTPL 2

 

X

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

Share-based compensation derivatives 4

 

FVTPL 2

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 


(1)          For accounting recognition and measurement purposes, classified as amortized cost (AC).

(2)          For accounting recognition and measurement purposes, classified as fair value through net income (FVTPL). Unrealized changes in the fair values of financial instruments are included in net income unless the instrument is part of a cash flow hedging relationship. The effective portion of unrealized changes in the fair values of financial instruments held for hedging are included in other comprehensive income.

(3)          Long-term investments over which we do not have significant influence are measured at fair value if those fair values can be reliably measured. For accounting recognition and measurement purposes, on an investment-by-investment basis, long-term investments are classified as either fair value through net income or fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI).

(4)          Use of derivative financial instruments is subject to a policy which requires that no derivative transaction is to be entered into for the purpose of establishing a speculative or leveraged position (the corollary being that all derivative transactions are to be entered into for risk management purposes only) and sets criteria for the creditworthiness of the transaction counterparties.

 

Derivatives that are part of an established and documented cash flow hedging relationship are accounted for as held for hedging. We believe that classification as held for hedging results in a better matching of the change in the fair value of the derivative financial instrument with the risk exposure being hedged.

 

In respect of hedges of anticipated transactions, hedge gains/losses are included with the related expenditure and are expensed when the transaction is recognized in our results of operations. We have selected this method as we believe that it results in a better matching of the hedge gains/losses with the risk exposure being hedged.

 

Derivatives that are not part of a documented cash flow hedging relationship are accounted for as held for trading and thus are measured at fair value through net income.

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

We apply hedge accounting to financial instruments used to establish hedge accounting relationships for U.S. dollar-denominated transactions and to fix the cost of some share-based compensation. We believe that our use of derivative financial instruments for hedging or arbitrage assists us in managing our financing costs and/or lessening the uncertainty associated with our financing or other business activities. Uncertainty associated with currency risk and other price risk is lessened through our use of foreign exchange derivatives and share-based compensation derivatives that effectively swap floating currency exchange rates and share prices for fixed rates and prices. When entering into derivative financial instrument contracts, we seek to align the cash flow timing of the hedging items with that of the hedged items. The effects of this risk management strategy and its application are set out in (i)  following.

 

(b)          Credit risk

 

Excluding credit risk, if any, arising from currency swaps settled on a gross basis, the best representation of our maximum exposure (excluding income tax effects) to credit risk, which is a worst-case scenario and does not reflect results we expect, is set out in the following table:

 

 

29


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

As at (millions)

 

December 31, 
2018

 

December 31, 
2017

 

January 1, 
2017

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

(Note 2(c))

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

$

414

 

$

509

 

$

432

 

Accounts receivable

 

1,600

 

1,614

 

1,462

 

Contract assets

 

1,318

 

1,153

 

1,052

 

Derivative assets

 

103

 

24

 

17

 

 

 

$

3,435

 

$

3,300

 

$

2,963

 

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

Credit risk associated with cash and temporary investments is managed by ensuring that these financial assets are placed with: governments; major financial institutions that have been accorded strong investment grade ratings by a primary rating agency; and/or other creditworthy counterparties. An ongoing review evaluates changes in the status of counterparties.

 

Accounts receivable

 

Credit risk associated with accounts receivable is inherently managed by the size and diversity of our large customer base, which includes substantially all consumer and business sectors in Canada. We follow a program of credit evaluations of customers and limit the amount of credit extended when deemed necessary.

 

As at December 31, 2018, the weighted average age of customer accounts receivable was 30 days (December 31, 2017 — 26 days; January 1, 2017 — 26 days) and the weighted average age of past-due customer accounts receivable was 56 days (December 31, 2017 — 60 days; January 1, 2017 — 61 days). Accounts are considered to be past due (in default) when customers have failed to make the contractually required payments when due, which is generally within 30 days of the billing date. Any late payment charges are levied at an industry-based market or negotiated rate on outstanding non-current customer account balances.

 

 

 

December 31, 2018

 

December 31, 2017

 

January 1, 2017

 

As at (millions)

 

Gross

 

Allowance

 

Net  1

 

Gross

 

Allowance

 

Net  1

 

Gross

 

Allowance

 

Net  1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted -
Note 2(c))

 

 

 

 

 

(Note 2(c))

 

Customer accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Less than 30 days past billing date

 

$

762

 

$

(13

)

$

749

 

$

905

 

$

(10

)

$

895

 

$

899

 

$

(11

)

$

888

 

30-60 days past billing date

 

354

 

(10

)

344

 

185

 

(8

)

177

 

185

 

(9

)

176

 

61-90 days past billing date

 

80

 

(8

)

72

 

60

 

(8

)

52

 

44

 

(9

)

35

 

More than 90 days past billing date

 

67

 

(22

)

45

 

62

 

(17

)

45

 

80

 

(25

)

55

 

 

 

$

1,263

 

$

(53

)

$

1,210

 

$

1,212

 

$

(43

)

$

1,169

 

$

1,208

 

$

(54

)

$

1,154

 

 


(1)          Net amounts represent customer accounts receivable for which an allowance had not been made as at the dates of the Consolidated statements of financial position (see Note 6(b) ).

 

We maintain allowances for lifetime expected credit losses related to doubtful accounts. Current economic conditions (including forward-looking macroeconomic data), historical information (including credit agency reports, if available), reasons for the accounts being past due and the line of business from which the customer accounts receivable arose are all considered when determining whether to make allowances for past-due accounts. The same factors are considered when determining whether to write off amounts charged to the allowance for doubtful accounts against the customer accounts receivable; amounts charged to the customer accounts receivable allowance for doubtful accounts that were written off but were still subject to enforcement activity as at December 31, 2018, totalled $353 million (December 31, 2017 — $298 million; January 1, 2017 — $231 million). The doubtful accounts expense is calculated on a specific-identification basis for customer accounts receivable above a specific balance threshold and on a statistically derived allowance basis for the remainder. No customer accounts receivable are written off directly to the doubtful accounts expense.

 

The following table presents a summary of the activity related to our allowance for doubtful accounts.

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Balance, beginning of period

 

$

43

 

$

54

 

Additions (doubtful accounts expense)

 

56

 

54

 

Accounts written off, net of recoveries

 

(55

)

(66

)

Other

 

9

 

1

 

Balance, end of period

 

$

53

 

$

43

 

 

 

30


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Contract assets

 

Credit risk associated with contract assets is inherently managed by the size and diversity of our large customer base, which includes substantially all consumer and business sectors in Canada. We follow a program of credit evaluations of customers and limit the amount of credit extended when deemed necessary.

 

 

 

December 31, 2018

 

December 31, 2017

 

January 1, 2017

 

As at (millions)

 

Gross

 

Allowance

 

Net
(Note 6(c))

 

Gross

 

Allowance

 

Net
(Note 6(c))

 

Gross

 

Allowance

 

Net
(Note 6(c))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(Note 2(c))

 

 

 

 

 

(Note 2(c))

 

Contract assets, net of impairment allowance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

To be billed and thus reclassified to accounts receivable during:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The 12-month period ending one year hence

 

$

1,068

 

$

(51

)

$

1,017

 

$

958

 

$

(51

)

$

907

 

$

901

 

$

(48

)

$

853

 

The 12-month period ending two years hence

 

466

 

(22

)

444

 

407

 

(22

)

385

 

359

 

(21

)

338

 

Thereafter

 

15

 

(1

)

14

 

11

 

 

11

 

15

 

(1

)

14

 

 

 

$

1,549

 

$

(74

)

$

1,475

 

$

1,376

 

$

(73

)

$

1,303

 

$

1,275

 

$

(70

)

$

1,205

 

 

We maintain allowances for lifetime expected credit losses related to contract assets. Current economic conditions, historical information (including credit agency reports, if available), and the line of business from which the contract asset arose are all considered when determining impairment allowances. The same factors are considered when determining whether to write off amounts charged to the impairment allowance for contract assets against contract assets.

 

Derivative assets (and derivative liabilities)

 

Counterparties to our share-based compensation cash-settled equity forward agreements and foreign exchange derivatives are major financial institutions that have been accorded investment grade ratings by a primary credit rating agency. The total dollar amount of credit exposure under contracts with any one financial institution is limited and counterparties’ credit ratings are monitored. We do not give or receive collateral on swap agreements and hedging items due to our credit rating and those of our counterparties. While we are exposed to the risk of potential credit losses due to the possible non-performance of our counterparties, we consider this risk remote. Our derivative liabilities do not have credit risk-related contingent features.

 

(c)           Liquidity risk

 

As a component of our capital structure financial policies, discussed further in Note 3 , we manage liquidity risk by:

 

·                   maintaining a daily cash pooling process that enables us to manage our available liquidity and our liquidity requirements according to our actual needs;

·                   maintaining an agreement to sell trade receivables to an arm’s-length securitization trust and bilateral bank facilities ( Note 22 ), a commercial paper program ( Note 26(c) ) and syndicated credit facilities ( Note 26(d),(e) );

·                   maintaining an in-effect shelf prospectus;

·                   continuously monitoring forecast and actual cash flows; and

·                   managing maturity profiles of financial assets and financial liabilities.

 

Our debt maturities in future years are as disclosed in Note 26(g) . As at December 31, 2018, we could offer $2.5 billion of debt or equity securities pursuant to a shelf prospectus that is in effect until June 2020 (2017 — $1.2 billion pursuant to a shelf prospectus that was in effect until April 2018). We believe that our investment grade credit ratings contribute to reasonable access to capital markets.

 

We closely match the contractual maturities of our derivative financial liabilities with those of the risk exposures they are being used to manage.

 

The expected maturities of our undiscounted financial liabilities do not differ significantly from the contractual maturities, other than as noted below. The contractual maturities of our undiscounted financial liabilities, including interest thereon (where applicable), are set out in the following tables:

 

 

31


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

 

 

Non-derivative

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

Non-interest

 

 

 

Construction 

 

Composite long-term debt

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at 

 

bearing

 

 

 

credit facilities 

 

Long-term 

 

Finance

 

Currency swap agreement

 

 

 

Currency swap agreement 

 

 

 

December 31, 

 

financial 

 

Short-term 

 

commitment  2  

 

debt  1  

 

leases  1  

 

amounts to be exchanged  3

 

 

 

amounts to be exchanged

 

 

 

2018 (millions)

 

liabilities

 

borrowings  1

 

(Note 21)

 

(Note 26)

 

(Note 26)

 

(Receive)

 

Pay

 

Other

 

(Receive)

 

Pay

 

Total

 

2019

 

$

2,372

 

$

3

 

$

45

 

$

1,349

 

$

55

 

$

(877

)

$

851

 

$

 

$

(542

)

$

516

 

$

3,772

 

2020

 

251

 

3

 

 

1,567

 

51

 

(95

)

89

 

1

 

 

 

1,867

 

2021

 

102

 

103

 

 

1,567

 

 

(95

)

89

 

 

 

 

1,766

 

2022

 

18

 

 

 

2,086

 

 

(95

)

89

 

1

 

 

 

2,099

 

2023

 

19

 

 

 

886

 

 

(95

)

89

 

 

 

 

899

 

2024-2028

 

20

 

 

 

6,240

 

 

(1,917

)

1,847

 

 

 

 

6,190

 

Thereafter

 

 

 

 

7,744

 

 

(1,964

)

1,832

 

 

 

 

7,612

 

Total

 

$

2,782

 

$

109

 

$

45

 

$

21,439

 

$

106

 

$

(5,138

)

$

4,886

 

$

2

 

$

(542

)

$

516

 

$

24,205

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total ( Note 26(h) )

 

 

 

$

21,293

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


(1)           Cash outflows in respect of interest payments on our short-term borrowings, commercial paper, finance leases and amounts drawn under our credit facilities (if any) have been calculated based upon the interest rates in effect as at December 31, 2018.

(2)           The drawdowns on the construction credit facilities are expected to occur as construction progresses through 2019.

(3)           The amounts included in undiscounted non-derivative long-term debt in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt, and the corresponding amounts in the long-term debt currency swaps receive column, have been determined based upon the currency exchange rates in effect as at December 31, 2018. The hedged U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt contractual amounts at maturity, in effect, are reflected in the long-term debt currency swaps pay column as gross cash flows are exchanged pursuant to the currency swap agreements.

 

 

 

Non-derivative

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

Non-interest

 

 

 

Construction

 

Composite long-term debt

 

 

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2017

 

bearing
financial

 

Short-term

 

credit facilities
commitment
 2

 

Long-term
debt
1  

 

Currency swap agreement
amounts to be exchanged 
3

 

Currency swap agreement
amounts to be exchanged

 

 

 

(millions)

 

liabilities

 

borrowings  1

 

(Note 21)

 

(Note 26)

 

(Receive)

 

Pay

 

(Receive)

 

Pay

 

Total

 

2018

 

$

2,232

 

$

103

 

$

67

 

$

1,928

 

$

(1,188

)

$

1,206

 

$

(545

)

$

557

 

$

4,360

 

2019

 

40

 

 

 

1,531

 

(44

)

46

 

 

 

1,573

 

2020

 

19

 

 

 

1,480

 

(44

)

46

 

 

 

1,501

 

2021

 

95

 

 

 

1,480

 

(44

)

46

 

 

 

1,577

 

2022

 

18

 

 

 

1,913

 

(44

)

46

 

 

 

1,933

 

2023-2027

 

16

 

 

 

5,796

 

(1,591

)

1,679

 

 

 

5,900

 

Thereafter

 

 

 

 

5,634

 

 

 

 

 

5,634

 

Total

 

$

2,420

 

$

103

 

$

67

 

$

19,762

 

$

(2,955

)

$

3,069

 

$

(545

)

$

557

 

$

22,478

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

 

$

19,876

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


(1)           Cash outflows in respect of interest payments on our short-term borrowings, commercial paper and amounts drawn under our credit facilities (if any) have been calculated based upon the interest rates in effect as at December 31, 2017.

(2)           The drawdowns on the construction credit facilities were expected to occur as construction progresses through 2019.

(3)           The amounts included in undiscounted non-derivative long-term debt in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt, and the corresponding amounts in the long-term debt currency swaps receive column, have been determined based upon the currency exchange rates in effect as at December 31, 2017. The hedged U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt contractual amounts at maturity, in effect, are reflected in the long-term debt currency swaps pay column as gross cash flows are exchanged pursuant to the currency swap agreements.

 

(d)          Currency risk

 

Our functional currency is the Canadian dollar, but certain routine revenues and operating costs are denominated in U.S. dollars and some inventory purchases and capital asset acquisitions are sourced internationally. The U.S. dollar is the only foreign currency to which we have a significant exposure.

 

Our foreign exchange risk management includes the use of foreign currency forward contracts and currency options to fix the exchange rates on a varying percentage, typically in the range of 50% to 75%, of our domestic short-term U.S. dollar-denominated transactions and commitments and all U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper. Other than in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper, we designate only the spot element of these instruments as the hedging item; the forward element is wholly immaterial; in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper, we designate the forward rate.

 

As discussed further in Note 26(b)  and Note 26(f) , we are also exposed to currency risk in that the fair value or future cash flows of our U.S. Dollar Notes and our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility U.S. dollar borrowings could fluctuate because of changes in foreign exchange rates. Currency hedging relationships have been established for the related semi-annual interest payments and the principal payment at maturity in respect of the U.S. Dollar Notes; we designate only the spot element of these instruments as the hedging item; the forward element is wholly immaterial. As the functional currency of our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. subsidiary is the U.S. dollar, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates affecting its borrowings are reflected as a foreign currency translation adjustment within other comprehensive income.

 

 

32


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(e)           Interest rate risk

 

Changes in market interest rates will cause fluctuations in the fair values or future cash flows of temporary investments, construction credit facility advances made to the real estate joint venture, short-term obligations, long-term debt and interest rate swap derivatives.

 

When we have temporary investments, they have short maturities and fixed interest rates and as a result, their fair values will fluctuate with changes in market interest rates; absent monetization prior to maturity, the related future cash flows will not change due to changes in market interest rates.

 

If the balance of short-term investments includes dividend-paying equity instruments, we could be exposed to interest rate risk.

 

Due to the short-term nature of the applicable rates of interest charged, the fair value of the construction credit facility advances made to the real estate joint venture is not materially affected by changes in market interest rates; the associated cash flows representing interest payments will be affected until such advances are repaid.

 

As short-term obligations arising from bilateral bank facilities, which typically have variable interest rates, are rarely outstanding for periods that exceed one calendar week, interest rate risk associated with this item is not material.

 

Short-term borrowings arising from the sales of trade receivables to an arm’s-length securitization trust are fixed-rate debt. Due to the short maturities of these borrowings, interest rate risk associated with this item is not material.

 

All of our currently outstanding long-term debt, other than commercial paper and amounts drawn on our credit facilities ( Note 26(c), (e) ), is fixed-rate debt. The fair value of fixed-rate debt fluctuates with changes in market interest rates; absent early redemption, the related future cash flows will not change. Due to the short maturities of commercial paper, its fair value is not materially affected by changes in market interest rates, but the associated cash flows representing interest payments may be affected if the commercial paper is rolled over.

 

Amounts drawn on our short-term and long-term credit facilities will be affected by changes in market interest rates in a manner similar to commercial paper.

 

(f)            Other price risk

 

Long-term investments

 

We are exposed to equity price risk arising from investments classified as fair value through other comprehensive income. Such investments are held for strategic rather than trading purposes.

 

Share-based compensation derivatives

 

We are exposed to other price risk arising from cash-settled share-based compensation (appreciating Common Share prices increase both the expense and the potential cash outflow). Certain cash-settled equity swap agreements have been entered into that fix the cost associated with our estimate of TELUS Corporation restricted stock units which are expected to vest and are not subject to performance conditions ( Note 14(b) ).

 

(g)          Market risks

 

Net income and other comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, could have varied if the Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar exchange rate and our Common Share price varied by reasonably possible amounts from their actual statement of financial position date amounts.

 

The sensitivity analysis of our exposure to currency risk at the reporting date has been determined based upon a hypothetical change taking place at the relevant statement of financial position date. The U.S. dollar-denominated balances and derivative financial instrument notional amounts as at the statement of financial position dates have been used in the calculations.

 

The sensitivity analysis of our exposure to other price risk arising from share-based compensation at the reporting date has been determined based upon a hypothetical change taking place at the relevant statement of financial position date. The relevant notional number of Common Shares at the statement of financial position date, which includes those in the cash-settled equity swap agreements, has been used in the calculations.

 

Income tax expense, which is reflected net in the sensitivity analysis, reflects the applicable statutory income tax rates for the reporting periods.

 

 

33


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Years ended December 31 
(increase (decrease) in millions)

 

Net income

 

Other comprehensive income

 

Comprehensive income

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

Reasonably possible changes in market risks  1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10% change in C$: US$ exchange rate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Canadian dollar appreciates

 

$

(1

)

$

(1

)

$

(33

)

$

(15

)

$

(34

)

$

(16

)

Canadian dollar depreciates

 

$

1

 

$

1

 

$

33

 

$

15

 

$

34

 

$

16

 

25 basis point change in interest rates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rates increase

 

$

(2

)

$

(3

)

$

2

 

$

1

 

$

 

$

(2

)

Interest rates decrease

 

$

2

 

$

3

 

$

(1

)

$

 

$

1

 

$

3

 

25%  2 change in Common Share price  3

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Price increases

 

$

 

$

(8

)

$

(1

)

$

13

 

$

(1

)

$

5

 

Price decreases

 

$

5

 

$

14

 

$

1

 

$

(13

)

$

6

 

$

1

 

 


(1)          These sensitivities are hypothetical and should be used with caution. Changes in net income and/or other comprehensive income generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumption to the change in net income and/or other comprehensive income may not be linear. In this table, the effect of a variation in a particular assumption on the amount of net income and/or other comprehensive income is calculated without changing any other factors; in reality, changes in one factor may result in changes in another, which might magnify or counteract the sensitivities.

 

The sensitivity analysis assumes that we would realize the changes in exchange rates; in reality, the competitive marketplace in which we operate would have an effect on this assumption.

 

No consideration has been made for a difference in the notional number of Common Shares associated with share-based compensation awards made during the reporting period that may have arisen due to a difference in the Common Share price.

 

(2)          To facilitate ongoing comparison of sensitivities, a constant variance of approximate magnitude has been used. Reflecting a 12-month data period and calculated on a monthly basis, the volatility of our Common Share price as at December 31, 2018, was 10.9% (2017 — 7.0%).

 

(3)          The hypothetical effects of changes in the price of our Common Shares are restricted to those which would arise from our share-based compensation awards that are accounted for as liability instruments and the associated cash-settled equity swap agreements.

 

(h)          Fair values

 

General

 

The carrying values of cash and temporary investments, accounts receivable, short-term obligations, short-term borrowings, accounts payable and certain provisions (including restructuring provisions) approximate their fair values due to the immediate or short-term maturity of these financial instruments. The fair values are determined directly by reference to quoted market prices in active markets.

 

The fair values of our investment financial assets are based on quoted market prices in active markets or other clear and objective evidence of fair value.

 

The fair value of our long-term debt is based on quoted market prices in active markets.

 

The fair values of the derivative financial instruments we use to manage our exposure to currency risk are estimated based on quoted market prices in active markets for the same or similar financial instruments or on the current rates offered to us for financial instruments of the same maturity, as well as discounted future cash flows determined using current rates for similar financial instruments of similar maturities subject to similar risks (such fair value estimates being largely based on the Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar forward exchange rate as at the statement of financial position dates).

 

The fair values of the derivative financial instruments we use to manage our exposure to increases in compensation costs arising from certain forms of share-based compensation are based on fair value estimates of the related cash-settled equity forward agreements provided by the counterparty to the transactions (such fair value estimates being largely based on our Common Share price as at the statement of financial position dates).

 

Derivative

 

The derivative financial instruments that we measure at fair value on a recurring basis subsequent to initial recognition are set out in the following table.

 

 

34


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Designation

 

Maximum
 maturity date

 

Notional
amount

 

Fair value  1  and
 carrying value

 

Price or 
rate

 

Maximum
 maturity date

 

Notional 
amount

 

Fair value  1  and
carrying value

 

Price or
 rate

 

Current Assets  2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives used to manage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated purchases

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

414

 

$

25

 

US$1.00: C$1.28

 

2018

 

$

110

 

$

2

 

US$1.00: C$1.24

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar revenues

 

HFT  4

 

2019

 

$

74

 

1

 

US$1.00: C$1.36

 

2018

 

$

71

 

1

 

US$1.00: C$1.25

 

Changes in share-based compensation costs ( Note 14(b) )

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

63

 

2

 

$ 45.46

 

2018

 

$

73

 

14

 

$40.91

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt ( Note 26(b)-(c) )

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

761

 

21

 

US$1.00: C$1.33

 

2018

 

$

124

 

1

 

US$1.00: C$1.24

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

49

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

18

 

 

 

Other Long-Term Assets  2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives used to manage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Changes in share-based compensation costs ( Note 14(b) )

 

HFH  3

 

 

$

 

$

 

 

2019

 

$

63

 

$

6

 

$45.46

 

Currency risks arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt 5  ( Note 26(b)-(c) )

 

HFH  3

 

2048

 

$

3,134

 

54

 

US$1.00: C$1.28

 

 

$

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

54

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

6

 

 

 

Current Liabilities  2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives used to manage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated purchases

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

11

 

$

 

US$1.00: C$1.36

 

2018

 

$

376

 

$

14

 

US$1.00: C$1.30

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar revenues

 

HFT  4

 

2019

 

$

18

 

 

US$1.00: C$1.36

 

 

$

 

 

 

Changes in share-based compensation costs ( Note 14(b) )

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

2

 

 

$ 47.39

 

 

$

 

 

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt ( Note 26(b)-(c) )

 

HFH  3

 

 

$

 

 

 

2018

 

$

1,036

 

18

 

US$1.00: C$1.28

 

Interest rate risk associated with non-fixed rate credit facility amounts drawn ( Note 26(e) )

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

8

 

 

2.64%

 

 

$

 

 

 

Interest rate risk associated with planned refinancing of debt maturing

 

HFH  3

 

2019

 

$

250

 

9

 

2.40%, GOC 10-year term

 

2018

 

$

300

 

1

 

2.14%, GOC 10-year term

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

9

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

33

 

 

 

Other Long-Term Liabilities  2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives used to manage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Changes in share-based compensation costs ( Note 14(b) )

 

HFH  3

 

2020

 

$

67

 

$

3

 

$ 48.71

 

 

$

 

$

 

 

Currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt 5  ( Note 26(b)-(c) )

 

HFH  3

 

2027

 

$

991

 

2

 

US$1.00: C$1.33

 

2027

 

$

1,910

 

76

 

US$1.00: C$1.32

 

Interest rate risk associated with non-fixed rate credit facility amounts drawn ( Note 26(e) )

 

HFH  3

 

2022

 

$

145

 

1

 

2.64%

 

 

$

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

6

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

76

 

 

 

 


(1)       Fair value measured at reporting date using significant other observable inputs (Level 2).

(2)       Derivative financial assets and liabilities are not set off.

(3)       Designated as held for hedging (HFH) upon initial recognition (cash flow hedging item); hedge accounting is applied. Unless otherwise noted, hedge ratio is 1:1 and is established by assessing the degree of matching between the notional amounts of hedging items and the notional amounts of the associated hedged items.

(4)       Designated as held for trading (HFT) and classified as fair value through net income upon initial recognition; hedge accounting is not applied.

(5)       As set out in (d) , we designate only the spot element as the hedging item. As at December 31, 2018, the foreign currency basis spread included in the fair value of the derivative instruments, and which is used for purposes of assessing hedge ineffectiveness, was $29 (December 31, 2017 — $4; January 1, 2017 — $(1)).

 

 

35


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Non-derivative

 

Our long-term debt, which is measured at amortized cost, and the fair value thereof, are set out in the following table.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Carrying 
value

 

Fair value

 

Carrying 
value

 

Fair value

 

Long-term debt ( Note 26 )

 

$

14,101

 

$

14,209

 

$

13,660

 

$

14,255

 

 

(i)             Recognition of derivative gains and losses

 

The following table sets out the gains and losses, excluding income tax effects, arising from derivative instruments that are classified as cash flow hedging items and their location within the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income.

 

Credit risk associated with such derivative instruments, as discussed further in (b) , would be the primary source of hedge ineffectiveness. There was no ineffective portion of derivative instruments classified as cash flow hedging items for the periods presented.

 

 

 

 

 

Amount of gain (loss)
recognized in other
comprehensive income

 

Gain (loss) reclassified from other comprehensive
income to income (effective portion)  (Note 11)

 

 

 

 

 

(effective portion)  (Note 11)

 

 

 

Amount

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Location

 

2018

 

2017

 

Derivatives used to manage currency risk

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Arising from U.S. dollar-denominated purchases

 

 

 

$

39

 

$

(23

)

Goods and services purchased

 

$

6

 

$

(5

)

Arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt 1

 

26(b)-(c)

 

194

 

(109

)

Financing costs

 

241

 

(146

)

 

 

 

 

233

 

(132

)

 

 

247

 

(151

)

Derivatives used to manage other market risk

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Arising from changes in share-based compensation costs

 

14(b)

 

(8

)

24

 

Employee benefits expense

 

2

 

17

 

 

 

 

 

$

225

 

$

(108

)

 

 

$

249

 

$

(134

)

 


(1)          Amounts recognized in other comprehensive income are net of the change in the foreign currency basis spread (which is used for purposes of assessing hedge ineffectiveness) included in the fair value of the derivative instruments; such amount for the year ended December 31, 2018, was $25 (2017 — $5).

 

The following table sets out the gains and losses arising from derivative instruments that are classified as held for trading and that are not designated as being in a hedging relationship, and their location within the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income.

 

 

 

 

 

Gain (loss) recognized in
income on derivatives

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Location

 

2018

 

2017

 

Derivatives used to manage currency risk

 

Financing costs

 

$

 

$

3

 

 

5                  segment information

 

General

 

Operating segments are components of an entity that engage in business activities from which they earn revenues and incur expenses (including revenues and expenses related to transactions with the other component(s)), the operations of which can be clearly distinguished and for which the operating results are regularly reviewed by a chief operating decision-maker to make resource allocation decisions and to assess performance. As we do not currently aggregate operating segments, our reportable segments as at December 31, 2018, are also wireless and wireline. The wireless segment includes network revenues and equipment sales arising from mobile technologies. The wireline segment includes data revenues (which include Internet protocol; television; hosting, managed information technology and cloud-based services; customer care and business services (formerly business process outsourcing); certain healthcare solutions; and home and business security), voice and other telecommunications services revenues (excluding wireless arising from mobile technologies), and equipment sales. Segmentation has been based on similarities in technology (mobile versus fixed), the technical expertise required to deliver the services and products, customer characteristics, the distribution channels used and regulatory treatment. Intersegment sales are recorded at the exchange value, which is the amount agreed to by the parties.

 

The segment information regularly reported to our Chief Executive Officer (our chief operating decision-maker), and the reconciliations thereof to our products and services view of revenues, other revenues and income before income taxes, are set out in the following table.

 

 

36


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Years ended December 31

 

Wireless

 

Wireline

 

Eliminations

 

Consolidated

 

(millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

Operating revenues

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

External revenues

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service

 

$

6,054

 

$

5,896

 

$

5,828

 

$

5,436

 

$

 

$

 

$

11,882

 

$

11,332

 

Equipment

 

1,963

 

1,739

 

250

 

234

 

 

 

2,213

 

1,973

 

Revenues arising from contracts with customers

 

8,017

 

7,635

 

6,078

 

5,670

 

 

 

14,095

 

13,305

 

Other operating income

 

118

 

36

 

155

 

67

 

 

 

273

 

103

 

 

 

8,135

 

7,671

 

6,233

 

5,737

 

 

 

14,368

 

13,408

 

Intersegment revenues

 

47

 

43

 

207

 

206

 

(254

)

(249

)

 

 

 

 

$

8,182

 

$

7,714

 

$

6,440

 

$

5,943

 

$

(254

)

$

(249

)

$

14,368

 

$

13,408

 

EBITDA  1

 

$

3,431

 

$

3,250

 

$

1,673

 

$

1,660

 

$

 

$

 

$

5,104

 

$

4,910

 

CAPEX, excluding spectrum licences  2

 

$

896

 

$

978

 

$

2,018

 

$

2,116

 

$

 

$

 

$

2,914

 

$

3,094

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating revenues — external (above)

 

$

14,368

 

$

13,408

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased

 

6,368

 

5,904

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Employee benefits expense

 

2,896

 

2,594

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

EBITDA (above)

 

5,104

 

4,910

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation

 

1,669

 

1,617

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amortization

 

598

 

552

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income

 

2,837

 

2,741

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financing costs

 

661

 

573

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income before income taxes

 

$

2,176

 

$

2,168

 

 


(1)          Earnings before interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization (EBITDA) does not have any standardized meaning prescribed by IFRS-IASB and is therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers; we define EBITDA as operating revenues less goods and services purchased and employee benefits expense. We have issued guidance on, and report, EBITDA because it is a key measure that management uses to evaluate the performance of our business, and it is also utilized in measuring compliance with certain debt covenants.

(2)          Total capital expenditures (CAPEX); see Note 31(a)  for a reconciliation of capital expenditures, excluding spectrum licences to cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences reported in the Consolidated statements of cash flows.

 

Geographical information

 

We attribute revenues from external customers to individual countries on the basis of the location where the goods and/or services are provided. We do not have significant revenues that we attribute to countries other than Canada (our country of domicile), nor do we have significant amounts of property, plant, equipment and/or intangible assets located outside of Canada. As at December 31, 2018, on a historical cost basis, we had $546 million (2017 — $262 million) of goodwill located outside of Canada.

 

 

37


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

6                  revenue from contracts with customers

 

(a)          Revenues

 

In the determination of the minimum transaction prices in contracts with customers, amounts are allocated to fulfilling, or completion of fulfilling, future contracted performance obligations. These unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, future contracted performance obligations are largely in respect of services to be provided over the duration of the contract. The following table sets out our aggregate estimated minimum transaction prices allocated to remaining unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, future contracted performance obligations and the timing of when we might expect to recognize the associated revenues; actual amounts could differ from these estimates due to a variety of factors, including the unpredictable nature of: customer behaviour; industry regulation; the economic environments in which we operate; and competitor behaviour.

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Estimated minimum transaction price allocated to remaining unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, performance obligations to be recognized as revenue in a future period 1, 2

 

 

 

 

 

During the 12-month period ending one year hence

 

$

2,306

 

$

2,075

 

During the 12-month period ending two years hence

 

933

 

856

 

Thereafter

 

24

 

24

 

 

 

$

3,263

 

$

2,955

 

 


(1)          Excludes constrained variable consideration amounts, amounts arising from contracts originally expected to have a duration of one year or less and, as a permitted practical expedient, amounts arising from contracts that are not affected by revenue recognition timing differences arising from transaction price allocation or from contracts under which we may recognize and bill revenue in an amount that corresponds directly with our completed performance obligations.

(2)          IFRS-IASB requires the explanation of when we expect to recognize as revenue the amounts disclosed as the estimated minimum transaction price allocated to remaining unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, performance obligations. The estimated amounts disclosed are based upon contractual terms and maturities. Actual minimum transaction price revenues recognized, and the timing thereof, will differ from these estimates primarily due to the frequency with which the actual durations of contracts with customers do not match their contractual maturities.

 

(b)          Accounts receivable

 

As at (millions)

 

Note

 

December 31,
2018

 

December 31,
2017

 

January 1,
2017

 

Customer accounts receivable

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

 

 

$

1,263

 

$

1,221

 

$

1,217

 

Transitional amount

 

2(c)

 

 

(9

)

(9

)

As adjusted

 

 

 

1,263

 

1,212

 

1,208

 

Accrued receivables — customer

 

 

 

175

 

143

 

131

 

Allowance for doubtful accounts

 

4(b)

 

(53

)

(43

)

(54

)

 

 

 

 

1,385

 

1,312

 

1,285

 

Accrued receivables — other

 

 

 

215

 

302

 

177

 

 

 

 

 

$

1,600

 

$

1,614

 

$

1,462

 

 

(c)           Contract assets

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Balance, beginning of period

 

 

 

$

1,303

 

$

 

Transitional amount

 

2(c)

 

 

1,205

 

As adjusted

 

 

 

1,303

 

1,205

 

Net additions arising from operations

 

 

 

1,455

 

1,270

 

Amounts billed in period and thus reclassified to accounts receivable 1

 

 

 

(1,284

)

(1,166

)

Change in impairment allowance, net 

 

4(b)

 

(1

)

(3

)

Other

 

 

 

2

 

(3

)

Balance, end of period

 

 

 

$

1,475

 

$

1,303

 

To be billed and thus reclassified to accounts receivable during:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The 12-month period ending one year hence

 

 

 

$

1,017

 

$

907

 

The 12-month period ending two years hence

 

 

 

444

 

385

 

Thereafter

 

 

 

14

 

11

 

Balance, end of period

 

 

 

$

1,475

 

$

1,303

 

Reconciliation of contract assets presented in the Consolidated statements of financial position — current

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross contract assets

 

 

 

$

1,017

 

$

907

 

Reclassification to contract liabilities of contracts with contract assets less than contract liabilities

 

24

 

(3

)

(4

)

Reclassification from contract liabilities of contracts with contract liabilities less than contract assets 

 

24

 

(154

)

(146

)

 

 

 

 

$

860

 

$

757

 

 


(1)          For the year ended December 31, 2018, amounts billed for our wireless segment and reclassified to accounts receivable totalled $1,180 (2017 — $1,060).

 

 

38


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

7                  other operating income

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Government assistance, including deferral account amortization

 

 

 

$

23

 

$

32

 

Investment income, gain (loss) on disposal of assets and other

 

21

 

230

 

45

 

Changes in business combination-related accrued receivable and provisions

 

 

 

17

 

26

 

Interest income

 

21(c)

 

3

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

273

 

$

103

 

 

We receive government assistance, as defined by IFRS-IASB, from a number of sources and include such amounts received in Other operating income. We recognize such amounts on an accrual basis as the subsidized services are provided or as the subsidized costs are incurred.

 

CRTC subsidy

 

Local exchange carriers’ costs of providing the level of residential basic telephone services that the CRTC requires to be provided in high cost serving areas are greater than the amounts the CRTC allows the local exchange carriers to charge for the level of service. To ameliorate the situation, the CRTC directs the collection of contribution payments, in a central fund, from all registered Canadian telecommunications service providers (including voice, data and wireless service providers) that are then disbursed to incumbent local exchange carriers as subsidy payments to partially offset the costs of providing residential basic telephone services in non-forborne high cost serving areas. The subsidy payment disbursements are based upon a total subsidy requirement calculated on a per network access line/per band subsidy rate. For the year ended December 31, 2018, our subsidy receipts were $18 million (2017 — $19 million).

 

The CRTC currently determines, at a national level, the total annual contribution requirement necessary to pay the subsidies and then collects contribution payments from the Canadian telecommunications service providers, calculated as a percentage of their CRTC-defined telecommunications service revenue. The final contribution expense rate for 2018 was 0.54% and the interim rate for 2019 has been set at 0.60%.

 

Government of Quebec

 

Salaries for qualifying employment positions in the province of Quebec, mainly in the information technology sector, are eligible for tax credits. In respect of such tax credits, for the year ended December 31, 2018, we recorded $4 million (2017 — $7 million).

 

8                  employee benefits expense

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

Employee benefits expense — gross

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wages and salaries

 

 

 

$

2,800

 

$

2,594

 

Share-based compensation

 

14

 

136

 

128

 

Pensions — defined benefit

 

15(b)

 

95

 

82

 

Pensions — defined contribution

 

15(f)

 

88

 

88

 

Restructuring costs

 

16(a)

 

126

 

26

 

Other

 

 

 

163

 

156

 

 

 

 

 

3,408

 

3,074

 

Capitalized internal labour costs, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Contract acquisition costs

 

20

 

 

 

 

 

Capitalized

 

 

 

(55

)

(47

)

Amortized

 

 

 

45

 

48

 

Contract fulfilment costs

 

20

 

 

 

 

 

Capitalized

 

 

 

(3

)

(4

)

Amortized

 

 

 

3

 

2

 

Property, plant and equipment

 

 

 

(332

)

(321

)

Intangible assets subject to amortization

 

 

 

(170

)

(158

)

 

 

 

 

(512

)

(480

)

 

 

 

 

$

2,896

 

$

2,594

 

 

 

39


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

9                  financing costs

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Interest expense  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest on long-term debt

 

 

 

$

598

 

$

561

 

Interest on short-term borrowings and other

 

 

 

6

 

5

 

Interest accretion on provisions

 

25

 

21

 

13

 

Long-term debt prepayment premium

 

26(b)

 

34

 

 

 

 

 

 

659

 

579

 

Employee defined benefit plans net interest

 

15(b), (g)

 

17

 

6

 

Foreign exchange

 

 

 

(6

)

(5

)

 

 

 

 

670

 

580

 

Interest income

 

 

 

(9

)

(7

)

 

 

 

 

$

661

 

$

573

 

 

10           income taxes

 

(a)          Expense composition and rate reconciliation

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

Current income tax expense

 

 

 

 

 

For the current reporting period

 

$

483

 

$

205

 

Adjustments recognized in the current period for income taxes of prior periods

 

(5

)

(82

)

 

 

478

 

123

 

Deferred income tax expense (recovery)

 

 

 

 

 

Arising from the origination and reversal of temporary differences

 

75

 

361

 

Revaluation of deferred income tax liability to reflect future income tax rates

 

 

28

 

Adjustments recognized in the current period for income taxes of prior periods

 

(1

)

78

 

 

 

74

 

467

 

 

 

$

552

 

$

590

 

 

Our income tax expense and effective income tax rate differ from those calculated by applying the applicable statutory rates for the following reasons:

 

Years ended December 31 ($ in millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted – Note 2(c))

 

Income taxes computed at applicable statutory rates

 

$

586

 

27.0

%

$

578

 

26.7

%

Revaluation of deferred income tax liability to reflect future income tax rates

 

 

 

28

 

1.3

 

Adjustments recognized in the current period for income taxes of prior periods

 

(6

)

(0.3

)

(4

)

(0.2

)

Other

 

(28

)

(1.3

)

(12

)

(0.6

)

Income tax expense per Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income

 

$

552

 

25.4

%

$

590

 

27.2

%

 

(b)          Temporary differences

 

We must make significant estimates in respect of the composition of our deferred income tax liability. Our operations are complex and the related income tax interpretations, regulations, legislation and jurisprudence are continually changing. As a result, there are usually some income tax matters in question.

 

Temporary differences comprising the net deferred income tax liability and the amounts of deferred income taxes recognized in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income and the Consolidated statements of changes in owners’ equity are estimated as follows:

 

 

40


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(millions)

 

Property, plant
and equipment
and intangible
assets subject
to amortization

 

Intangible
assets with
indefinite lives

 

Contract
assets and
liabilities

 

Net pension
and share-
based
compensation
amounts

 

Provisions not
currently
deductible

 

Losses
available to
be carried
forward 
1

 

Other

 

Partnership
income
unallocated for
income tax
purposes

 

Net deferred
income tax
liability

 

As at January 1, 2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

$

870

 

$

1,457

 

$

 

$

(48

)

$

(148

)

$

(6

)

$

(18

)

$

(5

)

$

2,102

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers transitional amount ( Note 2(c) )

 

 

 

404

 

 

 

 

 

 

404

 

As adjusted 2

 

870

 

1,457

 

404

 

(48

)

(148

)

(6

)

(18

)

(5

)

2,506

 

Deferred income tax expense recognized in

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income ( Note 2(c) )

 

348

 

84

 

37

 

(11

)

8

 

(1

)

(3

)

5

 

467

 

Other comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

(61

)

 

 

4

 

 

(57

)

Deferred income taxes charged directly to owners’ equity and other

 

3

 

20

 

 

 

 

 

(3

)

 

20

 

As at December 31, 2017 3

 

1,221

 

1,561

 

441

 

(120

)

(140

)

(7

)

(20

)

 

2,936

 

Deferred income tax expense recognized in

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

14

 

78

 

55

 

(20

)

(10

)

1

 

(44

)

 

74

 

Other comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

119

 

 

 

(6

)

 

113

 

Deferred income taxes charged directly to owners’ equity and other

 

(2

)

79

 

 

 

(54

)

 

1

 

 

24

 

As at December 31, 2018 4

 

$

1,233

 

$

1,718

 

$

496

 

$

(21

)

$

(204

)

$

(6

)

$

(69

)

$

 

$

3,147

 

 


(1)              We expect to be able to utilize our non-capital losses prior to expiry.

(2)              Deferred tax liability of $2,511, net of deferred tax asset of $5 (included in Other long-term assets).

(3)              Deferred tax liability of $2,941, net of deferred tax asset of $5 (included in Other long-term assets).

(4)              Deferred tax liability of $3,152, net of deferred tax asset of $5 (included in Other long-term assets).

 

IFRS-IASB requires the separate disclosure of temporary differences arising from the carrying value of investments in subsidiaries and partnerships exceeding their tax base, for which no deferred income tax liabilities have been recognized because the parent is able to control the timing of the reversal of the difference and it is probable that it will not reverse in the foreseeable future. In our specific instance, this is relevant to our investments in Canadian subsidiaries and Canadian partnerships. We are not required to recognize such deferred income tax liabilities, as we are in a position to control the timing and manner of the reversal of the temporary differences, which would not be expected to be exigible to income tax, and it is probable that such differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future. We are in a position to control the timing and manner of the reversal of temporary differences in respect of our non-Canadian subsidiaries, and it is probable that such differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

 

(c)           Other

 

We have net capital losses, and such losses may only be applied against realized taxable capital gains. We expect to include a net capital loss carry-forward of $NIL (2017 — $NIL) in our Canadian income tax returns. During the year ended December 31, 2018, we recognized the benefit of $NIL (2017 — $4 million) of net capital losses.

 

We conduct research and development activities, which are eligible to earn Investment Tax Credits. During the year ended December 31, 2018, we recorded Investment Tax Credits of $10 million (2017 — $12 million). Of this amount, $6 million (2017 — $7 million) was recorded as a reduction of property, plant and equipment and/or intangible assets and the balance was recorded as a reduction of Goods and services purchased.

 

 

41


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

11           other comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Items that may subsequently be reclassified to income

 

Item never
reclassified to
income

 

 

 

Item never
reclassified to
income

 

 

 

 

 

Change in unrealized fair value of derivatives designated as cash flow hedges in current period (Note 4(i))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives used to manage currency risk

 

Derivatives used to manage other market risks

 

 

 

Cumulative

 

Change in

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(millions)

 

Gains
(losses)
arising

 

Prior period
(gains) losses
transferred to
net income

 

Total

 

Gains
(losses)
arising

 

Prior period
(gains) losses
transferred to
net income

 

Total

 

Total

 

foreign
currency
translation
adjustment

 

measurement
of investment
financial
assets

 

Accumulated
other
comp. income

 

Employee
defined benefit
plan
re-measurements

 

Other
comp. income

 

Accumulated balance as at January 1, 2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

 

 

 

 

$

(22

)

 

 

 

 

$

2

 

$

(20

)

$

48 

 

$

16

 

$

44 

 

 

 

 

 

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments transitional amount ( Note 2(a) )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3

)

(3

)

 

 

 

 

As adjusted

 

 

 

 

 

(22

)

 

 

 

 

2

 

(20

)

48

 

13

 

41

 

 

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount arising

 

$

(132

)

$

151

 

19

 

$

24

 

$

(17

)

7

 

26

 

5

 

(14

)

17

 

$

(234

)

$

(217

)

Income taxes

 

$

(21

)

$

27

 

6

 

$

6

 

$

(5

)

1

 

7

 

 

(2

)

5

 

(62

)

(57

)

Net

 

 

 

 

 

13

 

 

 

 

 

6

 

19

 

5

 

(12

)

12

 

$

(172

)

$

(160

)

Accumulated balance as at December 31, 2017

 

 

 

 

 

$

(9

)

 

 

 

 

$

8

 

$

(1

)

$

53

 

$

1

 

$

53

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated balance as at January 1, 2018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

 

 

 

 

$

(9

)

 

 

 

 

$

8

 

$

(1

)

$

53

 

$

 

$

57 

 

 

 

 

 

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments transitional amount ( Note 2(a) )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(4

)

(4

)

 

 

 

 

As adjusted

 

 

 

 

 

(9

)

 

 

 

 

8

 

(1

)

53

 

1

 

53

 

 

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount arising

 

$

233

 

$

(247

)

(14

)

$

(8

)

$

(2

)

(10

)

(24

)

(30

)

(1

)

(55

)

$

452

 

$

397

 

Income taxes

 

$

40

 

$

(44

)

(4

)

$

(2

)

$

 

(2

)

(6

)

 

 

(6

)

119

 

113

 

Net

 

 

 

 

 

(10

)

 

 

 

 

(8

)

(18

)

(30

)

(1

)

(49

)

$

333

 

$

284

 

Accumulated balance as at December 31, 2018

 

 

 

 

 

$

(19

)

 

 

 

 

$

 

$

(19

)

$

23

 

$

 

$

4

 

 

 

 

 

Attributable to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

12

 

 

 

 

 

Non-controlling interests

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(8

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

4

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

42


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

12           per share amounts

 

Basic net income per Common Share is calculated by dividing net income attributable to Common Shares by the total weighted average number of Common Shares outstanding during the period. Diluted net income per Common Share is calculated to give effect to share option awards and restricted stock units.

 

The following table presents reconciliations of the denominators of the basic and diluted per share computations. Net income was equal to diluted net income for all periods presented.

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Basic total weighted average number of Common Shares outstanding

 

597

 

593

 

Effect of dilutive securities

 

 

 

 

 

Share option awards

 

 

 

Diluted total weighted average number of Common Shares outstanding

 

597

 

593

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, no outstanding TELUS Corporation share option awards were excluded in the calculation of diluted net income per Common Share.

 

13           dividends per share

 

(a)          Dividends declared

 

Years ended December 31 (millions

 

 

 

 

 

except per share amounts)

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

Declared

 

Paid to

 

 

 

Declared

 

Paid to

 

 

 

Common Share dividends

 

Effective

 

Per share

 

shareholders

 

Total

 

Effective

 

Per share

 

shareholders

 

Total

 

Quarter 1 dividend

 

Mar. 9, 2018

 

$

0.5050

 

Apr. 2, 2018

 

$

299

 

Mar. 10, 2017

 

$

0.4800

 

Apr. 3, 2017

 

$

283

 

Quarter 2 dividend

 

Jun. 8, 2018

 

0.5250

 

Jul. 3, 2018

 

315

 

Jun. 9, 2017

 

0.4925

 

Jul. 4, 2017

 

293

 

Quarter 3 dividend

 

Sep. 10, 2018

 

0.5250

 

Oct. 1, 2018

 

313

 

Sep. 8, 2017

 

0.4925

 

Oct. 2, 2017

 

292

 

Quarter 4 dividend

 

Dec. 10, 2018

 

0.5450

 

Jan. 2, 2019

 

326

 

Dec. 11, 2017

 

0.5050

 

Jan. 2, 2018

 

299

 

 

 

 

 

$

2.1000

 

 

 

$

1,253

 

 

 

$

1.9700

 

 

 

$

1,167

 

 

On February 13, 2019, the Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $0.5450 per share on our issued and outstanding Common Shares payable on April 1, 2019, to holders of record at the close of business on March 11, 2019. The final amount of the dividend payment depends upon the number of Common Shares issued and outstanding at the close of business on March 11, 2019.

 

(b)          Dividend Reinvestment and Share Purchase Plan

 

We have a Dividend Reinvestment and Share Purchase Plan under which eligible holders of Common Shares may acquire additional Common Shares by reinvesting dividends and by making additional optional cash payments to the trustee. In respect of Common Shares whose eligible shareholders have elected to participate in the plan, dividends declared during the year ended December 31, 2018, of $54 million (2017 — $58 million) were to be reinvested in Common Shares acquired by the trustee from Treasury, with no discount applicable.

 

14           share-based compensation

 

(a)          Details of share-based compensation expense

 

Reflected in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as Employee benefits expense and in the Consolidated statements of cash flows are the following share-based compensation amounts:

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

Employee
benefits
expense

 

Associated
operating
cash
outflows

 

Statement
of cash
flows
adjustment

 

Employee
benefits
expense

 

Associated
operating
cash
outflows

 

Statement
of cash
flows
adjustment

 

Restricted stock units

 

(b)

 

$

99

 

$

(98

)

$

1

 

$

83

 

$

(67

)

$

16

 

Employee share purchase plan

 

(c)

 

37

 

(37

)

 

37

 

(37

)

 

Share option awards

 

(d)

 

5

 

 

5

 

1

 

 

1

 

 

 

 

 

$

141

 

$

(135

)

$

6

 

$

121

 

$

(104

)

$

17

 

 

For the year ended December 31, 2018, the associated operating cash outflows in respect of restricted stock units were net of cash inflows arising from cash-settled equity forward agreements of $9 million (2017 — $14 million). For the year ended December 31, 2018, the income tax benefit arising from share-based compensation was $37 million (2017 — $32 million).

 

 

43


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(b)          Restricted stock units

 

General

 

We use restricted stock units as a form of retention and incentive compensation. Each restricted stock unit is nominally equal in value to one equity share and is nominally entitled to the dividends that would arise thereon if it were an issued and outstanding equity share. The notional dividends are recorded as additional issuances of restricted stock units during the life of the restricted stock unit. Due to the notional dividend mechanism, the grant-date fair value of restricted stock units equals the fair market value of the corresponding equity shares at the grant date. The restricted stock units generally become payable when vesting is complete and typically vest over a period of 33 months (the requisite service period). The vesting method of restricted stock units, which is determined on or before the date of grant, may be either cliff or graded; the majority of restricted stock units outstanding are cliff-vesting. The associated liability is normally cash-settled.

 

TELUS Corporation restricted stock units

 

We also award restricted stock units that largely have the same features as our general restricted stock units, but have a variable payout (0% — 200%) that depends upon the achievement of our total customer connections performance condition (with a weighting of 25%) and the total shareholder return on our Common Shares relative to an international peer group of telecommunications companies (with a weighting of 75%). The grant-date fair value of the notional subset of our restricted stock units affected by the total customer connections performance condition equals the fair market value of the corresponding Common Shares at the grant date, and thus the notional subset has been included in the presentation of our restricted stock units with only service conditions. The recurring estimate, which reflects a variable payout, of the fair value of the notional subset of our restricted stock units affected by the relative total shareholder return performance condition is determined using a Monte Carlo simulation.

 

The following table presents a summary of outstanding TELUS Corporation non-vested restricted stock units.

 

Number of non-vested restricted stock units as at December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Restricted stock units without market performance conditions

 

 

 

 

 

Restricted stock units with only service conditions

 

3,037,881

 

3,327,464

 

Notional subset affected by total customer connections performance condition

 

155,639

 

154,452

 

 

 

3,193,520

 

3,481,916

 

Restricted stock units with market performance conditions

 

 

 

 

 

Notional subset affected by relative total shareholder return performance condition

 

466,917

 

463,357

 

 

 

3,660,437

 

3,945,273

 

 

The following table presents a summary of the activity related to TELUS Corporation restricted stock units without market performance conditions.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

Number of restricted
stock units
 1

 

Weighted
average
grant-date

 

Number of restricted
stock units
 1

 

Weighted
average
grant-date 

 

Years ended December 31

 

Non-vested

 

Vested

 

fair value

 

Non-vested

 

Vested

 

fair value

 

Outstanding, beginning of period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-vested

 

3,481,916

 

 

$

41.87

 

3,390,979

 

 

$

41.71

 

Vested

 

 

32,848

 

$

41.00

 

 

29,108

 

$

38.09

 

Issued

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Initial award

 

1,769,092

 

 

$

45.72

 

1,825,688

 

 

$

43.56

 

In lieu of dividends

 

208,503

 

359

 

$

46.32

 

206,715

 

455

 

$

43.98

 

Vested

 

(1,963,722

)

1,963,722

 

$

40.34

 

(1,766,680

)

1,766,680

 

$

43.73

 

Settled in cash

 

 

(1,933,546

)

$

40.08

 

 

(1,698,008

)

$

43.63

 

Forfeited and cancelled

 

(302,269

)

 

$

43.16

 

(174,786

)

(65,387

)

$

42.88

 

Outstanding, end of period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-vested

 

3,193,520

 

 

$

44.85

 

3,481,916

 

 

$

41.87

 

Vested

 

 

63,383

 

$

44.89

 

 

32,848

 

$

41.00

 

 


(1)          Excluding the notional subset of restricted stock units affected by the relative total shareholder return performance condition.

 

With respect to certain issuances of TELUS Corporation restricted stock units, we have entered into cash-settled equity forward agreements that fix our cost; that information, as well as a schedule of non-vested TELUS Corporation restricted stock units outstanding as at December 31, 2018, is set out in the following table.

 

 

44


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Vesting in years ending December 31

 

Number of
fixed-cost
restricted
stock units

 

Our fixed cost
per restricted
stock unit

 

Number of
variable-cost
restricted stock
units

 

Total number of
non-vested
restricted stock
units
 1

 

2019

 

1,439,418

 

$

45.53 

 

219,443

 

1,658,861

 

2020

 

1,369,272

 

$

48.71 

 

369,734

 

1,739,006

 

 

 

2,808,690

 

 

 

589,177

 

3,397,867

 

 


(1)          Excluding the notional subset of restricted stock units affected by the relative total shareholder return performance condition vesting in the years ending December 31, 2019.

 

TELUS International (Cda) Inc. restricted stock units

 

We also award restricted stock units that largely have the same features as the TELUS Corporation restricted stock units, but have a variable payout (0% — 150%) that depends upon the achievement of TELUS International (Cda) Inc. financial performance and non-market quality-of-service performance conditions.

 

The following table presents a summary of the activity related to TELUS International (Cda) Inc. restricted stock units.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

US$ denominated

 

Canadian $ denominated

 

US$ denominated

 

Canadian $ denominated

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

Number of

 

average

 

Number of

 

average

 

Number of restricted

 

average

 

Number of

 

average

 

 

 

restricted

 

grant-date

 

restricted

 

grant-date

 

stock units

 

grant-date

 

restricted

 

grant-date

 

Years ended December 31

 

stock units

 

fair value

 

stock units

 

fair value

 

Non-vested

 

Vested

 

fair value

 

stock units

 

fair value

 

Outstanding, beginning of period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-vested

 

374,786

 

US$

24.45

 

 

$

 

163,785

 

 

US$

21.90

 

 

$

 

Vested

 

 

US$

 

32,299

 

$

21.36

 

 

 

US$

 

32,299

 

$

21.36

 

Issued - initial award

 

197,495

 

US$

28.07

 

 

$

 

213,768

 

 

US$

26.40

 

 

$

 

Vested

 

 

US$

 

 

$

 

(208

)

208

 

US$

24.10

 

 

$

 

Exercised

 

 

US$

 

 

$

 

 

(208

)

US$

24.10

 

 

$

 

Forfeited and cancelled

 

(10,569

)

US$

26.28

 

 

$

 

(2,559

)

 

US$

24.10

 

 

$

 

Outstanding, end of period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-vested

 

561,712

 

US$

25.68

 

 

$

 

374,786

 

 

US$

24.45

 

 

$

 

Vested

 

 

US$

 

32,299

 

$

21.36

 

 

 

US$

 

32,299

 

$

21.36

 

 

(c)           Employee share purchase plan

 

We have an employee share purchase plan under which eligible employees up to a certain job classification can purchase our Common Shares through regular payroll deductions. In respect of Common Shares held within the employee share purchase plan, Common Share dividends declared during the year ended December 31, 2018, of $34 million (2017 — $31 million) were to be reinvested in Common Shares acquired by the trustee from Treasury, with no discount applicable.

 

(d)          Share option awards

 

General

 

We use share option awards as a form of retention and incentive compensation. We apply the fair value method of accounting for share-based compensation awards granted to officers and other employees. Share option awards typically have a three-year vesting period (the requisite service period). The vesting method of share option awards, which is determined on or before the date of grant, may be either cliff or graded; all share option awards granted subsequent to 2004 have been cliff-vesting.

 

The weighted average fair value of share option awards granted is calculated by using the Black-Scholes model (a closed-form option pricing model). The risk-free interest rate used in determining the fair value of the share option awards is based on a Government of Canada yield curve that is current at the time of grant. The expected lives of the share option awards are based on our historical share option award exercise data. Similarly, expected volatility considers the historical volatility in the price of our Common Shares for TELUS Corporation share options and average historical volatility in the prices of a peer group’s shares in respect of TELUS International (Cda) Inc. share options. The dividend yield is the annualized dividend current at the time of grant divided by the share option award exercise price. Dividends are not paid on unexercised share option awards and are not subject to vesting.

 

TELUS Corporation share options

 

Employees may receive options to purchase Common Shares at an exercise price equal to the fair market value at the time of grant. Share option awards granted under the plan may be exercised over specific periods not to exceed seven years from the time of grant. No share option awards were granted in fiscal 2018 or 2017.

 

 

45


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

These share option awards have a net-equity settlement feature. The optionee does not have the choice of exercising the net-equity settlement feature; it is at our option whether the exercise of a share option award is settled as a share option or settled using the net-equity settlement feature.

 

The following table presents a summary of the activity related to the TELUS Corporation share option plan.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Years ended December 31

 

Number of
share
options

 

Weighted
average share
option price

 

Number of
share
options

 

Weighted
average share
option price

 

Outstanding, beginning of period

 

740,471

 

$

26.99

 

1,417,693

 

$

24.49

 

Exercised  1

 

(402,528

)

$

25.26

 

(652,926

)

$

21.90

 

Forfeited

 

(2,046

)

$

29.19

 

(3,908

)

$

27.56

 

Expired

 

(9,733

)

$

23.24

 

(20,388

)

$

16.31

 

Outstanding, end of period 2

 

326,164

 

$

29.22

 

740,471

 

$

26.99

 

 


(1)          The total intrinsic value of share option awards exercised for the year ended December 31, 2018, was $8 million (2017 — $15 million), reflecting a weighted average price at the dates of exercise of $46.04 per share (2017 — $44.63 per share). The difference between the number of share options exercised and the number of Common Shares issued (as reflected in the Consolidated statements of changes in owners’ equity) is the effect of our choosing to settle share option award exercises using the net-equity settlement feature.

(2)          All outstanding TELUS Corporation share options are vested, their range of prices is $28.56 — $31.69 per share and their weighted average remaining contractual life is 0.4 years.

 

TELUS International (Cda) Inc. share options

 

Employees may receive equity share options (equity-settled) to purchase TELUS International (Cda) Inc. common shares at a price equal to, or a multiple of, the fair market value at the time of grant and/or phantom share options (cash-settled) that provide them with exposure to TELUS International (Cda) Inc. common share price appreciation. Share option awards granted under the plan may be exercised over specific periods not to exceed ten years from the time of grant. All equity share option awards and most phantom share option awards have a variable payout (0% — 100%) that depends upon the achievement of TELUS International (Cda) Inc. financial performance and non-market quality-of-service performance conditions.

 

The following table presents a summary of the activity related to the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. share option plan.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

US$ denominated

 

Canadian $ denominated

 

US$ denominated

 

Canadian $ denominated

 

Years ended December 31

 

Number
of share
options

 

Weighted
average
share option
price 
1

 

Number
of share
options

 

Share
option
price 
2

 

Number
of share
options

 

Weighted
average
share option
price 
1

 

Number
of share
options

 

Share
option
price 
2

 

Outstanding, beginning of period

 

748,626

 

US$

30.12

 

53,832

 

$

21.36

 

573,354

 

US$

30.86

 

53,832

 

$

21.36

 

Granted

 

111,281

 

US$

27.81

 

 

$

 

175,272

 

US$

27.70

 

 

$

 

Forfeited

 

(1,172

)

US$

27.70

 

 

$

 

 

US$

 

 

$

 

Outstanding, end of period

 

858,735

 

US$

29.83

 

53,832

 

$

21.36

 

748,626

 

US$

30.12

 

53,832

 

$

21.36

 

 


(1)              The range of share option prices is US$21.90 — US$40.26 per TELUS International (Cda) Inc. equity share and the weighted average remaining contractual life is 8.4 years.

(2)              The weighted average remaining contractual life is 7.5 years.

 

15           employee future benefits

 

We have a number of defined benefit and defined contribution plans that provide pension and other retirement and post-employment benefits to most of our employees. As at December 31, 2018 and 2017, all registered defined benefit pension plans were closed to substantially all new participants and substantially all benefits had vested. The benefit plans in which our employees are participants reflect developments in our corporate history.

 

TELUS Corporation Pension Plan

 

Management and professional employees in Alberta who joined us prior to January 1, 2001, and certain unionized employees who joined us prior to June 9, 2011, are covered by this contributory defined benefit pension plan, which comprises slightly more than one-half of our total defined benefit obligation accrued. The plan contains a supplemental benefit account that may provide indexation of up to 70% of the annual increase in a specified cost-of-living index. Pensionable remuneration is determined by the average of the best five years of remuneration in the last ten years preceding retirement.

 

 

46


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Pension Plan for Management and Professional Employees of TELUS Corporation

 

This defined benefit pension plan, which with certain limited exceptions ceased accepting new participants on January 1, 2006, and which comprises approximately one-quarter of our total defined benefit obligation accrued, provides a non-contributory base level of pension benefits. Additionally, on a contributory basis, employees annually can choose increased and/or enhanced levels of pension benefits above the base level. At an enhanced level of pension benefits, the plan has indexation of 100% of the annual increase in a specified cost-of-living index, to an annual maximum of 2%. Pensionable remuneration is determined by the annualized average of the best 60 consecutive months of remuneration.

 

TELUS Québec Defined Benefit Pension Plan

 

This contributory defined benefit pension plan, which ceased accepting new participants on April 14, 2009, covers any employee not governed by a collective agreement in Quebec who joined us prior to April 1, 2006, any non-supervisory employee governed by a collective agreement who joined us prior to September 6, 2006, and certain other unionized employees. The plan comprises approximately one-tenth of our total defined benefit obligation accrued. The plan has no indexation and pensionable remuneration is determined by the average of the best four years of remuneration.

 

TELUS Edmonton Pension Plan

 

This contributory defined benefit pension plan ceased accepting new participants on January 1, 1998. Indexation is 60% of the annual increase in a specified cost-of-living index and pensionable remuneration is determined by the annualized average of the best 60 consecutive months of remuneration. The plan comprises less than one-tenth of our total defined benefit obligation accrued.

 

Other defined benefit pension plans

 

In addition to the foregoing plans, we have non-registered, non-contributory supplementary defined benefit pension plans, which have the effect of maintaining the earned pension benefit once the allowable maximums in the registered plans are attained. As is common with non-registered plans of this nature, these plans are typically funded only as benefits are paid. These plans comprise less than 5% of our total defined benefit obligation accrued.

 

We have three contributory non-indexed defined benefit pension plans arising from a pre-merger acquisition, which comprise less than 1% of our total defined benefit obligation accrued; these plans ceased accepting new participants in September 1989. During the year ended December 31, 2018, these plans were settled.

 

Telecommunication Workers Pension Plan

 

Certain employees in British Columbia are covered by a negotiated-cost, target-benefit union pension plan. Our contributions are determined in accordance with provisions of negotiated labour contracts, the current one of which expires December 31, 2021, and are generally based on employee gross earnings. We are not required to guarantee the benefits or assure the solvency of the plan, and we are not liable to the plan for other participating employers’ obligations. For the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, our contributions comprised a significant proportion of the employer contributions to the union pension plan; similarly, a significant proportion of the plan participants were our active and retired employees.

 

British Columbia Public Service Pension Plan

 

Certain employees in British Columbia are covered by a public service pension plan. Contributions are determined in accordance with provisions of labour contracts negotiated by the Province of British Columbia and are generally based on employee gross earnings.

 

Defined contribution pension plans

 

We offer three defined contribution pension plans, which are contributory, and these are the pension plans that we sponsor that are available to our non-unionized and certain of our unionized employees. Employees, annually, can generally choose to contribute to the plans at a rate of between 3% and 6% of their pensionable earnings. Generally, we match 100% of the contributions of employees up to 5% of their pensionable earnings and 80% of employee contributions greater than that. Membership in a defined contribution pension plan is generally voluntary until an employee’s third-year service anniversary. In the event that annual contributions exceed allowable maximums, excess amounts are in certain cases contributed to a non-registered supplementary defined contribution pension plan.

 

Other defined benefit plans

 

Other defined benefit plans, which are all non-contributory and, as at December 31, 2018 and 2017, non-funded, are comprised of a healthcare plan for retired employees and a life insurance plan, both of which ceased accepting new participants on January 1, 1997.

 

 

47


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(a)          Defined benefit pension plans — funded status overview

 

Information concerning our defined benefit pension plans, in aggregate, is as follows:

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

PRESENT VALUE OF THE DEFINED BENEFIT OBLIGATIONS

 

 

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

 

$

9,419

 

$

8,837

 

Current service cost

 

108

 

100

 

Past service cost

 

1

 

(2

)

Interest expense

 

318

 

331

 

Actuarial loss (gain) arising from:

 

 

 

 

 

Demographic assumptions

 

(62

)

77

 

Financial assumptions

 

(588

)

526

 

Settlements

 

(16

)

 

Benefits paid

 

(457

)

(450

)

Balance, end of year

 

8,723

 

9,419

 

PLAN ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value, beginning of year

 

9,195

 

8,873

 

Return on plan assets

 

 

 

 

 

Notional interest income on plan assets at discount rate

 

306

 

330

 

Actual return on plan assets (less) greater than discount rate

 

(51

)

360

 

Settlements

 

(16

)

 

Contributions

 

 

 

 

 

Employer contributions ( d)

 

52

 

66

 

Employees’ contributions

 

20

 

22

 

Benefits paid

 

(457

)

(450

)

Administrative fees

 

(6

)

(6

)

Fair value, end of year

 

9,043

 

9,195

 

Effect of asset ceiling limit

 

 

 

 

 

Beginning of year

 

(110

)

(115

)

Change

 

(153

)

5

 

End of year

 

(263

)

(110

)

Fair value of plan assets at end of year, net of asset ceiling limit

 

8,780

 

9,085

 

FUNDED STATUS — PLAN SURPLUS (DEFICIT)

 

$

57

 

$

(334

)

 

The measurement date used to determine the plan assets and defined benefit obligations accrued was December 31.

 

(b)          Defined benefit pension plans — details

 

Expense

 

Our defined benefit pension plan expense (recovery) was as follows:

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Recognized in

 

Employee
benefits
expense
(Note 8)

 

Financing
costs
(Note 9)

 

Other
comp.
income
(Note 11)

 

Total

 

Employee
benefits
expense
(Note 8)

 

Financing
costs
(Note 9)

 

Other
comp.
income
(Note 11)

 

Total

 

Current service cost

 

$

88

 

$

 

$

 

$

88

 

$

78

 

$

 

$

 

$

78

 

Past service costs

 

1

 

 

 

1

 

(2

)

 

 

(2

)

Net interest; return on plan assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest expense arising from defined benefit obligations accrued

 

 

318

 

 

318

 

 

331

 

 

331

 

Return, including interest income, on plan assets  1

 

 

(306

)

51

 

(255

)

 

(330

)

(360

)

(690

)

Interest effect on asset ceiling limit

 

 

4

 

 

4

 

 

4

 

 

4

 

 

 

 

16

 

51

 

67

 

 

5

 

(360

)

(355

)

Administrative fees

 

6

 

 

 

6

 

6

 

 

 

6

 

Re-measurements arising from:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Demographic assumptions

 

 

 

(62

)

(62

)

 

 

77

 

77

 

Financial assumptions

 

 

 

(588

)

(588

)

 

 

526

 

526

 

 

 

 

 

(650

)

(650

)

 

 

603

 

603

 

Changes in the effect of limiting net defined benefit assets to the asset ceiling

 

 

 

149

 

149

 

 

 

(9

)

(9

)

 

 

$

95

 

$

16

 

$

(450

)

$

(339

)

$

82

 

$

5

 

$

234

 

$

321

 

 


(1)           The interest income on the plan assets portion of the employee defined benefit plans net interest amount included in Financing costs reflects a rate of return on plan assets equal to the discount rate used in determining the defined benefit obligations accrued.

 

 

48


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Disaggregation of defined benefit pension plan funding status

 

Defined benefit obligations accrued are the actuarial present values of benefits attributed to employee services rendered to a particular date. Our disaggregation of defined benefit pension plan surpluses and deficits at year-end is as follows:

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Defined
benefit
obligations
accrued

 

Plan
assets

 

Difference
(Notes 20, 27)

 

PBSR
solvency
position 
1

 

Defined
benefit
obligations
accrued

 

Plan
assets

 

Difference
(Notes 20, 27)

 

PBSR
solvency
position 
1

 

Pension plans that have plan assets in excess of defined benefit obligations accrued

 

$

7,479

 

$

7,982

 

$

503

 

$

360

 

$

8,116

 

$

8,272

 

$

156

 

$

451

 

Pension plans that have defined benefit obligations accrued in excess of plan assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Funded

 

1,038

 

798

 

(240

)

(84

)

1,099

 

813

 

(286

)

(61

)

Unfunded

 

206

 

 

(206

)

N/A

2

204

 

 

(204

)

N/A

2

 

 

1,244

 

798

 

(446

)

(84

)

1,303

 

813

 

(490

)

(61

)

 

 

$

8,723

 

$

8,780

 

$

57

 

$

276

 

$

9,419

 

$

9,085

 

$

(334

)

$

390

 

Defined benefit obligations accrued owed to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Active members

 

$

1,960

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,285

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred members

 

469

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

560

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pensioners

 

6,294

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,574

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

8,723

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

9,419

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


(1)          The Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions, by way of the Pension Benefits Standards Regulations, 1985 (PBSR) (see (d) ), requires that a solvency valuation be performed on a periodic basis. The actual PBSR solvency positions are determined in conjunction with mid-year annual funding reports prepared by actuaries (see  (d) ); as a result, the PBSR solvency positions in this table as at December 31, 2018 and 2017, are interim estimates and updated estimates, respectively. The interim estimate as at December 31, 2017, was a net surplus of $255.

Interim estimated solvency ratios as at December 31, 2018, ranged from 94% to 106% (2017 — updated estimate is 95% to 108%; interim estimate was 90% to 105%) and the estimated three-year average solvency ratios, adjusted as required by the PBSR, ranged from 95% to 106% (2017 — updated estimate is 94% to 105%; interim estimate was 93% to 104%).

The solvency valuation effectively uses the fair value (excluding any asset ceiling limit effects) of the funded defined benefit pension plan assets (adjusted for theoretical wind-up expenses) to measure the solvency assets. Although the defined benefit obligations accrued and the solvency liabilities are calculated similarly, the assumptions used for each differ, primarily in respect of retirement ages and discount rates, and the solvency liabilities, due to the required assumption that each plan is terminated on the valuation date, do not reflect assumptions about future compensation levels. Relative to the experience-based estimates of retirement ages used for purposes of determining the defined benefit obligations accrued, the minimum no-consent retirement age used for solvency valuation purposes may result in either a greater or lesser pension liability, depending upon the provisions of each plan. The solvency positions in this table reflect composite weighted average discount rates of 3.00% (2017 — 3.00%). A hypothetical decrease of 25 basis points in the composite weighted average discount rate would result in a $303 decrease in the PBSR solvency position as at December 31, 2018 (2017 — $316); these sensitivities are hypothetical, should be used with caution, are calculated without changing any other assumption and generally cannot be extrapolated because changes in amounts may not be linear.

(2)          PBSR solvency position calculations are not required for the three pension plans arising from a pre-merger acquisition or for the non-registered, unfunded pension plans.

 

Fair value measurements

 

Information about the fair value measurements of our defined benefit pension plan assets, in aggregate, is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value measurements at reporting date using

 

 

 

Total

 

Quoted prices in active
markets for identical items

 

Other

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

Asset class

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Canadian

 

$

1,048

 

$

1,385

 

$

821

 

$

1,129

 

$

227

 

$

256

 

Foreign

 

1,943

 

1,867

 

581

 

853

 

1,362

 

1,014

 

Debt securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issued by national, provincial or local governments

 

1,494

 

1,512

 

1,369

 

1,389

 

125

 

123

 

Corporate debt securities

 

1,243

 

1,208

 

 

 

1,243

 

1,208

 

Asset-backed securities

 

30

 

31

 

 

 

30

 

31

 

Commercial mortgages

 

1,631

 

1,659

 

 

 

1,631

 

1,659

 

Cash, cash equivalents and other

 

338

 

486

 

8

 

38

 

330

 

448

 

Real estate

 

1,316

 

1,047

 

 

 

1,316

 

1,047

 

 

 

9,043

 

9,195

 

$

2,779

 

$

3,409

 

$

6,264

 

$

5,786

 

Effect of asset ceiling limit

 

(263

)

(110

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

8,780

 

$

9,085

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

49


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

As at December 31, 2018, pension benefit trusts that we administered held no TELUS Corporation Common Shares and held debt of TELUS Corporation with a fair value of approximately $2 million (2017 — $3 million) (see (c) — Allowable and prohibited investment types ). As at December 31, 2018 and 2017, pension benefit trusts that we administered did not lease real estate to us.

 

Future benefit payments

 

Estimated future benefit payments from our defined benefit pension plans, calculated as at December 31, 2018, are as follows:

 

Years ending December 31 (millions)

 

 

 

2019

 

$

455

 

2020

 

460

 

2021

 

466

 

2022

 

472

 

2023

 

476

 

2024-2028

 

2,451

 

 

(c)    Plan investment strategies and policies

 

Our primary goal for the defined benefit pension plans is to ensure the security of the retirement income and other benefits of the plan members and their beneficiaries. A secondary goal is to maximize the long-term rate of return on the defined benefit plans’ assets within a level of risk acceptable to us.

 

Risk management

 

We consider absolute risk (the risk of contribution increases, inadequate plan surplus and unfunded obligations) to be more important than relative return risk. Accordingly, the defined benefit plans’ designs, the nature and maturity of defined benefit obligations and the characteristics of the plans’ memberships significantly influence investment strategies and policies. We manage risk by specifying allowable and prohibited investment types, setting diversification strategies and determining target asset allocations.

 

Allowable and prohibited investment types

 

Allowable and prohibited investment types, along with associated guidelines and limits, are set out in each plan’s required Statement of Investment Policies and Procedures (SIPP), which is reviewed and approved annually by the designated governing body. The SIPP guidelines and limits are further governed by the permitted investments and lending limits set out in the Pension Benefits Standards Regulations, 1985 . As well as conventional investments, each fund’s SIPP may provide for the use of derivative products to facilitate investment operations and to manage risk, provided that no short position is taken, no use of leverage is made and no guidelines and limits established in the SIPP are violated. Internally and externally managed funds are not permitted to directly invest in our securities and are prohibited from increasing grandfathered investments in our securities; any such grandfathered investments were made prior to the merger of BC TELECOM Inc. and TELUS Corporation, our predecessors.

 

Diversification

 

Our strategy for investments in equity securities is to be broadly diversified across individual securities, industry sectors and geographical regions. A meaningful portion (20% — 30% of total plan assets) of the plans’ investment in equity securities is allocated to foreign equity securities with the intent of further diversifying plan assets. Debt securities may include a meaningful allocation to mortgages, with the objective of enhancing cash flow and providing greater scope for the management of the bond component of the plan assets. Debt securities also may include real return bonds to provide inflation protection, consistent with the indexed nature of some defined benefit obligations. Real estate investments are used to provide diversification of plan assets, hedging of potential long-term inflation and comparatively stable investment income.

 

Relationship between plan assets and benefit obligations

 

With the objective of lowering the long-term costs of our defined benefit pension plans, we purposely mismatch plan assets and benefit obligations. This mismatching is effected by including equity investments in the long-term asset mix, as well as fixed income securities and mortgages with durations that differ from those of the benefit obligations.

 

As at December 31, 2018, the present value-weighted average timing of estimated cash flows for the obligations (duration) of the defined benefit pension plans was 13.0 years (2017 — 13.9 years) and of the other defined benefit plans was 6.4 years (2017 — 6.8 years). Compensation for liquidity issues that may have otherwise arisen from the mismatching of plan assets and benefit obligations is provided by broadly diversified investment holdings (including cash and short-term investments) and cash flows from dividends, interest and rents from those diversified investment holdings.

 

 

50


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Asset allocations

 

Our defined benefit pension plans’ target asset allocations and actual asset allocations are as follows:

 

 

 

Target
allocation

 

Percentage of plan assets
at end of year

 

Years ended December 31

 

2019

 

2018

 

2017

 

Equity securities

 

25-55%

 

33

%

35

%

Debt securities

 

40-75%

 

52

%

53

%

Real estate

 

10-30%

 

15

%

12

%

Other

 

0-10%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

100

%

100

%

 

(d)    Employer contributions

 

The determination of the minimum funding amounts necessary for substantially all of our registered defined benefit pension plans is governed by the Pension Benefits Standards Act, 1985 , which requires that, in addition to current service costs being funded, both going-concern and solvency valuations be performed on a specified periodic basis.

 

·                   Any excess of plan assets over plan liabilities determined in the going-concern valuation reduces our minimum funding requirement for current service costs, but may not reduce the requirement to an amount less than the employees’ contributions. The going-concern valuation generally determines the excess (if any) of a plan’s assets over its liabilities on a projected benefit basis.

 

·                   As of the date of these consolidated financial statements, the solvency valuation generally requires that a plan’s average solvency liabilities, determined on the basis that the plan is terminated on the valuation date, in excess of its assets (if any) be funded, at a minimum, in equal annual amounts over a period not exceeding five years. So as to manage the risk of overfunding the plans, which results from the solvency valuation for funding purposes utilizing average solvency ratios, our funding may include the provision of letters of credit. As at December 31, 2018, undrawn letters of credit in the amount of $174 million (2017 — $188 million) secured certain obligations of the defined benefit pension plans, including non-registered, unfunded plans.

 

Our best estimate of fiscal 2019 employer contributions to our defined benefit plans is approximately $36 million for defined benefit pension plans. This estimate is based upon the mid-year 2018 annual funding valuations that were prepared by actuaries using December 31, 2017, actuarial valuations. The funding reports are based on the pension plans’ fiscal years, which are calendar years. The next annual funding valuations are expected to be prepared mid-year 2019.

 

(e)    Assumptions

 

As referred to in Note 1(b) , management is required to make significant estimates related to certain actuarial and economic assumptions that are used in determining defined benefit pension costs, defined benefit obligations accrued and pension plan assets. These significant estimates are of a long-term nature, consistent with the nature of employee future benefits.

 

Demographic assumptions

 

In determining the defined benefit pension expense recognized in net income for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, we utilized the Canadian Institute of Actuaries CPM 2014 mortality tables.

 

Financial assumptions

 

The discount rate, which is used to determine a plan’s defined benefit obligations accrued, is based upon the yield on long-term, high-quality fixed-term investments, and is set annually. The rate of future increases in compensation is based upon current benefits policies and economic forecasts.

 

The significant weighted average actuarial assumptions arising from these estimates and adopted in measuring our defined benefit obligations accrued are as follows:

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Discount rate 1  used to determine:

 

 

 

 

 

Net benefit costs for the year ended December 31

 

3.40

%

3.80

%

Defined benefit obligations accrued as at December 31

 

3.90

%

3.40

%

Current service cost in subsequent fiscal year

 

4.00

%

3.50

%

Rate of future increases in compensation used to determine:

 

 

 

 

 

Net benefit costs for the year ended December 31

 

2.70

%

2.51

%

Defined benefit obligations accrued as at December 31

 

2.80

%

2.70

%

 


(1)          The discount rate disclosed in this table reflects the computation of an average discount rate that replicates the timing of the obligation cash flows.

 

 

51


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Sensitivity of key assumptions

 

The sensitivity of our key assumptions for our defined benefit pension plans was as follows:

 

Years ended, or as at, December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Increase (decrease) (millions)

 

Change in
obligations

 

Change in
expenses

 

Change in
obligations

 

Change in
expenses

 

Sensitivity of key demographic assumptions to an increase of one year 1  in life expectancy

 

$

242

 

$

11

 

$

270

 

$

10

 

Sensitivity of key financial assumptions to a hypothetical decrease of 25 basis points 1  in:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Discount rate

 

$

292

 

$

16

 

$

337

 

$

16

 

Rate of future increases in compensation

 

$

(27

)

$

(3

)

$

(34

)

$

(3

)

 


(1)          These sensitivities are hypothetical and should be used with caution. Favourable hypothetical changes in the assumptions result in decreased amounts, and unfavourable hypothetical changes in the assumptions result in increased amounts, of the obligations and expenses. Changes in amounts based on a variation in assumptions of one year or 25 basis points generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumption to the change in amounts may not be linear. Also, in this table, the effect of a variation in a particular assumption on the change in obligations or change in expenses is calculated without changing any other assumption; in reality, changes in one factor may result in changes in another (for example, increases in the discount rate may result in changes in expectations about the rate of future increases in compensation), which might magnify or counteract the sensitivities.

 

(f)     Defined contribution plans – expense

 

Our total defined contribution pension plan costs recognized were as follows:

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Union pension plan and public service pension plan contributions

 

$

22

 

$

23

 

Other defined contribution pension plans

 

66

 

65

 

 

 

$

88

 

$

88

 

 

We expect that our 2019 union pension plan and public service pension plan contributions will be approximately $22 million.

 

(g)    Other defined benefit plans

 

For the year ended December 31, 2018, other defined benefit plan current service cost was $NIL (2017 — $NIL), financing cost was $1 million (2017 — $1 million) and other re-measurements recorded in other comprehensive income were $2 million (2017 — $NIL). Estimated future benefit payments from our other defined benefit plans, calculated as at December 31, 2018, are $1 million annually for the five-year period from 2019 to 2023 and $6 million for the five-year period from 2024 to 2028.

 

16   restructuring and other costs

 

(a)          Details of restructuring and other costs

 

With the objective of reducing ongoing costs, we incur associated incremental non-recurring restructuring costs, as discussed further in (b)  following. We may also incur atypical charges when undertaking major or transformational changes to our business or operating models or post-acquisition business integration. We include incremental atypical external costs incurred in connection with business acquisition or disposition activity, as well as litigation costs, in the context of significant losses or settlements, in other costs.

 

Restructuring and other costs are presented in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income, as set out in the following table:

 

 

 

Restructuring (b)

 

Other (c)

 

Total

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

Goods and services purchased

 

$

52

 

$

66

 

$

129

 

$

15

 

$

181

 

$

81

 

Employee benefits expense

 

126

 

26

 

10

 

10

 

136

 

36

 

 

 

$

178

 

$

92

 

$

139

 

$

25

 

$

317

 

$

117

 

 

(b)    Restructuring provisions

 

Employee-related provisions and other provisions, as presented in Note 25, include amounts in respect of restructuring activities. In 2018, restructuring activities included ongoing and incremental efficiency initiatives, including personnel-related costs and rationalization of real estate. These initiatives were intended to improve our long-term operating productivity and competitiveness.

 

(c)    Other

 

During the year ended December 31, 2018, incremental external costs were incurred in connection with business acquisition activity. In connection with business acquisitions, non-recurring atypical business integration expenditures that would be considered neither restructuring costs nor part of the fair value of the net assets acquired have been

 

 

52


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

included in other costs. As well, we fundamentally transformed our operating model in respect of our philanthropic giving. We made an initial donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation of $100 million of TELUS Corporation Common Shares; we have committed to subsequent donations of $18 million.

 

17           property, plant and equipment

 

(millions)

 

Note

 

Network
assets 
1

 

Buildings and
leasehold
improvements

 

Other  1

 

Land

 

Assets under
construction

 

Total

 

At cost

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at January 1, 2017

 

 

 

$

28,284

 

$

2,954

 

$

1,021

 

$

55

 

$

592

 

$

32,906

 

Additions 2

 

 

 

972

 

51

 

44

 

 

1,426

 

2,493

 

Additions arising from business acquisitions

 

 

 

25

 

8

 

9

 

 

 

42

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

 

 

(1,724

)

(63

)

(48

)

(7

)

 

(1,842

)

Assets under construction put into service

 

 

 

1,167

 

127

 

69

 

 

(1,363

)

 

As at December 31, 2017

 

 

 

28,724

 

3,077

 

1,095

 

48

 

655

 

33,599

 

Additions 2

 

 

 

1,039

 

27

 

37

 

 

1,265

 

2,368

 

Additions arising from business acquisitions

 

18(b)

 

4

 

13

 

9

 

 

 

26

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

 

 

(767

)

56

 

(52

)

 

 

(763

)

Assets under construction put into service

 

 

 

956

 

100

 

85

 

 

(1,141

)

 

As at December 31, 2018

 

 

 

$

29,956

 

$

3,273

 

$

1,174

 

$

48

 

$

779

 

$

35,230

 

Accumulated depreciation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at January 1, 2017

 

 

 

$

19,950

 

$

1,836

 

$

656

 

$

 

$

 

$

22,442

 

Depreciation

 

 

 

1,396

 

106

 

115

 

 

 

1,617

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

 

 

(1,708

)

(58

)

(62

)

 

 

(1,828

)

As at December 31, 2017

 

 

 

19,638

 

1,884

 

709

 

 

 

22,231

 

Depreciation

 

 

 

1,431

 

115

 

123

 

 

 

1,669

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

 

 

(769

)

51

 

(43

)

 

 

(761

)

As at December 31, 2018

 

 

 

$

20,300

 

$

2,050

 

$

789

 

$

 

$

 

$

23,139

 

Net book value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2017

 

 

 

$

9,086

 

$

1,193

 

$

386

 

$

48

 

$

655

 

$

11,368

 

As at December 31, 2018

 

 

 

$

9,656

 

$

1,223

 

$

385

 

$

48

 

$

779

 

$

12,091

 

 


(1)          As at December 31, 2018, the net carrying amount of assets under finance leases included in network assets was $100 (2017 — $NIL) and included in other was $1 (2017 — $NIL).

(2)          For the year ended December 31, 2018, additions include $(15) (2017 — $7) in respect of asset retirement obligations (see Note 25 ).

 

As at December 31, 2018, our contractual commitments for the acquisition of property, plant and equipment totalled $177 million over a period ending December 31, 2022 (2017 — $184 million over a period ending December 31, 2019).

 

 

53


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

18   intangible assets and goodwill

 

(a)          Intangible assets and goodwill, net

 

 

 

Intangible assets subject to amortization

 

Intangible
assets with
indefinite lives

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(millions)

 

Customer contracts,
related customer
relationships and
subscriber base

 

Software

 

Access to
rights-of-way
and other

 

Assets
under
construction

 

Total

 

Spectrum
licences

 

Total
intangible
assets

 

Goodwill  1

 

Total
intangible
assets and
goodwill

 

At cost

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at January 1, 2017

 

$

485

 

$

4,295

 

$

93

 

$

212

 

$

5,085

 

$

8,693

 

$

13,778

 

$

4,151

 

$

17,929

 

Additions

 

 

74

 

5

 

538

 

617

 

 

617

 

 

617

 

Additions arising from business acquisitions

 

134

 

101

 

 

 

235

 

 

235

 

452

 

687

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

(61

)

(209

)

(1

)

 

(271

)

 

(271

)

 

(271

)

Assets under construction put into service

 

 

406

 

 

(406

)

 

 

 

 

 

Net foreign exchange differences

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3

)

(3

)

As at December 31, 2017

 

558

 

4,667

 

97

 

344

 

5,666

 

8,693

 

14,359

 

4,600

 

18,959

 

Additions

 

 

69

 

5

 

582

 

656

 

1

 

657

 

 

657

 

Additions arising from business acquisitions (b)

 

219

 

19

 

 

 

238

 

 

238

 

456

 

694

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

(138

)

(248

)

1

 

 

(385

)

 

(385

)

 

(385

)

Assets under construction put into service

 

 

585

 

 

(585

)

 

 

 

 

 

Net foreign exchange differences

 

(1

)

 

 

 

(1

)

 

(1

)

41

 

40

 

As at December 31, 2018

 

$

638

 

$

5,092

 

$

103

 

$

341

 

$

6,174

 

$

8,694

 

$

14,868

 

$

5,097

 

$

19,965

 

Accumulated amortization

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at January 1, 2017

 

$

323

 

$

3,032

 

$

59

 

$

 

$

3,414

 

$

 

$

3,414

 

$

364

 

$

3,778

 

Amortization

 

48

 

500

 

4

 

 

552

 

 

552

 

 

552

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

(61

)

(202

)

(2

)

 

(265

)

 

(265

)

 

(265

)

As at December 31, 2017

 

310

 

3,330

 

61

 

 

3,701

 

 

3,701

 

364

 

4,065

 

Amortization

 

56

 

538

 

4

 

 

598

 

 

598

 

 

598

 

Dispositions, retirements and other

 

(140

)

(247

)

 

 

(387

)

 

(387

)

 

(387

)

As at December 31, 2018

 

$

226

 

$

3,621

 

$

65

 

$

 

$

3,912

 

$

 

$

3,912

 

$

364

 

$

4,276

 

Net book value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2017

 

$

248

 

$

1,337

 

$

36

 

$

344

 

$

1,965

 

$

8,693

 

$

10,658

 

$

4,236

 

$

14,894

 

As at December 31, 2018

 

$

412

 

$

1,471

 

$

38

 

$

341

 

$

2,262

 

$

8,694

 

$

10,956

 

$

4,733

 

$

15,689

 

 


(1)          Accumulated amortization of goodwill is amortization recorded prior to 2002; there are no accumulated impairment losses in the accumulated amortization of goodwill. The goodwill additions arising from business acquisitions for the year ended December 31, 2017, have been adjusted as set out in (c) .

 

As at December 31, 2018, our contractual commitments for the acquisition of intangible assets totalled $59 million over a period ending December 31, 2021 (2017 — $36 million over a period ending December 31, 2020).

 

 

54


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(b)    Business acquisitions

 

AlarmForce Industries

 

On January 4, 2018, we acquired the customers, assets and operations of AlarmForce Industries Inc. in British Columbia, Alberta and Saskatchewan, the primary reason for which is to leverage our telecommunications infrastructure and expertise to continue to enhance connected home, business, security and health services for our customers.

 

The primary factor that contributed to the recognition of goodwill was the earnings capacity of the acquired business in excess of the net tangible and intangible assets acquired (such excess arising from the acquired workforce and the benefits of acquiring an established business). The amount assigned to goodwill is not expected to be deductible for income tax purposes.

 

Xavient Information Systems

 

On February 6, 2018, through our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. subsidiary, we acquired 65% of Xavient Information Systems, a group of information technology consulting and software services companies with facilities in the United States and India. The investment was made with a view to enhancing our ability to provide complex and higher-value information technology services, improving our related sales and solutioning capabilities and acquiring multi-site redundancy in support of other facilities.

 

In respect of the 65% acquired business, we concurrently provided a written put option to the remaining selling shareholders; the written put option for the remaining 35% of the economic interest would become exercisable no later than December 31, 2020. The acquisition-date fair value of the puttable shares held by the non-controlling shareholders has been recorded as a provision (see Note 25 ). Also concurrent with our acquisition of the initial 65% interest, the non-controlling shareholders provided us with a purchased call option, which substantially mirrors the written put option.

 

The primary factor that contributed to the recognition of goodwill was the earnings capacity of the acquired business in excess of the net tangible and intangible assets acquired (such excess arising from the acquired workforce and the benefits of acquiring an established business). Not all of the amount assigned to goodwill is expected to be deductible for income tax purposes.

 

Medisys Health Group Inc.

 

On July 19, 2018, we acquired Medisys Health Group Inc., a business complementary to our existing lines of healthcare business. The investment was made with a view to growing the delivery of employee-centred workplace health and wellness services.

 

The primary factor that contributed to the recognition of goodwill was the earnings capacity of the acquired business in excess of the net tangible and intangible assets acquired (such excess arising from the acquired workforce and the benefits of acquiring an established business). None of the amount assigned to goodwill is expected to be deductible for income tax purposes.

 

Individually immaterial transactions

 

During the year ended December 31, 2018, we acquired 100% ownership of businesses complementary to our existing lines of business. The primary factor that gave rise to the recognition of goodwill was the earnings capacity of the acquired businesses in excess of the net tangible and intangible assets acquired (such excess arising from the low level of tangible assets relative to the earnings capacities of the businesses). A portion of the amounts assigned to goodwill may be deductible for income tax purposes.

 

Acquisition-date fair values

 

Acquisition-date fair values assigned to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed are set out in the following table:

 

 

55


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

 

 

Home and business security-related

 

 

 

TELUS Health-related

 

 

 

 

 

As at acquisition-date fair values (millions)

 

AlarmForce
Industries

 

Individually
immaterial
transactions

 

Total

 

Xavient
Information
Systems

 

Medisys
Health
Group Inc. 
1

 

Individually
immaterial
transactions

 

Total

 

Individually
immaterial
transactions

 

Total

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash

 

$

 

$

1

 

$

1

 

$

8

 

$

3

 

$

 

$

3

 

$

 

$

12

 

Accounts receivable 2

 

 

 

 

33

 

15

 

2

 

17

 

4

 

54

 

Other

 

1

 

 

1

 

3

 

2

 

 

2

 

 

6

 

 

 

1

 

1

 

2

 

44

 

20

 

2

 

22

 

4

 

72

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Buildings and leasehold improvements

 

 

 

 

1

 

12

 

 

12

 

 

13

 

Other

 

1

 

 

1

 

5

 

3

 

 

3

 

4

 

13

 

Intangible assets subject to amortization 3

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Customer contracts and related customer relationships

 

13

 

13

 

26

 

100

 

72

 

10

 

82

 

11

 

219

 

Software

 

 

 

 

 

4

 

10

 

14

 

5

 

19

 

Other

 

 

 

 

4

 

1

 

 

1

 

 

5

 

 

 

14

 

13

 

27

 

110

 

92

 

20

 

112

 

20

 

269

 

Total identifiable assets acquired

 

15

 

14

 

29

 

154

 

112

 

22

 

134

 

24

 

341

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Short-term borrowings

 

 

 

 

6

 

62

 

 

62

 

 

68

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

 

 

 

29

 

13

 

 

13

 

4

 

46

 

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

1

 

1

 

2

 

 

5

 

1

 

6

 

1

 

9

 

Provisions

 

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

2

 

 

2

 

 

 

1

 

1

 

2

 

35

 

82

 

1

 

83

 

5

 

125

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

1

 

 

1

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

 

 

 

2

 

8

 

 

8

 

 

10

 

Deferred income taxes

 

1

 

3

 

4

 

 

20

 

 

20

 

 

24

 

 

 

1

 

3

 

4

 

2

 

29

 

 

29

 

 

35

 

Total liabilities assumed

 

2

 

4

 

6

 

37

 

111

 

1

 

112

 

5

 

160

 

Net identifiable assets acquired

 

13

 

10

 

23

 

117

 

1

 

21

 

22

 

19

 

181

 

Goodwill

 

55

 

47

 

102

 

244

 

83

 

16

 

99

 

11

 

456

 

Net assets acquired

 

$

68

 

$

57

 

$

125

 

$

361

 

$

84

 

$

37

 

$

121

 

$

30

 

$

637

 

Acquisition effected by way of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash consideration

 

$

68

 

$

54

 

$

122

 

$

125

 

$

3

 

$

29

 

$

32

 

$

11

 

$

290

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

 

3

 

3

 

15

 

2

 

3

 

5

 

 

23

 

Provisions

 

 

 

 

202

 

 

5

 

5

 

 

207

 

Issue of TELUS Corporation Common Shares

 

 

 

 

 

79

 

 

79

 

19

 

98

 

Issue of shares by a subsidiary to a non-controlling interest

 

 

 

 

19

 

 

 

 

 

19

 

 

 

$

68

 

$

57

 

$

125

 

$

361

 

$

84

 

$

37

 

$

121

 

$

30

 

$

637

 

 

 

56


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 


(1)          The purchase price allocation, primarily in respect of customer contracts, related customer relationships and leasehold interests and deferred income taxes, had not been finalized as of the date of issuance of these consolidated financial statements. As is customary in a business acquisition transaction, until the time of acquisition of control, we did not have full access to the books and records of Medisys Health Group Inc. Upon having sufficient time to review the books and records of Medisys Health Group Inc., we expect to finalize our purchase price allocation.

(2)          The fair value of accounts receivable is equal to the gross contractual amounts receivable and reflects the best estimates at the acquisition dates of the contractual cash flows expected to be collected.

(3)          Customer contracts and customer relationships (including those related to customer contracts) are expected to be amortized over periods of 6 to 10 years; software is expected to be amortized over a period of 5 years.

 

Pro forma disclosures

 

The following pro forma supplemental information represents certain results of operations as if the business acquisitions noted above had been completed at the beginning of the fiscal 2018 year.

 

Year ended December 31, 2018 (millions except per share amounts)

 

As reported  1

 

Pro forma  2

 

Operating revenues

 

$

14,368

 

$

14,468

 

Net income

 

$

1,624

 

$

1,628

 

Net income per Common Share

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

2.68

 

$

2.68

 

Diluted

 

$

2.68

 

$

2.68

 

 


(1)          Operating revenues and net income for the year ended December 31, 2018, include: $17 and $NIL, respectively, in respect of AlarmForce Industries; $166 and $2, respectively, in respect of Xavient Information Systems; and $48 and $NIL, respectively, in respect of Medisys Health Group Inc.

(2)          Pro forma amounts for the year ended December 31, 2018, reflect the acquired businesses. The results of the acquired businesses have been included in our Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income effective the dates of acquisition.

 

The pro forma supplemental information is based on estimates and assumptions that are believed to be reasonable. The pro forma supplemental information is not necessarily indicative of our consolidated financial results in future periods or the actual results that would have been realized had the business acquisitions been completed at the beginning of the periods presented. The pro forma supplemental information includes incremental property, plant and equipment depreciation, intangible asset amortization, financing and other charges as a result of the acquisitions, net of the related tax effects.

 

(c)           Business acquisition — prior period

 

On August 31, 2017, we acquired 55% of Voxpro Limited, a business process outsourcing and contact centre services company with facilities in Ireland, the United States and Romania. As at December 31, 2017, the purchase price allocation had not been finalized. During the three-month period ended March 31, 2018, preliminary acquisition-date values assigned for goodwill and provisions were finalized and each was increased by $19 million; as required by IFRS-IASB, comparative amounts have been adjusted so as to reflect those increases effective the acquisition date.

 

(d)          Business acquisition — subsequent to reporting period

 

On January 14, 2019, we acquired a business complementary to our existing telecommunications lines of business, for consideration consisting of cash of $89 million and TELUS Corporation Common Shares of $38 million. The investment was made with a view to growing our managed network, cloud, security and unified communications services.

 

As of February 14, 2019, our initial provision for the net identifiable assets acquired is in the range of $30 million — $40 million; as is customary in a business acquisition transaction, until the time of acquisition of control, we did not have full access to the books and records of the acquired business. Upon having sufficient time to review the books and records of the acquired business, as well as obtaining new and additional information about the related facts and circumstances as of the acquisition date, we will adjust the provisional amounts for identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed and thus finalize our purchase price allocation.

 

(e)           Intangible assets with indefinite lives — spectrum licences

 

Our intangible assets with indefinite lives include spectrum licences granted by Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada, which are used for the provision of both mobile and fixed wireless services. The spectrum licence policy terms indicate that the spectrum licences will likely be renewed. We expect our spectrum licences to be renewed every 20 years following a review of our compliance with licence terms. In addition to current usage, our licensed spectrum can be used for planned and new technologies. As a result of our assessment of the combination of these significant factors, we currently consider our spectrum licences to have indefinite lives and, as referred to in Note 1(b) , this represents a significant judgment for us.

 

 

57


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(f)            Impairment testing of intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill

 

General

 

As referred to in Note 1(f) , the carrying values of intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill are periodically tested for impairment and, as referred to in Note 1(b) , this test represents a significant estimate for us, while also requiring significant judgments to be made.

 

The carrying values allocated to intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill are set out in the following table.

 

 

 

Intangible assets with
indefinite lives

 

Goodwill

 

Total

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

2018

 

2017  1

 

2018

 

2017

 

Wireless

 

$

8,694

 

$

8,693

 

$

2,861

 

$

2,860

 

$

11,555

 

$

11,553

 

Wireline

 

 

 

1,872

 

1,376

 

1,872

 

1,376

 

 

 

$

8,694

 

$

8,693

 

$

4,733

 

$

4,236

 

$

13,427

 

$

12,929

 

 


(1)          The goodwill balance for wireline as at December 31, 2017, has been adjusted as set out in (c) .

 

The recoverable amounts of the cash-generating units’ assets have been determined based on a fair value less costs of disposal calculation. There is a material degree of uncertainty with respect to the estimates of the recoverable amounts of the cash-generating units’ assets, given the necessity of making key economic assumptions about the future. Recoverable amounts based on fair value less costs of disposal are categorized as Level 3 fair value measures.

 

We validate our recoverable amount calculation results through a market-comparable approach and an analytical review of industry facts and facts that are specific to us. The market-comparable approach uses current (at time of test) market consensus estimates and equity trading prices for U.S. and Canadian firms in the same industry. In addition, we ensure that the combination of the valuations of the cash-generating units is reasonable based on our current (at time of test) market value.

 

Key assumptions

 

The fair value less costs of disposal calculation uses discounted cash flow projections that employ the following key assumptions: future cash flows and growth projections (including judgments about the allocation of future capital expenditures to support both wireless and wireline operations); associated economic risk assumptions and estimates of the likelihood of achieving key operating metrics and drivers; estimates of future generational infrastructure capital expenditures; and the future weighted average cost of capital. We consider a range of reasonably possible amounts to use for key assumptions and decide upon amounts that represent management’s best estimates of market amounts. In the normal course, we make changes to key assumptions so that they reflect current (at time of test) economic conditions, updates of historical information used to develop the key assumptions and changes (if any) in our debt ratings.

 

The key assumptions for cash flow projections are based upon our approved financial forecasts, which span a period of three years and are discounted, for December 2018 annual impairment test purposes, at a consolidated post-tax notional rate of 7.0% (2017 – 7.0%). For impairment testing valuations, cash flows subsequent to the three-year projection period are extrapolated, for December 2018 annual impairment test purposes, using perpetual growth rates of 2.00% (2017 – 2.25%) for each of the wireless cash-generating unit and the wireline cash-generating unit; these growth rates do not exceed the long-term average growth rates observed in the markets in which we operate.

 

We believe that any reasonably possible change in the key assumptions on which the calculation of the recoverable amounts of our cash-generating units is based would not cause the cash-generating units’ carrying values (including the intangible assets with indefinite lives and the goodwill allocated to each cash-generating unit) to exceed their recoverable amounts. If the future were to adversely differ from management’s best estimates for the key assumptions and associated cash flows were to be materially adversely affected, we could potentially experience future material impairment charges in respect of our intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill.

 

Sensitivity testing

 

Sensitivity testing was conducted as a part of the December 2018 annual impairment test, a component of which was hypothetical changes in the future weighted average cost of capital. Stress testing included a scenario of moderate declines in annual cash flows with all other assumptions being held constant; under this scenario, we would be able to recover the carrying values of our intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill for the foreseeable future.

 

 

58


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

19           leases

 

We occupy leased premises in various locations and have the right of use of land, buildings and equipment under operating leases. Most of our leases for real estate that we use for office or network (including wireless site) purposes typically have extension options which we use to protect our investment in leasehold improvements (including wireless site equipment) and to mitigate relocation risk, and/or which reflect the importance of the underlying right-of-use lease assets to our operations. Our judgment of lease terms for leased real estate utilized in connection with our telecommunications infrastructure, more so than for any other leased asset, routinely includes periods covered by options to extend the lease terms, as we are reasonably certain to extend such leases.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2018, operating lease expenses, which are net of the amortization of deferred gains on the sale-leaseback of buildings and the occupancy costs associated with leased real estate, were $243 million (2017 – $245 million); occupancy costs associated with leased real estate totalled $99 million (2017 – $90 million).

 

As referred to in Note 16 , we have consolidated our administrative real estate holdings and, in some instances, this has resulted in subletting land and buildings. The future minimum lease payments under operating leases are as follows:

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Years ending

 

Operating
leases with
arm’s-length
lessors 
1

 

Operating
leases with
related party
lessor 
2

 

Total

 

Operating
leases with
arm’s-length
lessors
1

 

Operating
leases with
related party
lessors 
2

 

Total

 

1 year hence

 

$

240

 

$

2

 

$

242

 

$

218

 

$

6

 

$

224

 

2 years hence

 

222

 

6

 

228

 

191

 

12

 

203

 

3 years hence

 

195

 

6

 

201

 

169

 

13

 

182

 

4 years hence

 

161

 

6

 

167

 

147

 

13

 

160

 

5 years hence

 

139

 

6

 

145

 

122

 

13

 

135

 

Thereafter

 

681

 

112

 

793

 

534

 

208

 

742

 

 

 

$

1,638

 

$

138

 

$

1,776

 

$

1,381

 

$

265

 

$

1,646

 

 


(1)          Immaterial amounts for minimum lease receipts from sublet land and buildings have been netted against the minimum lease payments in this table. Minimum lease payments exclude occupancy costs and thus will differ from future amounts reported for operating lease expenses. As at December 31, 2018, commitments for occupancy costs under operating leases totalled $813 (2017 – $816).

(2)          As set out in Note 21(c), we have entered into leases with real estate joint ventures. This table includes 100% of the minimum lease payment amounts due under these leases; of the total, $46 (2017 – $109) is due to our economic interest in the real estate joint venture and $92 (2017 – $156) is due to our partners’ economic interests in the real estate joint venture.

 

Of the total amount above as at December 31, 2018:

 

·                   Approximately 28% (2017 – 33%) was in respect of our five largest leases, all of which were for office premises over various terms, with expiry dates ranging from 2024 to 2039 (2017 – ranging from 2024 to 2036); the weighted average remaining term of these leases is approximately 13 years (2017 – 13 years).

·                   Approximately 34% (2017 – 29%) was in respect of wireless site leases; the weighted average remaining term of these leases is approximately 14 years (2017 – 14 years).

 

See Note 2(b)  for details of significant changes to IFRS-IASB which are not yet effective and have not yet been applied, but which will significantly affect the timing of the recognition of operating lease expenses and their recognition in the Consolidated statement of financial position, as well as their classification in the Consolidated statement of income and other comprehensive income and the Consolidated statement of cash flows.

 

20           other long-term assets

 

As at (millions)

 

Note

 

December 31,
2018

 

December 31,
2017

 

January 1,
2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

(Note 2(c))

 

Pension assets

 

15(b)

 

$

503

 

$

156

 

$

358

 

Costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract with a customer

 

 

 

110

 

107

 

93

 

Portfolio investments 1

 

 

 

70

 

41

 

62

 

Prepaid maintenance

 

 

 

55

 

57

 

62

 

Real estate joint venture advances

 

21(c)

 

69

 

47

 

21

 

Real estate joint ventures

 

21(c)

 

5

 

15

 

30

 

Derivative assets

 

4(h)

 

54

 

6

 

6

 

Other

 

 

 

120

 

99

 

101

 

 

 

 

 

$

986

 

$

528

 

$

733

 

 


(1)          Fair value measured at reporting date using significant other observable inputs (Level 2).

 

 

59


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The costs incurred to obtain and fulfill contracts with customers are set out in the following table:

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

Costs incurred to

 

 

 

Costs incurred to

 

 

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Obtain
contracts with
customers

 

Fulfill contracts
with customers

 

Total

 

Obtain
contracts with
customers

 

Fulfill contracts
with customers

 

Total

 

Balance, beginning of period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As previously reported

 

$

329

 

$

11

 

$

340

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

Transitional amount

 

 

 

 

295

 

8

 

303

 

As adjusted

 

329

 

11

 

340

 

295

 

8

 

303

 

Additions

 

313

 

8

 

321

 

304

 

4

 

308

 

Amortization

 

(286

)

(4

)

(290

)

(270

)

(1

)

(271

)

Balance, end of period

 

$

356

 

$

15

 

$

371

 

$

329

 

$

11

 

$

340

 

Current 1

 

$

256

 

$

5

 

$

261

 

$

230

 

$

3

 

$

233

 

Non-current

 

100

 

10

 

110

 

99

 

8

 

107

 

 

 

$

356

 

$

15

 

$

371

 

$

329

 

$

11

 

$

340

 

 


(1)          Presented on the Consolidated statements of financial position in prepaid expenses.

 

21           real estate joint ventures

 

(a)          General

 

In 2011, we partnered, as equals, with an arm’s-length party in a residential condominium, retail and commercial real estate redevelopment project, TELUS Garden, in Vancouver, British Columbia. TELUS is a tenant in TELUS Garden, which is now our global headquarters. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the real estate joint venture sold the income-producing properties and the related net assets. The purchaser assumed the 3.7% mortgage and the 3.4% bonds secured by the income-producing properties.

 

In 2013, we partnered, as equals, with two arm’s-length parties (one of which is our TELUS Garden partner) in a residential, retail and commercial real estate redevelopment project, TELUS Sky, in Calgary, Alberta. The new-build tower, scheduled for completion in 2019, is to be built to the LEED Platinum standard.

 

(b)          Real estate joint ventures — summarized financial information

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

$

11

 

$

20

 

Escrowed deposits for tenant inducements and liens

 

4

 

1

 

Other

 

2

 

4

 

 

 

17

 

25

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

Property under development — investment property

 

256

 

194

 

Investment property

 

 

221

 

Other

 

 

35

 

 

 

256

 

450

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

273

 

$

475

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND OWNERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

$

19

 

$

13

 

Current portion of 3.7% mortgage and senior secured 3.4% bonds

 

 

5

 

Construction holdback liabilities

 

15

 

10

 

 

 

34

 

28

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

Construction credit facilities

 

207

 

141

 

3.7% mortgage due September 2024

 

 

27

 

Senior secured 3.4% bonds due July 2025

 

 

208

 

 

 

207

 

376

 

 

 

241

 

404

 

Owners’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

TELUS  1

 

13

 

29

 

Other partners

 

19

 

42

 

 

 

32

 

71

 

 

 

$

273

 

$

475

 

 


(1)          The equity amounts recorded by the real estate joint venture differ from those recorded by us by the amount of the deferred gains on our real estate contributed and the valuation provision we have recorded in excess of that recorded by the real estate joint venture.

 

 

60


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Revenue

 

 

 

 

 

From investment property

 

$

21

 

$

34

 

From sale of residential condominiums

 

$

 

$

19

 

Other operating income

 

$

345

 

$

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

$

5

 

$

8

 

Interest expense  1

 

$

6

 

$

8

 

Net income and comprehensive income 2

 

$

322

 

$

(6

)

 


(1)          During the year ended December 31, 2018, the real estate joint ventures capitalized $8 (2017 – $3) of financing costs.

(2)          As the real estate joint ventures are partnerships, no provision for income taxes of the partners is made in determining the real estate joint ventures’ net income and comprehensive income.

 

(c)           Our real estate joint ventures activity

 

Our real estate joint ventures investment activity is set out in the following table.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Loans and
receivables
 1

 

Equity  2

 

Total

 

Loans and
receivables
 1

 

Equity  2

 

Total

 

Related to real estate joint ventures’ statements of income and other comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Comprehensive income attributable to us 3

 

$

 

$

171

 

$

171

 

$

 

$

2

 

$

2

 

Related to real estate joint ventures’ statements of financial position

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Items not affecting currently reported cash flows

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Recognition of gain deferred on our real estate initially contributed

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

1

 

Construction credit facilities financing costs charged by us and other (Note 7)

 

3

 

 

3

 

 

 

 

Cash flows in the current reporting period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction credit facilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amounts advanced

 

22

 

 

22

 

26

 

 

26

 

Financing costs paid to us

 

(3

)

 

(3

)

 

 

 

Funds repaid to us and earnings distributed

 

 

(181

)

(181

)

 

(18

)

(18

)

Net increase (decrease)

 

22

 

(10

)

12

 

26

 

(15

)

11

 

Real estate joint ventures carrying amounts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of period

 

47

 

15

 

62

 

21

 

30

 

51

 

Balance, end of period

 

$

69

 

$

5

 

$

74

 

$

47

 

$

15

 

$

62

 

 


(1)          Loans and receivables are included in our Consolidated statements of financial position as Real estate joint venture advances and are comprised of advances under construction credit facilities (see (d) ).

(2)          We account for our interests in the real estate joint ventures using the equity method of accounting.

(3)          As the real estate joint ventures are partnerships, no provision for income taxes of the partners is made in determining the real estate joint ventures’ net income and comprehensive income; a provision for income taxes is made in determining the comprehensive income attributable to us.

 

Prior to the sale of the TELUS Garden income-producing properties, during the year ended December 31, 2018, the TELUS Garden real estate joint venture recognized $7 million (2017 – $12 million) of revenue from our TELUS Garden office tenancy; of this amount, one-half was due to our economic interest in the real estate joint venture and one-half was due to our partner’s economic interest in the real estate joint venture.

 

(d)          Commitments and contingent liabilities

 

Construction commitments

 

The TELUS Sky real estate joint venture is expected to spend a total of approximately $400 million on the construction of a mixed-use tower. As at December 31, 2018, the real estate joint venture’s construction-related contractual commitments were approximately $35 million through to 2019 (2017 – $82 million through to 2019).

 

Construction credit facilities

 

The TELUS Sky real estate joint venture has a credit agreement with three Canadian financial institutions (as 66-2/3% lender) and TELUS Corporation (as 33-1/3% lender) to provide $342 million of construction financing for the project. The construction credit facilities contain customary real estate construction financing representations, warranties and covenants and are secured by demand debentures constituting first fixed and floating charge mortgages over the underlying real estate assets. The construction credit facilities are available by way of bankers’ acceptance or prime loan and bear interest at rates in line with similar construction financing facilities.

 

 

61


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Construction credit facilities commitment — TELUS Corporation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Undrawn

 

4(c)

 

$

45

 

$

67

 

Advances

 

 

 

69

 

47

 

 

 

 

 

114

 

114

 

Construction credit facilities commitment — other

 

 

 

228

 

228

 

 

 

 

 

$

342

 

$

342

 

 

22           short-term borrowings

 

On July 26, 2002, one of our subsidiaries, TELUS Communications Inc., entered into an agreement with an arm’s-length securitization trust associated with a major Schedule I bank under which it is able to sell an interest in certain trade receivables up to a maximum of $500 million (2017 – $500 million). The term of this revolving-period securitization agreement ends December 31, 2021 (2017 – December 31, 2018), and it requires minimum cash proceeds of $100 million from monthly sales of interests in certain trade receivables. TELUS Communications Inc. is required to maintain a credit rating of at least BB (2017 – BB) from Dominion Bond Rating Service or the securitization trust may require the sale program to be wound down prior to the end of the term.

 

Sales of trade receivables in securitization transactions are recognized as collateralized short-term borrowings and thus do not result in our de-recognition of the trade receivables sold. When we sell our trade receivables, we retain reserve accounts, which are retained interests in the securitized trade receivables, and servicing rights. As at December 31, 2018, we had sold to the trust (but continued to recognize) trade receivables of $120 million (2017 – $119 million). Short-term borrowings of $100 million (2017 – $100 million) are comprised of amounts advanced to us by the arm’s-length securitization trust pursuant to the sale of trade receivables.

 

The balance of short-term borrowings (if any) is comprised of amounts drawn on our bilateral bank facilities.

 

23           accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Accrued liabilities

 

$

1,159

 

$

1,066

 

Payroll and other employee-related liabilities

 

429

 

403

 

Restricted stock units liability

 

72

 

66

 

 

 

1,660

 

1,535

 

Trade accounts payable

 

686

 

717

 

Interest payable

 

157

 

147

 

Other

 

67

 

61

 

 

 

$

2,570

 

$

2,460

 

 

24           advance billings and customer deposits

 

As at (millions)

 

December 31,
2018

 

December 31,
2017

 

January 1,
2017

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

(Note 2(c))

 

Advance billings

 

$

535

 

$

506

 

$

456

 

Deferred customer activation and connection fees

 

10

 

13

 

17

 

Customer deposits

 

13

 

21

 

15

 

Regulatory deferral accounts

 

 

1

 

8

 

Contract liabilities

 

558

 

541

 

496

 

Other

 

95

 

91

 

88

 

 

 

$

653

 

$

632

 

$

584

 

 

Contract liabilities represent our future performance obligations to customers in respect of services and/or equipment and for which we have received consideration from the customer or for which an amount is due from the customer. Our contract liability balances, and the changes in those balances, are set out in the following table:

 

 

62


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Balance, beginning of period

 

 

 

$

780

 

$

732

 

Revenue deferred in previous period and recognized in current period

 

 

 

(689

)

(670

)

Net additions arising from operations

 

 

 

708

 

718

 

Regulatory deferral account drawdown

 

 

 

 

(7

)

Additions arising from business combinations

 

18(b)

 

9

 

7

 

Balance, end of period

 

 

 

$

808

 

$

780

 

Current

 

 

 

$

715

 

$

691

 

Non-current

 

27

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred revenues

 

 

 

78

 

71

 

Deferred customer activation and connection fees

 

 

 

15

 

18

 

 

 

 

 

$

808

 

$

780

 

Reconciliation of contract liabilities presented in the consolidated statements of financial position — current

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross contract liabilities

 

 

 

$

715

 

$

691

 

Reclassification to contract assets for contracts with contract liabilities less than contract assets

 

 

 

(154

)

(146

)

Reclassification from contract assets for contracts with contract assets less than contract liabilities

 

 

 

(3

)

(4

)

 

 

 

 

$

558

 

$

541

 

 

25           provisions

 

(millions)

 

Asset
retirement
obligation

 

Employee-
related

 

Written put
options 
1

 

Other

 

Total

 

As at January 1, 2017

 

$

339

 

$

77

 

$

 

$

103

 

$

519

 

Additions

 

13

 

39

 

90

 

58

 

200

 

Reversal

 

(53

)

(5

)

(11

)

(1

)

(70

)

Use

 

(6

)

(75

)

 

(40

)

(121

)

Interest effect  2

 

58

 

 

2

 

 

60

 

Effects of foreign exchange, net

 

 

 

1

 

 

1

 

As at December 31, 2017

 

351

 

36

 

82

 

120

 

589

 

Additions

 

6

 

124

 

207

 

72

 

409

 

Reversal

 

 

 

(17

)

(5

)

(22

)

Use

 

(10

)

(72

)

(13

)

(44

)

(139

)

Interest effect  2

 

(11

)

 

10

 

 

(1

)

Effects of foreign exchange, net

 

 

 

21

 

 

21

 

As at December 31, 2018

 

$

336

 

$

88

 

$

290

 

$

143

 

$

857

 

Current

 

$

6

 

$

35

 

$

 

$

37

 

$

78

 

Non-current

 

345

 

1

 

82

 

83

 

511

 

As at December 31, 2017

 

$

351

 

$

36

 

$

82

 

$

120

 

$

589

 

Current

 

$

8

 

$

84

 

$

9

 

$

28

 

$

129

 

Non-current

 

328

 

4

 

281

 

115

 

728

 

As at December 31, 2018

 

$

336

 

$

88

 

$

290

 

$

143

 

$

857

 

 


(1)          The additions for the year ended December 31, 2017, for written put options have been adjusted as set out in Note 18(c) .

(2)          The difference of $(22) (2017 — $47) between the asset retirement obligation interest effect in this table and the amount included in the amount disclosed in Note 9 is in respect of the change in the discount rates applicable to the provision, such difference being included in the cost of the associated asset(s) by way of being included with (netted against) the additions detailed in Note 17 .

 

Asset retirement obligation

 

We establish provisions for liabilities associated with the retirement of property, plant and equipment when those obligations result from the acquisition, construction, development and/or normal operation of the assets. We expect that the cash outflows in respect of the balance accrued as at the financial statement date will occur proximate to the dates these assets are retired.

 

Employee-related

 

The employee-related provisions are largely in respect of restructuring activities (as discussed further in Note 16(b) ). The timing of the cash outflows in respect of the balance accrued as at the financial statement date is substantially short-term in nature.

 

Written put options

 

In connection with certain business acquisitions, we have established provisions for contingent consideration and for written put options in respect of non-controlling interests. Cash outflows for contingent consideration are expected on a current basis. Provisions for written put options are determined based on the net present value of estimated future

 

 

63


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

earnings results and require us to make key economic assumptions about the future. No cash outflows for the written put options are expected prior to their initial exercisability in 2020.

 

Other

 

The provisions for other include: legal claims; non-employee-related restructuring activities; and contract termination costs and onerous contracts related to business acquisitions. Other than as set out following, we expect that the cash outflows in respect of the balance accrued as at the financial statement date will occur over an indeterminate multi-year period.

 

As discussed further in Note 29 , we are involved in a number of legal claims and we are aware of certain other possible legal claims. In respect of legal claims, we establish provisions, when warranted, after taking into account legal assessments, information presently available, and the expected availability of recourse. The timing of cash outflows associated with legal claims cannot be reasonably determined.

 

In connection with business acquisitions, we have established provisions for contingent consideration, contract termination costs and onerous contracts acquired.

 

26           long-term debt

 

(a)          Details of long-term debt

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

TELUS Corporation notes  

 

(b)

 

$

12,186

 

$

11,561

 

TELUS Corporation commercial paper

 

(c)

 

774

 

1,140

 

TELUS Communications Inc. debentures  

 

(e)

 

620

 

620

 

TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility

 

(f)

 

419

 

339

 

Finance leases

 

(g)

 

102

 

 

Long-term debt

 

 

 

$

14,101

 

$

13,660

 

Current

 

 

 

$

836

 

$

1,404

 

Non-current

 

 

 

13,265

 

12,256

 

Long-term debt

 

 

 

$

14,101

 

$

13,660

 

 

(b)          TELUS Corporation notes

 

The notes are senior unsecured and unsubordinated obligations and rank equally in right of payment with all of our existing and future unsecured unsubordinated obligations, are senior in right of payment to all of our existing and future subordinated indebtedness, and are effectively subordinated to all existing and future obligations of, or guaranteed by, our subsidiaries. The indentures governing the notes contain certain covenants that, among other things, place limitations on our ability, and the ability of certain of our subsidiaries, to: grant security in respect of indebtedness; enter into sale-leaseback transactions; and incur new indebtedness.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Principal face amount

 

Redemption present
value spread

 

Series  1

 

Issued

 

Maturity

 

Issue
price

 

Effective
interest
rate 
2

 

Originally
issued

 

Outstanding at
financial
statement date

 

Basis
points

 

Cessation
date

 

5.05% Notes, Series CG

 

December 2009

 

December 2019  3

 

$

994.19

 

5.13

%

$

1.0 billion

 

$

NIL

 

45.5

4

N/A

 

5.05% Notes, Series CH

 

July 2010

 

July 2020

 

$

997.44

 

5.08

%

$

1.0 billion

 

$

1.0 billion

 

47

4

N/A

 

3.35% Notes, Series CJ

 

December 2012

 

March 2023

 

$

998.83

 

3.36

%

$

500 million

 

$

500 million

 

40

5

Dec. 15, 2022

 

3.35% Notes, Series CK

 

April 2013

 

April 2024

 

$

994.35

 

3.41

%

$

1.1 billion

 

$

1.1 billion

 

36

5

Jan. 2, 2024

 

4.40% Notes, Series CL

 

April 2013

 

April 2043

 

$

997.68

 

4.41

%

$

600 million

 

$

600 million

 

47

5

Oct. 1, 2042

 

3.60% Notes, Series CM

 

November 2013

 

January 2021

 

$

997.15

 

3.65

%

$

400 million

 

$

400 million

 

35

5

N/A

 

5.15% Notes, Series CN

 

November 2013

 

November 2043

 

$

995.00

 

5.18

%

$

400 million

 

$

400 million

 

50

5

May 26, 2043

 

3.20% Notes, Series CO

 

April 2014

 

April 2021

 

$

997.39

 

3.24

%

$

500 million

 

$

500 million

 

30

5

Mar. 5, 2021

 

4.85% Notes, Series CP

 

Multiple 6

 

April 2044

 

$

987.91

6

4.93

% 6

$

500 million

6

$

900 million

6

46

5

Oct. 5, 2043

 

3.75% Notes, Series CQ

 

September 2014

 

January 2025

 

$

997.75

 

3.78

%

$

800 million

 

$

800 million

 

38.5

5

Oct. 17, 2024

 

4.75% Notes, Series CR

 

September 2014

 

January 2045

 

$

992.91

 

4.80

%

$

400 million

 

$

400 million

 

51.5

5

July 17, 2044

 

1.50% Notes, Series CS

 

March 2015

 

March 2018

 

$

999.62

 

1.51

%

$

250 million

 

$

NIL

 

N/A

7

N/A

 

2.35% Notes, Series CT

 

March 2015

 

March 2022

 

$

997.31

 

2.39

%

$

1.0 billion

 

$

1.0 billion

 

35.5

5

Feb. 28, 2022

 

4.40% Notes, Series CU

 

March 2015

 

January 2046

 

$

999.72

 

4.40

%

$

500 million

 

$

500 million

 

60.5

5

July 29, 2045

 

3.75% Notes, Series CV

 

December 2015

 

March 2026

 

$

992.14

 

3.84

%

$

600 million

 

$

600 million

 

53.5

5

Dec. 10, 2025

 

2.80% U.S. Dollar Notes 8

 

September 2016

 

February 2027

 

US$

991.89

 

2.89

%

US$

600 million

 

US$

600 million

 

20

9

Nov. 16, 2026

 

3.70% U.S. Dollar Notes 10

 

March 2017

 

September 2027

 

US$

998.95

 

3.71

%

US$

500 million

 

US$

500 million

 

20

9

June 15, 2027

 

4.70% Notes, Series CW

 

Multiple 11

 

March 2048

 

$

998.06

11

4.71

% 11

$

325 million

11

$

475 million

11

58.5

5

Sept. 6, 2047

 

3.625% Notes, Series CX

 

February 2018

 

March 2028

 

$

989.49

 

3.75

%

$

600 million

 

$

600 million

 

37

5

Dec. 1, 2027

 

4.60% U.S. Dollar Notes 12

 

June 2018

 

November 2048

 

US$

987.60

 

4.68

%

US$

750 million

 

US$

750 million

 

25

9

May 16, 2048

 

 

 

64


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 


(1)              Interest is payable semi-annually. The notes require us to make an offer to repurchase the notes at a price equal to 101% of their principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of repurchase upon the occurrence of a change in control triggering event, as defined in the supplemental trust indenture.

(2)              The effective interest rate is that which the notes would yield to an initial debt holder if held to maturity.

(3)              On June 28, 2018, we exercised our right to early redeem, on August 1, 2018, all of our 5.05% Notes, Series CG. The long-term debt prepayment premium recorded in the three-month period ended September 30, 2018, was $34 million before income taxes (see Note 9 ).

(4)              The notes are redeemable at our option, in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, on not fewer than 30 and not more than 60 days’ prior notice. The redemption price is equal to the greater of (i) the present value of the notes discounted at the Government of Canada yield plus the redemption present value spread, or (ii) 100% of the principal amount thereof. In addition, accrued and unpaid interest, if any, will be paid to the date fixed for redemption.

(5)              At any time prior to the respective maturity dates set out in the table, the notes are redeemable at our option, in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, on not fewer than 30 and not more than 60 days’ prior notice. The redemption price is equal to the greater of (i) the present value of the notes discounted at the Government of Canada yield plus the redemption present value spread calculated over the period to maturity, other than in the case of the Series CT, Series CU, Series CW and Series CX notes, for which it is calculated over the period to the redemption present value spread cessation date, or (ii) 100% of the principal amount thereof. In addition, accrued and unpaid interest, if any, will be paid to the date fixed for redemption. On or after the respective redemption present value spread cessation dates set out in the table, the notes are redeemable at our option, in whole but not in part, on not fewer than 30 and not more than 60 days’ prior notice, at redemption prices equal to 100% of the principal amounts thereof.

(6)              $500 million of 4.85% Notes, Series CP were issued in April 2014 at an issue price of $998.74 and an effective interest rate of 4.86%. This series of notes was reopened in December 2015 and a further $400 million of notes were issued at an issue price of $974.38 and an effective interest rate of 5.02%.

(7)              The notes were not redeemable at our option, other than in the event of certain changes in tax laws.

(8)              We have entered into a foreign exchange derivative (a cross currency interest rate exchange agreement) that effectively converted the principal payments and interest obligations to Canadian dollar obligations with a fixed interest rate of 2.95% and an issued and outstanding amount of $792 million (reflecting a fixed exchange rate of $1.3205).

(9)              At any time prior to the respective maturity dates set out in the table, the notes are redeemable at our option, in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, on not fewer than 30 and not more than 60 days’ prior notice. The redemption price is equal to the greater of (i) the present value of the notes discounted at the U.S. Adjusted Treasury Rate plus the redemption present value spread calculated over the period to the redemption present value spread cessation date, or (ii) 100% of the principal amount thereof. In addition, accrued and unpaid interest, if any, will be paid to the date fixed for redemption. On or after the respective redemption present value spread cessation dates set out in the table, the notes are redeemable at our option, in whole but not in part, on not fewer than 30 and not more than 60 days’ prior notice, at redemption prices equal to 100% of the principal amounts thereof.

(10)         We have entered into a foreign exchange derivative (a cross currency interest rate exchange agreement) that effectively converted the principal payments and interest obligations to Canadian dollar obligations with a fixed interest rate of 3.41% and an issued and outstanding amount of $667 million (reflecting a fixed exchange rate of $1.3348).

(11)         $325 million of 4.70% Notes, Series CW were issued in March 2017 at an issue price of $990.65 and an effective interest rate of 4.76%. This series of notes was reopened in February 2018 and a further $150 million of notes were issued at an issue price of $1,014.11 and an effective interest rate of 4.61%.

(12)         We have entered into a foreign exchange derivative (a cross currency interest rate exchange agreement) that effectively converted the principal payments and interest obligations to Canadian dollar obligations with a fixed interest rate of 4.41% and an issued and outstanding amount of $974 million (reflecting a fixed exchange rate of $1.2985).

 

(c)           TELUS Corporation commercial paper

 

TELUS Corporation has an unsecured commercial paper program, which is backstopped by our $2.25 billion syndicated credit facility (see (d) ) and is to be used for general corporate purposes, including capital expenditures and investments. This program enables us to issue commercial paper, subject to conditions related to debt ratings, up to a maximum aggregate amount at any one time of $1.4 billion (2017 — $1.4 billion). Foreign currency forward contracts are used to manage currency risk arising from issuing commercial paper denominated in U.S. dollars. Commercial paper debt is due within one year and is classified as a current portion of long-term debt, as the amounts are fully supported, and we expect that they will continue to be supported, by the revolving credit facility, which has no repayment requirements within the next year. As at December 31, 2018, we had $774 million of commercial paper outstanding, all of which was denominated in U.S. dollars (US$569 million), with an effective weighted average interest rate of 3.02%, maturing through June 2019.

 

(d)          TELUS Corporation credit facility

 

As at December 31, 2018, TELUS Corporation had an unsecured revolving $2.25 billion bank credit facility, renewed in May 2018 and expiring on May 31, 2023 (2017 — expiring on May 31, 2021), with a syndicate of financial institutions, which is to be used for general corporate purposes, including the backstopping of commercial paper.

 

TELUS Corporation’s credit facility bears interest at prime rate, U.S. Dollar Base Rate, a bankers’ acceptance rate or London interbank offered rate (LIBOR) (all such terms as used or defined in the credit facility), plus applicable margins. The credit facility contains customary representations, warranties and covenants, including two financial quarter-end ratio tests. These tests are that our net debt to operating cash flow ratio must not exceed 4.00:1.00 and our operating cash flow to interest expense ratio must not be less than 2.00:1.00, all as defined in the credit facility.

 

Continued access to TELUS Corporation’s credit facility is not contingent upon TELUS Corporation maintaining a specific credit rating.

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Net available

 

$

1,476

 

$

1,110

 

Backstop of commercial paper

 

774

 

1,140

 

Gross available

 

$

2,250

 

$

2,250

 

 

 

65


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

We had $184 million of letters of credit outstanding as at December 31, 2018 (2017 — $224 million), issued under various uncommitted facilities; such letter of credit facilities are in addition to the ability to provide letters of credit pursuant to our committed bank credit facility. We have arranged incremental letters of credit to allow us to participate in Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada’s 600 MHz wireless spectrum auction that is to be held in March 2019. Under the terms of the auction, communications between bidders that would provide insights into bidding strategies, including reference to preferred blocks, technologies or valuations, are precluded until the deadline for the final payment in the auction. Disclosure of the precise amount of our letters of credit could be interpreted as a signal of bidding intentions. The maximum amount of letters of credit that any individual participant could be required to deliver is approximately $880 million.

 

(e)           TELUS Communications Inc. debentures

 

The Series 3 and 5 Debentures were issued by a predecessor corporation of TELUS Communications Inc., BC TEL, under a Trust Indenture dated May 31, 1990. The Series B Debentures were issued by a predecessor corporation of TELUS Communications Inc., AGT Limited, under a Trust Indenture dated August 24, 1994, and a supplemental trust indenture dated September 22, 1995.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Principal face amount

 

Redemption present
value spread

 

Series  1

 

Issued

 

Maturity

 

Issue
price

 

Originally
issued

 

Outstanding at
financial
statement date

 

Basis points

 

10.65% Debentures, Series 3

 

June 1991

 

June 2021

 

$

998.00

 

$

175 million

 

$

175 million

 

N/A (non-redeemable)

 

9.65% Debentures, Series 5  2

 

April 1992

 

April 2022

 

$

972.00

 

$

150 million

 

$

249 million

 

N/A (non-redeemable)

 

8.80% Debentures, Series B

 

September 1995

 

September 2025

 

$

995.10

 

$

200 million

 

$

200 million

 

15

3

 


(1)          Interest is payable semi-annually.

(2)          Series 4 Debentures were exchangeable, at the holder’s option, effective on April 8 of any year during the four-year period from 1996 to 1999, for Series 5 Debentures; $99 million of Series 4 Debentures were exchanged for Series 5 Debentures.

(3)          At any time prior to the maturity date set out in the table, the debentures are redeemable at our option, in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, on not less than 30 days’ prior notice. The redemption price is equal to the greater of (i) the present value of the debentures discounted at the Government of Canada yield plus the redemption present value spread, or (ii) 100% of the principal amount thereof. In addition, accrued and unpaid interest, if any, will be paid to the date fixed for redemption.

 

The debentures became obligations of TELUS Communications Inc. pursuant to an amalgamation on January 1, 2001, are not secured by any mortgage, pledge or other charge and are governed by certain covenants, including a negative pledge and a limitation on issues of additional debt, subject to a debt to capitalization ratio and an interest coverage test. Effective June 12, 2009, TELUS Corporation guaranteed the payment of the debentures’ principal and interest.

 

(f)            TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility

 

As at December 31, 2018, TELUS International (Cda) Inc. had a bank credit facility, secured by its assets, expiring on December 20, 2022, with a syndicate of financial institutions. The credit facility is comprised of a US$350 million (2017 — US$350 million) revolving component and an amortizing US$120 million (2017 — US$120 million) term loan component. The credit facility is non-recourse to TELUS Corporation. As at December 31, 2018, $427 million ($419 million net of unamortized issue costs) was outstanding, all of which was denominated in U.S. dollars (US$313 million), with the revolving component having a weighted average interest rate of 4.22%.

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Revolving
component

 

Term loan
component 
1

 

Total

 

Revolving
component

 

Term loan
component

 

Total

 

Available

 

US$

150

 

US$

N/A

 

US$

150

 

US$

193

 

US$

N/A

 

US$

193

 

Outstanding

 

200

 

113

 

313

 

157

 

119

 

276

 

 

 

US$

350

 

US$

113

 

US$

463

 

US$

350

 

US$

119

 

US$

469

 

 


(1)          We have entered into a receive-floating interest rate, pay-fixed interest rate exchange agreement that effectively converts our interest obligations on the debt to a fixed rate of 2.64%.

 

TELUS International (Cda) Inc.’s credit facility bears interest at prime rate, U.S. Dollar Base Rate, a bankers’ acceptance rate or London interbank offered rate (LIBOR) (all such terms as used or defined in the credit facility), plus applicable margins. The credit facility contains customary representations, warranties and covenants, including two financial quarter-end ratio tests. These tests are that TELUS International (Cda) Inc.’s net debt to operating cash flow ratio must not exceed 3.25:1.00 and its operating cash flow to debt service (interest and scheduled principal repayment) ratio must not be less than 1.50:1.00, all as defined in the credit facility.

 

The term loan is subject to an amortization schedule which requires that 5% of the principal advanced be repaid each year of the term of the agreement, with the balance due at maturity.

 

 

66


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(g)          Finance leases

 

Finance leases are subject to amortization schedules, which results in the principal being repaid over various periods of approximately two years. The weighted average interest rate on finance leases was 2.87% as at December 31, 2018. See Note 2(b)  for details of significant changes to IFRS-IASB that are not yet effective and have not yet been applied.

 

(h)          Long-term debt maturities

 

Anticipated requirements to meet long-term debt repayments, calculated upon such long-term debts owing as at December 31, 2018, are as follows:

 

Composite long-term debt
denominated in

 

Canadian dollars

 

U.S. dollars

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term

 

Finance

 

 

 

Long-term

 

Currency swap agreement
amounts to be exchanged

 

 

 

 

 

Years ending December 31 (millions)

 

debt

 

leases

 

Total

 

debt

 

(Receive)  1

 

Pay

 

Total

 

Total

 

2019

 

$

 

$

52

 

$

52

 

$

784

 

$

(776

)

$

755

 

$

763

 

$

815

 

2020

 

1,000

 

50

 

1,050

 

8

 

 

 

8

 

1,058

 

2021

 

1,075

 

 

1,075

 

8

 

 

 

8

 

1,083

 

2022

 

1,249

 

 

1,249

 

402

 

 

 

402

 

1,651

 

2023

 

500

 

 

500

 

 

 

 

 

500

 

2024-2028

 

3,300

 

 

3,300

 

1,501

 

(1,501

)

1,459

 

1,459

 

4,759

 

Thereafter

 

3,275

 

 

3,275

 

1,023

 

(1,023

)

974

 

974

 

4,249

 

Future cash outflows in respect of composite long-term debt principal repayments

 

10,399

 

102

 

10,501

 

3,726

 

(3,300

)

3,188

 

3,614

 

14,115

 

Future cash outflows in respect of associated interest and like carrying costs  2

 

5,408

 

4

 

5,412

 

1,906

 

(1,838

)

1,698

 

1,766

 

7,178

 

Undiscounted contractual maturities ( Note 4(c) )

 

$

15,807

 

$

106

 

$

15,913

 

$

5,632

 

$

(5,138

)

$

4,886

 

$

5,380

 

$

21,293

 

 


(1)           Where applicable, principal-related cash flows reflect foreign exchange rates at December 31, 2018.

(2)           Future cash outflows in respect of associated interest and like carrying costs for commercial paper and amounts drawn under our credit facilities (if any) have been calculated based upon the rates in effect at December 31, 2018.

 

27           other long-term liabilities

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

Contract liabilities

 

24

 

$

78

 

$

71

 

Other

 

 

 

7

 

10

 

Deferred revenues

 

 

 

85

 

81

 

Pension benefit liabilities

 

15(b)

 

446

 

490

 

Other post-employment benefit liabilities

 

15(g)

 

45

 

47

 

Restricted stock unit and deferred share unit liabilities

 

 

 

63

 

68

 

Derivative liabilities

 

4(h)

 

6

 

76

 

Other

 

 

 

78

 

67

 

 

 

 

 

723

 

829

 

Deferred customer activation and connection fees

 

24

 

15

 

18

 

 

 

 

 

$

738

 

$

847

 

 

28           Common Share capital

 

(a)          General

 

Our authorized share capital is as follows:

 

As at December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

First Preferred Shares

 

1 billion

 

1 billion

 

Second Preferred Shares

 

1 billion

 

1 billion

 

Common Shares

 

2 billion

 

2 billion

 

 

Only holders of Common Shares may vote at our general meetings, with each holder of Common Shares entitled to one vote per Common Share held at all such meetings so long as not less than 66-2/3% of the issued and outstanding Common Shares are owned by Canadians. With respect to priority in payment of dividends and in the distribution of

 

 

67


 

 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

assets in the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, whether voluntary or involuntary, or any other distribution of our assets among our shareholders for the purpose of winding up our affairs, preferences are as follows: First Preferred Shares; Second Preferred Shares; and finally Common Shares.

 

As at December 31, 2018, approximately 47 million Common Shares were reserved for issuance, from Treasury, under a share option plan (see Note 14(d) ).

 

(b)          Purchase of Common Shares for cancellation pursuant to normal course issuer bid

 

As referred to in Note 3 , we may purchase a portion of our Common Shares for cancellation pursuant to normal course issuer bids in order to maintain or adjust our capital structure. In November 2017, we received approval for a normal course issuer bid to purchase and cancel up to 8 million of our Common Shares (up to a maximum amount of $250 million) from November 13, 2017, to November 12, 2018. In July 2018, we received approval to amend the normal course issuer bid to allow a wholly owned subsidiary to purchase our Common Shares, to a maximum amount of $105 million, for donation to a charitable foundation we have established (see Note 16(c) ). In December 2018, we received approval for a normal course issuer bid to purchase and cancel up to 8 million of our Common Shares (up to a maximum amount of $250 million) from January 2, 2019, to January 1, 2020.

 

Common Share transactions by our wholly owned subsidiary are presented in the Consolidated statement of changes in owners’ equity as treasury share transactions.

 

29                contingent liabilities

 

(a)          Claims and lawsuits

 

General

 

A number of claims and lawsuits (including class actions and intellectual property infringement claims) seeking damages and other relief are pending against us and, in some cases, other wireless carriers and telecommunications service providers. As well, we have received notice of, or are aware of, certain possible claims (including intellectual property infringement claims) against us and, in some cases, other wireless carriers and telecommunications service providers.

 

It is not currently possible for us to predict the outcome of such claims, possible claims and lawsuits due to various factors, including: the preliminary nature of some claims; uncertain damage theories and demands; an incomplete factual record; uncertainty concerning legal theories and procedures and their resolution by the courts, at both the trial and the appeal levels; and the unpredictable nature of opposing parties and their demands.

 

However, subject to the foregoing limitations, management is of the opinion, based upon legal assessments and information presently available, that it is unlikely that any liability, to the extent not provided for through insurance or otherwise, would have a material effect on our financial position and the results of our operations, including cash flows, with the exception of the items enumerated following.

 

Certified class actions

 

Certified class actions against us include the following:

 

Per minute billing class action

 

In 2008 a class action was brought in Ontario against us alleging breach of contract, breach of the Ontario Consumer Protection Act , breach of the Competition Act and unjust enrichment, in connection with our practice of “rounding up” wireless airtime to the nearest minute and charging for the full minute. The action sought certification of a national class. In November 2014, an Ontario class only was certified by the Ontario Superior Court of Justice in relation to the breach of contract, breach of Consumer Protection Act , and unjust enrichment claims; all appeals of the certification decision have now been exhausted. At the same time, the Ontario Superior Court of Justice declined to stay the claims of our business customers notwithstanding an arbitration clause in our customer service agreements with those customers. This latter decision was appealed and on May 31, 2017, the Ontario Court of Appeal dismissed our appeal. The Supreme Court of Canada granted us leave to appeal this decision and has now heard our appeal; we are awaiting the Court’s decision.

 

Call set-up time class actions

 

In 2005 a class action was brought against us in British Columbia alleging that we have engaged in deceptive trade practices in charging for incoming calls from the moment the caller connects to the network, and not from the moment the incoming call is connected to the recipient. In 2011, the Supreme Court of Canada upheld a stay of all of

 

 

68


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

the causes of action advanced by the plaintiff in this class action, with one exception, based on the arbitration clause that was included in our customer service agreements. The sole exception was the cause of action based on deceptive or unconscionable practices under the British Columbia Business Practices and Consumer Protection Act , which the Supreme Court of Canada declined to stay. In January 2016, the British Columbia Supreme Court certified this class action in relation to the claim under the Business Practices and Consumer Protection Act . The class is limited to residents of British Columbia who contracted wireless services with us in the period from January 21, 1999, to April 2010. We have appealed the certification decision. A companion class action was brought against us in Alberta at the same time as the British Columbia class action. The Alberta class action duplicates the allegations in the British Columbia action, but has not proceeded to date and is not certified. Subject to a number of conditions, including court approval, we have now settled both the British Columbia and the Alberta class actions.

 

Uncertified class actions

 

Uncertified class actions against us include:

 

9-1-1 class actions

 

In 2008 a class action was brought in Saskatchewan against us and other Canadian telecommunications carriers alleging that, among other matters, we failed to provide proper notice of 9-1-1 charges to the public, have been deceitfully passing them off as government charges, and have charged 9-1-1 fees to customers who reside in areas where 9-1-1 service is not available. The plaintiffs advance causes of action in breach of contract, misrepresentation and false advertising and seek certification of a national class. A virtually identical class action was filed in Alberta at the same time, but the Alberta Court of Queen’s Bench declared that class action expired against us as of 2009. No steps have been taken in this proceeding since 2016.

 

Electromagnetic field radiation class actions

 

In 2013 a class action was brought in British Columbia against us, other telecommunications carriers, and cellular telephone manufacturers alleging that prolonged usage of cellular telephones causes adverse health effects. The British Columbia class action alleges: strict liability; negligence; failure to warn; breach of warranty; breach of competition, consumer protection and trade practices legislation; negligent misrepresentation; breach of a duty not to market the products in question; and waiver of tort. Certification of a national class is sought. No steps have been taken in this proceeding since 2014. In 2015 a class action was brought in Quebec against us, other telecommunications carriers, and various other defendants alleging that electromagnetic field radiation causes adverse health effects, contravenes the Quebec Environmental Quality Act , creates a nuisance, and constitutes an abuse of right pursuant to the Quebec Civil Code . The authorization hearing for this matter occurred in May 2018 and on June 27, 2018, the Quebec Superior Court dismissed the authorization application. That decision is now final.

 

Public Mobile class actions

 

In 2014 class actions were brought against us in Quebec and Ontario on behalf of Public Mobile’s customers, alleging that changes to the technology, services and rate plans made by us contravene our statutory and common law obligations. In particular, the Quebec action alleges that our actions constitute a breach of the Quebec Consumer Protection Act , the Quebec Civil Code , and the Ontario Consumer Protection Act . It has not yet proceeded to an authorization hearing. The Ontario class action alleges negligence, breach of express and implied warranty, breach of the Competition Act , unjust enrichment, and waiver of tort. No steps have been taken in this proceeding since it was filed and served.

 

Handset subsidy class action

 

In 2016 a class action was brought in Quebec against us and other telecommunications carriers alleging that we breached the Quebec Consumer Protection Act and the Civil Code of Quebec by making false or misleading representations relating to the handset subsidy provided to our wireless customers, and by charging our wireless customers inflated rate plan prices and termination fees higher than those permitted under the Act . The claim was later amended to also seek compensation for amounts paid by class members to unlock their mobile devices. This action has not yet proceeded to an authorization hearing.

 

 

69


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Intellectual property infringement claims

 

Claims and possible claims received by us include:

 

4G LTE network patent infringement claim

 

A patent infringement claim was filed in Ontario in 2016 alleging that communications between devices, including cellular telephones, and base stations on our 4G LTE network infringe three third-party patents. The Plaintiff has since abandoned its claims in respect of two of the three patents. The claims based on the third patent are set to be tried in the fourth quarter of 2019.

 

Other claims

 

Claims and possible claims received by us include:

 

Area code 867 blocking claim

 

In 2018 a claim was brought against us alleging breach of a Direct Connection Call Termination Services Agreement, breach of a duty of good faith, and intentional interference with economic relations. The plaintiffs allege that we have improperly blocked calls to area code 867 (including to customers of a plaintiff), for which a second plaintiff provides wholesale session initiation trunking services. The plaintiffs seek damages of $135 million.

 

Summary

 

We believe that we have good defences to the above matters. Should the ultimate resolution of these matters differ from management’s assessments and assumptions, a material adjustment to our financial position and the results of our operations, including cash flows, could result. Management’s assessments and assumptions include that reliable estimates of any such exposure cannot be made considering the continued uncertainty about: the nature of the damages that may be sought by the plaintiffs; the causes of action that are being, or may ultimately be, pursued; and, in the case of the uncertified class actions, the causes of action that may ultimately be certified.

 

(b)           Indemnification obligations

 

In the normal course of operations, we provide indemnification in conjunction with certain transactions. The terms of these indemnification obligations range in duration. These indemnifications would require us to compensate the indemnified parties for costs incurred as a result of failure to comply with contractual obligations, or litigation claims or statutory sanctions, or damages that may be suffered by an indemnified party. In some cases, there is no maximum limit on these indemnification obligations. The overall maximum amount of an indemnification obligation will depend on future events and conditions and therefore cannot be reasonably estimated. Where appropriate, an indemnification obligation is recorded as a liability. Other than obligations recorded as liabilities at the time of the related transactions, historically we have not made significant payments under these indemnifications.

 

See Note 21(d)  for details regarding our guarantees to the real estate joint ventures.

 

As at December 31, 2018, we had no liability recorded in respect of our indemnification obligations.

 

30                related party transactions

 

(a)          Transactions with key management personnel

 

Our key management personnel have authority and responsibility for overseeing, planning, directing and controlling our activities and consist of our Board of Directors and our Executive Leadership Team.

 

Total compensation expense for key management personnel, and the composition thereof, is as follows:

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Short-term benefits

 

$

12

 

$

12

 

Post-employment pension  1  and other benefits

 

8

 

4

 

Share-based compensation  2

 

44

 

34

 

 

 

$

64

 

$

50

 

 


(1)          Our Executive Leadership Team members are members of our Pension Plan for Management and Professional Employees of TELUS Corporation and certain other non-registered, non-contributory supplementary defined benefit pension plans.

(2)          For the year ended December 31, 2018, share-based compensation expense is net of $NIL (2017 — $4) of the effects of derivatives used to manage share-based compensation costs ( Note 14(b) ).

 

As disclosed in Note 14 , we made initial awards of share-based compensation in 2018 and 2017, including, as set out in the following table, to our key management personnel. As most of these awards are cliff-vesting or graded-vesting and

 

 

70


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

have multi-year requisite service periods, the related expense will be recognized rateably over a period of years and thus only a portion of the 2018 and 2017 initial awards are included in the amounts in the table above.

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ in millions)

 

Number of
restricted
stock units

 

Notional
value 
1

 

Grant-date
fair value 
1

 

Number of
restricted
stock units

 

Notional
value 
1

 

Grant-date
fair value 
1

 

Awarded in period

 

608,849

 

$

28

 

$

36

 

686,595

 

$

30

 

$

30

 

 


(1)          Notional value is determined by multiplying the Common Share price at the time of award by the number of units awarded. The grant-date fair value differs from the notional value because the fair values of some awards have been determined using a Monte Carlo simulation (see Note 14(b) ).

 

The liability amounts accrued for share-based compensation awards to key management personnel are as follows:

 

As at December 31 (millions)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Restricted stock units

 

$

41

 

$

40

 

Deferred share units  1

 

21

 

24

 

 

 

$

62

 

$

64

 

 


(1)          Our Directors’ Deferred Share Unit Plan provides that, in addition to his or her annual equity grant of deferred share units, a director may elect to receive his or her annual retainer and meeting fees in deferred share units, Common Shares or cash. Deferred share units entitle directors to a specified number of, or a cash payment based on the value of, our Common Shares. Deferred share units are paid out when a director ceases to be a director, for any reason, at a time elected by the director in accordance with the Directors’ Deferred Share Unit Plan ; during the year ended December 31, 2018, $6 (2017 — $14) was paid out.

 

Employment agreements with members of the Executive Leadership Team typically provide for severance payments if an executive’s employment is terminated without cause: generally 18—24 months of base salary, benefits and accrual of pension service in lieu of notice, and 50% of base salary in lieu of an annual cash bonus. In the event of a change in control, Executive Leadership Team members are not entitled to treatment any different than that given to our other employees with respect to non-vested share-based compensation.

 

(b)          Transactions with defined benefit pension plans

 

During the year ended December 31, 2018, we provided management and administrative services to our defined benefit pension plans; the charges for these services were on a cost recovery basis and amounted to $6 million (2017 — $6 million).

 

(c)           Transactions with real estate joint ventures

 

During the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, we had transactions with the real estate joint ventures, which are related parties, as set out in Note 21.

 

31                additional statement of cash flow information

 

(a)          Statements of cash flows — operating activities, investing activities and financing activities

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(adjusted –
Note 2(c))

 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net change in non-cash operating working capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

 

 

$

74

 

$

(70

)

Inventories

 

 

 

4

 

(60

)

Contract assets

 

 

 

(103

)

(57

)

Prepaid expenses

 

 

 

(46

)

(50

)

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

 

 

(11

)

126

 

Income and other taxes receivable and payable, net

 

 

 

277

 

(90

)

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

 

 

12

 

41

 

Provisions

 

 

 

49

 

(59

)

 

 

 

 

$

256

 

$

(219

)

 

 

71


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Years ended December 31 (millions)

 

Note

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Capital asset additions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross capital expenditures

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment

 

17

 

$

(2,383

)

$

(2,486

)

Intangible assets

 

18

 

(657

)

(617

)

 

 

 

 

(3,040

)

(3,103

)

Additions arising from finance leases

 

 

 

102

 

 

Additions arising from non-monetary transactions

 

 

 

24

 

9

 

Capital expenditures

 

 

 

(2,914

)

(3,094

)

Asset retirement obligations netted (included) in additions

 

 

 

15

 

(7

)

 

 

 

 

(2,899

)

(3,101

)

Other non-cash items included above

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Change in associated non-cash investing working capital

 

 

 

47

 

(27

)

Non-cash change in asset retirement obligation

 

 

 

(22

)

47

 

 

 

 

 

25

 

20

 

 

 

 

 

$

(2,874

)

$

(3,081

)

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issue of shares by subsidiary to non-controlling interests

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issue of shares

 

 

 

$

43

 

$

 

Non-monetary issue of shares in business combination

 

18(b)

 

(19

)

 

Cash proceeds on share issuance

 

 

 

24

 

 

Transaction costs and other

 

 

 

 

(1

)

 

 

 

 

$

24

 

$

(1

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

72


 

notes to consolidated financial statements

 

(b)     Changes in liabilities arising from financing activities

 

 

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2017

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Statement of cash flows

 

Non-cash changes

 

 

 

Statement of cash flows

 

Non-cash changes

 

 

 

(millions)

 

As at
January 1,
2017

 

Issued or
received

 

Redemptions,
repayments or
payments

 

Foreign
exchange
movement
(Note 4(i))

 

Other

 

As at
December 31,
2017

 

Issued or
received

 

Redemptions,
repayments or
payments

 

Foreign
exchange
movement
(Note 4(i))

 

Other

 

As at
December 31,
2018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends payable to holders of Common Shares

 

$

284

 

$

 

$

(1,152

)

$

 

$

1,167

 

$

299

 

$

 

$

(1,226

)

$

 

$

1,253

 

$

326

 

Dividends reinvested in shares from Treasury

 

 

 

70

 

 

(70

)

 

 

85

 

 

(85

)

 

 

 

$

284

 

$

 

$

(1,082

)

$

 

$

1,097

 

$

299

 

$

 

$

(1,141

)

$

 

$

1,168

 

$

326

 

Short-term borrowings

 

$

100

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

100

 

$

26

 

$

(93

)

$

(1

)

$

68

 

$

100

 

Long-term debt

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TELUS Corporation notes

 

$

11,367

 

$

990

 

$

(700

)

$

(91

)

$

(5

)

$

11,561

 

$

1,725

 

$

(1,250

)

$

170

 

$

(20

)

$

12,186

 

TELUS Corporation commercial paper

 

613

 

5,295

 

(4,710

)

(58

)

 

1,140

 

3,678

 

(4,115

)

71

 

 

774

 

TELUS Communications Inc. debentures

 

619

 

 

 

 

1

 

620

 

 

 

 

 

620

 

TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility

 

332

 

82

 

(56

)

(20

)

1

 

339

 

97

 

(50

)

33

 

 

419

 

Finance leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3

)

 

105

 

102

 

Derivatives used to manage currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt — liability (asset)

 

20

 

4,710

 

(4,746

)

149

 

(40

)

93

 

4,115

 

(4,074

)

(241

)

34

 

(73

)

 

 

12,951

 

11,077

 

(10,212

)

(20

)

(43

)

13,753

 

9,615

 

(9,492

)

33

 

119

 

14,028

 

To eliminate effect of gross settlement of derivatives used to manage currency risk arising from U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt

 

 

(4,710

)

4,710

 

 

 

 

(4,115

)

4,115

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

12,951

 

$

6,367

 

$

(5,502

)

$

(20

)

$

(43

)

$

13,753

 

$

5,500

 

$

(5,377

)

$

33

 

$

119

 

$

14,028

 

 

 

73


 

TELUS CORPORATION

 

Management’s discussion and analysis

 

2018

 

 


 

Caution regarding forward-looking statements

 

The terms TELUS, the Company, we, us and our refer to TELUS Corporation and, where the context of the narrative permits or requires, its subsidiaries.

 

This document contains forward-looking statements about expected events and our financial and operating performance. Forward-looking statements include any statements that do not refer to historical facts. They include, but are not limited to, statements relating to our objectives and our strategies to achieve those objectives, our targets, outlook, updates, and our multi-year dividend growth program. Forward-looking statements are typically identified by the words assumption, goal, guidance, objective, outlook, strategy, target and other similar expressions, or future or conditional verbs such as aim, anticipate, believe, could, expect, intend, may, plan, predict, seek, should, strive and will . These statements are made pursuant to the “safe harbour” provisions of applicable securities laws in Canada and the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 .

 

By their nature, forward-looking statements are subject to inherent risks and uncertainties and are based on assumptions, including assumptions about future economic conditions and courses of action. These assumptions may ultimately prove to have been inaccurate and, as a result, our actual results or events may differ materially from expectations expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements. Our general outlook and assumptions for 2019 are presented in Section 9 General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings in this Management’s discussion and analysis (MD&A).

 

Risks and uncertainties that could cause actual performance or events to differ materially from the forward-looking statements made herein and in other TELUS filings include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

·                   Regulatory decisions and developments including changes to our regulatory regime or the outcomes of proceedings, cases or inquiries relating to its application, such as: the potential of government intervention to further increase wireless competition and any new regulatory requirements as a result of the CRTC’s planned review to be commenced in 2019 of the wholesale wireless regulatory framework; the potential for government intervention concerning the CRTC’s decision on lower-cost data-only plans; changes to the cost burden associated with CRTC-mandated network interconnections; disputes with certain municipalities regarding rights-of-way bylaws, and other potential threats to unitary federal regulatory authority over telecommunications, including provincial wireless and consumer protection legislation; the impact of the CRTC’s wireline wholesale services review, with a review of rates and configurations for wholesale access currently in progress for TELUS; the CRTC’s forthcoming report on the retail practices of Canada’s large telecommunications carriers, as directed by the Governor in Council; the Competition Bureau’s market study on competition in broadband services; the CRTC’s phase-out of the local service subsidy regime and corresponding establishment of a broadband funding regime to support the enhancement of high-speed Internet services focusing on underserved areas in Canada; the CRTC’s review of the price cap and local forbearance regimes; the CRTC’s proceeding to create a mandatory code of conduct to address the clarity and content of contracts for retail fixed Internet access and related issues; broadcasting-related issues, such as: the CRTC’s implementation of new initiatives discussed in its May 2018 report “Harnessing Change: The Future of Programming Distribution in Canada”; the federal government’s review of the Broadcasting Act , Telecommunications Act and Radiocommunication Act as announced on June 5, 2018; the review of the Copyright Act , which began in early 2018; spectrum and compliance with licences, including our compliance with licence conditions, changes to spectrum licence fees, spectrum policy determinations such as restrictions on the purchase, sale and transfer of spectrum licences, and the amount of spectrum TELUS is able to acquire and its cost under the Technical, Policy and Licensing Framework for Spectrum in the 600 MHz Band auction , as well as cost and availability of spectrum in the 3500 MHz and mmWave bands; the impact on us and other Canadian telecommunications carriers of government or regulatory actions with respect to certain countries or suppliers; restrictions on non-Canadian ownership and control of TELUS Common Shares and the ongoing monitoring and compliance with such restrictions; and our ability to comply with complex and changing regulation of the healthcare and medical devices industry in the provinces of Canada in which we operate, including as an operator of health clinics.

 

·                   Competitive environment including: our ability to continue to retain customers through an enhanced customer service experience, including through the deployment and operation of evolving wireless and wireline infrastructure; intense wireless competition, including the ability of industry competitors to successfully combine a mix of high-speed Internet access (HSIA) and, in some cases, wireless services under one bundled and/or discounted monthly rate, along with their existing broadcast or satellite-based TV services; the success of new products, new services and supporting systems, such as home automation security, and Internet of Things (IoT) services for Internet-connected devices; wireline voice and data competition including continued intense rivalry across all services among wireless and wireline telecommunications companies, cable-TV providers, other communications companies and over-the-top (OTT) services, which, among other things, places pressures on current and future average billing per subscriber unit per month (ABPU), average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU), cost of acquisition, cost of retention and churn rate for all services, as do customer usage patterns, increased data bucket sizes or flat-rate pricing trends for voice and data, inclusive rate plans for voice and data and availability of Wi-Fi networks for data; mergers and acquisitions of industry competitors; pressures on high-speed Internet and TV ARPU and churn rate resulting from market conditions, government actions and customer usage patterns; residential and business network access line (NAL) losses; subscriber additions and retention volumes, and associated costs for wireless, TV and high-speed Internet services; our ability to obtain and offer content on a timely basis across multiple devices on wireless and TV platforms at a reasonable cost; vertical integration in the broadcasting industry resulting in competitors owning broadcast content services, and timely and effective enforcement of related regulatory safeguards; our ability to compete successfully in customer care and business services (CCBS) given our competitors’ brand recognition, consolidation and strategic alliances as well as technology development and, in our TELUS Health business, our ability to compete with other providers of electronic medical records and pharmacy management products, systems integrators and health service providers including those that own a vertically integrated mix of health services delivery, IT solutions, and related services, and global providers that could achieve expanded Canadian footprints.

 

 

2


 

·                   Technological substitution including: reduced utilization and increased commoditization of traditional wireline voice local and long distance services from impacts of OTT applications and wireless substitution, a declining overall market for paid TV services, including as a result of content piracy and signal theft and as a result of a rise in OTT direct to consumer video offerings and virtual multichannel video programming distribution platforms; the increasing number of households that have only wireless and/or Internet-based telephone services; potential wireless ABPU and ARPU declines as a result of, among other factors, substitution to messaging and OTT applications; substitution to increasingly available Wi-Fi services; and disruptive technologies, such as OTT IP services, including Network as a Service in the business market, that may displace or re-rate our existing data services.

 

·                   Technology including: high subscriber demand for data that challenges wireless networks and spectrum capacity levels and may be accompanied by increases in delivery cost; our reliance on information technology and our need to streamline our legacy systems; the roll-out and evolution of wireless broadband technologies and systems including video distribution platforms and telecommunications network technologies (broadband initiatives, such as fibre to the premises (FTTP), wireless small-cell deployment, 5G wireless and availability of resources and ability to build out adequate broadband capacity); our reliance on wireless network access agreements, which have facilitated our deployment of wireless technologies; choice of suppliers and those suppliers’ ability to maintain and service their product lines, which could affect the success of upgrades to, and evolution of, technology that we offer; supplier limitations and concentration and market power for network equipment, TELUS TV ®  and wireless handsets; the performance of wireless technology; our expected long-term need to acquire additional spectrum capacity through future spectrum auctions and from third parties to address increasing demand for data; deployment and operation of new wireline broadband network technologies at a reasonable cost and availability and success of new products and services to be rolled out using such network technologies; network reliability and change management; self-learning tools and automation that may change the way we interact with customers; and uncertainties around our strategy to replace certain legacy wireline network technologies, systems and services to reduce operating costs.

 

·                   Capital expenditure levels and potential outlays for spectrum licences in spectrum auctions or from third parties , due to: our broadband initiatives, including connecting more homes and businesses directly to fibre; our ongoing deployment of newer wireless technologies, including wireless small cells to improve coverage and capacity and prepare for a more efficient and timely evolution to 5G wireless services; utilizing acquired spectrum; investments in network resiliency and reliability; subscriber demand for data; evolving systems and business processes; implementing efficiency initiatives; supporting large complex deals; and future wireless spectrum auctions held by Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada (ISED) including the 600 MHz spectrum auction scheduled to take place in March 2019 which will result in increased expenditures. Our capital expenditure levels could be impacted if we do not achieve our targeted operational and financial results.

 

·                   Operational performance and business combination risks including: our reliance on legacy systems and ability to implement and support new products and services and business operations in a timely manner; our ability to implement effective change management for system replacements and upgrades, process redesigns and business integrations (such as our ability to successfully integrate acquisitions, complete divestitures or establish partnerships in a timely manner, and realize expected strategic benefits, including those following compliance with any regulatory orders); our ability to identify and manage new risks inherent to new service offerings that we may provide, including as a result of acquisitions, which could result in damage to our brand, our business in the relevant area or as a whole, additional exposure to litigation or regulatory proceedings; and real estate joint venture risks.

 

·                   Data protection including risks that malfunctions or unlawful acts could result in the unauthorized access to, change, loss, or distribution of data, which may compromise the privacy of individuals and could result in financial loss and harm to our reputation and brand.

 

·                   Security threats including intentional damage or unauthorized access to our physical assets or our IT systems and networks, which could prevent us from providing reliable service or result in unauthorized access to our information or that of our customers.

 

·                   Ability to successfully implement cost reduction initiatives and realize planned savings, net of restructuring and other costs, without losing customer service focus or negatively affecting business operations . Examples of these initiatives are: our operating efficiency and effectiveness program to drive improvements in financial results; business integrations; business product simplification; business process outsourcing; offshoring and reorganizations, including any full-time equivalent (FTE) employee reduction programs; procurement initiatives; and real estate rationalization.

 

·                   Implementation of large enterprise deals , which may be adversely impacted by available resources, system limitations and degree of co-operation from other service providers.

 

·                   Foreign operations and our ability to successfully manage operations in foreign jurisdictions, including managing risks such as currency fluctuations.

 

·                   Business continuity events including: our ability to maintain customer service and operate our network in the event of human error or human-caused threats, such as cyberattacks and equipment failures that could cause various degrees of network outages; supply chain disruptions, delays and economics including as a result of government restrictions or trade actions; natural disaster threats; epidemics; pandemics; political instability in certain international locations; information security and privacy breaches, including data loss or theft of data; and the completeness and effectiveness of business continuity and disaster recovery plans and responses.

 

·                   Human resource matters including: recruitment, retention and appropriate training in a highly competitive industry, and the level of employee engagement.

 

·                   Financing and debt requirements including: our ability to carry out financing activities, our ability to refinance our maturing debt, our ability to maintain investment grade credit ratings in the range of BBB+ or the equivalent. Our business plans and growth could be negatively affected if existing financing is not sufficient to cover our funding requirements.

 

 

3


 

·                   Lower than planned free cash flow could constrain our ability to invest in operations, reduce debt or return capital to shareholders, and could affect our ability to sustain our dividend growth program through 2019 . This program may be affected by factors such as the competitive environment, economic performance in Canada, our earnings and free cash flow, our levels of capital expenditures and spectrum licence purchases, acquisitions, the management of our capital structure, and regulatory decisions and developments. Quarterly dividend decisions are subject to assessment and determination by our Board of Directors (Board) based on our financial position and outlook. Shares may be purchased under our normal course issuer bid (NCIB) when and if we consider it opportunistic, based on our financial position and outlook, and the market price of TELUS shares. There can be no assurance that our dividend growth program or any NCIB will be maintained, not changed and/or completed through 2019.

 

·                   Taxation matters including: interpretation of complex domestic and foreign tax laws by the relevant tax authorities that may differ from our interpretations; the timing and character of income and deductions, such as tax depreciation and operating expenses; tax credits or other attributes; changes in tax laws, including tax rates; tax expenses being materially different than anticipated, including the taxability of income and deductibility of tax attributes; elimination of income tax deferrals through the use of different tax year-ends for operating partnerships and corporate partners; and changes to the interpretation of tax laws, including as a result of changes to applicable accounting standards or tax authorities adopting more aggressive auditing practices, tax reassessments or adverse court decisions impacting the tax payable by us.

 

·                   Litigation and legal matters including: our ability to successfully respond to investigations and regulatory proceedings; our ability to defend against existing and potential claims and lawsuits (including intellectual property infringement claims and class actions based on consumer claims, data, privacy or security breaches and secondary market liability), or to negotiate and execute upon indemnity rights or other protections in respect of such claims and lawsuits; and the complexity of legal compliance in domestic and foreign jurisdictions, including compliance with competition, anti-bribery and foreign corrupt practices laws.

 

·                   Health, safety and the environment including: lost employee work time resulting from illness or injury, public concerns related to radio frequency emissions, environmental issues affecting our business including climate change, waste and waste recycling, risks relating to fuel systems on our properties, and changing government and public expectations regarding environmental matters and our responses.

 

·                   Economic growth and fluctuations including: the state of the economy in Canada, which may be influenced by economic and other developments outside of Canada, including potential outcomes of yet unknown policies and actions of foreign governments; future interest rates; inflation; unemployment levels; effects of fluctuating oil prices; effects of low business spending (such as reducing investments and cost structure); pension investment returns, funding and discount rates; and fluctuations in foreign exchange rates of the currencies in the regions in which we operate, and the impact of tariffs on trade between Canada and the U.S. as well as global implications of a trade conflict between the U.S. and China.

 

These risks are described in additional detail in Section 9 General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings and Section 10 Risks and risk management in this MD&A. Those descriptions are incorporated by reference in this cautionary statement but are not intended to be a complete list of the risks that could affect the Company.

 

Many of these factors are beyond our control or our current expectations or knowledge. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial may also have a material adverse effect on our financial position, financial performance, cash flows, business or reputation. Except as otherwise indicated in this document, the forward-looking statements made herein do not reflect the potential impact of any non-recurring or special items or any mergers, acquisitions, dispositions or other business combinations or transactions that may be announced or that may occur after the date of this document.

 

Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements in this document describe our expectations and are based on our assumptions as at the date of this document and are subject to change after this date. Except as required by law, we disclaim any intention or obligation to update or revise any forward-looking statements.

 

This cautionary statement qualifies all of the forward-looking statements in this MD&A.

 

 

4


 

Management’s discussion and analysis (MD&A)

February 14, 2019

 

Contents

 

Section

 

Page

 

Subsection

1.

 

Introduction

 

6

 

1.1 Preparation of the MD&A

 

 

 

 

6

 

1.2 The environment in which we operate

 

 

 

 

7

 

1.3 Highlights of 2018

 

 

 

 

12

 

1.4 Performance scorecard (key performance measures)

2.

 

Core business and strategy

 

15

 

2.1 Core business

 

 

 

 

15

 

2.2 Strategic imperatives

3.

 

Corporate priorities

 

16

 

 

4.

 

Capabilities

 

19

 

4.1 Principal markets addressed and competition

 

 

 

 

22

 

4.2 Operational resources

 

 

 

 

25

 

4.3 Liquidity and capital resources

 

 

 

 

27

 

4.4 Disclosure controls and procedures and changes in internal control over financial reporting

5.

 

Discussion of operations

 

28

 

5.1 General

 

 

 

 

30

 

5.2 Summary of consolidated quarterly results, trends and fourth quarter recap

 

 

 

 

33

 

5.3 Consolidated operations

 

 

 

 

36

 

5.4 Wireless segment

 

 

 

 

40

 

5.5 Wireline segment

6.

 

Changes in financial position

 

44

 

 

7.

 

Liquidity and capital resources

 

45

 

7.1 Overview

 

 

 

 

46

 

7.2 Cash provided by operating activities

 

 

 

 

46

 

7.3 Cash used by investing activities

 

 

 

 

47

 

7.4 Cash used by financing activities

 

 

 

 

49

 

7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures

 

 

 

 

50

 

7.6 Credit facilities

 

 

 

 

51

 

7.7 Sale of trade receivables

 

 

 

 

52

 

7.8 Credit ratings

 

 

 

 

52

 

7.9 Financial instruments, commitments and contingent liabilities

 

 

 

 

57

 

7.10 Outstanding share information

 

 

 

 

57

 

7.11 Transactions between related parties

8.

 

Accounting matters

 

58

 

8.1 Critical accounting estimates and judgments

 

 

 

 

64

 

8.2 Accounting policy developments

9.

 

General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings

 

67

 

9.1 Telecommunications industry in 2018

 

 

 

68

 

9.2 Telecommunications industry general outlook and trends

 

 

 

71

 

9.3 TELUS assumptions for 2019

 

 

 

72

 

9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings

10.

 

Risks and risk management

 

75

 

10.1 Overview

 

 

 

 

76

 

10.2 Regulatory matters

 

 

 

 

78

 

10.3 Competitive Environment

 

 

 

 

81

 

10.4 Technology

 

 

 

 

86

 

10.5 Operational performance

 

 

 

 

90

 

10.6 Human resources

 

 

 

 

90

 

10.7 Financing, debt requirements and returning cash to shareholders

 

 

 

 

91

 

10.8 Taxation matters

 

 

 

 

92

 

10.9 Litigation and legal matters

 

 

 

 

95

 

10.10 Health, safety and environment

 

 

 

 

96

 

10.11 Economic growth and fluctuations

11.

 

Definitions and reconciliations

 

98

 

11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures

 

 

 

 

101

 

11.2 Operating indicators

 

Copyright © 2019 TELUS Corporation. All rights reserved. Certain products and services named in this report are trademarks. The symbols TM and ® indicate those owned by TELUS Corporation or its subsidiaries. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.

 

 

5


 

1.               Introduction

 

The forward-looking statements in this section, including estimates regarding economic growth, are qualified by the Caution regarding forward-looking statements at the beginning of this Management’s discussion and analysis (MD&A).

 

1.1 Preparation of the MD&A

 

The following sections are a discussion of our consolidated financial position and financial performance for the year ended December 31, 2018, and should be read together with our December 31, 2018, audited consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income, statements of financial position, statements of changes in owners’ equity and statements of cash flows, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the Consolidated financial statements) . The generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) we use are the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). Our Consolidated financial statements comply with IFRS-IASB and Canadian GAAP. In this MD&A, the term IFRS refers to these standards. We adopted IFRS 9, Financial Instruments, and IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, on January 1, 2018, with retrospective application. See Section 5.2 Summary of consolidated quarterly results, trends and fourth quarter recap , Section 5.4 Wireless segment and Section 5.5 Wireline segment of the MD&A, as well as Note 2 of the Consolidated financial statements, for reconciliations of results excluding IFRS 15 effects. In our discussion, we also use certain non-GAAP financial measures to evaluate our performance, monitor compliance with debt covenants and manage our capital structure. These measures are defined, qualified and reconciled with their nearest GAAP measures in Section 11.1 . All currency amounts are in Canadian dollars, unless otherwise specified.

 

Additional information relating to the Company, including our annual information form and other filings with securities commissions or similar regulatory authorities in Canada, is available on SEDAR ( sedar.com ). Our filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States, including Form 40-F, are available on EDGAR ( sec.gov ).

 

Our disclosure controls and procedures are designed to provide reasonable assurance that all relevant information is gathered and reported to senior management on a timely basis, so that appropriate decisions can be made regarding public disclosure. This MD&A and the Consolidated financial statements were reviewed by our Audit Committee and authorized by our Board of Directors (Board) for issuance on February 14, 2019.

 

In this MD&A, unless otherwise indicated, results for the year ended December 31, 2018, are compared with results for the year ended December 31, 2017, adjusted for the retrospective application of IFRS 9 and IFRS 15 (for the year ended December 31, 2017).

 

1.2 The environment in which we operate

 

The success of our business and the challenges we face can best be understood with reference to the environment in which we operate, including broader economic factors that affect our customers and us, and the competitive nature of our industry. Our estimates regarding our environment also form an important part of the assumptions on which our targets are based.

 

2018 Canadian telecom
industry revenues

 

TELUS 2018 revenues

 

TELUS subscriber
connections

 

TELUS 2018 dividends
declared and growth

 

Est. $63 billion

 

$

14.4 billion

 

13.4 million

 

$1.3 billion / 7.4%

 

 

Economic growth

 

We estimate that the rate of economic growth in Canada in 2019 will be 2.0% (2.1% in 2018), both rates being based on a composite of estimates from Canadian banks and other sources. For our incumbent local exchange carrier (ILEC) provinces in Western Canada, we estimate that economic growth will be 2.3% in 2019 in British Columbia (B.C.) (2.2% in 2018) and 2.1% in Alberta (2.2% in 2018). The Bank of Canada’s January 2019 Monetary Policy Report estimated that economic growth in Canada will be 1.7% in 2019 (2.0% in 2018). The extent to which these economic growth estimates affect us and the timing of their impact will depend upon the actual experience of specific sectors of the Canadian economy.

 

With respect to the national unemployment rate, Statistics Canada’s Labour Force Survey reported a rate of 5.6% for December 2018 (5.7% reported for December 2017). The unemployment rate for B.C. was 4.4% for December 2018 (4.6% for December 2017), while the unemployment rate for Alberta was 6.4% for December 2018 (6.9% for December 2017). Based on a composite of estimates from Canadian banks and other sources, we estimate that the unemployment rate in 2019 will be 5.8% in Canada, 4.9% in B.C. and 6.2% in Alberta.

 

With respect to the pace of housing starts, in January 2019, Canada Mortgage and Housing Corporation reported housing starts in Canada of approximately 213,000 units in 2018 and approximately 220,000 units in 2017. Based on a

 

 

6


 

composite of estimates from Canadian banks and other sources, we estimate that housing starts in Canada for 2019 will be approximately 196,000 units.

 

Canadian telecommunications industry growth

 

We estimate that Canadian telecommunications industry revenues (including TV revenue and excluding media revenue) grew by approximately 4% in 2018 (3% in 2017). We estimate that the Canadian wireless industry grew by approximately 1.5 million new subscribers in 2018 and experienced approximately 4.2% network revenue growth. Key drivers of subscriber growth included immigration and population growth; the trend toward multiple devices, including tablets; the expanding functionality of data and related applications; and mobile adoption by both younger and older generations. With respect to the wireline industry, the Canadian consumer high-speed Internet penetration rate grew by approximately 2% in 2018 and subscriber growth is expected to continue. Competitive pressures continued in both the wireline consumer and business markets, while declines in higher-margin legacy voice services were ongoing, partially attributable to technological substitution. (See Section 9 General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings, Section 10.3 Competition, and Section 10.11 Economic growth and fluctuations. )

 

1.3 Highlights of 2018

 

Home and business security-related acquisitions

 

Throughout 2018, we completed home and business security acquisitions, including our January 2018 acquisition of the customers, assets and operations of AlarmForce Industries Inc. in B.C., Alberta and Saskatchewan. These acquisitions, combined with our growing gigabit-capable TELUS PureFibre™ infrastructure, were made with a view to accelerating our position in smart home and security services, and providing us with the ability to offer our customers additional services as part of a bundle.

 

Xavient Information Systems

 

In February 2018, through our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. subsidiary, we closed an acquisition of a 65% interest in Xavient Information Systems (Xavient), a group of information technology consulting and software services companies with facilities in the U.S. and India. The investment was made with a view to enhancing our ability to provide complex and higher-value information technology services, improving our related sales and solutioning capabilities, and acquiring multi-site redundancy in support of other facilities.

 

Medisys Health Group Inc.

 

In July 2018, we acquired Medisys Health Group Inc., a leading provider of preventative healthcare and wellness services for workplaces across Canada. The total purchase price was approximately $84 million, of which $79 million was paid by issuance of approximately 1.7 million TELUS Common Shares. The investment was made with a view to growing the delivery of employee-centred workplace health and wellness services. With this acquisition, TELUS Health will be able to deliver employee-centred care, backed by TELUS’ broadband network and supported by digital tools such as patient portals, virtual care, wellness and mental health applications, electronic prescribing, electronic benefit claims and secure messaging. The Medisys Health Group network will serve as an innovation hub for next-generation technology, as well as preventative care and wellness programs, so that patient outcomes can be measured.

 

Long-term debt issues

 

On March 1, 2018, we issued $600 million of senior unsecured notes at 3.625% due March 1, 2028 and $150 million through the re-opening of Series CW Notes at 4.70% due March 6, 2048. The net proceeds were used to repay approximately $725 million of outstanding commercial paper; to fund the repayment, on maturity, of a portion of the $250 million principal amount outstanding on TELUS’ Series CS Notes due March 27, 2018; and for general corporate purposes.

 

On June 12, 2018, we issued US$750 million of senior unsecured 30-year notes at 4.60%, maturing on November 16, 2048. The net proceeds were used to repay outstanding indebtedness, including outstanding commercial paper, and for general corporate purposes. We have fully hedged the principal and interest obligations of the notes against fluctuations in the Canadian dollar foreign exchange rate for the entire term of the notes by entering into a foreign exchange derivative (a cross currency interest rate exchange agreement), which effectively converted the principal payments and interest obligations to Canadian dollar obligations with a fixed interest rate of 4.41% and an issued and outstanding amount of $974 million (reflecting a fixed exchange rate of $1.2985).

 

Early redemption of 2019 Notes

 

On August 1, 2018, we executed our June 28, 2018, notice to early redeem all of our $1.0 billion 5.05% Series CG Notes due December 4, 2019. The long-term debt prepayment premium recorded was approximately $34 million before income taxes (or $0.04 per share after income taxes).

 

 

7


 

Sale of TELUS Garden and donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation

 

On August 8, 2018, the TELUS Garden real estate joint venture sold the income-producing properties and the related net assets. The purchaser assumed the 3.7% mortgage and the 3.4% bonds secured by the income-producing properties. In the application of equity accounting, we recorded our share of the non-recurring gain at $171 million. Concurrently, we committed to a donation of $118 million to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation™ to help ensure that vulnerable youth can thrive in our digital society through better access to technology, health and educational opportunities. Of this $118 million, we have donated $101 million in 2018, including an initial donation of $100 million made in the third quarter of 2018 in TELUS Corporation Common Shares acquired in the market. The remainder of the committed donation may be made in TELUS Corporation Common Shares or cash and is committed over a 10-year period. The Foundation will give financial grants to grassroots charities across Canada that need help in directly supporting underserved youth in our communities. Through these grants, the Foundation will support our TELUS Community Boards in connecting youth to the people and opportunities that matter most.

 

Changes to the Board of Directors

 

John Lacey, an independent director who had served as a TELUS director since 2000, retired from our Board in May 2018.

 

In August 2018, we welcomed Christine Magee to our Board. Christine is the Co-Founder and Co-Chair of Sleep Country Canada, the largest mattress retailer in Canada. From 1982 to 1994, Christine worked in the banking and financial services industry at the National Bank of Canada and Continental Bank of Canada. She is currently a member of the board of directors of Metro Inc., Woodbine Entertainment Group, Trillium Health Partners, Plan International Canada, and the Advisory Council of the Talent Fund. Christine has also taken on an active mentoring role for Women’s Executive Network. The recipient of numerous awards and other recognition, Christine received the Excellence Canada Special Recognition of Achievement Award in 2017, and was appointed to the Order of Canada on July 1, 2015. Christine holds an Honours Business and Administration degree from the University of Western Ontario.

 

In November 2018, Denise Pickett joined our Board. Denise was named Chief Risk Officer and President, Global Risk, Banking and Compliance, American Express in February 2018. From 1992 to the present, Denise has held a series of progressively senior roles throughout American Express. She was Country Manager for American Express Canada and President and CEO of Amex Bank of Canada. Denise subsequently relocated to the United States, where she served as the President of American Express OPEN, the company’s small business division, and then as the President of U.S. Consumer Services. She was also a member of the board of directors of the Hudson’s Bay Company (2012 to 2018) and serves as Vice Chair of the board of directors of the United Way of New York City. Denise holds an MBA in Marketing from the Schulich School of Business at York University and earned an Honours BA in Human Biology and Physiology from the University of Toronto. She was named to Payment Source’s Most Influential Women in Payments in 2018.

 

Business acquisition — subsequent to 2018

 

On January 14, 2019, we acquired a business complementary to our existing telecommunications lines of business, for consideration consisting of cash of $89 million and TELUS Corporation Common Shares of $38 million. The investment was made with a view to growing our managed network, cloud, security and unified communications services.

 

 

8


 

Consolidated highlights

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

Years ended December 31 ($ millions, except footnotes and unless noted otherwise)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Consolidated statements of income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating revenues 1

 

14,368

 

13,408

 

7.2

%

Operating income

 

2,837

 

2,741

 

3.5

%

Income before income taxes

 

2,176

 

2,168

 

0.4

%

Net income

 

1,624

 

1,578

 

2.9

%

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

1,600

 

1,559

 

2.6

%

Adjusted Net income 2

 

1,703

 

1,643

 

3.7

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings per share (EPS) ($)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic EPS

 

2.68

 

2.63

 

1.9

%

Adjusted basic EPS 2

 

2.85

 

2.77

 

2.9

%

Diluted EPS

 

2.68

 

2.63

 

1.9

%

Dividends declared per Common Share ($)

 

2.10

 

1.97

 

6.6

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic weighted-average Common Shares outstanding (millions)

 

597

 

593

 

0.7

%

Consolidated statements of cash flows

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash provided by operating activities

 

4,058

 

3,947

 

2.8

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash used by investing activities

 

(2,977

)

(3,643

)

(18.3

)%

Acquisitions

 

(280

)

(564

)

(50.4

)%

Capital expenditures 3

 

(2,914

)

(3,094

)

(5.8

)%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash used by financing activities

 

(1,176

)

(227

)

n/m

 

Other highlights

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Subscriber connections 4 (thousands)

 

13,434

 

13,050

 

2.9

%

Earnings before interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization (EBITDA) 2

 

5,104

 

4,910

 

3.9

%

Restructuring and other costs 2,5

 

317

 

117

 

n/m

 

Adjusted EBITDA 6

 

5,250

 

5,005

 

4.9

%

Adjusted EBITDA margin 7  (%)

 

37.0

 

37.4

 

(0.4

)pts.

Free cash flow 2

 

1,197

 

966

 

23.9

%

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs 2,8  (times)

 

2.54

 

2.67

 

(0.13

)

 


Notations used in MD&A: n/m — not meaningful; pts. — percentage points.

 

(1)          In the third quarter of 2018, we recorded equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden.

 

(2)          These are non-GAAP and other financial measures. See Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures.

 

(3)          Capital expenditures include assets purchased but not yet paid for, and consequently differ from Cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences, as reported in the Consolidated financial statements.

 

(4)          The sum of active wireless subscribers, residential network access lines (NALs), high-speed Internet access subscribers and TELUS TV subscribers, measured at the end of the respective periods based on information in billing and other systems. Effective April 1, 2018, and on a prospective basis, we have adjusted cumulative subscriber connections to remove approximately 68,000 TELUS TV subscribers as we have ceased marketing our Satellite TV product. Q4 2018 opening postpaid and total subscribers, as well as associated Q4 2018 operating statistics (average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU), average billing per subscriber unit per month (ABPU), and churn) have been adjusted to exclude an estimated 23,000 subscribers impacted by the CRTC’s final pro-rating ruling in June 2018, which was effective October 1, 2018.

 

(5)          In the third quarter of 2018, we recorded a donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation of $118 million as part of other costs.

 

(6)          Adjusted EBITDA for all periods excludes restructuring and other costs (see Section 11.1 for restructuring and other cost amounts) and non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures. Adjusted EBITDA for 2017 excludes the MTS net recovery (as defined later in this section).

 

(7)          Adjusted EBITDA margin is Adjusted EBITDA divided by Operating revenues, where the calculation of the Operating revenues excludes non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, and for 2017, excludes the MTS net recovery (as defined later in this section).

 

(8)          Excluding the third quarter of 2018 equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, the 2018 amount would be 2.62.

 

Operating highlights

 

·                   Consolidated operating revenues increased by $960 million in 2018:

 

Service revenues increased by $550 million in 2018, mainly due to growth in wireless network revenue and wireline data services revenue, partly offset by the ongoing decline in legacy wireline voice revenue.

 

 

9


 

Equipment revenues increased by $240 million in 2018, largely due to higher wireless equipment revenue resulting from a higher volume of new postpaid contracts, as well as higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units.

 

Other operating income increased by $170 million in 2018. In the third quarter of 2018, we recorded equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden of $171 million, as previously noted, of which 50% was allocated to each of the wireless and wireline segments. Excluding the effect of equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, Other operating income was relatively flat. In 2017, we recorded a non-recurring pre-tax recovery of contingent consideration paid of $26 million to reflect the revised estimate of qualifying Manitoba Telecom Services Inc. (MTS) subscribers acquired (MTS contingent consideration recovery). The change in Other operating income reflects the non-recurrence of the 2017 MTS contingent consideration recovery, partly offset by higher net gains from the sale of property, plant and equipment, and a decrease in the provision related to written put options in respect of non-controlling interests.

 

For additional details on operating revenues, see Section 5.4 Wireless segment and Section 5.5 Wireline segment .

 

·                   During 2018, our total subscriber connections increased by 384,000, reflecting a 4.2% increase in wireless postpaid subscribers, a 6.6% increase in high-speed Internet subscribers and, excluding the Satellite TV subscriber adjustment, a 4.8% increase in TELUS TV subscribers, partly offset by a 1.0% decline in wireless prepaid subscribers and a 3.9% decline in wireline residential NALs.

 

Our postpaid wireless subscriber net additions were 356,000 in 2018, down 23,000 from 2017, due to higher deactivations associated with a larger subscriber base partly offset by higher gross additions resulting from continued net new demand from Canadian consumers and businesses. Our comparatively low postpaid churn rate was 0.89% in 2018, while our blended churn rate was 1.08% in 2018. In 2017, our postpaid churn rate was 0.90% and our blended churn rate was 1.11%. (See Section 5.4 Wireless segment for additional details.)

 

Net additions of high-speed Internet subscribers were 115,000 in 2018, up 34,000 from 2017. The increase resulted from the increased demand for our high-speed broadband services, including fibre to the premises (FTTP), as well as improved churn reflecting our focus on executing our customers first initiatives and retention programs. Net additions of TELUS TV subscribers were 63,000 in 2018, up 28,000 from 2017. The increase reflects a lower customer churn rate from stronger retention efforts and higher gross additions from our diverse product offerings. Our continued focus on expanding our addressable high-speed Internet and Optik TV ®  footprint, connecting more homes and businesses directly to fibre, and bundling these services together contributed to combined Internet and TV subscriber growth of 110,000 or 3.9% over the last 12 months. We have made TELUS PureFibre available to 61% of our broadband footprint at the end of 2018. (See Section 5.5 Wireline segment for additional details.)

 

·                   Operating income increased by $96 million in 2018, reflecting higher wireless equipment margins and wireless network growth driven by a growing customer base, in addition to growth in EBITDA contribution from our customer care and business services (CCBS) (formerly business process outsourcing) business. These factors were partly offset by increased costs associated with a growing wireless customer base, declines in wireline legacy voice services, higher wireline restructuring and other costs from efficiency initiatives, and increased depreciation and amortization.

 

EBITDA includes restructuring and other costs, non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, and the fourth quarter 2017 MTS contingent consideration recovery net of post-closing adjustments (MTS net recovery). EBITDA increased by $194 million or 3.9% in 2018.

 

Adjusted EBITDA excludes restructuring and other costs and non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, as well as the 2017 MTS net recovery. Adjusted EBITDA increased by $245 million or 4.9% for 2018. The increase reflects higher wireless equipment margins and wireless network revenue growth driven by a growing customer base, in addition to growth in EBITDA contribution from our CCBS business. These factors were partly offset by increased costs associated with a growing wireless customer base and declines in wireline legacy voice services. (See Section 5.4 Wireless segment and Section 5.5 Wireline segment for additional details.)

 

·                   Income before income taxes increased by $8 million in 2018. Higher Operating income, as noted above, was offset by an increase in Financing costs. The increase in Financing costs resulted primarily from the $34 million long-term debt prepayment premium in the third quarter of 2018, higher average long-term debt outstanding along with a higher average effective interest rate in 2018, and higher interest accretion on provisions. (See Financing costs in Section 5.3.)

 

 

10


 

·                   Income taxes decreased by $38 million in 2018 and the effective tax rate decreased from 27.2% to 25.4%. The decrease in the effective tax rate was primarily due to the lower capital gain rate on the TELUS Garden sale, as well as a requirement to revalue deferred tax liabilities for changes in legislated tax rates in 2017.

 

·                   Net income attributable to Common Shares increased by $41 million in 2018. This increase was primarily driven by higher Operating income and lower income taxes, partly offset by increased Financing costs.

 

Adjusted Net income excludes the effects of restructuring and other costs, income tax-related adjustments, non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, the long-term debt prepayment premium and the 2017 MTS net recovery. Adjusted Net income increased by $60 million or 3.7% for the full year of 2018.

 

Reconciliation of adjusted Net income

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

Years ended December 31 ($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

1,600

 

1,559

 

41

 

Add back (deduct):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Restructuring and other costs, after income taxes 1

 

235

 

86

 

149

 

(Favourable) unfavourable income tax-related adjustments

 

(7

)

21

 

(28

)

Non-recurring losses and equity losses (gains and equity income) related to real estate joint ventures, after income taxes 2

 

(150

)

(1

)

(149

)

Long-term debt prepayment premium, after income taxes

 

25

 

 

25

 

MTS net recovery

 

 

(22

)

22

 

Adjusted Net income

 

1,703

 

1,643

 

60

 

 


(1)          Includes our third quarter of 2018 committed donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation of $90 million after income taxes .

 

(2)          Includes equity income arising from the third quarter 2018 sale of TELUS Garden of $150 million after income taxes.

 

·                   Basic EPS increased by $0.05 or 1.9% in 2018. This increase was primarily driven by higher Operating income and lower income taxes, partly offset by increased Financing costs.

 

Adjusted basic EPS excludes the effects of restructuring and other costs, income tax-related adjustments, non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, the long-term debt prepayment premium and the 2017 MTS net recovery. Adjusted basic EPS increased by $0.08 or 2.9% for the full year of 2018.

 

Reconciliation of adjusted basic EPS

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

Years ended December 31 ($)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Basic EPS

 

2.68

 

2.63

 

0.05

 

Add back (deduct):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Restructuring and other costs, after income taxes, per share 1

 

0.39

 

0.15

 

0.24

 

(Favourable) unfavourable income-tax related adjustments, per share

 

(0.01

)

0.03

 

(0.04

)

Non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, after income taxes, per share 2

 

(0.25

)

 

(0.25

)

Long-term debt prepayment premium, after income taxes, per share

 

0.04

 

 

0.04

 

MTS net recovery, per share

 

 

(0.04

)

0.04

 

Adjusted basic EPS

 

2.85

 

2.77

 

0.08

 

 


(1)          Includes our third quarter of 2018 committed donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation of $0.15 per share after income taxes .

 

(2)          Includes equity income arising from the third quarter 2018 sale of TELUS Garden of $0.25 per share after income taxes.

 

·                   Dividends declared per Common Share totalled $2.10 in 2018, up 6.6% from 2017. On February 13, 2019, the Board declared a first quarter dividend of $0.5450 per share on the issued and outstanding Common Shares, payable on April 1, 2019, to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 11, 2019. The first quarter dividend increased by $0.04 per share or 7.9% from the $0.5050 per share dividend declared one year earlier, consistent with our multi-year dividend growth program described in Section 4.3 Liquidity and capital resources .

 

Liquidity and capital resource highlights

 

·                   Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs was 2.54 times at December 31, 2018, down from 2.67 times at December 31, 2017, as the effect of the increase in EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs exceeded the effect of the increase in net debt. Excluding the third quarter of 2018 equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, the ratio was 2.62. (See Section 4.3 Liquidity and capital resources and Section 7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures. )

 

 

11


 

·                   Cash provided by operating activities increased by $111 million in 2018 due to growth in EBITDA and lower restructuring and other costs disbursements, net of expense and Shares settled from Treasury. This was partly offset by other working capital changes and increased interest paid, which includes the long-term debt prepayment premium.

 

·                   Cash used by investing activities decreased by $666 million in 2018, attributed to lower cash payments for business acquisitions, lower capital expenditures and non-recurring real estate joint venture receipts, net of advances arising from the sale of TELUS Garden. Acquisitions decreased by $284 million in 2018 as we made larger cash payments for business acquisitions in 2017. Capital expenditures decreased by $180 million in 2018 primarily reflecting the planned reduction in our capital spend. We have made TELUS PureFibre available to 61% of our broadband footprint at December 31, 2018. (See Section 7.3 Cash used by investing activities .)

 

·                   Cash used by financing activities increased by $949 million in 2018, primarily reflecting lower issuances of long-term debt, net of redemptions and repayment, as well as Treasury shares acquired. (See Section 7.4 Cash used by financing activities. )

 

·                   Free cash flow increased by $231 million in 2018, largely resulting from higher Adjusted EBITDA and lower capital expenditures, partly offset by increased interest paid. (See calculation in Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .) The application of IFRS 15 reflects a non-cash accounting change. As such, the underlying economics and free cash flow generated by the business are not impacted by the change.

 

1.4 Performance scorecard (key performance measures)

 

In 2018, we achieved three of four IFRS 15-translated consolidated targets, missing only the target for capital expenditures. Our original targets were announced on February 8, 2018 and were set excluding the impact of IFRS 15. On May 10, 2018, we announced equivalent targets that were translated to reflect the adoption of IFRS 15 herein referred to as the consolidated targets.

 

We achieved our consolidated revenue target, primarily due to growth in wireless network revenue resulting from growth in our wireless subscriber base. Additionally, we experienced increased wireline data service revenue resulting from increases in CCBS revenue inclusive of acquisitions, Internet and enhanced data service, TELUS Health revenue, TELUS TV revenue and revenue from our home and business security lines of business, partly offset by the ongoing decline in legacy wireline voice revenue. As well, we experienced increased equipment revenues from a higher volume of new postpaid contracts and higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units.

 

We met our Adjusted EBITDA target largely from higher wireless equipment margins and wireless network revenue growth driven by a growing customer base, in addition to growth in EBITDA contribution from our CCBS business. These factors were partly offset by increased costs associated with a growing wireless customer base and declines in wireline legacy voice services.

 

Our basic EPS fell within our target range, driven by higher Operating income and lower income taxes, partly offset by increased Financing costs.

 

Our capital expenditures in 2018 exceeded our consolidated target, as we made opportunistic capital expenditures prior to the year-end. We also continued to focus on investments in broadband infrastructure, including connecting more homes and businesses directly to our fibre-optic infrastructure, which resulted in TELUS PureFibre reaching 61% of our broadband footprint at year-end. These investments also support our systems reliability and operational efficiency and effectiveness, as well as our small-cell technology strategy to improve coverage and prepare for a more efficient and timely evolution to 5G.

 

Our capital structure financial policies and report on financing and capital structure management plans are described in Section 4.3 .

 

The following scorecard compares TELUS’ performance to our consolidated 2018 targets. For information related to our 2018 targets, see Section 9 General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings .

 

 

12


 

Scorecard

 

 

 

2018 performance

 

 

 

Consolidated targets 2  and
growth

 

Actual results
and growth

 

Result

 

Consolidated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenues

 

An increase of
4 to 6%
2a

 

$14.37 billion
7.2%

 

ü

 

Adjusted EBITDA 1

 

An increase of
3 to 6%
2b

 

$5.25 billion
4.9%

 

ü

 

Basic EPS

 

An increase of up to
6%
2c

 

$2.68
1.9%

 

ü

 

Capital expenditures (excluding spectrum licences)

 

Approx. $2.85 billion

 

$2.91 billion

 

X

 

 


Met target ü ; Missed target X.

 

(1)          See description in Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures.

 

(2)          Reflects the 2018 translated targets that were announced on May 10, 2018, to reflect the adoption of IFRS 15. The original 2018 targets were set on February 8, 2018 and were based on pre-IFRS 15 results.

 

(2a)             The original target for Consolidated revenues excluding the impact of IFRS 15 was $13.835 to $14.100 billion, or an increase of 4 to 6%.

 

(2b)             The original target for Consolidated Adjusted EBITDA excluding the impact of IFRS 15 was $5.105 to $5.230 billion, or an increase of 4 to 7%.

 

(2c)              The original target for basic EPS excluding the impact of IFRS 15 was $2.53 to $2.68, or an increase of 3 to 9%.

 

 

13


 

We made the following key assumptions when we announced the 2018 targets in February 2018.

 

Assumptions for 2018 targets and results

 

·                   Our economic assumptions are based on a composite of estimates from Canadian banks and other sources. Our original assumptions for 2018 were: (i) slightly slower rate of economic growth in Canada of 2.2%, down from an estimated 3.1% in 2017; (ii) for our ILEC provinces in Western Canada, economic growth in B.C. of 2.5%, down from an estimated 3.4% in 2017, and economic growth in Alberta of 2.4%, down from an estimated 3.9% in 2017.

 

In our MD&A for the first quarter of 2018, we revised our 2018 economic growth assumption to 2.1% for Canada. In our MD&A for the third quarter of 2018, we revised our 2018 economic growth assumptions to 2.2% for B.C. and 2.2% for Alberta.

 

We currently estimate that economic growth for 2018 was 2.1% for Canada, 2.2% for B.C. and 2.2% for Alberta.

 

·                   Our original assumption for restructuring and other costs was approximately $135 million. In our MD&A for the third quarter of 2018, we revised our assumption for restructuring and other costs upwards to approximately $300 million to account for the committed donation of $118 million to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation and to support ongoing and incremental operational efficiencies and personnel-related costs. Our actual 2018 amount for restructuring and other costs was $317 million.

 

·                   Our assumption for income taxes was computed at a statutory rate of 26.7 to 27.3% and cash income tax payments of approximately $170 million to $230 million. Our actual results were at a statutory income tax rate of 27.0% and cash income tax payments were $197 million.

 

·                   Our assumption was for stabilization in the average Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar exchange rate, which was US$0.77 in 2017. The average Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar exchange rate was US$0.77 during 2018 and closed at US$0.73 on December 31, 2018.

 

·                   Our assumption was that no wireless spectrum auctions were anticipated in 2018. We participated in a wireless residual spectrum auction in 2018 resulting in Cash payment for spectrum licences of $1 million in 2018.

 

Confirmed:

 

·                   No material adverse regulatory rulings or government actions.

 

·                   Continued intense wireless and wireline competition in both consumer and business markets.

 

·                   An increase in wireless industry penetration of the Canadian market.

 

·                   Ongoing subscriber adoption of, and upgrades to, data-intensive smartphones, as customers want more mobile connectivity to the Internet.

 

·                   Wireless revenue growth resulting from growth in both postpaid subscriber loadings and blended ABPU.

 

·                   Continued pressure on wireless acquisition and retention expenses, dependent on gross loading and customer renewal volumes, competitive intensity and customer preferences.

 

·                   Continued growth in wireline data revenue, resulting from an increase in high-speed Internet and TELUS TV subscribers, speed upgrades and expanding broadband infrastructure, as well as CCBS and healthcare solutions.

 

·                   Continued erosion of wireline voice revenues, resulting from technological substitution and greater use of inclusive long distance.

 

·                   Continued focus on our customers first initiatives and maintaining our customers’ likelihood-to-recommend scores.

 

·                   Pension plans: Defined benefit pension plan expense of approximately $97 million recorded in Employee benefits expense and approximately $14 million recorded in employee defined benefit plans net interest in Financing costs; a rate of 3.40% for discounting the obligation (2017 — 3.80%) and a rate of 3.50% for current service costs for employee defined benefit pension plan accounting purposes (2017 — 4.00%); and defined benefit pension plan funding of approximately $50 million. Actual results were: $95 million recorded in Employee benefits expense, $16 million recorded in employee defined benefit plans net interest, a rate of 3.90% for discounting the obligation, a rate of 3.50% for current service costs employee defined benefit pension plan accounting purposes, and defined benefit pension plan funding of $52 million.

 

·                   Further investments in broadband infrastructure, including expanding our fibre-optic infrastructure and 4G LTE capacity expansion and upgrades, as well as investments in network and systems resiliency and reliability.

 

 

14


 

2.               Core business and strategy

 

2.1 Core business

 

We provide a wide range of telecommunications products and services. Wireless products and services include network revenue (data and voice) and equipment sales arising from mobile technologies. Wireline products and services include data revenues (which include revenues from Internet protocol; television; hosting, managed information technology and cloud-based services; customer care and business services (CCBS) (formerly business process outsourcing); certain healthcare solutions; and home and business security), voice revenues, and other telecommunications services and equipment revenues. We earn the majority of our revenue from access to, and usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure, and from providing services and products that facilitate access to, and usage of, our infrastructure.

 

2.2 Strategic imperatives

 

Since 2000, we have maintained a proven national growth strategy. Our strategic intent is to unleash the power of the Internet to deliver the best solutions to Canadians at home, in the workplace and on the move.

 

We also developed six strategic imperatives in 2000 that remain relevant for future growth, despite changing regulatory, technological and competitive environments. We believe that a consistent focus on these imperatives guides our actions and contributes to the achievement of our financial goals. To advance these long-term strategic imperatives and address near-term opportunities and challenges, we confirm or set new corporate priorities each year, as further described in Section 3 . Our six strategic imperatives are listed below.

 

·                   Focusing relentlessly on growth markets of data, IP and wireless

 

·                   Providing integrated solutions that differentiate TELUS from our competitors

 

·                   Building national capabilities across data, IP, voice and wireless

 

·                   Partnering, acquiring and divesting to accelerate the implementation of our strategy and focus our resources on core business

 

·                   Going to market as one team under a common brand, executing a single strategy

 

·                   Investing in internal capabilities to build a high-performance culture and efficient operation.

 

 

15


 

3.               Corporate priorities

 

We confirm or set new corporate priorities each year to advance TELUS’ long-term strategic imperatives (see Section 2.2 ) and address near-term opportunities and challenges. The following table provides a discussion of activities and initiatives that relate to our 2018 corporate priorities.

 

Honouring our team, customers and social purpose by delivering on our brand promise

 

·                   Each year, we conduct team member Pulsecheck engagement surveys to gather confidential team member feedback about TELUS as a place to work and to measure our progress in establishing a high-performance culture. Following each survey, business units and departments make use of their Pulsecheck results to review their current action plans and prioritize their ongoing actions. In 2018, our employee engagement score increased by 1 percentage point to 85%, elevating our high-performance culture and continuing to place our Company within the top 10% of all employers surveyed on a global basis.

 

·                   In November 2018, the Commission for Complaints for Telecom-television Services (CCTS) issued its annual report for the 12-month period ended July 31, 2018, and TELUS again received the fewest customer complaints among the national carriers, while Koodo ®  again received the fewest complaints among the national flanker brands. TELUS, Koodo and Public Mobile were the subjects of 6.6%, 2.5% and 1.0% of the total customer complaints accepted by the CCTS, respectively, or 10.1% of total customer complaints, in aggregate, when approximately 28% of Canadian wireless customers have chosen us as their wireless service provider.

 

·                   As noted in Section 1.3 , we committed to a donation of $118 million to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation to help ensure vulnerable youth thrive in our digital society through better access to technology, health and educational opportunities. Of this $118 million, we have donated $101 million in 2018, including an initial donation of $100 million that was made in the third quarter of 2018 in TELUS Common Shares acquired in the market. The remainder of the committed donation is committed over a 10-year period.

 

·                   On February 1, 2018, we were awarded the 2018 Best Sustainability Report in the Technology & Communications sector by the Finance and Sustainability Initiative.

 

·                   We extended the reach of our Mobility for Good™ program in 2018 to Ontario and Alberta, and launched a pilot program in Quebec, in partnership with the Children’s Aid Foundation of Canada and Fondation du Centre Jeunesse. Mobility for Good provides qualifying youth transitioning from foster care with fully subsidized smartphones and data plans from TELUS, enabling them to stay connected to their vital support networks.

 

·                   In November 2018, we expanded our Internet for Good™ program by participating in the federal government’s new Connecting Families initiative to help bridge the digital divide for Canadian families who may struggle to afford Internet access. Internet for Good provides access to low-cost high-speed Internet, training and tools to low-income families.

 

·                   During 2018, we expanded our Health for Good™ program to Vancouver, Victoria and Calgary to provide healthcare to vulnerable and underserved Canadians by deploying specially equipped mobile health clinics into communities where frontline care is urgently needed. In September 2018, we announced a $5 million commitment to expand our Health for Good program nationally.

 

·                   In September 2018, we were recognized for corporate social responsibility by being named to the Dow Jones Sustainability North America Index for the 18th consecutive year. Additionally, we were named to the Dow Jones Sustainability World Index for the third year in a row.

 

·                   We continued to promote safe and responsible behaviour online through the delivery of TELUS Wise ®  digital citizenship workshops to more than 52,000 youth, adults and seniors in 2018. We also continued our partnership with the WE organization and focused on our shared goal to #EndBullying. As part of our commitment to end bullying, we are asking citizens to join us in our mission to promote positive behaviour online by signing the TELUS Wise Digital Pledge.

 

·                   Our customers’ likelihood-to-recommend scores improved year over year for Consumer Solutions and TELUS Health.

 

Leveraging our broadband networks to drive TELUS’ growth

 

·                   We continued to invest in our leading-edge broadband technology, which has enabled the success of our Internet, Optik TV and Pik TV ®  offerings, business services, and Mobility solutions and helps ready our network for 5G deployment in the future.

 

·                   Our 4G LTE infrastructure covered 99% of Canada’s population at December 31, 2018.

 

·                   Our high-speed broadband footprint covered more than 3.1 million households and businesses in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec at December 31, 2018, including approximately 1.89 million households and businesses covered with fibre-optic cable (representing 61% of our broadband footprint), providing these premises with immediate access to our gigabit-capable fibre-optic infrastructure. This is up from approximately 1.44 million households and businesses in 2017.

 

·                   In OpenSignal’s State of Mobile Networks: Canada (February 2018) report, we were recognized as having the fastest 4G download speed and the fastest overall download speed.

 

·                   In the J.D. Power 2018 Canadian Wireless Network Quality Study, TELUS was ranked Highest Wireless Network Quality Performance in Ontario for four years in a row and in the West (including British Columbia, Alberta, Saskatchewan and Manitoba) for three years in a row.

 

·                   Based on data from the first half of 2018, followed by data from the second half of 2018, we won Ookla’s Mobile Speedtest Award for fastest mobile network in Canada for the second year in a row. Meanwhile, according to Ookla’s Speedtest Global

 

 

16


 

Index for December 2018, TELUS ranked third in the word for the fastest mobile network, while Canada as a country also ranked third fastest behind Iceland and Norway.

 

·                   In August 2018, we were ranked as having the fastest overall download speeds nationally for the second year in a row according to OpenSignal’s State of Mobile Networks: Canada (August 2018) report. Additionally, we were ranked first in LTE speeds in two key markets — Toronto and Montreal.

 

·                   In PCMag’s Fastest Mobile Network Canada 2018 report released in September 2018, we were named as having the fastest mobile network nationally, for the second year in a row. We were also ranked as having the fastest network in certain markets across Canada, including Vancouver, Calgary, Edmonton, Winnipeg, Toronto, Ottawa, Montreal, Quebec and Halifax. Additionally, Koodo was recognized as having the best wireless plan in Canada.

 

·                   We were recognized as providing Canadians with the best mobile video experience in OpenSignal’s State of Mobile Video (September 2018) report.

 

·                   In February 2018, the Digital Technology Supercluster, with TELUS as the lead applicant, was one of the winners in the government of Canada’s Innovation Superclusters Initiative and will receive significant funding to further develop Canada’s strengths in data collection, analytics and visualization technologies for diverse industries. The Digital Technology Supercluster was officially launched in November 2018.

 

·                   In April 2018, we became the first provider in Canada to offer 4K HDR content, which is available on Optik TV via Netflix and On Demand. 4K HDR dramatically enhances the picture quality of existing 4K technology by improving the colour contrast range with millions of additional colour options to each individual pixel.

 

·                   Our Pik TV offering can now be accessed directly from an Internet browser, from Apple TV (fourth generation and above) or through our Android or iOS mobile applications, enabling streaming on computers, smartphones and tablets. Our Pik TV media box and its support for Google Play Store applications is now an optional, complementary component of the Pik TV experience.

 

·                   In August 2018, we announced the debut of Travelxp 4K HDR, a global travel and lifestyle channel, available for Optik TV customers in B.C. and Alberta. This is the first time a network broadcasting 24/7 4K HDR has been available in Canada. Customers who do not yet have 4K HDR-capable TVs can still enjoy Travelxp in 4K, HD or standard definition.

 

·                   In September 2018, we launched the Platinum wireless rate plan, which allows customers to obtain higher-tier handsets for a lower upfront payment. We also unveiled our Bring-It-Back™ upgrade program, which is available to existing customers on Premium, Premium Plus and Platinum plans, and to new customers activating on Platinum plans. The Bring-It-Back program allows customers to upgrade to higher-tier smartphones with lower upfront payments and, at the end of the term, choose to either return the device or repay the original Bring-It-Back program amount.

 

·                   In May 2018, we expanded our voice over LTE (VoLTE) coverage across the province of Manitoba.

 

·                   We launched TELUS SmartHome Security and TELUS Secure Business in B.C., Alberta and Saskatchewan, with TELUS SmartHome Security also offered in Eastern Quebec. TELUS SmartHome Security provides security and automation technology for residential customers. TELUS Secure Business offers security solutions that help small businesses run safely and smoothly through a suite of integrated smart automation, intrusion monitoring and video surveillance solutions.

 

·                   In October 2018, we launched our first LTE-M low-power wide-area (LPWA) technology deployment, which delivers a strong wireless connection to IoT (Internet of Things) devices while requiring minimal power for each transmission, helping to prolong the battery life of connected devices. It will extend the reach of our 4G LTE infrastructure further for compatible devices, penetrate deeper into buildings and underground, and enable simpler and more cost-efficient connected solutions to run efficiently on battery power for years.

 

·                   To provide customers with an improved wireless calling experience, as of October 2018, customers with a VoLTE-enabled phone will be able to place and receive calls using LTE technology instead of HSPA technology while roaming in the U.S.

 

·                   Throughout the year, we made a series of announcements regarding the connection of additional homes and businesses to our TELUS PureFibre infrastructure, including:

 

·                   Further investments of approximately $50 million to connect additional homes and businesses in Eastern Quebec by the end of 2021. These investments were made with support from the federal government’s Connect to Innovate program and the provincial government’s Québec branché program. With this support, we are continuing to deploy our TELUS PureFibre network in Eastern Quebec, which will connect more than 99% of Eastern Quebec homes and businesses by 2021

 

·                   An investment of $20 million within Port Moody, B.C. to connect by the end of 2020

 

·                   An investment of $65 million in the city of Delta, B.C., including Tilbury and Annacis Island

 

·                   An investment of $45 million in the district of North Vancouver, B.C.

 

·                   An investment of $110 million within Richmond, B.C., including Steveston, to connect by the spring of 2019

 

·                   An investment of $21 million within Langley City, B.C. to connect by the spring of 2019

 

·                   An investment of $8 million within Princeton, B.C. to connect by the end of 2019.

 

·                   We have now connected more than 100 communities in the Greater Quebec City and Eastern Quebec region to our TELUS PureFibre infrastructure.

 

·                   In December 2018, we launched Gigabit Internet and Internet 750/750, offering 1 Gps download and 940 Mbps upload speeds, and 750 Mbps symmetrical download and upload speeds, respectively. These plans are available to all TELUS

 

 

17


 

PureFibre customers in Western Canada.

 

Fuelling our future through recurring efficiency gains

 

·                   We achieved efficiency gains to continue investing in our digital transformation, including conducting an urban trial, with a leading vendor, of 5G wireless-to-the-home service using customer premises equipment.

 

·                   We took steps to simplify our organizational structure in order to drive better customer outcomes. This will allow us to leverage cross-country synergies by streamlining our workflows to stay ahead of growing business complexities.

 

·                   We incurred incremental restructuring and other costs with the objective of improving our operating efficiency and effectiveness. Restructuring costs associated with the rationalization of administrative, channel and network real estate were recorded in Goods and services purchased. Employee-related restructuring costs for reorganizing and streamlining business processes, such as certain client care, marketing and support functions, were recorded in Employee benefits expense. Other costs for incremental external expense in connection with business acquisition or disposition activity were recorded in Goods and services purchased.

 

Driving emerging opportunities in TELUS Health and TELUS International

 

·                   In January 2018, we launched the TELUS Baby Health app, a free digital tool that can be used to create a health record for infants and as an educational resource for new and expecting parents.

 

·                   In February 2018, we acquired WEBS Inc. with a view to broadening our portfolio of health benefit management solutions.

 

·                   We completed the acquisition of a 65% interest in Xavient Information Systems, as noted in Section 1.3 , which now operates as Xavient Digital — powered by TELUS International. With this acquisition, we have increased our ability to expand our global IT services offering with the addition of advanced, next-generation IT consulting and delivery capabilities, including artificial intelligence-powered digital transformation services, user interface/user experience design, open source platform services, DevOps, and IT lifecycle services, in order to provide a more comprehensive suite of services, positioning us for future growth.

 

·                   We acquired Medisys Health Group Inc., as noted in Section 1.3 , with a view to enhancing our capability for delivering employee-centred workplace health and wellness services.

 

·                   In August 2018, we launched the LivingWell Companion™, medical alert devices that enable more independent senior living and provide peace of mind to caregivers. The devices provide 24/7 access to a trained operator and fall detection support by calling emergency contacts and dispatching an ambulance where needed while relaying important health information on the senior’s behalf.

 

·                   In September 2018, TELUS Health announced a partnership with Babylon, a British digital healthcare provider, to better connect patients with medical solutions through a digital healthcare smartphone app. This service will complement existing healthcare services across the country by delivering more options to Canadians for accessing quality healthcare and communicating more efficiently with healthcare practitioners from anywhere, at any time.

 

Our 2019 corporate priorities are provided in the table below.

 

2019 corporate priorities

 

·                   Honouring our customers, communities and social purpose by our team delivering on our brand promise

 

·                   Leveraging our broadband networks to drive TELUS’ growth

 

·                   Fuelling our future through recurring efficiency gains

 

·                   Driving emerging opportunities to build scale in TELUS Health and TELUS International.

 

 

18


 

4.               Capabilities

 

The forward-looking statements in this section, including statements regarding our dividend growth program and our financial objectives in Section 4.3 , are qualified by the Caution regarding forward-looking statements at the beginning of this MD&A.

 

4.1 Principal markets addressed and competition

 

Wireless products and services for consumers and businesses across Canada

 

Our products and services

 

·                   Data and voice — Fast Internet access for video, social networking, messaging and mobile applications, including our new Optik TV app; Internet of Things (IoT) solutions (including machine-to-machine (M2M) connectivity); clear and reliable voice services; push-to-talk (PTT) solutions, including TELUS Link ®  service; and international roaming.

 

·                   Devices — The latest smartphones, tablets, mobile Internet keys, mobile Wi-Fi devices, M2M modems, digital life devices and wearable technology, such as smart watches.

 

·                   Suite of IoT solutions to support Canadian businesses locally and internationally, including asset tracking, fleet management, remote monitoring, digital signage and security.

 

Our capabilities

 

·                   Licensed gross national wireless spectrum holdings averaging 160.8 MHz.

 

·                   Coast-to-coast digital 4G LTE access technology:

 

·                   Overall coverage of 99% of Canada’s population, with the LTE advanced (LTE-A) technology covering 93% of Canada’s population at December 31, 2018. Coverage includes domestic roaming agreements.

 

·                   Coverage and capacity were enhanced with the deployment of the 700 MHz wireless spectrum licences acquired in 2014 and the deployment of the 2500 MHz wireless spectrum licences acquired in 2015. We plan to utilize other spectrum licences purchased in recent years in combination with unlicensed supplementary spectrum, as network and device ecosystems evolve.

 

·                   Manufacturer’s rated download speeds: LTE-A, up to 1,100 Mbps; LTE, up to 150 Mbps; HSPA+, up to 42 Mbps. Average expected speeds: LTE-A, 12-250 Mbps; LTE, 12-45 Mbps; HSPA+, 4-14 Mbps. 1

 

·                   Reverts to HSPA+ technology and speeds when customers are outside LTE coverage areas.

 

·                   International voice and data roaming capabilities in more than 225 destinations.

 

Competition overview

 

·                   Facilities-based national competitors Rogers Wireless and Bell Mobility, as well as provincial or regionally focused telecommunications companies Shaw, Quebecor, SaskTel, Eastlink, Tbaytel and Xplornet.

 

·                   Fixed wireless services.

 

·                   Resellers of competitors’ wireless networks.

 

·                   Services offered by cable-TV and wireless competitors over wireless and metropolitan Wi-Fi networks.

 


(1)          Network speeds vary with location, signal and customer device. Compatible device required.

 

 

19


 

Wireline products and services: Residential services in British Columbia, Alberta and Eastern Quebec; healthcare solutions; business services across Canada; and customer care and business services (CCBS) solutions offered internationally

 

Our products and services

 

·                   Voice — Reliable fixed phone service with long distance and advanced calling features; voice over IP (VoIP) supporting voice services into the future.

 

·                   Internet — TELUS PureFibre, which covers 61% of our broadband footprint at December 31, 2018. Fixed high-speed Internet access (HSIA) service with email and a comprehensive suite of security solutions. Also includes HSIA over LTE, with reliable Wi-Fi, and cloud storage. TELUS offers multiple plans, including 1 Gbps download and 940 Mbps upload speeds, and 750 Mbps symmetrical download and upload speeds.

 

·                   TELUS TV — High-definition entertainment service with Optik TV and Pik TV. Optik TV offers extensive content options, including 4K HDR TV, On Demand content and Netflix, as well as 4K entertainment, such as live TV, On Demand content, Netflix and YouTube. Optik TV also delivers innovative features, including a wireless digital box, large PVR capacity and the ability to restart live TV in progress or from the past 30 hours. In addition, our Optik TV app allows customers to watch live TV, set recordings and access On Demand content from a smartphone, tablet or computer. Pik TV delivers a streamlined offer for customers through our Pik TV media box or Apple TV, and is also accessible through an Internet browser or our Android or iOS mobile applications. Pik TV embraces the changing environment where content is increasingly available from over-the-top (OTT) services (see Section 3 for further information).

 

·                   IP connectivity for businesses — Converged voice, video and data services and Internet access, offered on a high-performing network. Also includes software-defined wide area network (SD-WAN) offerings.

 

·                   Cloud and managed IT services — Suite of hybrid IT solutions provides traditional and cloud technologies, network connectivity, security, managed IT and cloud advisory services.

 

·                   Security consulting and managed services — Cloud and on-premises solutions ensuring security for data, email, websites, networks and applications.

 

·                   Unified Communications conferencing and collaboration — Full range of equipment and application solutions, including Unified Communications as a Service (UCaaS), to support meetings and webcasts by means of phone, video and Internet.

 

·                   CCBS solutions, IT and digital business services through TELUS International. With more than 32,000 employees operating in 10 countries across North and Central America, Asia, and Europe, supporting customers in more than 40 languages, TELUS International offers voice and non-voice customer interaction services, and designs, builds and delivers next-generation digital solutions covering digital transformation, IT lifecycle, advisory and digital consulting, risk management, and back-office support. These solutions and services are provided across the technology, financial services, communications, gaming, travel/hospitality and healthcare industries.

 

·                   Healthcare — TELUS Health’s services, including pharmacy management, electronic medical records (EMR) and mobile EMR, electronic health records, drug information systems, regional clinical information systems, personal health record systems, remote patient monitoring, online settlement claims management solutions, e-prescribing services, TELUS Health Exchange Platform and MedDialog, as well as employee wellness, comprehensive primary care, and workplace health and well-being services.

 

·                   Fixed wireless services — HSIA over LTE and wireless home phone.

 

·                   Home and business security — Real-time 24/7 central monitoring station, guard response service (where available), and wireless and hard-wired security accessibility, integrated with smart devices, such as cameras and sensors. These services are part of enabling smart homes and businesses through deploying evolving technology solutions such as home health monitoring, which was implemented in B.C. in 2018.

 

 

20


 

Our capabilities

 

·                   High-speed broadband footprint covered more than 3.1 million households and businesses in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec at December 31, 2018.

 

·                   Ongoing connection of households and businesses directly to fibre-optic cable; approximately 1.89 million households and businesses covered with TELUS PureFibre in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec at December 31, 2018, and we have reached 61% of our broadband footprint.

 

·                   Broadcasting distribution licences allowing us to offer digital television services in incumbent territories, as well as licences to offer commercial video-on-demand services.

 

·                   Security technology to support central monitoring and guard response service (where available), integrated with automated smart devices. Field services capabilities to install, upgrade and repair security technology at customers’ premises.

 

·                   An IP-based national network overlaying an extensive switched network in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec, as well as global interconnection arrangements.

 

·                   Eight data centres in six communities directly connected to the national TELUS IP network, creating an advanced and regionally diverse computing infrastructure in Canada.

 

·                   Access to businesses across Canada through our network, as well as competitive local exchange carrier status.

 

·                   CCBS solutions, next-generation IT and digital business services with global delivery capabilities through our multinational, multi-language programs, supported by more than 32,000 employees across North America, Asia, Europe and Central America, as at December 31, 2018.

 

·                   Technology solutions to assist health regions, hospitals, insurers, consumers and employers; also to improve connectivity and collaboration among healthcare providers, including physicians, nurses, pharmacists and physiotherapists.

 

Competition overview

 

·                   Cable-TV competitors for Internet and entertainment services, such as Shaw Communications (in B.C. and Alberta) and Cogeco Cable and Videotron (in Eastern Quebec).

 

·                   Substitution of wireless services, including our own wireless offerings, for residential local and long distance services. The percentage of households with wireless-only telephone services (among all providers, including TELUS) is estimated to be 48% in B.C. and Alberta, and 19% in Eastern Quebec in 2018, compared to 45% and 18%, respectively, in 2017.

 

·                   Allstream Inc., a national telecommunications service provider for business customers, owned by Zayo Group Holdings Inc., a U.S.-based provider of communications infrastructure services. Our national telecommunications competitors Rogers Communications Inc. and BCE Inc. also offer telecommunications services for business and enterprise customers.

 

·                   Various others offering VoIP-based local and long distance, as well as Internet and data services, or reselling those services.

 

·                   OTT and direct-to-consumer voice and/or entertainment services, such as Skype, Netflix, Amazon Prime Video, CBS All Access and YouTube.

 

·                   Satellite-based entertainment and Internet services offered by Bell Canada, Shaw Communications and Xplornet.

 

·                   Competitors to our CCBS business include customized managed outsourcing solutions competitors, such as system integrators CGI Group Inc., EDS division of HP Enterprise Services and IBM. Competitors for contact centre and IT digital services include companies such as Convergys, Teleperformance, Sykes, Atento, Genpact and Sitel.

 

·                   Fixed wireless services.

 

·                   Competitors for TELUS Health include providers of EMR and pharmacy management products, such as Omnimed, Familiprix, Medfar, Fillware, ARI and Logipharm. Competitors also include systems integrators; health service providers, such as Loblaws, McKesson and the Jean Coutu Group, that have also become vertically integrated and own a mix of health services delivery, IT solutions and related services; and potentially, global providers, such as EPIC and Cerner, that could achieve expanded Canadian footprints. Competitors for TELUS Health’s corporate and preventative health service offerings include Medcan, Cleveland Clinic, Dialogue and Wellpoint.

 

·                   Competitors for home and business security range from local to national companies, such as ADT, Chubb-Edwards, Stanley Security, Fluent Home and Brinks Home Security.

 

 

21


 

4.2 Operational resources

 

Resources

 

Our team

 

·                   Approximately 58,000 employees at the end of 2018, with 26,000 employees located in Canada and 32,000 employees located internationally.

 

·                   Approximately 9,480 of our employees are covered by collective agreements. The agreement with the Telecommunications Workers Union (TWU), United Steel Workers Local Union 1944, which covers approximately 8,060 employees, expires on December 31, 2021. The agreement with the Syndicat québécois des employés de TELUS (SQET), which covers approximately 740 employees, expires on December 31, 2022. The agreement with the Syndicat des agents de maîtrise de TELUS (SAMT), which covers approximately 625 employees in the TELUS Quebec region, expires on March 31, 2022. Our TELUS Sourcing Solutions Inc. subsidiary is signatory to a collective agreement with the B.C. Government and Services Employees’ Union, which covers less than 100 employees and expires on April 30, 2019.

 

·                   Operations at Canadian and international locations to support CCBS solutions and digital business services for external customers, as well as for certain internal functions.

 

·                   Employee compensation programs that support a high-performance culture and contain market-driven and performance-based components (bonus and share-based compensation) to attract and retain key employees.

 

·                   Succession management and talent reviews for our team continue to cover attrition and ongoing sourcing strategies for ready access to labour in Canada, with competition for talent in specialized or emerging skill areas presenting a challenge. To address this challenge, we continue with an innovative sourcing strategy to proactively attract and engage candidates. Additionally, for our CCBS solutions, we have ready access to labour in the U.S. for management and support positions, and in various international locations for contact centres. We also use external contractors and consultants.

 

·                   Learning and development programs to improve employee engagement levels and enhance our customers’ experiences.

 

Our brand and distribution channels

 

·                   TELUS — A national telecommunications company providing a wide range of telecommunications services and products, including wireless and wireline voice and data, with a well-established and recognizable brand (TELUS, the future is friendly ® ).

 

·                   Koodo Mobile ®  — A national provider of postpaid and prepaid wireless voice and data services with a broad distribution network, including TELUS-owned stores, dealers and third-party electronics retailers.

 

·                   Public Mobile — A prepaid wireless service provider with a distribution channel that is primarily web-based, providing customers with a SIM-only service.

 

·                   Optik TV brand, launched in mid-2010. Pik TV brand, launched in mid-2017.

 

·                   TELUS PureFibre, our next-generation fibre-optic network.

 

·                   TELUS Health, a national provider of telehomecare, electronic medical and health records, consumer health, benefits management, pharmacy management and preventive healthcare services.

 

·                   TELUS SmartHome Security — Our brand offering security services for residential customers, launched in mid-2018.

 

·                   TELUS Secure Business — Our brand offering security services for businesses, launched in mid-2018.

 

·                   Our sales and support distribution channels:

 

·               Wireless services are supported through a broad network of TELUS-owned and branded stores, including our 50% ownership of the kiosk channel WOW! Mobile, an extensive distribution network of exclusive dealers and large third-party electronics retailers (e.g. Best Buy, Walmart and London Drugs), as well as online self-serve applications, mass marketing campaigns and customer care telephone agents.

 

·               Wireline residential services are supported through TELUS-owned and branded stores, including third-party electronics retailers, as well as mass marketing campaigns, customer care telephone agents, and online and TV-based self-serve applications.

 

·               Through telus.com , we sell both wireless and wireline products and services online. We also provide online account management tools, enabling wireless and wireline customers to manage their accounts through our website or mobile applications.

 

·               TELUS Health provides some of its consumer services — personal health records and home health monitoring — in partnership with provincial governments.

 

·               Business services, including healthcare, across wireless and wireline are supported through certain dedicated stores for business, TELUS sales representatives, product specialists, independent dealers and online self-serve applications for small and medium-sized businesses. CCBS solutions and digital business services are supported through sales representatives and client relationship management teams.

 

·               Dedicated direct-to-consumer channel with approximately 500 field sales agents.

 

 

22


 

Resources

 

Our technology, systems and properties

 

·                   We are a technology-enabled company with a multitude of IT systems and processes. We are focused on driving innovation and making generational investments to deliver state-of-the-art broadband solutions in an increasingly digital society.

 

·                   Wireless broadband infrastructure — In 2012, we launched our 4G LTE wireless technology capable of speeds of up to 110 Mbps, and today, our wireless technology covers 99% of Canada’s population. Our LTE technology allows customers to take advantage of the newest mobile devices and enjoy a seamless experience across their multiple devices. In 2015, we launched the newest LTE advanced (LTE-A) network technology and have been working to expand our LTE capabilities with this technology ever since. In April 2016, we enhanced our LTE-A technology with the first global implementation of frequency division duplex (FDD) 4x4 multiple-input-multiple-output (MIMO) technology. We implemented another key enhancement to our LTE-A infrastructure in June 2017 by introducing quad-band LTE-A carrier aggregation technology — this technology covers 92% of Canada’s population and enables theoretical peak speeds of 1.1 Gbps. See Leveraging our broadband networks to drive TELUS’ growth in Section 3 Corporate Priorities for additional information.

 

·                   In 2014, we deployed a centralized radio access technology (C-RAN) in Vancouver and, in 2016, launched voice over LTE (VoLTE) service in B.C. and Alberta communities. Both deployments were key transformations in our wireless capabilities. We were also the first national operator to provide high-speed Internet service over our LTE infrastructure for rural customers in B.C., Alberta and Quebec through our Smart Hub wireless Internet solution. Today, we serve nearly 60,000 households in rural Canada that do not have the same level of access to broadband service.

 

·                   We have made significant investments in heterogeneous network (HetNet) technology, one of the key building blocks for 5G. HetNet combines multiple types of cells, such as outdoor macro cells and microcells, as well as indoor pico cells, to enhance coverage and capacity in crowded urban areas and inside buildings. By taking continuous strides to evolve our small cell technology concurrent with the evolution of network technologies to LTE-A pro (i.e. 4.5G), in 2017, we became the first operator in Canada to introduce licensed assisted access (LAA) small cells for both outdoor and indoor environments, capable of speeds up to 970 Mbps. In 2018, we continued advancing LAA technology with the fastest speeds in Canada, up to 1.1 Gbps.

 

·                   In 2018, we became the first operator globally to introduce LTE FDD Massive MIMO 32TRx technology on the B7 band as part of the LTE-A pro technology evolution. This technology will further enhance the capacity of our wireless infrastructure and enable a stronger customer experience.

 

·                   Wireline broadband infrastructure — Our investments to deploy our gigabit-enabled TELUS PureFibre technology have brought fibre-optic connectivity deeper into our infrastructure and directly to homes and businesses. At the end of 2018, 1.89 million homes and businesses in communities across B.C., Alberta and Quebec had access to ultra-fast, symmetrical 150/150 and 750/750 Internet download and upload speeds with TELUS PureFibre. Over 100 communities now also have 1 Gbps and 750 Mbps Internet service tier options available to them. Recognizing the need for highly reliable, high-capacity connectivity with low latency to support emerging services such as virtualized networks and Internet of Things (IoT) applications, we have also begun rolling out a next-generation nationwide optical backbone network capable of 400 Gbps per channel with automated self-healing and the ability to turn up network capacity on demand.

 

·                   We started the next evolution of our wireline IP and optical core/edge technology, collapsed metro architecture, and initial deployments will continue over three years. This architecture enables a number of future requirements to support 5G and network growth, including significant per-port cost improvement, the ability to leverage software-defined networking (SDN) and network function virtualization (NFV), and improved network and service resiliency.

 

·                   We completed Phase 1 of our third-generation national dense wavelength division multiplexing (DWDM) T transport backbone (packet transport 3.0) CDC (colourless, directionless and contentionless) network overlay, connecting Alberta and Ontario. This architecture will allow network growth without the need for costly re-generation, enable optimal optical rerouting during a fibre cut and reduce network growth costs. The second phase of the build began in 2018, with anticipated completion in 2019, and the final stage is set to be completed in 2020.

 

·                   We advanced our converged voice evolution strategy with the launch of our enhanced home phone service and small business voice services. These services leverage the capabilities of the TELUS PureFibre infrastructure and will serve as a foundation for new services in conjunction with our wireless technology.

 

·                   We have continued to innovate for our customers through our Optik TV and Pik TV platforms. In 2018, we introduced HDR (high dynamic range) colour capability to our 4K Optik TV customers, making us the first operator in Canada to deliver 4K/HDR video across live TV, video-on-demand and Netflix services. We also launched an Apple TV application for Pik TV and gave customers the option to purchase Pik TV using only a web browser. By investing in the cloudification of video infrastructure and innovative applications, we will continue to advance our priority of enabling “anytime, everywhere” content and entertainment, thereby continuing to deliver an exceptional customer experience.

 

·                   In 2018, we also launched TELUS Boost Wi-Fi, a network of boosters that extends the reach of strong and reliable in-home Wi-Fi signals.

 

 

23


 

Resources

 

Our technology, systems and properties (continued)

 

·                   Real estate — Our network facilities are constructed under or along streets and highways, pursuant to rights-of-way granted by the owners of land, including municipalities and the Crown, or on freehold land we own.

 

·                   Our real estate properties (owned or leased) also include administrative office spaces, work centres and space for telecommunications equipment. Some buildings are constructed on leasehold land and the majority of wireless radio antennae are on towers that are situated on lands or are on buildings held under leases or licences with varying terms. We also participate in two real estate joint ventures. (See Section 7.11. )

 

·                   Intangible assets — Our intangible assets include wireless spectrum licences from Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada (ISED), which are essential to providing wireless services. We have assets averaging 160.8 MHz nationally. We have deployed 700 MHz, 2300 MHz, 2500 MHz, 1900 MHz, AWS-1, AWS-3 and 850 MHz spectrum to evolve our wireless infrastructure and will look to the introduction of new bands that will enable the realization of 5G technology. We intend to continue acquiring spectrum within the rules set out by ISED to meet our future capacity requirements.

 

·                   Intellectual property, which we own or which we have been granted the right to use, is also an essential asset for us. Intellectual property enables us to be known and recognized in the marketplace through our brand style, trade dress, domain names and trademarks. It protects our know-how and software, systems, processes and method of doing business through copyrights, patents and information treated as confidential. It also helps us to increase our competitiveness by fostering an innovative work environment. Each form of intellectual property is important to our success. For instance, the TELUS brand plays a key role in product positioning and our Company’s reputation. We aim to maximize the value of our intangible assets in the areas of innovation and invention by ensuring that they are adequately used, protected and valued. To protect our intellectual property assets, we rely on a combination of legal protections afforded under copyright, trademark, patent and other intellectual property laws, as well as contractual provisions under licensing arrangements. Further information on recognized tangible and intangible properties can be found in Section 8.1 Critical accounting estimates and judgments .

 

·                   Our broadcasting distribution licences enable us to provide entertainment services. See Broadcasting-related issues in Section 9.4 describing developments relating to these licences.

 

·                   Future technologies, TELUS Health and TELUS International — In addition to evolving our existing wireless and wireline infrastructure, we are investing in the technologies of the future that will serve as the foundation to provide next-generation services to Canadians. By way of example, we are building the next generation of 5G wireless technologies and capitalizing on the promise of convergent wireless and wireline network technologies. As mobile operators globally work to develop 5G, we have achieved groundbreaking wireless speeds of nearly 30 Gbps — 200 times faster than today’s LTE standard — in our Living Lab. In 2017, we broke new ground by piloting 5G wireless-to-the-premises (WTTx) technology and achieved 2 Gbps download speeds in a live-environment test using 3.5 GHz spectrum.

 

·                   In 2018, we achieved the first 3GPP-based 5G non-standalone (NSA) technology field trial in HetNet architecture in Canada, which included both outdoor macro cells on 3.5 GHz spectrum and 28 GHz spectrum microcells. We also demonstrated a number of 5G experience use cases including live video distribution, face identification, and home security during the seventh next generation mobile networks (NGMN) Industry Conference & Exhibition held in Vancouver in November 2018. These are key milestones in our ongoing effort to unleash the benefits of 5G for Canadians.

 

·                   We continue to invest in enabling systems such as our Jasper connected device platform (CDP) and our dedicated machine-to-machine virtual evolved packet core (M2M vEPC) to support IoT applications, where the ease of onboarding partners is crucial for emerging services such as connected vehicles, fleet management and more.

 

·                   In 2017, we launched our Network as a Service (NaaS) solution, the first Canadian NFV infrastructure that will power the virtualized networks of the future and enable Canadian businesses to better serve their customers with improved total cost of ownership. Looking ahead, we will continue on our journey of network virtualization in support of bringing services to customers faster.

 

·                   In 2018, we deployed our LTE-machine (LTE-M) technology across Canada. LTE-M is a low-power wide area network (LPWAN) technology, which is ideal for IoT because it supports large numbers of devices that transmit infrequent, short bursts of data, like IoT sensors. It will enable a plethora of IoT applications through long-range connectivity, extended battery life and carrier-grade security and quality of service.

 

·                   Through TELUS Health’s services — such as pharmacy management, electronic medical records (EMRs) (including mobile EMRs), electronic health records, personal health records, clinical information systems, remote patient monitoring, virtual care and online claims settlement management software solutions, including the online renewal of prescriptions, e-prescribing services and MedDialog — TELUS Health facilitates the integration of electronic health records from the home to the doctor’s office to the hospital, making critical health information available to healthcare providers over our wireless and wireline broadband network.

 

·                   Through TELUS International, we continue to provide a wide array of products and services, as described in Section 4.1 . These services are provided from facilities located in North America, Asia, Europe and Central America.

 

 

24


 

4.3 Liquidity and capital resources

 

Capital structure financial policies

 

Our objective when managing capital is to maintain a flexible capital structure that optimizes the cost and availability of capital at acceptable risk.

 

In the management of capital and in its definition, we include Common Share equity (excluding Accumulated other comprehensive income), Long-term debt (including long-term credit facilities, commercial paper backstopped by long-term credit facilities and any hedging assets or liabilities associated with Long-term debt items, net of amounts recognized in Accumulated other comprehensive income), Cash and temporary investments, and short-term borrowings arising from securitized trade receivables.

 

We manage our capital structure and make adjustments to it in light of changes in economic conditions and the risk characteristics of our business. In order to maintain or adjust our capital structure, we may adjust the amount of dividends paid to holders of Common Shares, purchase Common Shares for cancellation pursuant to normal course issuer bid (NCIB) programs, issue new shares, issue new debt, issue new debt to replace existing debt with different characteristics, and/or increase or decrease the amount of trade receivables sold to an arm’s-length securitization trust.

 

We monitor capital utilizing a number of measures, including our net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio, coverage ratios and dividend payout ratios. (See definitions in Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .)

 

Financing and capital structure management plans

 

Report on financing and capital structure management plans

 

Pay dividends to the holders of Common Shares under our multi-year dividend growth program

 

·                   In May 2016, we announced our intention to target ongoing semi-annual dividend increases, with the annual increase in the range of 7 to 10% from 2017 through to the end of 2019, thereby extending the policy first announced in May 2011. Notwithstanding this target, dividend decisions will continue to be subject to our Board’s assessment and the determination of our financial position and outlook on a quarterly basis. Our long-term dividend payout ratio guideline is 65 to 75% of prospective net earnings per share. (See Section 7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures. ) There can be no assurance that we will maintain a dividend growth program or that it will be unchanged through 2019. (See Caution regarding forward-looking statements — Ability to sustain our dividend growth program through 2019 and Section 10.7 Financing, debt requirements and returning cash to shareholders.)

 

·                   Dividends declared in 2018 totalled $2.10 per share, an increase of $0.13 per share or 6.6% compared to the dividends declared in 2017. On February 13, 2019, the Board declared a first quarter dividend of $0.5450 per share, payable on April 1, 2019, to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 11, 2019. The first quarter dividend for 2019 reflects a cumulative increase of $0.04 per share or 7.9% from the $0.5050 per share dividend declared one year earlier.

 

·                   During 2018, our dividend reinvestment and share purchase plan trustee purchased from Treasury approximately 1.8 million dividend reinvestment Common Shares for $85 million, with no discount applicable.

 

Purchase Common Shares

 

·                   In August 2018, we received approval from the Toronto Stock Exchange (TSX) to amend our 2018 NCIB expiring on November 12, 2018, to permit TELUS Communications Inc., a direct wholly owned subsidiary of TELUS Corporation, to purchase Common Shares with an aggregate fair market value of up to $105 million for donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation. All other terms of the 2018 NCIB remained unchanged except that the maximum number of shares that can be purchased during the same trading day on the TSX was 238,480 shares (being 25% of the average daily trading volume for the six months ended July 31, 2018, which was equal to 953,922 shares), subject to certain exemptions for block purchases.

 

·                   Under the 2018 NCIB, in August and September 2018, TELUS Communications Inc. purchased approximately 2.1 million Common Shares in aggregate in the market for $100 million, and donated the Shares on a timely basis shortly thereafter to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation.

 

·                   In December 2018, we received approval from the TSX for a new 2019 NCIB to purchase and cancel up to 8 million Common Shares for consideration of up to $250 million over a 12-month period, from January 2, 2019, to January 1, 2020, through the facilities of the TSX, the New York Stock Exchange, and alternative trading platforms or as otherwise permitted by applicable securities laws. TELUS will purchase Common Shares only when and if we consider it opportunistic, subject to any purchases that may be made under an automatic share purchase plan (ASPP). As of February 14, 2019, we have not had any transactions pursuant to our 2019 NCIB.

 

·                   We may also enter into an ASPP with a broker for the purpose of permitting us to purchase our Common Shares under our NCIB at times when we would not be permitted to trade in our shares, including regularly scheduled quarterly blackout periods. Such purchases will be determined by the broker in its sole discretion based on parameters that we have established prior to any blackout period, in accordance with TSX rules and applicable securities laws. The ASPP has been approved by the TSX and may be implemented from time to time in the future.

 

 

25


 

Report on financing and capital structure management plans

 

Use proceeds from securitized trade receivables (Short-term borrowings), bank facilities and commercial paper as needed, to supplement free cash flow and meet other cash requirements

 

·                   Our issued and outstanding commercial paper was $774 million at December 31, 2018, all of which was denominated in U.S. dollars (US$569 million), compared to $1,140 million (US$908 million) at December 31, 2017.

 

·                   Our net draws on the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility were $427 million ($419 million net of unamortized costs) at December 31, 2018, compared to $346 million ($339 million net of unamortized issue costs) at December 31, 2017.

 

·                   Proceeds from securitized trade receivables were $100 million at December 31, 2018, unchanged from December 31, 2017.

 

Maintain compliance with financial objectives

 

Certain of our current financial objectives will be reviewed in 2019 for possible revision due to changes arising from the adoption of new accounting standards, notably IFRS 16, Leases . (See Section 8.2 Accounting policy developments .)

 

·                   Maintain investment grade credit ratings in the range of BBB+ or the equivalent — On February 14, 2019, investment grade credit ratings from the four rating agencies that cover TELUS were in the desired range. (See Section 7.8 Credit ratings .)

 

·                   Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio of 2.00 to 2.50 times — As measured at December 31, 2018, the ratio was 2.54 times, outside of the objective range, primarily due to the funding of spectrum licences acquired in wireless spectrum auctions held during 2014 and 2015, and the elevated strategic capital investments in our fibre-optic infrastructure. Given the cash demands of upcoming spectrum auctions, the assessment of the guideline and return to the objective range remains to be determined; however, it is our intent to return to a ratio below 2.50 times in the medium term, consistent with our long-term strategy. (See Section 7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures .) Excluding the equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden in the third quarter of 2018, the ratio was 2.62 at December 31, 2018.

 

·                   Dividend payout ratio of 65 to 75% of net earnings per share on a prospective basis — Our objective range is on a prospective basis. The dividend payout ratio we present in this MD&A is a historical measure utilizing the last four quarters of dividends declared and earnings per share, and is disclosed for illustrative purposes in evaluating our target guideline. As at December 31, 2018, the historical ratio of 78% and the adjusted historical ratio of 81% exceeded the objective range; however, we currently expect that we will be within our target guideline when considered on a prospective basis within the medium term. (See Section 7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures .)

 

·                   Generally maintain a minimum of $1 billion in unutilized liquidity — As at December 31, 2018, our unutilized liquidity on a consolidated basis was approximately $2.1 billion. (See Section 7.6 Credit facilities .)

 

Financing and capital structure management plans for 2019

 

At the end of 2018, our long-term debt (excluding unamortized discount) was $14.2 billion and the weighted average term to maturity was approximately 12.2 years (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases). Our weighted average interest rate on long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases) was 4.18% at December 31, 2018, the same as one year earlier. Aside from Short-term borrowings of $100 million, commercial paper of $774 million (US$569 million), the utilized revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility of $273 million (US$200 million) and finance leases of $102 million, all of our debt was on a fixed-rate basis.

 

During 2019, we may issue senior Notes to fund spectrum purchases, accelerate future debt by prepaying certain Notes, refinance maturing debt or use for general corporate purposes. Anticipated free cash flow and sources of capital are expected to be more than sufficient to meet requirements. For the related risk discussion, see Section 10.7 Financing, debt requirements and returning cash to shareholders.

 

 

 

26


 

4.4 Disclosure controls and procedures and changes in internal control over financial reporting

 

Disclosure controls and procedures

 

Disclosure controls and procedures are designed to provide reasonable assurance that all relevant information is gathered and reported to senior management, including the President and Chief Executive Officer (CEO) and the Executive Vice-President and Chief Financial Officer (CFO), on a timely basis so that appropriate decisions can be made regarding public disclosure.

 

The CEO and the CFO have assessed the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures related to the preparation of this MD&A and the December 31, 2018, Consolidated financial statements. They have concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective, at a reasonable assurance level, in ensuring that material information relating to TELUS and its consolidated subsidiaries would be made known to them by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which the MD&A and the Consolidated financial statements were being prepared.

 

Internal control over financial reporting

 

Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements in accordance with IFRS-IASB and the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States, as applicable. TELUS’ CEO and CFO have assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, in accordance with the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) , issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this assessment, TELUS’ CEO and CFO have concluded that our internal control over financial reporting is effective as of December 31, 2018, and have certified TELUS’ annual filings within our annual report on Form 40-F, as required by the United States’ Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 , and TELUS’ Annual Information Form, as required by National Instrument 52-109 Certification of Disclosure in Issuers’ Annual and Interim Filings .

 

Deloitte LLP, our auditor, has audited our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018.

 

Changes in internal control over financial reporting

 

There were no changes in internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting in 2018.

 

 

27


 

5.               Discussion of operations

 

This section contains forward-looking statements, including those with respect to average billing per subscriber unit per month (ABPU) and average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU) growth, wireless trends regarding loading and retention spending, high-speed Internet subscriber growth and various future trends. To support the transition to the new accounting standard, we believe ABPU provides management, investors and analysts with useful information to assess and evaluate our performance excluding the effects of implementing IFRS 15. ABPU represents the average monthly wireless network revenue derived from monthly service plan, roaming and usage charges, as well as monthly re-payments of the outstanding device balance owing from customers on contract (see Section 11.2 Operating indicators ). There can be no assurance that we have accurately identified these trends based on past results or that these trends will continue. See  Caution regarding forward-looking statements at the beginning of this MD&A.

 

5.1 General

 

A significant judgment we make is in respect of distinguishing between our wireless and wireline operations and cash flows (and this extends to allocations of both direct and indirect expenses and capital expenditures). The clarity of such distinction has been increasingly affected by the convergence and integration of our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure and technology. The continued build-out of our technology-agnostic fibre-optic infrastructure, in combination with converged edge technology, has significantly affected this judgment, as has the commercialization of fixed-wireless telecommunications solutions for customers and the consolidation of our non-customer facing operations. As a result, it has become increasingly impractical and difficult to objectively and clearly distinguish between our wireless and wireline operations and cash flows. As we do not currently aggregate operating segments, our reportable segments as at December 31, 2018, are also wireless and wireline. Segmented information in Note 5 of the Consolidated financial statements is regularly reported to our Chief Executive Officer (CEO) (our chief operating decision-maker).

 

We applied IFRS 9 and IFRS 15, both with a transition date of January 1, 2018, with retrospective application. Refer to Section 8.2 Accounting policy developments in this MD&A and Note 2 of the Consolidated financial statements for further information. In the following table, the selected information presented below excluding IFRS 9 and IFRS 15 has been derived from, and should be read in conjunction with, the audited consolidated financial statements of TELUS Corporation dated December 31, 2017.

 

Selected annual information

 

Years ended December 31 

 

2018

 

2017

 

2017

 

2016

 

($ in millions, except per share amounts)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15 (2017 adjusted)

 

Excluding IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15

 

Operating revenues

 

14,368

 

13,408

 

13,304

 

12,799

 

Net income

 

1,624

 

1,578

 

1,479

 

1,236

 

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

1,600

 

1,559

 

1,460

 

1,223

 

Net income per Common Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic earnings per share

 

2.68

 

2.63

 

2.46

 

2.06

 

Diluted earnings per share

 

2.68

 

2.63

 

2.46

 

2.06

 

Cash dividends declared per Common Share

 

2.10

 

1.97

 

1.97

 

1.84

 

 

At December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

2017

 

2016

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15 (2017 adjusted)

 

Excluding IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15

 

Total assets

 

33,065

 

31,053

 

29,548

 

27,729

 

Current maturities of long-term debt

 

836

 

1,404

 

1,404

 

1,327

 

Non-current financial liabilities 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

395

 

152

 

152

 

57

 

Long-term debt

 

13,265

 

12,256

 

12,256

 

11,604

 

Other long-term financial liabilities

 

169

 

224

 

224

 

166

 

Total non-current liabilities

 

13,829

 

12,632

 

12,632

 

11,827

 

Deferred income taxes

 

3,152

 

2,941

 

2,500

 

2,107

 

Common equity

 

10,259

 

9,416

 

8,221

 

7,917

 

 


(1)               In our specific current instance, financial liabilities do not include liabilities that are excluded by definition (e.g. employee benefits and share-based compensation liabilities) or liabilities that do not involve a future outlay of economic resources (e.g. deferred recognition of customer activation and connection fees; deferred gains on sale-leaseback of buildings).

 

 

28


 

Operating revenues: Combined wireless revenue and wireline data revenue represented approximately 90% of consolidated revenues in 2018 and approximately 89% in 2017. Excluding the effects of IFRS 9 and IFRS 15, combined wireless revenue and wireline data revenue represented approximately 87% in 2016.

 

Total assets: Growth in Total assets includes increases in Property, plant and equipment and Intangible assets, which increased by a combined $1,021 million in 2018 and $1,198 million in 2017. These increases resulted primarily from our ongoing investments in broadband infrastructure, connecting additional homes and businesses directly to our fibre-optic technology, and business acquisitions. See Section 7.3 Cash used by investing activities .

 

For changes in Long-term debt , see Section 6 Changes in financial position and Section 7.4 Cash used by financing activities .

 

 

 

29


 

5.2 Summary of consolidated quarterly results, trends and fourth quarter recap

 

Summary of quarterly results

 

($ millions, except per share amounts)

 

2018 Q4

 

2018 Q3

 

2018 Q2

 

2018 Q1

 

2017 Q4

 

2017 Q3

 

2017 Q2

 

2017 Q1

 

Operating revenues 1

 

3,764

 

3,774

 

3,453

 

3,377

 

3,541

 

3,404

 

3,280

 

3,183

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased 2,4

 

1,784

 

1,685

 

1,491

 

1,408

 

1,635

 

1,522

 

1,423

 

1,324

 

Employee benefits expense 2

 

745

 

740

 

711

 

700

 

683

 

638

 

649

 

624

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

586

 

572

 

559

 

550

 

564

 

547

 

526

 

532

 

Total operating expenses

 

3,115

 

2,997

 

2,761

 

2,658

 

2,882

 

2,707

 

2,598

 

2,480

 

Operating income

 

649

 

777

 

692

 

719

 

659

 

697

 

682

 

703

 

Financing costs before long-term debt prepayment premium

 

159

 

162

 

150

 

156

 

144

 

149

 

142

 

138

 

Long-term debt prepayment premium

 

 

34

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income before income taxes

 

490

 

581

 

542

 

563

 

515

 

548

 

540

 

565

 

Income taxes

 

122

 

134

 

145

 

151

 

161

 

142

 

144

 

143

 

Net income

 

368

 

447

 

397

 

412

 

354

 

406

 

396

 

422

 

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

357

 

443

 

390

 

410

 

353

 

403

 

389

 

414

 

Net income per Common Share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic earnings per share (EPS)

 

0.60

 

0.74

 

0.66

 

0.69

 

0.59

 

0.68

 

0.66

 

0.70

 

Adjusted basic EPS 3

 

0.69

 

0.74

 

0.70

 

0.73

 

0.66

 

0.70

 

0.70

 

0.71

 

Diluted EPS

 

0.60

 

0.74

 

0.66

 

0.69

 

0.59

 

0.68

 

0.66

 

0.70

 

Dividends declared per Common Share

 

0.5450

 

0.5250

 

0.5250

 

0.5050

 

0.5050

 

0.4925

 

0.4925

 

0.4800

 

Additional information:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

EBITDA 3

 

1,235

 

1,349

 

1,251

 

1,269

 

1,223

 

1,244

 

1,208

 

1,235

 

Restructuring and other costs 3,4

 

75

 

173

 

35

 

34

 

54

 

23

 

36

 

4

 

Non-recurring gains and equity income (non-recurring losses and equity losses) related to real estate joint ventures

 

 

171

 

 

 

(2

)

 

3

 

 

MTS net recovery

 

 

 

 

 

21

 

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA 3

 

1,310

 

1,351

 

1,286

 

1,303

 

1,258

 

1,267

 

1,241

 

1,239

 

Cash provided by operating activities

 

948

 

1,066

 

1,206

 

838

 

979

 

1,133

 

1,126

 

709

 

Free cash flow 3

 

122

 

303

 

329

 

443

 

274

 

215

 

260

 

217

 

 


(1)               In the third quarter of 2018, we recorded equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden.

 

(2)               Goods and services purchased and Employee benefits expense amounts include restructuring and other costs.

 

(3)               See Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .

 

(4)               In the third quarter of 2018, we recorded a donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation of $118 million as part of other costs.

 

Trends

 

The trend of year-over-year increases in consolidated revenue reflects: (i) wireless network revenue generated from growth in our subscriber base; and (ii) growth in wireline data services revenues, including customer care and business services (CCBS) (formerly business process outsourcing), Internet and enhanced data, TELUS Health, TELUS TV services, and home and business security. Increased CCBS revenues, TELUS Health revenues, home security and business security revenues include revenues from business acquisitions. Increased Internet and TV service revenues are being generated by subscriber growth and higher Internet revenue per customer. Year-over-year wireless equipment revenues generally increased from a higher volume of new postpaid contracts and higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units. Operating revenues in the third quarter of 2018 include equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden. For additional information on wireless and wireline revenue and subscriber trends, see Section 5.4 Wireless segment and Section 5.5 Wireline segment .

 

 

30


 

 

 

The trend of year-over-year increases in Goods and services purchased expense reflects increases in wireless and wireline customer service, roaming and external labour expenses to support growth in both our subscriber base and business acquisitions; increased wireline TV costs of sales associated with a growing subscriber base; and higher equipment expenses associated with an increase in postpaid gross additions and increases in higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units. Goods and services purchased in the third quarter of 2018 include a $118 million charitable donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation. (See Section 1.3 for additional details.)

 

The general trend of year-over-year increases in net Employee benefits expense reflects increases in the number of employees resulting from business acquisitions, including those supporting CCBS revenue growth, expansion of our TELUS Health offerings and growth in our home and business security lines of business. This was partly offset by moderating salaries expense resulting from reductions in the number of full-time equivalent (FTE) domestic employees related to cost efficiency and effectiveness programs.

 

The trend of year-over-year increases in Depreciation and amortization reflects increases due to growth in capital assets, which is supporting the expansion of our broadband footprint and enhanced LTE technology coverage, and growth in business acquisitions. The investments in our fibre-optic technology also support our small-cell technology strategy to improve coverage and capacity while preparing for a more efficient and timely evolution to 5G.

 

The trend of year-over-year increases in Financing costs reflects an increase in long-term debt outstanding, mainly associated with our generational investments in fibre to homes and businesses and our wireless technology, and our business acquisitions, in addition to a higher average effective interest rate. Financing costs include a long-term debt prepayment premium of $34 million in the third quarter of 2018. Financing costs are net of capitalized interest, which was related to spectrum licences acquired during past wireless spectrum licence auctions. Capitalization of interest ceased in the first quarter of 2017, as cell sites were then capable of utilizing the acquired frequencies. Financing costs also includes Interest accretion on provisions and Employee defined benefit plans net interest expense. Additionally, for the eight periods shown, Financing costs include varying amounts of foreign exchange gains or losses and varying amounts of interest income.

 

The trend in Net income reflects the items noted above, as well as non-cash adjustments arising from legislated income tax changes and adjustments recognized in the current periods for income taxes of prior periods, including any related after-tax interest on reassessments. Historically, the trend in basic EPS has been impacted by the same trends

 

 

31


 

as Net income and has also been impacted by share purchases under our normal course issuer bid (NCIB) programs. See Financing and capital structure management plans within Section 4.3 .

 

The general trend of year-over-year increases in Cash provided by operating activities reflects generally higher year-over-year consolidated EBITDA. This trend was reduced by increased interest payments arising from increases in debt outstanding and year-over-year increases in fixed-term interest rates. The trend of year-over-year increases in free cash flow reflects the above factors affecting Cash provided by operating activities. Additionally, free cash flow was impacted by the increases in capital expenditures in 2017, as we connected more homes and businesses directly to fibre and by the end of 2018, TELUS PureFibre was available to 61% of our broadband footprint. For further discussion on these trends, see Section 5.4 Wireless segment and Section 5.5 Wireline segment .

 

Fourth quarter recap

 

Results for the fourth quarter of 2018 (three-month period ended December 31, 2018) are discussed in our February 14, 2019 news release and are compared with results from the fourth quarter of 2017 (three-month period ended December 31, 2017), adjusted for the retrospective application of IFRS 9 and IFRS 15 (to the three-month period ended December 31, 2017).

 

·                   Consolidated operating revenues in the fourth quarter of 2018 were $3,764 million, an increase of $223 million.

 

·                   Service revenues in the fourth quarter of 2018 were $3,014 million and increased by $133 million, reflecting growth in wireless network revenue and wireline data services, partly offset by the continuing decline in wireline voice revenues. Wireless network revenue increases were driven by a growing wireless subscriber base partly offset by lower ARPU per customer. The increase in wireline data services revenue reflects increased CCBS revenue growth, including the growth in business volumes from recent business acquisitions, as well as increases in Internet and enhanced data service, TELUS Health revenues, TELUS TV revenue and revenues from our home and business security lines of business. Internet and TV revenues increased due to subscriber growth, as well as higher Internet revenue per customer.

 

·                   Equipment revenues in the fourth quarter of 2018 were $699 million and increased by $103 million, primarily due to increased wireless revenue mainly from more higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units and growth in revenue per handset, as well as a higher volume of new postpaid contracts. Excluding the effects of implementing IFRS 15, equipment revenues would have increased by $13 million or 6.0% in the fourth quarter of 2018.

 

·                   Other operating income in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $51 million and decreased by $13 million, mainly due to the non-recurrence of the 2017 MTS contingent consideration recovery, partly offset by higher net gains from the sale of property, plant and equipment and a decrease in the provision related to written put options in respect of non-controlling interests.

 

·                   Consolidated operating expenses in the fourth quarter of 2018 were $3,115 million, an increase of $233 million.

 

·                   Goods and services purchased in the fourth quarter of 2018 were $1,784 million and increased by $149 million, largely due to higher wireless handset costs reflecting higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units, increases in employee-related and other costs related to business acquisitions, higher wireline product costs associated with equipment sales and TELUS Health services, higher TV content costs, and higher administrative costs to support the larger wireless customer base, partly offset by the non-recurrence of 2017 non-labour restructuring and other costs, including those associated with the migration of subscribers from MTS and customer support costs related to acquired MTS subscribers.

 

·                   Employee benefits expense in the fourth quarter of 2018 were $745 million and increased by $62 million, due to higher compensation and benefit costs resulting from an increase in the number of employees from business acquisitions, as well as higher employee-related restructuring and other costs related to efficiency initiatives in the quarter. This was partly offset by lower compensation and benefit costs from a decrease in the number of domestic FTEs, excluding business acquisitions, and higher capitalized labour costs.

 

·                   Depreciation in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $428 million and increased by $14 million, due to higher expenditures associated with growth in capital assets over the last 12 months, including those arising from our investments in fibre and business acquisitions.

 

·                   Amortization of intangible assets in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $158 million and increased by $8 million, reflecting higher expenditures associated with the intangible asset base, including those arising from business acquisitions.

 

·                   EBITDA includes restructuring and other costs, non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, and the fourth quarter of 2017 MTS net recovery. EBITDA in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $1,235 million, an increase of $12 million or 1.0%.

 

 

32


 

·                   Adjusted EBITDA excludes restructuring and other costs, non-recurring gains and equity income (or net losses and equity losses) related to real estate joint ventures, and the fourth quarter of 2017 MTS net recovery. Adjusted EBITDA in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $1,310 million, an increase of $52 million or 4.1%, reflecting higher wireless equipment margins and wireless network revenue growth driven by a growing customer base, in addition to growth in EBITDA contribution from our CCBS business. These factors were partly offset by increased costs associated with a growing wireless customer base and declines in wireline legacy voice services.

 

·                   Net income attributable to Common Shares in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $357 million, an increase of $4 million, driven by lower income taxes, partly offset by lower Operating income and increased Financing costs. Adjusted Net income excludes the effects of restructuring and other costs, income tax-related adjustments, non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, the long-term debt prepayment premium and the 2017 MTS net recovery. Adjusted Net income in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $409 million and increased by $13 million or 3.3%.

 

·                   Basic EPS was $0.60 in the fourth quarter of 2018, an increase of $0.01 or 1.7%, driven by lower income taxes, partly offset by lower Operating income and increased Financing costs. Adjusted basic EPS excludes the effects of restructuring and other costs, income tax-related adjustments, non-recurring gains and equity income (non-recurring losses and equity losses) related to real estate joint ventures, the long-term debt prepayment premium and the 2017 MTS net recovery. Adjusted basic EPS in the fourth quarter of 2018 was $0.69 and increased by $0.03 or 4.5%.

 

·                   Cash provided by operating activities was $948 million in the fourth quarter of 2018, a decrease of $31 million, primarily due to increased income taxes paid and increased share-based compensation paid, partially offset by other working capital changes.

 

·                   Cash used by investing activities was $629 million in the fourth quarter of 2018, a decrease of $105 million, mainly due to lower capital expenditures primarily reflecting the planned reduction in our capital spend.

 

·                  Cash used by financing activities was $338 million in the fourth quarter of 2018, an increase of $114 million, primarily reflecting lower issuances of long-term debt, net of redemptions and repayment.

 

·                   Free cash flow was $122 million in the fourth quarter of 2018, a decrease of $152 million, primarily resulting from increased income taxes paid and increased shared-based compensation paid.

 

5.3 Consolidated operations

 

The following is a discussion of our consolidated financial performance. Segment information in Note 5 of the Consolidated financial statements is regularly reported to our CEO. We discuss the performance of our segments in Section 5.4 Wireless segment, Section 5.5 Wireline segment and Section 7.3 Cash used by investing activities.

 

 

Operating revenues

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Service

 

11,882

 

11,332

 

4.9

%

Equipment

 

2,213

 

1,973

 

12.2

%

Revenues arising from contracts with customers

 

14,095

 

13,305

 

5.9

%

Other operating income

 

273

 

103

 

n/m

 

Operating revenues

 

14,368

 

13,408

 

7.2

%

 

Consolidated operating revenues increased by $960 million in 2018.

 

 

33


 

·                   Service revenues increased by $550 million in 2018, reflecting growth in wireless network revenue and wireline data services, partly offset by the continuing decline in wireline voice revenues. Wireless network revenue increases reflect a growing wireless subscriber base. The increase in wireline data service revenue reflects increased CCBS revenue growth, including the growth in business volumes from recent business acquisitions, as well as increases in Internet and enhanced data service, TELUS Health revenues, TELUS TV revenue and revenues from our home and business security lines of business. Internet and TV revenues increased due to subscriber growth, as well as higher Internet revenue per customer.

 

·                   Equipment revenues increased by $240 million in 2018, primarily due to increased wireless revenue mainly from a higher volume of new postpaid contracts, as well as higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units. Excluding the effects of implementing IFRS 15, equipment revenues would have increased by $68 million or 9.4% in 2018. See Note 2(c)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

·                   Other operating income increased by $170 million in 2018, primarily due to the third quarter of 2018 equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden of $171 million, as noted in Section 1.3 . Excluding the effect of equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, Other operating income was relatively flat in the year, primarily due to the non-recurrence of the 2017 MTS contingent consideration recovery, partly offset by higher net gains from the sale of property, plant and equipment and a decrease in the provision related to written put options in respect of non-controlling interests.

 

Operating expenses

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased

 

6,368

 

5,904

 

7.9

%

Employee benefits expense

 

2,896

 

2,594

 

11.6

%

Depreciation

 

1,669

 

1,617

 

3.2

%

Amortization of intangible assets

 

598

 

552

 

8.3

%

Operating expenses

 

11,531

 

10,667

 

8.1

%

 

Consolidated operating expenses increased by $864 million in 2018.

 

·                   Goods and services purchased increased by $464 million in 2018, primarily due to the third quarter of 2018 $118 million donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation, as noted in Section 1.3, made in TELUS Corporation Common Shares. Excluding the effect of the donation, Goods and services purchased increased by $346 million or 5.9% in 2018, largely due to employee-related and other costs associated with business acquisitions, higher wireless handset costs reflecting higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units, higher wireline product costs associated with equipment sales and TELUS Health services, and higher TV content costs.

 

·                   Employee benefits expense increased by $302 million in 2018, due to higher compensation and benefit costs resulting from an increase in the number of employees from business acquisitions, as well as higher employee-related restructuring and other costs related to efficiency initiatives in the year. This was partly offset by lower compensation and benefit costs from a decrease in the number of domestic FTEs, excluding business acquisitions, and higher capitalized labour costs.

 

·                   Depreciation increased by $52 million in 2018 due to higher expenditures associated with growth in capital assets over the last 12 months, including those arising from our investments in fibre and business acquisitions.

 

·                   Amortization of intangible assets increased by $46 million in 2018, reflecting higher expenditures associated with the intangible asset base, including those arising from business acquisitions.

 

 

34


 

Operating income

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Wireless EBITDA (see Section 5.4 )

 

3,431

 

3,250

 

5.5

%

Wireline EBITDA (see Section 5.5 )

 

1,673

 

1,660

 

0.8

%

EBITDA

 

5,104

 

4,910

 

3.9

%

Depreciation and amortization (discussed above)

 

(2,267

)

(2,169

)

n/m

 

Operating income

 

2,837

 

2,741

 

3.5

%

 

Operating income increased by $96 million in 2018, while EBITDA increased by $194 million in 2018. These increases reflect higher wireless equipment margins and wireless network revenue growth driven by a growing customer base, in addition to growth in EBITDA contribution from our CCBS business. These factors were partly offset by increased costs associated with a growing wireless customer base, declines in wireline legacy voice services, and higher wireline restructuring and other costs related to efficiency initiatives, as well as increased depreciation and amortization.

 

Adjusted EBITDA

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Wireless Adjusted EBITDA (see Section 5.4 )

 

3,461

 

3,286

 

5.3

%

Wireline Adjusted EBITDA (see Section 5.5 )

 

1,789

 

1,719

 

4.1

%

Adjusted EBITDA

 

5,250

 

5,005

 

4.9

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA increased by $245 million or 4.9% in 2018, reflecting higher wireless equipment margins and wireless network revenue growth driven by a growing customer base, growth in EBITDA contribution from our CCBS business and higher Internet and TELUS Health margins. These factors were partly offset by increased costs associated with a growing wireless customer base, declines in wireline legacy voice services and a decline in the EBITDA contribution from our business services.

 

Financing costs

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Interest expense, before long-term debt prepayment premium

 

625

 

579

 

7.9

%

Long-term debt prepayment premium

 

34

 

 

n/m

 

Interest expense

 

659

 

579

 

13.8

%

Employee defined benefit plans net interest

 

17

 

6

 

n/m

 

Foreign exchange gains

 

(6

)

(5

)

20.0

%

Interest income

 

(9

)

(7

)

28.6

%

Financing costs

 

661

 

573

 

15.4

%

 

Financing costs increased by $88 million in 2018, mainly due to the following factors:

 

·                   Interest expense, before long-term debt prepayment premium increased by $46 million in 2018, primarily due to the following:

 

·                   Interest on long-term debt increased by $37 million in 2018, resulting from an increase in average long-term debt balances outstanding, in addition to an increase in the effective interest rate in the respective periods. Our weighted average interest rate on long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases) was 4.18% at December 31, 2018, as compared to 4.18% one year earlier. (See Long-term debt issues and repayments in Section 7.4 .)

 

·                   Interest accretion on provisions increased by $8 million in 2018, attributed to written put options in respect of business acquisitions.

 

·                   In the third quarter of 2018, we recorded a long-term debt prepayment premium of $34 million before income taxes related to the early redemption of all our $1.0 billion 5.05%, Series CG Notes due December 4, 2019. There was no comparable activity in 2017.

 

·                   Employee defined benefit plans net interest increased by $11 million in 2018, primarily due to the increase in the defined benefit plan deficit at December 31, 2017, to $334 million, up from $79 million one year earlier, partly offset by a decrease in the discount rate.

 

·                   Foreign exchange (gains) losses were relatively flat in 2018.

 

 

35


 

·                   Interest income was relatively flat in the full year of 2018.

 

 

Income taxes

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions, except tax rates)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Income tax computed at applicable statutory rates

 

586

 

578

 

1.4

%

Revaluation of deferred income tax liability to reflect income tax rates

 

 

28

 

n/m

 

Adjustments recognized in the current period for income taxes of prior periods

 

(6

)

(4

)

50.0

%

Other

 

(28

)

(12

)

133.3

%

Income taxes

 

552

 

590

 

(6.4

)%

Income taxes computed at applicable statutory rates (%)

 

27.0

 

26.7

 

0.3

pts.

Effective tax rate (%)

 

25.4

 

27.2

 

(1.8

)pts.

 

Total income tax expense decreased by $38 million in 2018. The effective tax rate decreased to 25.4% for the year, primarily due to a requirement to revalue the deferred tax liability for higher legislated tax rates in the fourth quarter of 2017, as well as the lower capital gain rate on the TELUS Garden sale.

 

 

Comprehensive income

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Net income

 

1,624

 

1,578

 

2.9

%

Other comprehensive income (net of income taxes):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Items that may be subsequently reclassified to income

 

(48

)

24

 

n/m

 

Items never subsequently reclassified to income

 

332

 

(184

)

n/m

 

Comprehensive income

 

1,908

 

1,418

 

34.6

%

 

Comprehensive income increased by $490 million in 2018, primarily as a result of changes in employee defined benefit plan re-measurement amounts largely arising from increases in the reference discount rate. Items that may be subsequently reclassified to income are composed of changes in the unrealized fair value of derivatives designated as cash flow hedges and foreign currency translation adjustments arising from translating financial statements of foreign operations. Items never subsequently reclassified to income are composed of changes in the measurement of investment financial assets and employee defined benefit plans re-measurement amounts.

 

5.4 Wireless segment

 

Postpaid subscribers
2018 : 8,311,000 +4.2%
2017: 7,978,000

 

Prepaid subscribers
2018 : 924,000 (1.0)%
2017: 933,000

 

Blended ABPU
2018 : $67.30 +0.4%
2017: $67.05

 

Postpaid churn rate
2018 : 0.89% (0.01) pts.
2017: 0.90%

 

Wireless trends and seasonality

 

The historical trend over the last eight quarters in wireless network revenue reflects growth in our subscriber base, as well as higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units. There has been a general year-over-year increase in equipment revenues from a higher volume of new postpaid contracts and higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units. The general trend of year-over-year increases in subscriber net additions resulted from the success of our promotions for prepaid subscribers; the effects of market

 

 

36


 

growth arising from a growing population, changing population demographics and an increasing number of customers with multiple devices; marketing efforts focused on higher-value postpaid loading; and continuous improvements in the speed and quality of our network, combined with our improved churn rate, which reflected our focus on executing customers first initiatives. Our expenditures on network improvements increase capacity and coverage, allowing us to grow revenue through net additions of wireless subscribers. Although there have historically been significant third and fourth quarter seasonal effects that result in increased loading, competitive intensity in both the consumer and business markets and launches of new devices may impact subscriber addition results and trends for future periods.

 

Wireless ABPU growth has been moderating, primarily due to two offsetting factors: (i) competitive pressures driving larger allotments of data and rate plans encompassing data sharing and international roaming features, as well as the consumer behavioural response to more frequent customer data usage notifications and offloading of data traffic to increasingly available Wi-Fi hotspots; and (ii) an increased mix of higher-priced rate plans, such as data share plans, in addition to more higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units, and an increased proportion of higher-value postpaid customers in the subscriber mix in 2018. As a result of increased competitive pressures, customers have been able to gain access to higher network speeds and larger allotments of data included for a given price point, further limiting ABPU expansion. The economic environment, consumer behaviour, the regulatory environment, device selection and other factors also impact ABPU, and as a consequence, there cannot be assurance that ABPU will return to growth in the coming quarters.

 

The trend of our comparatively low postpaid and blended churn rates reflects our customers first efforts, our retention programs and our focus on building and maintaining our high-quality network. We may experience pressure on our postpaid churn rate if the level of competitive intensity increases, in part due to increased promotional activity, if there is an increase in customers on expired or no contracts, or due to regulatory changes. Accordingly, our wireless segment historical operating results and trends may not be reflective of results and trends for future periods.

 

The effects of implementation of IFRS 15 are most pronounced in our wireless results. Although the measurement of the total revenue recognized over the life of a contract is largely unaffected by the new standard, the effect of IFRS 15 implementation generally accelerates the recognition of contract revenue relative to the associated cash inflows, which are unchanged. While the underlying transaction economics do not differ, during periods of sustained growth in the number of wireless subscriber contract additions (assuming comparable contract-lifetime per unit cash inflows), revenues under IFRS 15 would appear to be greater than would have been the case prior to IFRS 15. With respect to costs, the measurement of the total costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment over the life of a contract is unaffected by the new standard, but the timing of recognition is affected. The new standard results in our costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment, to the extent that they are material, being capitalized and subsequently recognized as an expense over the life of a contract on a rational, systematic basis consistent with the pattern of the transfer of goods or services to which the asset relates. Although the underlying transaction economics would not differ, during periods of sustained growth in the number of customer connection additions, assuming comparable per unit costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment, absolute profitability measures would appear to be greater than under the previous practice (immediate expensing of such costs). We will be implementing IFRS 16 on January 1, 2019, the effects of which will be more pronounced in our wireless results due to the relative prevalence of lease-in activity in the wireless business, and will impact trends in wireless EBITDA-based operating metrics; however, implementation will not have any impact on economics or cash flows. (See Section 8.2 Accounting policy developments for additional details.)

 

 

37


 

Wireless operating indicators

 

At December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

Subscribers 1  (000s):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Postpaid

 

8,311

 

7,978

 

4.2

%

Prepaid

 

924

 

933

 

(1.0

)%

Total

 

9,235

 

8,911

 

3.6

%

Postpaid proportion of subscriber base (%)

 

90.0

 

89.5

 

0.5

pts.

HSPA+ population coverage 2  (millions)

 

37.0

 

36.7

 

0.8

%

LTE population coverage 2  (millions)

 

36.9

 

36.6

 

0.8

%

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

 

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Subscriber gross additions 1  (000s):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Postpaid

 

1,150

 

1,140

 

0.9

%

Prepaid

 

366

 

320

 

14.4

%

Total

 

1,516

 

1,460

 

3.8

%

Subscriber net additions 1  (000s):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Postpaid

 

356

 

379

 

(6.1

)%

Prepaid

 

(9

)

(83

)

n/m

 

Total

 

347

 

296

 

17.2

%

ABPU, per month 1,3  ($)

 

67.30

 

67.05

 

0.4

%

ARPU, per month 1,3  ($)

 

56.08

 

56.55

 

(0.8

)%

Churn, per month 1,2  (%)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Blended

 

1.08

 

1.11

 

(0.03

)pts.

Postpaid

 

0.89

 

0.90

 

(0.01

)pts.

 


(1)               Q4 2018 opening postpaid and total subscribers, as well as associated Q4 2018 operating statistics (ARPU, ABPU and churn), have been adjusted to exclude an estimated 23,000 subscribers impacted by the CRTC’s final pro-rating ruling in June 2018, which was effective October 1, 2018.

 

(2)               Including network access agreements with other Canadian carriers.

 

(3)               See Section 11.2 Operating indicators . These are industry measures useful in assessing operating performance of a wireless company, but are not measures defined under IFRS-IASB.

 

Operating revenues — Wireless segment

 

Years ended December 31

 

 2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Network revenue

 

6,025

 

5,867

 

2.7

%

Equipment and other service revenues

 

1,992

 

1,768

 

12.7

%

Revenues arising from contracts with customers

 

8,017

 

7,635

 

5.0

%

Other operating income 1

 

118

 

36

 

n/m

 

External operating revenues

 

8,135

 

7,671

 

6.0

%

Intersegment revenues

 

47

 

43

 

9.3

%

Wireless operating revenues

 

8,182

 

7,714

 

6.1

%

 


(1)               Includes equity income related to real estate joint ventures allocated to the wireless segment of $85 million (50% of the total of $171 million) arising from the sale of TELUS Garden recorded in the third quarter of 2018.

 

Total wireless operating revenues increased by $158 million in 2018.

 

 

Network revenue from external customers increased by $158 million in 2018 or 2.7%, reflecting: (i) growth in the subscriber base; and (ii) a larger proportion of customers selecting higher-priced rate plans with larger data buckets or

 

 

38


 

periodically topping up their data buckets. These were partly offset by declining chargeable data usage and the competitive environment putting pressure on base rate plan prices in the current and prior periods. Monthly ABPU was $67.30 in 2018, reflecting an increase of $0.25 or 0.4%, as growth from customers selecting plans with larger data buckets, the introduction of our Platinum rate plan and more higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units was partly offset by declines in chargeable data usage and the competitive pressures on base rate plan prices mentioned above. Monthly ARPU was $56.08 in 2018, reflecting a decrease of $0.47 or 0.8% due to the declines in chargeable data usage and competitive pressures on base rate plan prices mentioned above.

 

·                   Gross subscriber additions were 1,516,000 in 2018, reflecting an increase of 56,000. Postpaid gross additions increased by 10,000 in 2018 due to the success of our promotions and marketing efforts focused on higher-value postpaid and smartphone loading, as well as demographic shifts, and growth, in the Canadian population, partly offset by the non-recurrence of an aggressive holiday rate plan offer that stimulated significant traffic in the prior year. Prepaid gross activations increased by 46,000 in 2018, mainly as a result of successful promotions and expanded prepaid channels.

 

·                   Our postpaid churn rate was 0.89% in 2018, as compared to 0.90% in 2017. The comparatively low postpaid churn rate during 2018 reflects our focus on executing customers first initiatives and retention programs and our leading network quality, partly offset by incremental deactivations from competitive intensity. Our blended churn rate was 1.08% in 2018, as compared to 1.11% in 2017. The improvement in our blended churn rate reflects aforementioned improvements in postpaid churn rates and improvements in prepaid churn rates, as well as an increase in the mix of postpaid subscribers compared to prepaid subscribers in our subscriber base.

 

·                   Net subscriber additions reflect postpaid net additions of 356,000 in 2018, compared to 379,000 in 2017. The decline is attributed to higher numbers of deactivations associated with a larger subscriber base, partly offset by higher numbers of gross additions. In 2018, our prepaid subscriber base decreased by 9,000, as compared to a decrease of 83,000 in 2017. Total net subscriber additions were 347,000 in 2018, reflecting a year-over-year improvement of 51,000 compared to 2017.

 

Equipment and other service revenues increased by $224 million in 2018, due to more higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units, growth in revenue per handset and a higher volume of new postpaid contracts. With the implementation of IFRS 15, equipment revenues are allocated a much larger portion of bundle revenues, particularly for our wireless segment, as, in contrast to the accounting principles that were superseded, IFRS 15 does not constrain the measurement of equipment revenue in bundled arrangements to amounts that are received at the time of activation of handsets. The measurement of equipment revenue and service revenue is determined by allocating the minimum transaction price (the “minimum spend” amount required in a contract with a customer) based upon the stand-alone selling prices of the contracted equipment and services included in the minimum transaction price. For clarity, the application of IFRS 15 does not affect our cash flows from operations or the underlying economics of our relationships with customers. See Note 1(e) and Note 2(a), (c)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Other operating income increased by $82 million in 2018, mainly due to the third quarter of 2018 equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, as noted in Section 1.3 , of which 50% of the total of $171 million was allocated to each of the wireless and wireline segments. Excluding the effect of the equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, the change in Other operating income decreased by $3 million in 2018, mainly due to the non-recurrence of the 2017 MTS contingent consideration recovery, partly offset by higher net gains from the sale of property, plant and equipment.

 

Intersegment revenues represent network services that are eliminated upon consolidation along with the associated wireline expenses.

 

Operating expenses — Wireless segment

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equipment sales expenses

 

1,960

 

1,805

 

8.6

%

Network operating expenses

 

841

 

826

 

1.8

%

Marketing expenses

 

393

 

373

 

5.4

%

Other 1,2

 

867

 

806

 

7.6

%

Employee benefits expense 1

 

690

 

654

 

5.5

%

Wireless operating expenses

 

4,751

 

4,464

 

6.4

%

 


(1)               Includes restructuring and other costs. See Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .

 

(2)               Includes a donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation allocated to the wireless segment of $59 million (50% of the total of $118 million) recorded in other costs in the third quarter of 2018.

 

 

39


 

Wireless operating expenses increased by $287 million in 2018.

 

Equipment sales expenses increased by $155 million in 2018, reflecting an increase in higher-value smartphones in the sales mix of gross additions and retention units, and an increase in new postpaid contracts.

 

Network operating expenses increased by $15 million in 2018, mainly due to increased roaming expenses.

 

Marketing expenses increased by $20 million in 2018, primarily due to higher commissions and higher advertising spend.

 

Other goods and services purchased increased by $61 million in 2018, mainly due to the third quarter of 2018 donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation, as noted in Section 1.3 , of which 50% of the total of $118 million was allocated to each of the wireless and wireline segments. Excluding the effect of the donation, Other goods and services purchased increased by $2 million in 2018, mainly due to higher administrative costs supporting the larger customer base, partly offset by the non-recurrence of 2017 customer support costs related to acquired MTS subscribers.

 

Employee benefits expense increased by $36 million in 2018, primarily due to higher labour-related restructuring costs related to efficiency initiatives, partly offset by higher capitalized labour costs and lower FTEs.

 

EBITDA — Wireless segment

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions, except margins)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

EBITDA

 

3,431

 

3,250

 

5.5

%

Add back restructuring and other costs included in EBITDA 1

 

115

 

57

 

n/m

 

Deduct non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures 2

 

(85

)

 

n/m

 

Deduct MTS net recovery

 

 

(21

)

n/m

 

Adjusted EBITDA 3

 

3,461

 

3,286

 

5.3

%

EBITDA margin (%)

 

41.9

 

42.1

 

(0.2

)pts.

Adjusted EBITDA margin 4  (%)

 

42.7

 

42.7

 

pts.

 


(1)          Includes a donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation allocated to the wireless segment of $59 million (50% of the total of $118 million) recorded in other costs in the third quarter of 2018.

 

(2)          Includes equity income related to real estate joint ventures allocated to the wireless segment of $85 million (50% of the total of $171 million) arising from the sale of TELUS Garden recorded in the third quarter of 2018.

 

(3)          See description under EBITDA in Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .

 

(4)          Adjusted EBITDA margin is Adjusted EBITDA divided by Operating revenues, where the calculation of Operating revenues excludes non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, and for 2017, excludes the MTS net recovery.

 

Wireless EBITDA increased by $181 million or 5.5% in 2018. Wireless Adjusted EBITDA increased by $175 million or 5.3% in 2018, reflecting higher equipment margins and network revenue growth driven by a larger customer base, partly offset by higher administrative costs and increased customer support costs due to growth in the subscriber base, as well as increased network operating expenses.

 

 

5.5 Wireline segment

 

High-speed Internet subscriber net additions

2018 : 115,000

2017:  81,000

 

TELUS TV subscriber net additions

2018 : 63,000

2017: 35,000

 

Residential NAL net losses

2018 : (51,000)

2017: (76,000)

 

Total wireline subscriber net additions

2018 : 127,000

2017: 40,000

 

Wireline trends

 

The trend over the last eight quarters of increases in wireline service revenue reflects growth in high-speed Internet and enhanced data services, CCBS revenues, TELUS TV revenues, TELUS Health revenues, and home and business security revenues, and is partly offset by declining wireline voice revenues and equipment revenues. The increases in Internet and TV service revenues are being generated by subscriber growth and higher Internet revenue per customer resulting from upgrades to faster speeds, larger data usage rate plans and expansion of our fibre footprint. We expect

 

 

40


 

continued high-speed Internet subscriber base growth as the economy grows and as we continue our investments in expanding our fibre-optic infrastructure. The total number of TELUS TV subscribers has increased as a result of our lower customer churn rate and diverse product offerings. Residential network access line (NAL) losses continue to reflect the ongoing trend of substitution to wireless and Internet-based services, but have been partly mitigated by the success of our bundled service offerings. The trend of declining wireline voice revenues is due to technological substitution, greater use of inclusive long distance coupled with lower long distance minutes used, and intensification of competition in the small and medium-sized business market. The general trend of increasing TELUS Health revenues has been driven by both organic growth and business acquisitions. The migration of business products and services offerings to IP services yield inherently lower margins compared to some legacy business products and service offerings. We expect the rate of growth of CCBS revenues to increase as a result of business acquisition growth and a recovery of organic growth.

 

The trends in wireline EBITDA-based operating metrics will be impacted by our adoption of IFRS 16, as discussed further in Section 8.2 Accounting policy developments .

 

Wireline operating indicators

 

At December 31 (000s)

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

Subscriber connections:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

High-speed Internet subscribers

 

1,858

 

1,743

 

6.6

%

TELUS TV subscribers 1

 

1,093

 

1,098

 

(0.5

)%

Residential NALs

 

1,248

 

1,298

 

(3.9

)%

Total wireline subscriber connections 1

 

4,199

 

4,139

 

1.4

%

 

Years ended December 31 (000s)

 

2018

 

2017 

 

Change

 

Subscriber connection net additions (losses):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

High-speed Internet

 

115

 

81

 

42.0

%

TELUS TV

 

63

 

35

 

80.0

%

Residential NALs

 

(51

)

(76

)

32.9

%

Total wireline subscriber connection net additions

 

127

 

40

 

n/m

 

 


(1)                    Effective April 1, 2018, and on a prospective basis, we have adjusted cumulative subscriber connections to remove approximately 68,000 TELUS TV subscribers as we have ceased marketing our Satellite TV product. Excluding the impacts of this adjustment, total TELUS TV subscriber connections would have increased by 4.8%.

 

Operating revenues — Wireline segment

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Data services

 

4,588

 

4,076

 

12.6

%

Voice services

 

1,084

 

1,216

 

(10.9

)%

Other services and equipment

 

406

 

378

 

7.4

%

Revenues arising from contracts with customers

 

6,078

 

5,670

 

7.2

%

Other operating income 1

 

155

 

67

 

n/m

 

External operating revenues

 

6,233

 

5,737

 

8.6

%

Intersegment revenues

 

207

 

206

 

0.5

%

Wireline operating revenues

 

6,440

 

5,943

 

8.4

%

 


(1)                    Includes equity income related to real estate joint ventures allocated to the wireline segment of $86 million (50% of the total of $171 million) arising from the sale of TELUS Garden recorded in the third quarter of 2018.

 

Total wireline operating revenues increased by $497 million in 2018.

 

 

 

41


 

·                   Data services revenues increased by $512 million in 2018. The increase was primarily due to: (i) growth in CCBS revenues, primarily due to growth in business volumes resulting from both business acquisitions and organic growth; (ii) increased Internet and enhanced data service revenues, reflecting higher revenue per customer as a result of upgrades to faster Internet speeds, larger data usage Internet rate plans and certain rate changes, as well as a 6.6% increase in our high-speed Internet subscribers over the last 12 months; (iii) increased TELUS Health revenues, driven by both business acquisitions and organic growth; (iv) revenues from our home and business security lines of business; and (v) increased TELUS TV revenues, reflecting subscriber growth of 4.8% over the last 12 months, excluding the Satellite TV subscriber adjustment. This growth was partly offset by the ongoing decline in legacy data services.

 

·                   Voice services revenues decreased by $132 million in 2018, reflecting the ongoing decline in legacy revenues from technological substitution, greater use of inclusive long distance plans and price plan changes. We experienced a 3.9% decline in residential NALs in 2018, as compared to a 5.5% decline in residential NALs in 2017.

 

·                   Other services and equipment revenues increased by $28 million in 2018, mainly due to higher data and voice equipment sales.

 

·                   Wireline subscriber connection net additions were 127,000 in 2018, reflecting an increase of 87,000.

 

·                   Net additions of high-speed Internet subscribers were 115,000 in 2018, reflecting an increase of 34,000 driven by increased customer demand for our high-speed broadband services, including fibre to the premises, as well as improved churn reflecting our focus on executing customers first initiatives and retention programs. Our continued focus on connecting more homes and businesses directly to fibre (with TELUS PureFibre available to 61% of our broadband footprint at the end of 2018), expanding and enhancing our addressable high-speed Internet and Optik TV footprint, and bundling these services together contributed to combined Internet and TV subscriber growth of 110,000 over the last 12 months.

 

·                   Net additions of TELUS TV subscribers were 63,000 in 2018, reflecting an increase of 28,000 due to a lower customer churn rate from stronger retention efforts and higher gross additions in response to our diverse product offerings.

 

·                   Residential NAL losses were 51,000 in 2018, as compared to NAL losses of 76,000 in 2017. The residential NAL losses continue to reflect the trend of substitution to wireless and Internet-based services, partially mitigated by the success of our stronger retention efforts.

 

Other operating income increased by $88 million in 2018, mainly due to the third quarter of 2018 equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, as noted in Section 1.3 , of which 50% of the total of $171 million was allocated to each of the wireless and wireline segments. Excluding the effect of the equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, Other operating income increased by $3 million in 2018 due to gains on the sale of certain assets, partly offset by a decrease in amounts recognized from the regulatory price cap deferral account for the provisioning of broadband Internet services to eligible rural and remote communities.

 

Intersegment revenues represent services including CCBS provided to the wireless segment. Such revenue is eliminated upon consolidation together with the associated expenses in wireless.

 

Operating expenses — Wireline segment

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Goods and services purchased 1,2

 

2,561

 

2,343

 

9.3

%

Employee benefits expense 1

 

2,206

 

1,940

 

13.7

%

Wireline operating expenses

 

4,767

 

4,283

 

11.3

%

 


(1)                    Includes restructuring and other costs. See Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures.

 

(2)                    Includes a donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation allocated to the wireline segment of $59 million (50% of the total of $118 million) recorded in other costs in the third quarter of 2018.

 

Total wireline operating expenses increased by $484 million in 2018.

 

Goods and services purchased increased by $218 million in 2018, primarily due to the third quarter of 2018 donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation, as noted in Section 1.3 , of which 50% of the total of $118 million was allocated to each of the wireless and wireline segments. Excluding the effect of the donation, Goods and services purchased increased by $159 million in 2018, mainly due to higher product costs associated with equipment sales and TELUS Health services, higher TV content costs mainly driven by our growing TV subscriber base (excluding the Satellite TV subscriber adjustment), and increases in external labour, employee-related and other costs related to business acquisitions.

 

 

42


 

Employee benefits expense increased by $266 million in 2018, mainly due to increases in compensation and benefit costs resulting from an increase in the number of employees from business acquisitions and higher labour-related restructuring costs related to efficiency initiatives in the year. These increases were partly offset by a decrease in the number of domestic FTEs, excluding business acquisitions, and higher capitalized labour costs, including contract acquisition and fulfilment costs.

 

EBITDA — Wireline segment

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ in millions, except margins)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

EBITDA

 

1,673

 

1,660

 

0.8

%

Add back restructuring and other costs included in EBITDA 1

 

202

 

60

 

n/m

 

Deduct non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures 2

 

(86

)

(1

)

n/m

 

Adjusted EBITDA 3

 

1,789

 

1,719

 

4.1

%

EBITDA margin (%)

 

26.0

 

27.9

 

(1.9

)pts.

Adjusted EBITDA margin 4  (%)

 

28.2

 

28.9

 

(0.7

)pts.

 


(1)          Includes a donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation allocated to the wireline segment of $59 million (50% of the total of $118 million) recorded in other costs in the third quarter of 2018.

 

(2)          Includes equity income related to real estate joint ventures allocated to the wireline segment of $86 million (50% of the total of $171 million) arising from the sale of TELUS Garden recorded in the third quarter of 2018.

 

(3)          See description under EBITDA in Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .

 

(4)          Adjusted EBITDA margin is Adjusted EBITDA divided by Operating revenues, where the calculation of Operating revenues excludes non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures.

 

Wireline EBITDA increased by $13 million or 0.8% in 2018. Wireline Adjusted EBITDA increased by $70 million or 4.1% in 2018, reflecting an increased contribution from our CCBS business arising primarily from business acquisitions, higher Internet and TELUS Health margins, and higher margins in other services and equipment, partly offset by the continued declines in legacy voice services and a decline in the EBITDA contribution from our business services.

 

 

 

43


 

6.               Changes in financial position

 

 

 

December 31

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

Financial position at:

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15 (2017 adjusted)

 

Change

 

Change includes:

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

414

 

509

 

(95

)

See Section 7 Liquidity and capital resources

 

Accounts receivable

 

1,600

 

1,614

 

(14

)

A decrease in roaming revenue accruals, as well as receipt of vendor credits and a 2017 refund for MTS subscribers not migrated to TELUS, partly offset by an increase in sales and subscriber growth

 

Income and other taxes receivable

 

3

 

96

 

(93

)

Refunds received, as well as Income and other taxes payable for the current year, which more than offset Income and other taxes receivable for prior years

 

Inventories

 

376

 

380

 

(4

)

A decrease in volume of handsets, partly offset by a higher cost mix of smartphones

 

Contract assets

 

860

 

757

 

103

 

An increase primarily driven by a higher number of contracted subscribers, as well as higher contract amounts per subscriber, in the period

 

Prepaid expenses

 

539

 

493

 

46

 

An increase in costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract with a customer

 

Current derivative assets

 

49

 

18

 

31

 

An increase in the nominal amounts of U.S. currency hedging items and a favourable change in the spread between the hedging rate and the actual rate at the balance sheet date.

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Short-term borrowings

 

100

 

100

 

 

See Section 7.7 Sale of trade receivables

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 

2,570

 

2,460

 

110

 

An increase in network-related accruals and payroll and other employee-related liabilities, partly offset by the timing of accounts payable and wireless handset purchases. See Note 23 of the Consolidated financial statements

 

Income and other taxes payable

 

218

 

34

 

184

 

Current income tax expense in excess of instalments

 

Dividends payable

 

326

 

299

 

27

 

Effects of an increase in the dividend rate, as well as an increase in the number of shares outstanding

 

Advance billings and customer deposits

 

653

 

632

 

21

 

An increase in advance billings reflecting increased wireless subscriber growth during the year. See Note 24 of the Consolidated financial statements

 

Provisions

 

129

 

78

 

51

 

New restructuring provisions exceeded restructuring disbursements. See Note 25 of the Consolidated financial statements

 

Current maturities of long-term debt

 

836

 

1,404

 

(568

)

A decrease in outstanding commercial paper and maturation of $250 of our 1.50% Notes, Series CS in March 2018

 

Current derivative liabilities

 

9

 

33

 

(24

)

A decrease in the nominal amounts of U.S. currency hedging items.

 

Working capital

(Current assets subtracting Current liabilities)

 

(1,000

)

(1,173

)

173

 

TELUS normally has a negative working capital position. See Financing and capital structure management plans in Section 4.3 and the Liquidity risk discussion in Section 7.9.

 

 

 

44


 

 

 

December 31

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2018

 

2017

 

 

 

 

 

Financial position at:

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15 (2017 adjusted)

 

Change

 

Change includes:

 

Non-current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

12,091

 

11,368

 

723

 

See Capital expenditures in Section 7.3 Cash used by investing activities and Depreciation in Section 5.3

 

Intangible assets, net

 

10,956

 

10,658

 

298

 

See Capital expenditures in Section 7.3 Cash used by investing activities and Amortization of intangible assets in Section 5.3

 

Goodwill, net

 

4,733

 

4,236

 

497

 

Acquisitions including Xavient Information Systems, Medisys Health Group Inc., and home and business security companies

 

Contract assets

 

458

 

396

 

62

 

An increase primarily driven by a higher number of contracted subscribers, as well as higher contract amounts per subscriber, in the period

 

Other long-term assets

 

986

 

528

 

458

 

An increase in pension assets resulting from actuarial gains primarily arising from financial assumption changes in the pension plans, as well as an increase in the nominal amounts of U.S. currency hedging items, a favourable change in the spread between the hedging rate and the actual rate at the balance sheet date, and a net increase in investments. See Note 20 of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

728

 

511

 

217

 

An increase due to written put options in connection with a business acquisition in respect of non-controlling interests. See Note 25 of the Consolidated financial statements

 

Long-term debt

 

13,265

 

12,256

 

1,009

 

See Section 7.4 Cash used by financing activities

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

738

 

847

 

(109

)

A decrease in pension and post-retirement liabilities resulting from actuarial gains primarily arising from financial assumption changes in the pension plans, as well as a decrease in the nominal amounts of U.S. currency hedging items and a favourable change in the spread between the hedging rate and the actual rate at the balance sheet date. See Note 27 of the Consolidated financial statements

 

Deferred income taxes

 

3,152

 

2,941

 

211

 

An increase in temporary differences between the accounting and tax basis of assets and liabilities, including employee benefit plan re-measurements recorded in Other comprehensive income.

 

Owners’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common equity

 

10,259

 

9,416

 

843

 

See Consolidated statements of changes in owners’ equity in the Consolidated financial statements

 

Non-controlling interests

 

82

 

42

 

40

 

See Consolidated statements of changes in owners’ equity in the Consolidated financial statements.

 

 

7.               Liquidity and capital resources

 

This section contains forward-looking statements, including those with respect to our dividend payout ratio and net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio. See Caution regarding forward-looking statements at the beginning of this MD&A.

 

7.1 Overview

 

Our capital structure financial policies and financing and capital structure management plans are described in Section 4.3 .

 

Cash flows

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Cash provided by operating activities

 

4,058

 

3,947

 

111

 

Cash used by investing activities

 

(2,977

)

(3,643

)

666

 

Cash used by financing activities

 

(1,176

)

(227

)

(949

)

Increase (decrease) in Cash and temporary investments, net

 

(95

)

77

 

(172

)

Cash and temporary investments, net, beginning of period

 

509

 

432

 

77

 

Cash and temporary investments, net, end of period

 

414

 

509

 

(95

)

 

 

45


o Table of Contents

 

7.2 Cash provided by operating activities

 

Analysis of changes in cash provided by operating activities

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

EBITDA (see Section 5.4 and Section 5.5 )

 

5,104

 

4,910

 

194

 

Restructuring and other costs, net of disbursements and Shares settled from Treasury

 

178

 

(21

)

199

 

Employee defined benefit plans expense, net of employer contributions

 

42

 

15

 

27

 

Share-based compensation expense, net of payments

 

6

 

17

 

(11

)

Interest paid, net of interest received

 

(606

)

(532

)

(74

)

Income taxes paid, net of recoveries received

 

(197

)

(191

)

(6

)

Other operating working capital changes

 

(469

)

(251

)

(218

)

Cash provided by operating activities

 

4,058

 

3,947

 

111

 

 

·                   Restructuring and other costs, net of disbursements and Shares settled from Treasury represented a net change of $199 million in 2018. This was largely attributed to our donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation, as noted in Section 1.3 , in addition to an increase in restructuring and other costs expense not yet disbursed related to improving our overall cost structure and operational effectiveness.

 

·                   Interest paid, net of interest received increased by $74 million, largely due to the long-term debt prepayment premium described in Section 5.3 , in addition to an increase in the average long-term debt balance, along with a higher average effective interest rate in 2018.

 

·                   For a discussion of Other operating working capital changes, see Section 6 Changes in financial position and Note 31(a)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

 

7.3 Cash used by investing activities

 

Analysis of changes in cash used by investing activities

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences

 

(2,874

)

(3,081

)

207

 

Cash payments for spectrum licences

 

(1

)

 

(1

)

Cash payments for acquisitions, net

 

(280

)

(564

)

284

 

Real estate joint ventures receipts, net of advances (advances, net of receipts)

 

162

 

(8

)

170

 

Proceeds on dispositions and Other

 

16

 

10

 

6

 

Cash used by investing activities

 

(2,977

)

(3,643

)

666

 

 

·                   The decrease in Cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences for 2018 was primarily composed of:

 

·                   A decrease in capital expenditures of $180 million in 2018 (see Capital expenditure measures table and discussion below).

 

·                   Lower capital expenditure payments with respect to payment timing differences, as the change in associated Accounts payable and accrued liabilities increased by $74 million in 2018.

 

·                   In 2018, we made cash payments for business acquisitions, including Medisys Health Group Inc., home and business security-related acquisitions including certain assets of AlarmForce Industries Inc., 65% of Xavient Information Systems (Xavient) and other individually immaterial acquisitions complementary to our existing lines of business. This is compared to business acquisition activity in 2017, which included 55% of Voxpro Limited, certain assets of Manitoba Telecom Services Inc. and the Kroll Computer Systems Inc. transaction.

 

·                   Real estate joint ventures receipts, net of advances increased by $170 million in 2018, attributed to funds repaid to us and earnings distributed from the TELUS Garden real estate joint venture arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, as noted in Section 1.3 .

 

 

46


Table of Contents

 

 

Capital expenditure measures

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ millions, except capital intensity)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Capital expenditures 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless segment

 

896

 

978

 

(8.4

)%

Wireline segment

 

2,018

 

2,116

 

(4.6

)%

Consolidated

 

2,914

 

3,094

 

(5.8

)%

Wireless segment capital intensity (%)

 

11

 

13

 

(2

)pts.

Wireline segment capital intensity (%)

 

31

 

36

 

(5

)pts.

Consolidated capital intensity 2 (%)

 

20

 

23

 

(3

)pts.

 


(1)               Capital expenditures include assets purchased but not yet paid for, and therefore differ from Cash payments for capital assets, excluding spectrum licences, as presented on the Consolidated statements of cash flows.

 

( 2)               See Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures .

 

Wireless segment capital expenditures decreased by $82 million in 2018, as we incurred costs in 2017 to update our radio access network technology in Ontario and Quebec, which was completed in the second quarter of 2017.

 

Wireline segment capital expenditures decreased by $98 million in 2018, primarily reflecting the planned reduction in our capital spend. We continued connecting additional homes and businesses directly to our fibre-optic technology and our investments support systems reliability and operational efficiency and effectiveness. These investments support our high-speed Internet and TELUS TV subscriber growth, as well as our customers’ demand for faster Internet speeds, and extend the reach and functionality of our business and healthcare solutions. At December 31, 2018, we made TELUS PureFibre available to 61% of our broadband footprint.

 

7.4 Cash used by financing activities

 

Analysis of changes in cash used by financing activities

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Dividends paid to holders of Common Shares

 

(1,141

)

(1,082

)

(59

)

Treasury shares acquired

 

(100

)

 

(100

)

Repayment of short-term borrowings, net

 

(67

)

 

(67

)

Long-term debt issued, net of redemptions and repayment

 

123

 

865

 

(742

)

Issue of shares by subsidiary to non-controlling interests

 

24

 

(1

)

25

 

Other

 

(15

)

(9

)

(6

)

 

 

(1,176

)

(227

)

(949

)

 

Dividends paid to holders of Common Shares

 

In connection with dividends declared during 2018, the dividend reinvestment and share purchase plan trustee (Trustee) purchased shares from Treasury for the dividend reinvestment and share purchase plan instead of acquiring Common Shares in the stock market. During 2018, cash dividends paid to the holders of Common Shares increased by $59 million, which reflects higher dividend rates under our dividend growth program (see Section 4.3 ), as well as an increase in the number of shares outstanding. During 2018, the Trustee purchased dividend reinvestment Common Shares for $85 million, with no discount applicable.

 

In January 2019, we paid dividends of $303 million to the holders of Common Shares and the Trustee purchased dividend reinvestment Common Shares from Treasury for $23 million, totalling $326 million.

 

Treasury shares acquired

 

As noted in Section 1.3 , an initial donation of $100 million to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation was made in TELUS Corporation Common Shares acquired in the market in the third quarter of 2018.

 

 

47


Table of Contents

 

Repayment of short-term borrowings, net

 

In connection with our third quarter of 2018 acquisition of Medisys Health Group Inc., we repaid short-term borrowings of $62 million.

 

Long-term debt issues and repayments

 

For the full year of 2018, long-term debt issues net of repayments were $123 million, a decrease of $742 million, primarily composed of:

 

·                   A net decrease in commercial paper, including foreign exchange effects, of $366 million to a balance of $774 million (US$569 million) at December 31, 2018, from a balance of $1,140 million (US$908 million) at December 31, 2017. Our commercial paper program, when utilized, provides low-cost funds and is fully backstopped by the five-year committed credit facility (see Section 7.6 Credit facilities ).

 

·                   An increase in net draws on the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility, including foreign exchange effects, of $81 million (US$37 million). As at December 31, 2018, net draws were $427 million ($419 million net of unamortized issue costs), all of which were denominated in U.S. dollars (US$313 million). As at December 31, 2017, net draws were $346 million ($339 million net of unamortized issue costs), all of which were denominated in U.S. dollars (US$276 million). The increase in net draws on the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility was used to fund the acquisition of 65% of Xavient. The credit facility is non-recourse to TELUS Corporation.

 

·                   The March 1, 2018, issues of $600 million of senior unsecured Series CX notes at 3.625% due March 1, 2028, and $150 million through the re-opening of Series CW notes at 4.70% due March 6, 2048. For additional information on these notes, refer to Note 26(b)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

·                   The June 2018 issue of US$750 million of senior unsecured 30-year notes at 4.60% due November 16, 2048. We have fully hedged the principal and interest obligations of the notes against fluctuations in the Canadian dollar foreign exchange rate for the entire term of the notes by entering into a foreign exchange derivative (a cross currency interest rate exchange agreement), which effectively converted the principal payments and interest obligations to Canadian dollar obligations with a fixed interest rate of 4.41% and an issued and outstanding amount of $974 million (reflecting a fixed exchange rate of $1.2985).

 

·                   The March 2018 repayment of $250 million of Series CS notes.

 

·                   The August 1, 2018, early full redemption of $1 billion of Series CG notes at 5.05% due December 4, 2019. The long-term debt prepayment premium recorded in the three-month period ended September 30, 2018, was $34 million before income taxes.

 

In comparison, for the full year of 2017, long-term debt issues net of repayments were $865 million and were primarily composed of:

 

·                   A net increase in commercial paper, including foreign exchange effects, of $527 million from a balance of $613 million (US$456 million) at December 31, 2016.

 

·                   An increase in net draws on the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility, including foreign exchange effects, of $6 million (US $23 million). As at December 31, 2016, net draws were $340 million ($332 million net of unamortized issue costs), all of which were denominated in U.S. dollars (US$253 million).

 

·                   The March 2017 issues of US$500 million of senior unsecured notes at 3.70%, due September 15, 2027, and $325 million of senior unsecured notes at 4.70% due March 6, 2048.

 

·                   The March 2017 repayment of $700 million of Series CD Notes.

 

The average term to maturity of our long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases) was approximately 12.2 years as at December 31, 2018, increasing from approximately 10.7 years as at December 31, 2017. Additionally, our weighted average cost of long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases) was 4.18% as at both December 31, 2018, and 2017.

 

 

 

48


Table of Contents

 

Issue of shares by subsidiary to non-controlling interests

 

In connection with our first quarter of 2018 acquisition of 65% of Xavient, our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. subsidiary issued shares to non-controlling interests.

 

7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures

 

Net debt was $13.8 billion at December 31, 2018, an increase of $0.4 billion when compared to one year earlier, resulting mainly from the issuances of the US$750 million of senior unsecured notes, $600 million of Series CX notes and $150 million through the re-opening of Series CW notes as described in Section 7.4 , as well as lower Cash and temporary investments, net. These increases were partially offset by a net reduction of commercial paper outstanding, the repayment of Series CS Notes and the early redemption of Series CG Notes as described in Section 7.4 . The calculation of Net debt will be impacted by the application of IFRS 16, Leases , as described in Section 8.2 and Note 2(b)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Fixed-rate debt as a proportion of total indebtedness was 91% as at December 31, 2018, up from 89% one year earlier, mainly due to a net decrease in commercial paper, which emulates floating-rate debt, as well as the June 2018 note issuance and the two unsecured note issuances in the first quarter of 2018 described in Section 7.4 . This was partly offset by an increase in the amounts drawn on the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility, which is non-recourse to TELUS Corporation, and the early redemption of Series CG Notes.

 

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio was 2.54 times, as measured at December 31, 2018, down from 2.67 times one year earlier, partly attributed to current year equity income related to real estate joint ventures arising from the sale of TELUS Garden. Excluding the equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, the ratio was 2.62 times as at December 31, 2018. Our long-term objective for this measure is within a range of 2.00 to 2.50 times, which we believe is consistent with maintaining investment grade credit ratings in the range of BBB+, or the equivalent, and providing reasonable access to capital. As at December 31, 2018, this ratio remains outside of the long-term objective range due to prior issuances of incremental debt, primarily for the acquisition in 2014 and 2015 of spectrum licences for approximately $3.6 billion and the elevated strategic capital investments in our fibre-optic infrastructure, partially offset by growth in EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs. These acquired licences have more than doubled our national spectrum holdings and represent an investment to extend our network capacity to support continuing data consumption growth, as well as growth in our wireless customer base. Given the cash demands of upcoming spectrum auctions, the assessment of this guideline and return to the objective range remains to be determined; however, it is our intent to return to a ratio below 2.50 times in the medium term, consistent with our long-term strategy. While this ratio exceeds our long-term objective range, we are well in compliance with the leverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities, which states that we may not permit our net debt to operating cash flow ratio to exceed 4.00:1.00 (see Section 7.6 Credit facilities ). The calculation of EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs will be impacted by the application of IFRS 16 as described in Section 8.2 and Note 2(b)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

 

 

49


Table of Contents

 

Liquidity and capital resource measures

 

As at, or years ended, December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

Change

 

Components of debt and coverage ratios 1  ($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and
IFRS 15 (2017 adjusted)

 

 

 

Net debt

 

13,770

 

13,422

 

348

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs

 

5,421

 

5,027

 

394

 

Net interest cost

 

644

 

567

 

77

 

Debt ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fixed-rate debt as a proportion of total indebtedness (%)

 

91

 

89

 

2

pts.

Average term to maturity of long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases) (years)

 

12.2

 

10.7

 

1.5

 

Weighted average interest rate on long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility and finance leases) (%)

 

4.18

 

4.18

 

pts.

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs 1,2  (times)

 

2.54

 

2.67

 

(0.13

)

Coverage ratios 1  (times)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings coverage

 

4.4

 

4.8

 

(0.4

)

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage

 

8.4

 

8.9

 

(0.5

)

Other measures 1  (%)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividend payout ratio

 

78

 

80

 

(2

)pts.

Dividend payout ratio of adjusted net earnings

 

81

 

80

 

1

pt.

 


(1)               See Section 11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures.

 

( 2)               Excluding the third quarter of 2018 equity income related to real estate joint ventures of $171 million arising from the sale of TELUS Garden, the ratio was 2.62 at December 31, 2018.

 

Earnings coverage ratio for 2018 was 4.4 times, down from 4.8 times one year earlier. An increase in income before borrowing costs and income taxes increased the ratio by 0.1, while an increase in borrowing costs reduced the ratio by 0.5.

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage ratio for 2018 was 8.4 times, down from 8.9 times one year earlier. Growth in EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs increased the ratio by 0.6, while an increase in net interest costs reduced the ratio by 1.1.

 

Dividend payout ratios: Actual dividend payout decisions will continue to be subject to our Board’s assessment and the determination of our financial position and outlook, as well as our long-term dividend payout objective range of 65 to 75% of prospective net earnings per share. The disclosed basic and adjusted dividend payout ratios are historical measures utilizing the last four quarters of dividends declared and earnings per share. We currently expect that we will be within our objective range when considered on a prospective dividend payout ratio basis within the medium term. The historical measures for the 12-month period ended December 31, 2018, are presented for illustrative purposes in evaluating our target guideline, and both exceeded the objective range.

 

7.6 Credit facilities

 

At December 31, 2018, we had available liquidity of approximately $1.5 billion from the TELUS revolving credit facility and approximately $205 million of available liquidity from the TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility. In addition, we had $400 million available under our trade receivables securitization program (see Section 7.7 Sale of trade receivables ). We are well within our objective of generally maintaining at least $1.0 billion of available liquidity.

 

TELUS revolving credit facility

 

We have a $2.25 billion (or U.S. dollar equivalent) revolving credit facility with a syndicate of financial institutions, which was renewed in May 2018 and which extended the expiration date from May 31, 2021 to May 31, 2023. The revolving credit facility is used for general corporate purposes, including the backstop of commercial paper, as required.

 

 

50


 

TELUS revolving credit facility at December 31, 2018

 

($ millions)

 

Expiry

 

Size

 

Drawn

 

Outstanding
undrawn
letters of
credit

 

Backstop for
commercial
paper
program

 

Available
liquidity

 

Five-year revolving facility 1

 

May 31, 2021

 

2,250

 

 

 

(774

)

1,476

 

 


(1)          Canadian dollars or U.S. dollar equivalent.

 

Our revolving credit facility contains customary covenants, including a requirement that we not permit our consolidated leverage ratio to exceed 4.00 to 1.00 and that we not permit our consolidated coverage ratio to be less than 2.00 to 1.00 at the end of any financial quarter. As at December 31, 2018, our consolidated leverage ratio was approximately 2.54 to 1.00, and our consolidated coverage ratio was approximately 8.42 to 1.00. These ratios are expected to remain well within the covenants. There are certain minor differences in the calculation of the leverage ratio and coverage ratio under the revolving credit facility, as compared with the calculation of Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs and EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage. Historically, the calculations have not been materially different. The covenants are not impacted by revaluation, if any, of Property, plant and equipment, Intangible assets or Goodwill for accounting purposes. Continued access to our credit facilities is not contingent on maintaining a specific credit rating.

 

Commercial paper

 

TELUS Corporation has an unsecured commercial paper program, which is backstopped by our revolving credit facility, enabling us to issue commercial paper up to a maximum aggregate amount of $1.4 billion as at December 31, 2018, including a U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper program for up to US$1.0 billion within this maximum aggregate amount. Foreign currency forward contracts are used to manage currency risk arising from issuing commercial paper denominated in U.S. dollars. The commercial paper program is to be used for general corporate purposes, including, but not limited to, capital expenditures and investments. Our ability to reasonably access the commercial paper market in Canada and the U.S. is dependent on our credit ratings (see Section 7.8 Credit ratings ).

 

TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility

 

As at December 31, 2018, TELUS International (Cda) Inc. had a bank credit facility, secured by its assets, expiring on December 20, 2022, with a syndicate of financial institutions. The credit facility is composed of a US$350 million (2017 — US$350 million) revolving component and an amortizing US$120 million (2017 — US$120 million) term loan component. The credit facility is non-recourse to TELUS Corporation. As at December 31, 2018, $427 million ($419 million net of unamortized issue costs) was outstanding, all of which was denominated in U.S. dollars (US$313 million), with the revolving component having a weighted average interest rate of 4.22%.

 

Other letter of credit facilities

 

At December 31, 2018, we had $184 million of letters of credit outstanding (2017 — $224 million) issued under various uncommitted facilities; such letter of credit facilities are in addition to the ability to provide letters of credit pursuant to our committed bank credit facility. Available liquidity under various uncommitted letters of credit facilities was $131 million at December 31, 2018. We have arranged incremental letters of credit to allow us to participate in Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada’s 600 MHz wireless spectrum auction that is to be held in March 2019. Under the terms of the auction, communications between bidders that would provide insights into bidding strategies, including reference to preferred blocks, technologies or valuations, are precluded until the deadline for the final payment in the auction. Disclosure of the precise amount of our letters of credit could be interpreted as a signal of bidding intentions. The maximum amount of letters of credit that any individual participant could be required to deliver is approximately $880 million.

 

7.7 Sale of trade receivables

 

TELUS Communications Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of TELUS, is a party to an agreement with an arm’s-length securitization trust associated with a major Schedule I Canadian bank, under which it is able to sell an interest in certain trade receivables for an amount up to a maximum of $500 million. The agreement is in effect until December 31, 2021 (2017 — December 31, 2018), and available liquidity was $400 million as at December 31, 2018. (See Note 22 of the Consolidated financial statements.) Sales of trade receivables in securitization transactions are recognized as collateralized Short-term borrowings and thus do not result in our de-recognition of the trade receivables sold.

 

TELUS Communications Inc. is required to maintain at least a BB credit rating by DBRS Ltd., or the securitization trust may require the sale program to be wound down prior to the end of the term. The necessary credit rating was exceeded as of February 14, 2019.

 

 

51


 

7.8 Credit ratings

 

There were no changes to our investment grade credit ratings during 2018, or as of February 14, 2019. We believe adherence to most of our stated financial policies (see Section 4.3 ), coupled with our efforts to maintain a constructive relationship with banks, investors and credit rating agencies, continues to provide reasonable access to capital markets. (See discussion of risks in Section 10.7 Financing, debt requirements and returning cash to shareholders .)

 

7.9 Financial instruments, commitments and contingent liabilities

 

Financial instruments

 

Our financial instruments, their accounting classification and the nature of certain risks that they may be subject to are set out below and described in Note 4 of the Consolidated financial statements. Our policies in respect of the recognition and measurement of financial instruments are described in Note 1(c)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

 

 

 

 

Risks

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Market risks

 

Financial instrument

 

Accounting classification

 

Credit

 

Liquidity

 

Currency

 

Interest rate

 

Other price

 

Measured at amortized cost

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

AC 1

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

Contract assets

 

AC 1

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction credit facilities advances to real estate joint venture

 

AC 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

Short-term obligations

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

Long-term debt

 

AC 1

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

Measured at fair value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and temporary investments

 

FVTPL 2

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

Long-term investments (not subject to significant influence) 3

 

FVTPL/FVOCI 3

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

Foreign exchange derivatives 4

 

FVTPL 2

 

X

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

Share-based compensation derivatives 4

 

FVTPL 2

 

X

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 


(1)          For accounting recognition and measurement purposes, classified as amortized cost (AC).

 

(2)          For accounting recognition and measurement purposes, classified as fair value through net income (FVTPL). Unrealized changes in the fair values of financial instruments are included in net income unless part of a cash flow hedging relationship. The effective portion of unrealized changes in the fair values of financial instruments held for hedging are included in other comprehensive income.

 

(3)          Long-term investments over which we do not have significant influence are measured at fair value if those fair values can be reliably measured. For accounting recognition and measurement purposes, on an investment-by-investment basis, long-term investments are classified as either fair value through net income or fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI).

 

(4)          Use of derivative financial instruments is subject to a policy which requires that no derivative transaction is to be entered into for the purpose of establishing a speculative or leveraged position (the corollary being that all derivative transactions are to be entered into for risk management purposes only) and sets criteria for the creditworthiness of the transaction counterparties.

 

Derivatives that are part of an established and documented cash flow hedging relationship are accounted for as held for hedging. We believe that classification as held for hedging results in a better matching of the change in the fair value of the derivative financial instrument with the risk exposure being hedged.

 

In respect of hedges of anticipated transactions, hedge gains/losses are included with the expenditure and are expensed when the transaction is recognized in our results of operations. We have selected this method as we believe that it results in a better matching of the hedge gains/losses with the risk exposure being hedged.

 

Derivatives that are not part of a documented cash flow hedging relationship are accounted for as held for trading and thus are measured at fair value through net income.

 

Credit risk

 

Credit risk arises from Cash and temporary investments, Accounts receivable, Contract assets and derivative financial instruments. We mitigate credit risk as follows:

 

·                   Credit risk associated with Cash and temporary investments is managed by ensuring that these financial assets are placed with governments, major financial institutions that have been accorded strong investment grade ratings by a primary rating agency, and/or other creditworthy counterparties. An ongoing review is performed to evaluate changes in the status of counterparties.

 

 

52


 

·                   Credit risk associated with Accounts receivable is inherently managed by the size and diversity of our large customer base, which includes substantially all consumer and business sectors in Canada. We follow a program of credit evaluations of customers and limit the amount of credit extended when deemed necessary. As at December 31, 2018, the weighted average age of past-due customer Accounts receivable was 56 days (2017 — 60 days).

 

We maintain allowances for lifetime expected credit losses related to doubtful accounts. Current economic conditions (including forward-looking macroeconomic data), historical information (including credit agency reports, if available), reasons for the accounts being past-due and line of business from which the customer Accounts receivable arose are all considered when determining whether to make allowances for past-due accounts. The same factors are considered when determining whether to write off amounts charged to the allowance for doubtful accounts against the customer Accounts receivable. The doubtful accounts expense is calculated on a specific-identification basis for customer Accounts receivable above a specific balance threshold and on a statistically derived allowance basis for the remainder. No customer Accounts receivable are written off directly to the doubtful accounts expense.

 

·                   Credit risk associated with Contract assets is inherently managed by the size and diversity of our large customer base, which includes substantially all customer and business sectors in Canada. We follow a program of credit evaluations of customers and limit the amount of credit extended when deemed necessary.

 

We maintain allowances for lifetime expected credit losses related to contract assets. Current economic conditions, historical information (including credit agency reports, if available), and the line of business from which the contract asset arose are all considered when determining impairment allowances. The same factors are considered when determining whether to write off amounts charged to the impairment allowance for contract assets against Contract assets.

 

·                   Counterparties to our share-based compensation cash-settled equity forward agreements and foreign exchange derivatives are major financial institutions that have been accorded investment grade ratings by a primary credit rating agency. The dollar amount of credit exposure under contracts with any one financial institution is limited and counterparties’ credit ratings are monitored. We do not give or receive collateral on swap agreements and hedging items due to our credit rating and those of our counterparties. While we are exposed to the risk of potential credit losses due to the possible non-performance of our counterparties, we consider this risk remote. Our derivative liabilities do not have credit risk-related contingent features.

 

Liquidity risk

 

Liquidity risk is the risk that we may not have cash available to satisfy our financial obligations as they come due. As a component of our capital structure financial policies, discussed in Section 4.3 Liquidity and capital resources , we manage liquidity risk by: maintaining a daily cash pooling process that enables us to manage our available liquidity and our liquidity requirements according to our actual needs; maintaining an agreement to sell trade receivables to an arm’s-length securitization trust; maintaining bilateral bank facilities and syndicated credit facilities; maintaining a commercial paper program; maintaining an in-effect shelf prospectus; continuously monitoring forecast and actual cash flows; and managing maturity profiles of financial assets and financial liabilities.

 

Our debt maturities in future years are as disclosed in the long-term debt principal maturities chart in Section 4.3 . As at December 31, 2018, we had liquidity of more than $1.5 billion available from unutilized credit facilities (see Section 7.6 Credit facilities ) and $400 million available under our trade receivables securitization program (see Section 7.7 Sale of trade receivables ), and we could offer $2.5 billion of debt or equity securities pursuant to a shelf prospectus that is in effect until June 2020. This adheres to our objective of generally maintaining at least $1 billion of available liquidity. We believe that our investment grade credit ratings contribute to reasonable access to capital markets.

 

The expected maturities of our undiscounted financial liabilities do not differ significantly from the contractual maturities, other than as shown in the table in Note 4(c)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Currency risk

 

Our functional currency is the Canadian dollar, but certain routine revenues and operating costs are denominated in U.S. dollars and some inventory purchases and capital asset acquisitions are sourced internationally. The U.S. dollar is the only foreign currency to which we have a significant exposure.

 

Our foreign exchange risk management includes the use of foreign currency forward contracts and currency options to fix the exchange rates on a varying percentage, typically in the range of 50 to 75%, of our domestic short-term U.S. dollar-denominated transactions and commitments and all U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper. Other than in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper, we designate only the spot element of these instruments as the hedging item; the forward element is wholly immaterial; in respect of U.S. dollar-denominated commercial paper, we designate the forward rate.

 

 

53


 

We are also exposed to currency risk in that the fair value or future cash flows of our U.S. Dollar Notes and our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. credit facility U.S. dollar borrowings could fluctuate because of changes in foreign exchange rates. Currency hedging relationships have been established for the related semi-annual interest payments and the principal payment at maturity in respect of the U.S. Dollar Notes; we designate only the spot element of these instruments as the hedging item; the forward element is wholly immaterial. As the functional currency of our TELUS International (Cda) Inc. subsidiary is the U.S. dollar, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates affecting its borrowings are reflected as a foreign currency translation adjustment within other comprehensive income.

 

Interest rate risk

 

Changes in market interest rates will cause fluctuations in the fair values or future cash flows of temporary investments, construction credit facility advances made to the real estate joint ventures, short-term obligations, long-term debt and interest rate swap derivatives.

 

When we have temporary investments, they have short maturities and fixed interest rates and as a result, their fair values will fluctuate with changes in market interest rates; absent monetization prior to maturity, the related future cash flows will not change due to changes in market interest rates.

 

If the balance of short-term investments includes dividend-paying equity instruments, we could be exposed to interest rate risk.

 

Due to the short-term nature of the applicable rates of interest charged, the fair value of the construction credit facility advances made to the real estate joint venture is not materially affected by changes in market interest rates; associated cash flows representing interest payments will be affected until such advances are repaid.

 

As short-term obligations arising from bilateral bank facilities, which typically have variable interest rates, are rarely outstanding for periods that exceed one calendar week, interest rate risk associated with this item is not material.

 

Short-term borrowings arising from the sales of trade receivables to an arm’s-length securitization trust are fixed-rate debt. Due to the short maturities of these borrowings, interest rate risk associated with this item is not material.

 

All of our currently outstanding long-term debt, other than commercial paper and amounts drawn on our credit facilities, is fixed-rate debt (see Section 7.5 ). The fair value of fixed-rate debt fluctuates with changes in market interest rates; absent early redemption, the related future cash flows will not change. Due to the short maturities of commercial paper, its fair value is not materially affected by changes in market interest rates, but the associated cash flows representing interest payments may be affected if the commercial paper is rolled over.

 

Amounts drawn on our short-term and long-term credit facilities will be affected by changes in market interest rates in a manner similar to commercial paper.

 

Other price risk

 

·                   Long-term investments: We are exposed to equity price risk arising from investments classified as fair value through other comprehensive income. Such investments are held for strategic rather than trading purposes.

 

·                   Share-based compensation derivatives: We are exposed to other price risk arising from cash-settled share-based compensation (appreciating Common Share prices increase both the expense and the potential cash outflow). Certain cash-settled equity swap agreements have been entered into that fix the cost associated with our estimate of our restricted stock units which are expected to vest and are not subject to performance conditions (see Note 14(b)  of the Consolidated financial statements).

 

Market risks

 

Net income and Other comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 could have varied if the Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar exchange rate and our Common Share price varied by reasonably possible amounts from their actual statement of financial position date amounts.

 

The sensitivity analysis of our exposure to market risks is shown in Note 4(g)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Fair values — General

 

The carrying values of Cash and temporary investments, Accounts receivable, short-term obligations, Short-term borrowings, Accounts payable and certain provisions (including restructuring provisions) approximate their fair values due to the immediate or short-term maturity of these financial instruments. The fair values are determined directly by reference to quoted market prices in active markets.

 

The fair values of our investment financial assets are based on quoted market prices in active markets or other clear and objective evidence of fair value.

 

 

54


 

The fair value of our Long-term debt is based on quoted market prices in active markets.

 

The fair values of the derivative financial instruments we use to manage our exposure to currency risk are estimated based upon quoted market prices in active markets for the same or similar financial instruments or on the current rates offered to us for financial instruments of the same maturity, as well as discounted future cash flows determined using current rates for similar financial instruments of similar maturities subject to similar risks (such fair value estimates being largely based on the Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar forward exchange rate as at the statement of financial position dates).

 

The fair values of the derivative financial instruments we use to manage our exposure to increases in compensation costs arising from certain forms of share-based compensation are based upon fair value estimates of the related cash-settled equity forward agreements provided by the counterparty to the transactions (such fair value estimates being largely based on our Common Share price as at the statement of financial position dates).

 

The derivative financial instruments that we measure at fair value on a recurring basis subsequent to initial recognition are as set out in Note 4(h)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Fair values — Derivative and non-derivative

 

The derivative financial instruments that we measure at fair value on a recurring basis subsequent to initial recognition, and our Long-term debt, which is measured at amortized cost, and the fair value thereof, are set out in tables in Note 4(h)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Recognition of derivative gains and losses

 

Gains and losses, excluding income tax effects, arising from derivative instruments that are classified as cash flow hedging items, as well as gains and losses arising from derivative instruments that are classified as held for trading and that are not designated as being in a hedging relationship, and their locations within the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income, are detailed in Note 4(i)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

 

55


 

Commitments and contingent liabilities

 

Contractual obligations as at December 31, 2018

 

($ millions)

 

2019

 

2020

 

2021

 

2022

 

2023

 

2024 -
2028

 

Thereafter

 

Total

 

Short-term borrowings

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest obligations

 

3

 

3

 

3

 

 

 

 

 

9

 

Principal obligations 1

 

 

 

100

 

 

 

 

 

100

 

 

 

3

 

3

 

103

 

 

 

 

 

109

 

Long-term debt

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest obligations

 

565

 

559

 

484

 

435

 

386

 

1,439

 

3,446

 

7,314

 

Principal maturities 2

 

784

 

1,008

 

1,083

 

1,651

 

500

 

4,801

 

4,298

 

14,125

 

 

 

1,349

 

1,567

 

1,567

 

2,086

 

886

 

6,240

 

7,744

 

21,439

 

Finance leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest obligations

 

3

 

1

 

 

 

 

 

 

4

 

Principal maturities 2

 

52

 

50

 

 

 

 

 

 

102

 

 

 

55

 

51

 

 

 

 

 

 

106

 

Construction credit facilities commitment 3

 

45

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

45

 

Minimum operating lease payments 3, 4

 

242

 

228

 

201

 

167

 

145

 

408

 

385

 

1,776

 

Occupancy costs 3

 

104

 

101

 

95

 

88

 

83

 

243

 

99

 

813

 

Purchase obligations 5

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenditures

 

499

 

134

 

100

 

70

 

69

 

176

 

9

 

1,057

 

Property, plant and equipment, and Intangible assets

 

178

 

50

 

6

 

2

 

 

 

 

236

 

 

 

677

 

184

 

106

 

72

 

69

 

176

 

9

 

1,293

 

Non-interest bearing financial liabilities

 

2,372

 

251

 

102

 

18

 

19

 

20

 

 

2,782

 

Other obligations

 

(39

)

(5

)

(6

)

(5

)

(6

)

(70

)

(132

)

(263

)

Total

 

4,808

 

2,380

 

2,168

 

2,426

 

1,196

 

7,017

 

8,105

 

28,100

 

 


(1)               See Section 7.7 Sale of trade receivables .

 

(2)               See Long-term debt maturity chart in Section 4.3 .

 

(3)               Construction credit facilities reflect loan amounts for a real estate joint venture, a related party. Minimum operating lease payments and occupancy costs include transactions with real estate joint ventures. See Section 7.11 Transactions between related parties.

 

(4)               Total minimum operating lease payments include approximately 28% in respect of our five largest leases for office premises over various terms, with expiry dates that range between 2024 and 2039 with a weighted average term of approximately 13 years; and approximately 34% in respect of wireless site leases with a weighted average term of approximately 14 years. Total minimum operating lease payments with related party lessor is immaterial. See Note 19 of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

(5)               Where applicable, purchase obligations reflect foreign exchange rates at December 31, 2018. Purchase obligations include future operating and capital expenditures that have been contracted for at the current year-end and include the most likely estimates of prices and volumes, where necessary. As purchase obligations reflect market conditions at the time the obligation was incurred for the items being purchased, they may not be representative of future years. Obligations from personnel supply contracts and other such labour agreements have been excluded.

 

Claims and lawsuits

 

A number of claims and lawsuits (including class actions and intellectual property infringement claims) seeking damages and other relief are pending against us and, in some cases, other wireless carriers and telecommunications service providers. As well, we have received notice of, or are aware of, certain possible claims (including intellectual property infringement claims) against us and, in some cases, other wireless carriers and telecommunications service providers. (See the related risk discussion in Section 10.9 Litigation and legal matters .)

 

It is not currently possible for us to predict the outcome of such claims, possible claims and lawsuits due to various factors, including: the preliminary nature of some claims; uncertain damage theories and demands; an incomplete factual record; uncertainty concerning legal theories and procedures and their resolution by the courts, at both the trial and the appeal levels; and the unpredictable nature of opposing parties and their demands.

 

However, subject to the foregoing limitations, management is of the opinion, based upon legal assessments and information presently available, that it is unlikely that any liability, to the extent not provided for through insurance or otherwise, would have a material effect on our financial position and the results of our operations, including cash flows, with the exception of the items disclosed in Note 29(a)  of the Consolidated financial statements. This is a significant judgment for us (see Section 8.1 Critical accounting estimates and judgments ).

 

 

56


 

Indemnification obligations

 

In the normal course of operations, we provide indemnification in conjunction with certain transactions. The terms of these indemnification obligations range in duration. These indemnifications would require us to compensate the indemnified parties for costs incurred as a result of failure to comply with contractual obligations, or litigation claims or statutory sanctions, or damages that may be suffered by an indemnified party. In some cases, there is no maximum limit on these indemnification obligations. The overall maximum amount of an indemnification obligation will depend on future events and conditions and therefore cannot be reasonably estimated. Where appropriate, an indemnification obligation is recorded as a liability. Other than obligations recorded as liabilities at the time of the related transactions, historically we have not made significant payments under these indemnifications.

 

As at December 31, 2018, we had no liability recorded in respect of our indemnification obligations.

 

7.10 Outstanding share information

 

Outstanding shares (millions)

 

December 31, 2018

 

January 31, 2019

 

Common Shares

 

599

 

600

 

Common Share options — all exercisable (one for one)

 

<1

 

<1

 

 

7.11 Transactions between related parties

 

Transactions with key management personnel

 

Our key management personnel have authority and responsibility for overseeing, planning, directing and controlling our activities and consist of our Board of Directors and our Executive Leadership Team. Total compensation expense for key management personnel was $64 million in 2018, as compared to $50 million in 2017. The increase in compensation expense for key management personnel was due to greater share-based compensation primarily arising from metrics affecting performance condition-based restricted stock units. See Note 30(a)  of the Consolidated financial statements for additional details.

 

Transactions with defined benefit pension plans

 

We provided management and administrative services to our defined benefit pension plans. Charges for these services were on a cost recovery basis and were immaterial.

 

Transactions with real estate joint ventures

 

In 2018, we had transactions with real estate joint ventures, which are related parties to us, as set out in Note 21 of our Consolidated financial statements.

 

For the TELUS Garden real estate joint venture, during the year ended December 31, 2018, the real estate joint venture sold the income-producing properties and the related net assets. The purchaser assumed the 3.7% mortgage and the 3.4% bonds secured by the income-producing properties. In the application of equity accounting, we recorded our share of the non-recurring gain at $171 million. Concurrently, we committed to a donation of $118 million, of which an initial donation of $100 million was made in TELUS Corporation Common Shares acquired in the market. See Section 1.3 and Note 28(b)  of the Consolidated financial statements for additional details.

 

For the TELUS Sky real estate joint venture, commitments and contingent liabilities include construction-related contractual commitments through to 2019 (approximately $35 million at December 31, 2018) and construction financing ($342 million with three Canadian financial institutions as 66-2/3% lender and TELUS as 33-1/3% lender). As well, we have entered into a lease agreement with the TELUS Sky real estate joint venture.

 

 

57


 

8.               Accounting matters

 

8.1 Critical accounting estimates and judgments

 

Our significant accounting policies are described in Note 1 of the Consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2018. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) requires management to make estimates, assumptions and judgments that affect: the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements; the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements; and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Our critical accounting estimates and significant judgments are generally discussed with the Audit Committee each quarter.

 

Examples of our significant judgments, apart from those involving estimation, include the following:

 

·                   Assessments about whether line items are sufficiently material to warrant separate presentation in the primary financial statements and, if not, whether they are sufficiently material to warrant separate presentation in the notes to the financial statements. In the normal course, we make changes to our assessments regarding materiality for presentation so that they reflect current economic conditions. Due consideration is given to the view that it is reasonable to expect differing opinions of what is, and is not, material.

 

·                   In respect of revenue-generating transactions, we must make judgments that affect the timing of the recognition of revenue. See Section 8.2 Accounting policy developments below and Note 2 of our Consolidated financial statements for significant changes to IFRS-IASB which significantly affect the timing of the recognition of revenue and the classification of revenues presented as either service or equipment revenues.

 

·                   We must make judgments about when we have satisfied our performance obligations to our customers, either over a period of time or at a point in time. Service revenues are recognized based upon customers’ access to, or usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure; we believe that this method faithfully depicts the transfer of the services, and thus the revenues are recognized as the services are made available and/or rendered. We consider our performance obligations arising from the sale of equipment to have been satisfied when the equipment has been delivered to, and accepted by, the end-user customers.

 

·                   Principally in the context of revenue-generating transactions involving wireless handsets, we must make judgments about whether third-party re-sellers that deliver equipment to our customers are acting in the transactions as principals or as our agents. Upon due consideration of the relevant indicators, we believe that the decision to consider the re-sellers to be acting, solely for accounting purposes, as our agents is more representative of the economic substance of the transactions, as we are the primary obligor to the end-user customers. The effect of this judgment is that no equipment revenue is recognized upon the transfer of inventory to third-party re-sellers.

 

·                   We compensate third-party re-sellers and our employees for generating revenues, and we must exercise judgment as to whether such sales-based compensation amounts are costs incurred to obtain contracts with customers that should be capitalized (see Note 20 of the Consolidated financial statements). We believe that compensation amounts tangentially attributable to obtaining a contract with a customer, because the amount of such compensation could be affected in ways other than by simply obtaining that contract, should be expensed as incurred; compensation amounts directly attributable to obtaining a contract with a customer should be capitalized and subsequently amortized on a systematic basis, consistent with the satisfaction of our associated performance obligations.

 

Judgment must also be exercised in the capitalization of costs incurred to fulfill revenue-generating contracts with customers. Such fulfilment costs are those incurred to set up, activate or otherwise implement services involving access to, or usage of, our telecommunications infrastructure that would not otherwise be capitalized as property, plant and equipment and intangible assets (see Note 20 of the Consolidated financial statements).

 

·                   The decision to depreciate and amortize any property, plant, equipment and intangible assets that are subject to amortization on a straight-line basis, as we believe that this method reflects the consumption of resources related to the economic lifespan of those assets better than an accelerated method and is more representative of the economic substance of the underlying use of those assets.

 

·                   The preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make judgments that affect the financial statement disclosure of information regularly reviewed by our chief operating decision-maker used to make resource allocation decisions and to assess performance (see Note 5 of the Consolidated financial statements). A significant judgment we make is in respect of distinguishing between our wireless and wireline operations and cash flows (and this extends to allocations of both direct and

 

 

58


 

indirect expenses and capital expenditures). The clarity of such distinction has been increasingly affected by the convergence and integration of our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure technology and operations. Less than one-half of the operating expenses included in the segment performance measure reported to our chief operating decision-maker during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, are direct costs; judgment, largely based upon historical experience, is applied in apportioning indirect expenses which are not objectively distinguishable between our wireless and wireline operations.

 

Recently, our judgment was that our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure technology and operations had not experienced sufficient convergence to objectively make their respective operations and cash flows practically indistinguishable. The continued build-out of our technology-agnostic fibre-optic infrastructure, in combination with converged edge network technology, has significantly affected this judgment, as has the commercialization of fixed-wireless telecommunications solutions for customers and the consolidation of our non-customer facing operations.

 

As a result, it has become increasingly difficult and impractical to objectively and clearly distinguish between our wireless and wireline operations and cash flows, and the assets from which those cash flows arise. Our judgment as to whether these operations can continue to be judged to be individual components of the business and discrete operating segments may change.

 

The increasing impracticality of objectively distinguishing between our wireless and wireline cash flows, and the assets from which those cash flows arise, is evidence of their increasing interdependence; this may result in the unification of the wireless cash-generating unit and the wireline cash-generating unit as a single cash-generating unit for impairment testing purposes in the future. As our business continues to evolve, new cash-generating units may develop.

 

·                   The view that our spectrum licences granted by Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada will likely be renewed; that we intend to renew them; that we believe we have the financial and operational ability to renew them; and, thus, that they have an indefinite life, as discussed further in Note 18(e)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

·                   In connection with the annual impairment testing of intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill, there are instances in which we must exercise judgment in allocating our net assets, including shared corporate and administrative assets, to our cash-generating units when determining their carrying amounts. These judgments are necessary because of the convergence that our wireless and wireline telecommunications infrastructure technology and operations have experienced to date, and because of our continuous development. There are instances in which similar judgments must also be made in respect of future capital expenditures in support of both wireless and wireline operations, which are a component of the determination of recoverable amounts used in the annual impairment testing, as discussed further in Note 18(f)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

·                   In respect of claims and lawsuits, as discussed further in Note 29(a)  of the Consolidated financial statements, the determination of whether an item is a contingent liability or whether an outflow of resources is probable and thus needs to be accounted for as a provision.

 

Examples of the significant estimates and judgments that we make, and their relative significance and degree of difficulty, are as set out in the graphic in Note 1 of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Our critical accounting estimates and assumptions are described below.

 

General

 

·                   In determining our critical accounting estimates, we consider trends, commitments, events or uncertainties that we reasonably expect to materially affect our methodology or assumptions. Our statements in this MD&A regarding such consideration are made subject to the Caution regarding forward-looking statements .

 

·                   In the normal course, we make changes to assumptions underlying all critical accounting estimates so that they reflect current economic conditions, updated historical information used to develop the assumptions, and changes in our credit ratings, where applicable. Unless indicated otherwise in the discussion below, we expect that no material changes in overall financial performance and financial statement line items would arise either from reasonably likely changes in material assumptions underlying the estimate or from selection of a different estimate from within a range of valid estimates.

 

·                   Our critical accounting estimates affect line items on the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income, and line items on the Consolidated statements of financial position, as follows:

 

 

59


 

 

 

Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

Employee

 

Consolidated statements
of financial position

 

Operating
revenues

 

Goods and
services
purchased

 

Employee
benefits
expense

 

Depreciation

 

Amortization
of intangible
assets

 

Financing
costs

 

defined benefit
plans re-
measurements
2

 

Intangible assets, net, and Goodwill, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

X 1

 

 

 

 

 

Employee defined benefit pension plans

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

X 3

 

X 3

 

X

 

X

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions for asset retirement obligations

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

Provisions related to business combinations

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

Investments

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Contract assets

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Inventories

 

 

 

X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


(1)          Accounting estimate, as applicable to Intangible assets with indefinite lives and Goodwill, primarily relates to spectrum holdings and accordingly affects our wireless cash-generating unit.

 

(2)          Other comprehensive income — Item never subsequently reclassified to income.

 

(3)          Accounting estimate impact due to internal labour capitalization rates.

 

·                   All critical accounting estimates are uncertain at the time an estimate is made and affect the following Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income line items: Income taxes (except for estimates about Goodwill) and Net income. Similarly, all critical accounting estimates affect the following Consolidated statements of financial position line items: Current assets (Income and other taxes receivable), Current liabilities (Income and other taxes payable), Deferred income tax liabilities and Common equity (retained earnings) and Non-controlling interests. The discussion of each critical accounting estimate does not differ between our two segments, wireless and wireline, unless explicitly noted.

 

Intangible assets, net; Goodwill, net; and Property, plant and equipment, net

 

General

 

·                   The Intangible assets, net, line item represents approximately 33% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 (34% as at December 31, 2017). Included in Intangible assets are spectrum licences, which represent approximately 26% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 (28% as at December 31, 2017).

 

·                   The Goodwill, net, line item represents approximately 14% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 and 2017.

 

·                   The Property, plant and equipment, net, line item on our Consolidated statements of financial position represents approximately 37% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 and 2017.

 

·                   If our estimates of the useful lives of assets were incorrect, we could experience increased or decreased charges for amortization or depreciation in the future. If the future were to differ adversely from our best estimate of key economic assumptions and associated cash flows were to materially decrease, we could potentially experience future material impairment charges in respect of our Property, plant and equipment assets, Intangible assets or Goodwill. If Intangible assets with indefinite lives were determined to have finite lives at some point in the future, we could experience increased charges for amortization of Intangible assets. Such charges in and of themselves do not result in a cash outflow and would not immediately affect our liquidity.

 

The recoverability of Intangible assets with indefinite lives ; the recoverability of Goodwill

 

·                   The carrying values of Intangible assets with indefinite lives and Goodwill are periodically tested for impairment, and this test represents a significant estimate for us.

 

 

60


 

·                   The recoverable amounts of the cash-generating units’ assets have been determined based on a fair value less costs of disposal calculation. There is a material degree of uncertainty with respect to the estimates of the recoverable amounts of the cash-generating units’ assets, given the necessity of making key economic assumptions about the future. The fair value less costs of disposal and value-in-use calculations both use future cash flows and growth projections (including judgments about the allocation of future capital expenditures supporting both wireless and wireline operations); associated economic risk assumptions and estimates of the likelihood of achieving key operating metrics and drivers; estimates of future generational infrastructure capital expenditures; and the future weighted average cost of capital.

 

·                   See Note 18(f)  of the Consolidated financial statements for further discussion of methodology and sensitivity testing.

 

The estimated useful lives of assets; the recoverability of tangible assets

 

·                   The estimated useful lives of assets are determined by a continuing program of asset life studies. The recoverability of assets with finite lives is significantly impacted by the estimated useful lives of assets.

 

·                   Assumptions underlying the estimated useful lives of assets include the timing of technological obsolescence, competitive pressures and future infrastructure utilization plans.

 

Employee defined benefit pension plans

 

Certain actuarial and economic assumptions used in determining defined benefit pension costs, accrued pension benefit obligations and pension plan assets

 

·                   We review industry practices, trends, economic conditions and data provided by actuaries when developing assumptions used in the determination of defined benefit pension costs and accrued pension benefit obligations. Pension plan assets are generally valued using market prices; however, some assets are valued using market estimates when market prices are not readily available. Actuarial support is obtained for interpolations of experience gains and losses that affect the employee defined benefit plan actuarial gains and losses and accrued pension benefit obligations. The discount rate, which is used to determine the accrued benefit obligation, is based upon the yield on long-term, high-quality fixed-term investments. The discount rate is set annually at the end of each calendar year, based upon yields on long-term corporate bond indices in consultation with actuaries, and is reviewed quarterly for significant changes. Future increases in compensation are based upon the current benefits policies and economic forecasts. We have examined our respective pension obligation and current service cost durations and observed a 10-year difference in duration. As individual discount rates more accurately reflect the obligation and current service cost, commencing in 2018, we applied a dual discount rate methodology.

 

·                   On an annual basis, at a minimum, the defined benefit pension plan assumptions are assessed and revised as appropriate. When the defined benefit pension plan key assumptions fluctuate significantly relative to their immediately preceding year-end values, actuarial gains (losses) arising from such significant fluctuations are recognized on an interim basis. Assumptions used in determining defined benefit pension costs, accrued pension benefit obligations and pension plan assets include life expectancy, discount rates, market estimates and rates of future compensation increases. Material changes in overall financial performance and financial statement line items would arise from reasonably likely changes, because of assumptions that have been revised to reflect updated historical information and updated economic conditions, in the material assumptions underlying this estimate. See Note 15 of the Consolidated financial statements for further analysis.

 

·                   This accounting estimate related to employee defined benefit pension plans is in respect of components of the Operating expenses line item, Financing costs line item and Other comprehensive income line item on our Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income. If the future were to adversely differ from our best estimate of assumptions used in determining defined benefit pension costs, accrued benefit obligations and pension plan assets, we could experience future increased (or decreased) defined benefit pension expense, financing costs and charges to Other comprehensive income.

 

Income tax assets and liabilities

 

The amount and composition of income tax assets and income tax liabilities, including the amount of unrecognized tax benefits

 

·                   Assumptions underlying the composition of income tax assets and liabilities are based upon an assessment of the technical merits of tax positions. Income tax benefits on uncertain tax positions are recognized only when it is more likely than not that the ultimate determination of the tax treatment of a position will result in the related benefit being realizable; however, this does not mean that tax authorities cannot challenge these positions. Income tax assets and liabilities are measured at the amount that is expected to be realized or incurred upon ultimate settlement with taxation authorities. Such assessments are based upon the applicable income tax legislation, regulations, interpretations and jurisprudence, all of which in turn are subject to change and interpretation.

 

 

61


 

·                   Current income tax assets and liabilities are estimated based upon the amount of income tax that is calculated as being owed to taxation authorities, net of periodic instalment payments. Deferred income tax liabilities are composed of the tax effect of temporary differences between the carrying amount and tax basis of assets and liabilities, as well as the income tax effect of undeducted income tax losses. The timing of the reversal of temporary differences is estimated and the income tax rate substantively enacted for the periods of reversal is applied to the temporary differences. The carrying amounts of assets and liabilities are based upon the amounts recorded in the financial statements and are, therefore, subject to accounting estimates that are inherent in those balances. The tax basis of assets and liabilities, as well as the amount of undeducted income tax losses, are based upon the assessment and measurement of tax positions, as noted above. Assumptions as to the timing of reversal of temporary differences include expectations about the future results of operations and future cash flows. The composition of income tax liabilities is reasonably likely to change from period to period because of changes in the estimation of these significant uncertainties.

 

·                   This accounting estimate is in respect of material asset and liability line items on our Consolidated statements of financial position comprising less than 1% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and approximately 10% of Total liabilities and owners’ equity as at December 31, 2018 and 2017. If the future were to adversely differ from our best estimate of the likelihood of tax positions being sustained, the amount of tax expected to be incurred, the future results of operations, the timing of reversal of deductible temporary differences and taxable temporary differences, and the tax rates applicable to future years, we could experience material current income tax adjustments and deferred income tax adjustments. Such current and deferred income tax adjustments could result in an increase or acceleration of cash outflows at an earlier time than might otherwise be expected.

 

Provisions for asset retirement obligations

 

Certain economic assumptions used in provisioning for asset retirement obligations

 

·                   Asset retirement obligation provisions are recognized for statutory, contractual or legal obligations, normally when incurred, associated with the retirement of Property, plant and equipment (primarily certain items of outside plant and wireless site equipment) when those obligations result from the acquisition, construction, development and/or normal operation of the assets. The obligations are measured initially at fair value, determined using present value methodology, and the resulting costs are capitalized as a part of the carrying value of the related asset.

 

·                   On an annual basis, at a minimum, assumptions underlying the provisions for asset retirement obligations include expectations, which may span numerous decades, about inflation, discount rates and any changes in the amount or timing of the underlying future cash flows. Material changes in financial position would arise from reasonably likely changes, because of assumptions that have been revised to reflect updated historical information and updated economic conditions, in the material assumptions underlying this estimate. The capitalized asset retirement cost is depreciated on the same basis as the related asset, and the discount accretion is included in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income as a component of Financing costs.

 

·                   This accounting estimate is in respect of the asset retirement obligations component of the Provisions line item on our Consolidated statements of financial position, and this component comprises approximately 1% of Total liabilities and owners’ equity as at December 31, 2018 and 2017. If the provisions for asset retirement obligations were to be inadequate, we could experience a charge to Goods and services purchased in the future. A charge for an inadequate asset retirement obligation provision would result in a cash outflow proximate to the time that the asset retirement obligation is satisfied.

 

Provisions related to business combinations

 

Provisions for written put options

 

·                   In connection with certain business acquisitions, we have established provisions for written put options in respect of non-controlling interests. We provide written put options to the remaining selling shareholders whereby they could put the remaining non-controlling interests at, or after, a specified date. The acquisition-date fair values of the puttable shares held by the non-controlling shareholders are recorded as provisions.

 

·                   On an annual basis, at a minimum, the provisions for written put options are assessed and revised as appropriate. The provisions for written put options have been determined based on the net present values of estimated future earnings results; there is a material degree of uncertainty with respect to the estimates of future earnings results, given the necessity of making key economic assumptions about the future. The amounts of provisions for written put options are reasonably likely to change from period to period because of changes in the estimation of future earnings and foreign exchange movements.

 

·                   This accounting estimate is in respect of the provisions for written put options in respect of the non-controlling interests component of the Provisions line item on our Consolidated statements of financial position, and this component comprises approximately 1% of Total liabilities and owners’ equity as at December 31, 2018 (2017 — less than 1%). If the provisions for written put options were to be inadequate, we could experience a charge to Operating

 

 

62


 

revenues in the future. A charge for an inadequate written put option provision would result in a cash outflow proximate to the time that the written put option is exercised.

 

Investments

 

The recoverability of long-term investments

 

·                   We assess the recoverability of our long-term investments on a regular, recurring basis. The recoverability of investments is assessed on a specific-identification basis, taking into consideration expectations about future performance of the investments and comparison of historical results to past expectations.

 

·                   The most significant assumptions underlying the recoverability of long-term investments are related to the achievement of future cash flow and operating expectations. Our estimate of the recoverability of long-term investments could change from period to period due to the recurring nature of the recoverability assessment and due to the nature of long-term investments (we do not control the investees).

 

·                   Investments are included in the Other long-term assets line item on our Consolidated statements of financial position, which itself comprises approximately 3% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 (2017 — 2%). If the allowance for recoverability of long-term investments were to be inadequate, we could experience an increased charge to Other operating income in the future. Such a provision for recoverability of long-term investments does not result in a cash outflow. When there is clear and objective evidence of an increase in the fair value of an investment, which may be indicated by either a recent sale of shares by another current investor or the injection of new cash into the entity by a new or existing investor, we recognize the after-tax increase in value in Other comprehensive income (change in unrealized fair value of available-for-sale financial assets).

 

Accounts receivable

 

General

 

·                   When determining our allowance for doubtful accounts, we consider the business area that gave rise to the Accounts receivable, conduct a statistical analysis of portfolio delinquency trends and perform specific account identification.

 

·                   These accounting estimates are in respect of the Accounts receivable line item on our Consolidated statements of financial position, which comprises approximately 5% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 and 2017. If the future were to differ adversely from our best estimates of the fair value of the residual cash flows and the allowance for doubtful accounts, we could experience an increase in the doubtful accounts expense in the future. Such doubtful accounts expense in and of itself does not result in a cash outflow.

 

The allowance for doubtful accounts

 

·                   The estimate of our allowance for doubtful accounts could materially change from period to period because the allowance is a function of the balance and composition of Accounts receivable, which can vary on a month-to-month basis. The variability of the balance of Accounts receivable arises from the variability of the amount and composition of Operating revenues and from the variability of Accounts receivable collection performance.

 

Contract assets

 

General

 

·                   We maintain allowances for lifetime expected credit losses related to contract assets. Current economic conditions, historical information (including credit agency reports, if available), and the line of business from which the contract asset arose are all considered when determining impairment allowances. The same factors are considered when determining whether to write off amounts charged to the impairment allowance for contract assets against contract assets.

 

The impairment allowance

 

·                   These accounting estimates are in respect of the Contract assets line items on our Consolidated statements of financial position, which comprise approximately 4% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 and 2017. If the future were to differ adversely from our best estimates of the fair value of the residual cash flows and the impairment allowance for contract assets, we could experience an increase in the impairment allowance for contracts against contract assets in the future. Such impairment allowance in and of itself does not result in a cash outflow.

 

Inventories

 

The allowance for inventory obsolescence

 

·                   We determine our allowance for inventory obsolescence based upon expected inventory turnover, inventory aging, and current and future expectations with respect to product offerings.

 

 

63


 

·                   Assumptions underlying the allowance for inventory obsolescence include future sales trends and offerings and the expected inventory requirements and inventory composition necessary to support these future offerings. Our estimate of the allowance for inventory obsolescence could materially change from period to period due to changes in product offerings and the level of consumer acceptance of those products.

 

·                   This accounting estimate is in respect of the Inventories line item on our Consolidated statements of financial position, which comprises approximately 1% of Total assets as at December 31, 2018 and 2017. If the allowance for inventory obsolescence were to be inadequate, we could experience a charge to Goods and services purchased in the future. Such an inventory obsolescence charge does not result in a cash outflow.

 

8.2 Accounting policy developments

 

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments

 

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments , is required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2018, with retrospective application. The new standard includes a model for the classification and measurement of financial instruments, a single forward-looking “expected loss” impairment model and a reformed approach to hedge accounting. Our financial performance is currently not materially affected by the retrospective application of the standard, nor is our financial position.

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers

 

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers , is required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2018. The International Accounting Standards Board and the Financial Accounting Standards Board of the United States worked on this joint project to clarify the principles for the recognition of revenue. The new standard was released in May 2014 and supersedes existing standards and interpretations, including IAS 18, Revenue . We have applied the standard retrospectively to prior reporting periods, subject to permitted and elected practical expedients.

 

The effects of the new standard and the materiality of those effects will vary by industry and entity; the effects of our retrospective application are set out in Note 2(c)  of the Consolidated financial statements. Like many other telecommunications companies, we are materially affected by its application, primarily in respect of the timing of revenue recognition, the classification of revenue, the capitalization of the costs of obtaining a contract with a customer and the capitalization of the costs of contract fulfilment (as defined by the new standard).

 

Revenue — timing of recognition; classification

 

The timing of revenue recognition and the classification of our revenues as either service revenues or equipment revenues are affected, since the allocation of consideration in multiple element arrangements (solutions for our customers that may involve deliveries of multiple services and products that occur at different points in time and/or over different periods of time) is no longer affected by the limitation cap methodology previously required by generally accepted accounting principles.

 

The effects of the timing of revenue recognition and the classification of revenue are most pronounced in our wireless results. Although the measurement of the total revenue recognized over the life of a contract is largely unaffected by the new standard, the prohibition of the use of the limitation cap methodology accelerates the recognition of total contract revenue, relative to both the associated cash inflows from customers and our previous practice (using the limitation cap methodology); however, cash inflows are unaffected. The acceleration of the recognition of contract revenue relative to the associated cash inflows also results in the recognition of an amount reflecting the resulting difference as a contract asset. Although the underlying transaction economics do not differ, during periods of sustained growth in the number of wireless subscriber connection additions, assuming comparable contract-lifetime per unit cash inflows, revenues would appear to be greater than under the previous practice (using the limitation cap methodology). Wireline results arising from transactions that include the initial provision of subsidized equipment or promotional pricing plans will be similarly affected.

 

We have applied the new standard retrospectively, subject to associated decisions in respect of transitional provisions and permitted practical expedients. The contract asset initially recorded upon transition to the new standard represents revenues that will not be, and have not been, reflected at any time in our periodic results of operations, but that would have been if not for the transition to the new standard; the effect of this “pulling forward” of revenues is expected to be somewhat muted by the composite ongoing inception, maturation and expiration of millions of multi-year contracts with our customers.

 

Costs of contract acquisition; costs of contract fulfilment — timing of recognition

 

Similarly, the measurement of the total costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment over the life of a contract is unaffected by the new standard, but the timing of recognition is. The new standard results in our costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment, to the extent that they are material, being capitalized and subsequently recognized as an expense over the life of a contract on a rational, systematic basis consistent with the pattern of the transfer of goods

 

 

64


 

or services to which the asset relates. Although the underlying transaction economics would not differ, during periods of sustained growth in the number of customer connection additions, assuming comparable per unit costs of contract acquisition and contract fulfilment, absolute profitability measures would appear to be greater than under the previous practice (immediate expensing of such costs).

 

Implementation

 

Our operations and associated systems are complex and our accounting for millions of multi-year contracts with our customers was affected. Significantly, in order to give effect to the new accounting methodology, incremental compilation of historical data was necessary for our millions of already existing multi-year contracts with our customers that were in-scope for purposes of transitioning to the new standard.

 

After a multi-year expenditure of time and effort, we developed the accounting policies, estimates, judgments and processes necessary to transition to the new standard. Upon completion of the implementation of these items, which included the critical incremental requirements of our information technology systems, we completed the incremental compilation of historical data and the related accounting for that data, all of which is necessary to transition to the new standard.

 

We are using the following practical expedients provided for in, and transitioning to, the new standard:

 

·                   No restatement for contracts that were completed as at January 1, 2017, or earlier.

 

·                   No restatement for contracts that were modified prior to January 1, 2017. The aggregate effect of all such modifications will be reflected when identifying satisfied and unsatisfied performance obligations and the transaction prices to be allocated thereto and when determining the transaction prices.

 

·                   No disclosure of the aggregate transaction prices allocated to the remaining unfulfilled, or partially unfulfilled, performance obligations for periods ending prior to January 1, 2018.

 

IFRS 16, Leases

 

In January 2016, the International Accounting Standards Board released IFRS 16, Leases , which is required to be applied for years beginning on or after January 1, 2019, and which supersedes IAS 17, Leases . The International Accounting Standards Board and the Financial Accounting Standards Board of the United States worked together to modify the accounting for leases, generally by eliminating lessees’ classification of leases as either operating leases or finance leases and, for IFRS-IASB, introducing a single lessee accounting model.

 

The most significant effect of the new standard will be the lessee’s recognition of the initial present value of unavoidable future lease payments as right-of-use lease assets and lease liabilities on the statement of financial position, including those for most leases that would currently be accounted for as operating leases. Both leases with durations of 12 months or less and leases for low-value assets may be exempted.

 

The measurement of the total lease expense over the term of a lease will be unaffected by the new standard. However, the new standard will result in an acceleration of the timing of lease expense recognition for leases that would currently be accounted for as operating leases; the International Accounting Standards Board expects that this effect may be muted by a lessee having a portfolio of leases with varying maturities and lengths of term, and we expect that we will be similarly affected. The presentation on the statement of income and other comprehensive income required by the new standard will result in the presentation of most non-executory lease expenses as depreciation of right-of-use lease assets and financing costs arising from lease liabilities, rather than as a part of goods and services purchased (executory lease expenses will remain a part of goods and services purchased); reported operating income would thus be higher under the new standard.

 

Relative to the results of applying the current standard, although actual cash flows will be unaffected, the lessee’s statement of cash flows will reflect increases in cash flows from operating activities offset equally by decreases in cash flows from financing activities. This is the result of the presentation of the payments of the “principal” component of leases that would currently be accounted for as operating leases as a cash flow use within financing activities under the new standard.

 

We will be applying the standard retrospectively, with the cumulative effect of the initial application of the new standard recognized at the date of initial application, January 1, 2019, subject to permitted and elected practical expedients; such method of application would not result in the retrospective adjustment of amounts reported for periods prior to fiscal 2019. The nature of the transition method selected is such that the lease population as at January 1, 2019, and the discount rates determined contemporaneously, will be the basis for the cumulative effects recorded as of that date.

 

Implementation

 

As a transitional practical expedient permitted by the new standard, we will not reassess whether contracts are, or contain, leases as at January 1, 2019, applying the criteria of the new standard; as at January 1, 2019, only contracts that were previously identified as leases applying IAS 17, Leases, and IFRIC 4, Determining whether an Arrangement contains a

 

 

65


 

Lease , will be a part of the transition to the new standard. Only contracts entered into (or changed) after January 1, 2019, will be assessed for being, or containing, leases applying the criteria of the new standard.

 

IFRS 3, Business Combinations

 

In October 2018, the International Accounting Standards Board amended IFRS 3, Business Combinations , seeking to clarify whether an acquisition transaction results in the acquisition of an asset or the acquisition of a business. The amendments are effective for acquisition transactions on or after January 1, 2020, although earlier application is permitted. The amended standard has a narrower definition of a business, which could result in the recognition of fewer business combinations than under the current standard; the implication of this is that amounts which may have been recognized as goodwill in a business combination under the current standard may now be recognized as allocations to net identifiable assets acquired under the amended standard (with an associated effect in an entity’s results of operations that would differ from the effect of goodwill having been recognized). We are currently assessing the impacts and transition provisions of the amended standard; however, we expect that we will apply the standard prospectively from January 1, 2020. The effects, if any, of the amended standard on our financial performance and disclosure will be dependent on the facts and circumstances of any future acquisition transactions.

 

Other issued standards

 

Other issued standards required to be applied for periods beginning on or after January 1, 2019, are expected to have no significant effect on our financial performance or disclosure.

 

 

66


 

9.               General trends, outlook and assumptions, and regulatory developments and proceedings

 

This section contains forward-looking statements, which should be read together with the Caution regarding forward-looking statements at the beginning of this MD&A.

 

9.1 Telecommunications industry in 2018

 

We estimate that Canadian telecommunications industry revenues (including TV and excluding media) grew by approximately 4% to approximately $63 billion in 2018. Wireless and data services continue to drive ongoing industry growth. Consumer communications and data consumption behaviours continue to demonstrate a strong preference for data-rich applications and data-intensive smartphones and tablets.

 

TELUS’ revenues of $14.4 billion represented approximately 23% of industry revenues, with wireless products and services representing 57% of our total revenues. In our wireline business, growth in high-speed Internet access, enhanced data, TV, healthcare, customer care and business services (CCBS) solutions, and home and business security has more than offset the decline in demand for legacy services.

 

Wireless

 

Based on publicly reported results and estimates, in 2018, the Canadian wireless industry experienced network revenue growth of approximately 4.2% and adjusted EBITDA growth of approximately 7.3%. TELUS wireless network revenue growth was 2.7%, and TELUS wireless Adjusted EBITDA grew by 5.3%.

 

We estimate that the Canadian wireless industry added approximately 1.5 million new subscriber units in 2018, compared to approximately 1.3 million in 2017. This was supported by immigration and population growth; the trend toward multiple devices, including tablets; the expanding functionality of data and related applications; and the adoption of mobile devices and services by both younger and older generations. The wireless penetration rate increased to approximately 89% in Canada, with further increases in penetration expected to continue in 2019. By comparison, the wireless penetration rate in the U.S. is well over 100%, while in Europe and Asia it is even higher, suggesting an opportunity for continued growth in Canada.

 

In 2018, the wireless market was again characterized by high levels of retention and acquisition activity and the associated high costs of device subsidies on two-year contracts, a heightened level of competitive intensity, and the continued adoption of higher-value, data-centric smartphones. Growth in blended average billing per subscriber unit per month (ABPU) has moderated due to declines in chargeable data usage and larger allotments of data driven by competitive pressures, in addition to other moderating factors such as: the popularity of data sharing plans; more frequent customer friendly data usage notifications; and an evolving customer mix shift towards non-traditional wireless devices. These factors are being offset by continuing robust customer growth and growing overall data usage, including customers selecting higher rate plans with larger data buckets on high-value smartphones and a larger proportion of postpaid customers in the subscriber mix.

 

While the general trend towards more moderate ABPU growth, compared to past years, was anticipated, we continue to work diligently to better monetize robust growth in data services while simultaneously delivering a strong value for money proposition to our customers. To this end, we are focusing intensely on quality margin accretive customer growth and strong ABPU performance through our consistent strategic execution of premium smartphone loading, which includes driving higher-value data and share plan adoption. Moreover, we are also focusing on the other levers available to us in an environment of moderating ABPU growth to ensure we continue to deliver on our wireless EBITDA growth objectives, including:

 

·                   Continuing to drive volume growth through high-quality loading on the back of strong ongoing industry growth

 

·                   Seeking new sources of wireless revenue, such as Internet of Things (IoT) or Internet of Everything, machine-to-machine (M2M) and security applications

 

·                   Exploring and securing new channel strategies with attractive associated economic characteristics

 

·                   Pursuing smart bundling opportunities across wireless and wireline to achieve better economies of scope and enhance lifetime revenue per customer

 

·                   Driving better roaming growth by further encouraging customers travelling abroad to adopt and use our Easy Roam ®  offering, which now covers more than 125 countries, as well as securing in-roaming opportunities for those travelling to Canada

 

·                   Working persistently to enhance the efficiency of the flow from revenue to EBITDA, or the flow from ABPU to average margin per subscriber unit per month (AMPU), in order to buttress and enhance our operating margins, including the organizational and management structure streamlining we undertook in the second half of 2018.

 

The Canadian wireless industry continues to be highly competitive and capital-intensive, with carriers continuing to expand and enhance their broadband wireless networks including material investments in spectrum.

 

 

67


 

Wireline

 

Canada’s four major cable-TV companies had an estimated base of approximately 3.8 million telephony subscribers at the end of 2018. This represents a national consumer market share of approximately 42.2%, up from approximately 41.5% in 2017. Other non-facilities-based competitors also offer local and long distance voice over IP (VoIP) services and resell high-speed Internet solutions. This competition, along with technological substitution by wireless services, is continuing to erode the number of residential network access lines and associated local and long distance revenues, as expected.

 

Although the consumer high-speed Internet market is maturing, with a penetration rate of approximately 86% in Western Canada and 85% across Canada, subscriber growth is expected to continue over the coming years. The four major cable-TV companies had an estimated 6.9 million Internet subscribers at the end of 2018 (50% market share), up 3% from approximately 6.7 million at the end of 2017. Telecommunications companies had approximately 6.7 million Internet subscribers (49% market share), up 4% from approximately 6.5 million at the end of 2017. We continue to make moderate gains in market share as a result of the expansion of our fibre-optic infrastructure and the pull-through of subscribers from our IP-based TELUS TV service.

 

While Canadians still watch conventional TV, digital platforms are playing an increasingly important role in the broadcasting industry. Popular online video services are providing Canadians with more choice about where, when and how to access their video content. In 2018, Canadian IP TV providers increased their subscriber base by an estimated 6% to 2.8 million as a result of expanded network coverage, enhanced differentiated service offerings, and marketing and promotions focused on IP TV. Despite this IP TV growth, the combined cable-TV and satellite-TV subscriber penetration rate declined. We estimate that the four major cable-TV companies have approximately 5.6 million TV subscribers or a 51% market share, a slight decrease from 52% at the end of 2017. The balance of industry subscribers were served by satellite-TV and regional providers.

 

In 2018, Rogers launched Ignite TV in Ontario, based on the Comcast X1 TV platform, while Quebecor announced its intention to unveil Helix, also based on the Comcast X1 TV platform in 2019. Our IP-based Optik TV platform continues to offer numerous service leadership advantages over this cable platform, including: flexible pricing plans and packaging available to all customers; picture clarity and quality; content depth and breadth; and the number of ways customers can access content, including wireless set-top boxes, Restart TV, higher capacity PVR and the Optik TV app, which offers more than twice the number of live TV channels at home or on the go compared to our cable competitor. Notably, we are the only Canadian TV service provider offering live 4K HDR channels and 4K HDR on-demand movies, including the latest Hollywood blockbusters and the latest movies and series from Netflix, which has named TELUS the #1 network for streaming Netflix in Canada in November and December of 2018 (based on the Netflix ISP Speed Index rankings for Canadian Providers as of November/December 2018), as well as 4K sports content, more HD content, more on-demand content, more over-the-top (OTT) content with Netflix, YouTube, TED Talks and the National Film Board of Canada, and we are the multicultural content leader in Western Canada.

 

The national Canadian telecom providers continue to acquire and otherwise develop capabilities in home security. In the first quarter of 2018, TELUS acquired all of the customers, assets and operations of AlarmForce Industries Inc. in B.C., Alberta and Saskatchewan. Additionally throughout 2018, we made other smaller home and business security-related acquisitions. These acquisitions were made to strengthen our opportunity to offer attractive bundled solutions and advance our connected home strategy while accelerating our entry into smart home solutions.

 

9.2 Telecommunications industry general outlook and trends

 

Wireless

 

Wireless growth continues to be driven by increasing data usage and adoption, including: higher-value smartphones, shared family data plans and tablets, and growth in IoT and M2M devices. In addition, consumers continue to replace wireline access with wireless access and related data services. These trends are expected to continue to drive a growing demand for wireless data services for the foreseeable future. Industry ABPU growth is expected to continue growing at a more modest rate than seen in recent years.

 

While LTE and LTE-A technologies increase download speeds, encourage data usage and improve the customer experience, growth in data traffic demands pose challenges to wireless access technology. (See High demand for data challenges wireless networks and may be accompanied by increases in delivery cost in Section 10.4 Technology.) To better manage this data traffic, Canadian providers continue to evolve their networks. Innovation, Science, and Economic Development Canada (ISED) announced the auction of 600 MHz spectrum in March 2019, including spectrum set aside for non-incumbent companies, with further spectrum auctions expected in 2020 and 2021.

 

M2M and IoT technologies connect communications-enabled remote devices via wireless technologies, allowing them to exchange key information and share processes. Advanced platforms and networks are already in place in industries such as healthcare, utilities, agriculture and fleet management, with deployment ongoing in other industries,

 

 

68


 

including vehicle insurance, retail, food services and consumer utilities. These and other industries are looking to IoT, combined with other applications, to generate value from their connections. IoT represents a meaningful opportunity for growth in mobility products and services, with secure connectivity, customer value and efficiency. While M2M applications generally have lower average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU), they tend to generate high service volumes with low or no subsidy costs, thereby supporting both revenue growth and margins.

 

5G has begun to play a mainstream role in technology evolution and innovation globally, and is an important component of meeting Canada’s and TELUS’ efforts to further bridge the digital divide and connect rural Canadians. Investing in 5G will drive capex savings by allowing us to provide high-speed Internet services over wireless in less urban areas, as well as improved cost savings and innovative services in industrial automation, transportation and telehealth. Driven by significantly faster speeds, lower latencies, improved reliability and attractive economics, 5G will enable a host of new applications: for industries, 5G will enable remote operations, industrial control and manufacturing automation; for consumers, home automation, autonomous vehicles, and wireless-to-the-home connectivity with speeds comparable to wired access technologies; and for healthcare, converged solutions for hospitals, clinics and remote patient monitoring. 5G is essential to Canada’s digital future and is expected to generate significant innovation, growth and productivity. Mobile 5G wireless technology is up to 100 times faster than current 4G technology.

 

Enabling a robust and reliable 5G experience for Canadians will require complementary wireless spectrum bands to support the needs of a diverse subscriber base. Low band spectrum, such as 600 MHz which will be auctioned by ISED in early 2019, is valuable as it covers wide areas and penetrates well into buildings, thus improving coverage in urban and suburban areas. This low band spectrum will play a vital role in bringing 5G to Canadians and as such, it is an important resource for Canada as wireless operators build out 5G in rural areas. High bandwidth spectrum, such as millimetre wave (mmWave) is valuable as it can enable speeds up to 100 times faster than 600 MHz spectrum, however, does not have the same coverage characteristics to penetrate well into buildings. This high-bandwidth spectrum and the associated faster connection speeds will help unlock new technologies such as virtual and augmented reality. Current trials show that mmWave delivers the richest 5G experience, albeit in a localized fashion. 3.5 GHz spectrum is important to the 5G ecosystem as it able to support both the coverage characteristics of low band spectrum with the speed characteristics of mmWave spectrum, albeit at slightly lower speeds. This spectrum will be integral to low latency communications services including autonomous monitoring and vehicle-to-everything communication. Current trials show 3.5 GHz is key for broader 5G coverage. S ee Section 9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings for further details on upcoming spectrum auctions.

 

Wireline

 

The traditional wireline telecommunications market is expected to remain very competitive in 2019 as technology substitution — such as the broad deployment of higher-speed Internet; the use of email, messaging and social media as alternatives to voice services; and the growth of wireless and VoIP services — continues to replace higher-margin legacy voice revenues. In our incumbent operating areas of B.C. and Alberta, it is estimated that 48% of households no longer have a fixed line and 29% of households no longer have a broadcast TV service in 2018. While we are a key provider of these substitution services, the decline in this legacy business is continuing as expected, although network access line (NAL) losses slowed considerably in 2018. Our long-standing growth strategy remains focused on wireless, data and IP-centric wireline capabilities.

 

The popularity of viewing TV and on-demand content anywhere, particularly on handheld devices, is expected to continue to grow as customers adopt services that enable them to view content on multiple screens. Streaming media providers continue to enhance OTT streaming services in order to compete for a share of viewership as viewing habits and consumer demand evolve. Studies suggest that 45% of Canadian households had a subscription to Netflix at the end of 2018. Other streaming TV services are expected to launch services in Canada in the upcoming years.

 

TV providers are monitoring OTT developments and evolving their content and market strategy to compete with these non-traditional offerings. Bell Media offers a content streaming service through its expanded Crave TV offering. We view OTT as an opportunity to add further capabilities to our linear and on-demand assets, providing customers with flexible options to choose the content they want and encourage greater customer use of the TELUS high-speed Internet and wireless technologies. We continue to enhance our Optik TV service by adding content and capabilities, including ultra-high-definition 4K content, and by entering into multicultural content and distribution deals with OTT content providers such as Netflix and Crave TV. TELUS continues to offer Pik TV, an attractive OTT-friendly basic TV offering that allows customers to access live TV and streaming services like Netflix and YouTube, conveniently and affordably, through a self-install media box, Apple TV, Internet browser or our Android and iOS mobile applications.

 

Telecommunications companies continue to make significant capital investments in broadband networks, with a focus on fibre to the premises or home (FTTP/FTTH) to maintain and enhance their ability to support enhanced IP-based services and higher broadband speeds. Cable-TV companies continue to evolve their cable networks with the gradual roll-out of the DOCSIS 3.1 platform. Although this platform increases speed in the near term and is cost-efficient, it does

 

 

69


 

not offer the same advanced capabilities as FTTP over the longer term, such as fast symmetrical upload and download speeds. At the end of 2018, our Optik TV footprint covered more than 3.1 million households and businesses, with approximately 97% having access to speeds of at least 50 Mbps, enabling us to deliver a better customer experience. In addition, at the end of 2018, our fibre-optic infrastructure was available to approximately 1.89 million homes and businesses, reaching 61% of our broadband footprint. Advances in LTE wireless technology and our extensive LTE access technology also allow us to target otherwise underserved areas with a fixed wireless solution, and 5G is widely expected to offer vastly expanded opportunities in this regard.

 

Combining wireline local and long distance voice services with wireless and high-speed Internet access and entertainment services, telecommunications companies can focus on offering bundled products to achieve competitive differentiation and provide customers with more flexibility and choice on networks that can reliably support these services. Our broadband investments, including the build-out of our FTTP broadband network, our premium differentiated IP-based Optik TV service and integrated bundled service offerings, continue to enhance our competitive position and customer loyalty relative to our main cable-TV competitor.

 

As the industry moves to 5G wireless in the coming years, we expect to be operating on, and providing services over, a more converged network. The lines between wireline access and wireless access will continue to blur, as the way we deliver services to customers — and the way our customers use those services — continue to evolve. As our broadband network continues to expand and 5G begins to be commercialized in the coming years, we expect to benefit from the flexibility of being able to select the most efficient way to deliver services across our footprint. We do not expect to have to build fibre to every home; instead we believe that there will be opportunities to deliver services to some areas within our broadband footprint wirelessly with 5G.

 

Additional wireline capabilities

 

In the business market (enterprise and small and medium-sized businesses, or SMB), the convergence of IT and telecommunications, facilitated by the ubiquity of IP, continues to shape the competitive environment, with non-traditional providers increasingly blurring the lines of competition and business models. Cable-TV companies continue to make investments to better compete in the highly contested SMB space. Telecommunications companies like TELUS are providing network-centric managed applications that leverage their significant FTTP investments, while IT service providers are bundling network connectivity with their proprietary software as service offerings. Although our business-to-business (B2B) line of business was dilutive to our EBITDA in 2018, we are aggressively pursuing opportunities to stabilize this business, return to growth and enhance margins in future years.

 

The development of IP-based platforms providing combined IP voice, data and video solutions creates potential cost efficiencies that compensate, in part, for the loss of margins resulting from the migration from legacy to IP-based services. New opportunities exist for integrated solutions and business process outsourcing that could have a greater business impact than traditional telecommunications services. Data security represents both a challenge and an opportunity for TELUS to provide customers with our data security solutions. Increasingly, businesses are looking to partner with their communications service provider to address their business goals and challenges, and to tailor cloud-based solutions for their needs that leverage telecommunications in ways not imagined 10 years ago. Cloud computing is changing service delivery to always-on and everything-as-a-service, and strong growth is expected in this area. TELUS offers Network as a Service capabilities that provide businesses the option of an IT network as a service over the Internet, mirrored across multiple locations, based on a self-serve platform that reduces deployment cycles and reliance on IT specialists. Our home and business security in Western Canada is powered by our broadband network and integrates the latest smart devices to improve the lives of Canadians.

 

Healthcare is expected to be a continued growth area in future years, based on an aging population in Canada, an increasing emphasis on chronic disease management, and the potential benefits that technology can deliver in terms of efficiency and effectiveness within the sector. We are leveraging our expanding broadband network to increase the availability, integration and effectiveness of our innovative tools and applications across the primary care ecosystem in order to position ourselves to compete for the anticipated future growth in this sector. These tools include personal health records to facilitate self-management of healthcare data, electronic drug prescriptions with online insurance validation by the physician, and home health monitoring devices and data capture with caregiver oversight. The digitization of everyday functions in the healthcare ecosystem, combined with broadband network connectivity, provides an open platform that can support the development and delivery of even more advanced health applications. In 2018, our home health monitoring service was implemented in B.C. following an earlier successful pilot that demonstrated reductions in hospitalizations, positive patient experiences and significant cost reductions. Pharma Space ® , our online pharmacy service that helps patients manage their prescriptions through features like scheduling online reminders and automatic refills, has enabled patients to refill more than four million prescriptions online in 2018. Our acquisition of Medisys Health Group Inc. will allow us to deliver employee-centred care with each clinic outfitted with the full suite of TELUS Health solutions, thereby providing us further opportunities to scale our TELUS Health business.

 

 

70


 

TELUS International (TI), our global CCBS and digital services provider, continues its expansion through organic growth and strategic acquisitions (see Section 1.3 Highlights of 2018 for further details). TI is a global customer experience innovator that designs, builds and delivers next-generation digital services for some of the world’s most demanding, discerning and disruptive tech brands. TELUS Corporation is TI’s largest customer. From TI’s successful inception 13 years ago in the Philippines, established to support TELUS’ growing customer service needs, TI has grown exponentially in size, scope and geographic diversity to deliver exceptional customer experiences for clients from sites in North and Central America, Europe and Asia. Notably, the acquisition of Xavient Information Systems, a global IT consulting and next-generation software services company, accelerates TI’s ability to expand its global IT services offering with the addition of advanced, next-generation IT consulting and delivery capabilities, in order to provide a more comprehensive suite of services to existing and prospective clients. These capabilities include artificial intelligence-powered digital transformation services, user interface/user experience (UI/UX) design, open source platform services, cloud services, OTT solutions, IoT, big data services, DevOps and IT lifecycle services. TI strengthens TELUS’ ability to provide global clients with leading, differentiated services that align with our top priority of delivering the best customer experience to all our customers .

 

As technology continues to change our industry rapidly, customer demand continues to evolve and grow, and Canada shifts to a more digital economy, we are committed to evolving our business and offering innovative and reliable services and thought leadership in core future growth areas that are complementary to our traditional business. This, along with our intense focus on leadership in delivering an enhanced customer experience, positions us for continued differentiation and growth.

 

9.3 TELUS assumptions for 2019

 

In 2019, we expect growth in both wireless and wireline EBITDA, driven by the continued high demand for data services and high-speed Internet access in our wireless and wireline products and services; our consistent strategic focus on our core wireless and wireline capabilities (see Section 2.2 Strategic imperatives, Section 3 Corporate priorities and Section 4 Capabilities ); significant ongoing investments in our leading broadband network; continued efforts to enhance operational efficiency; and our sustained focus on an enhanced customer experience across all areas of our operations.

 

Our assumptions in support of our 2019 outlook are generally based on the industry analysis above, including our estimates regarding economic and telecom industry growth (see Section 1.2 The environment in which we operate ), as well as our 2018 results and trends discussed in Section 5 . Our key assumptions include the following:

 

·                   Slightly slower rate of economic growth in Canada in 2019, estimated to be 2.0% (2.1% in 2018). For our incumbent local exchange carrier (ILEC) provinces in Western Canada, we estimate that economic growth in B.C. will be 2.3% in 2019 (2.2% in 2018), and that economic growth in Alberta will be 2.1% in 2019 (2.2% in 2018).

 

·                   No material adverse regulatory rulings or government actions.

 

·                   Continued intense wireless and wireline competition in both consumer and business markets.

 

·                   Continued increase in wireless industry penetration of the Canadian market.

 

·                   Ongoing subscriber adoption of, and upgrades to, data-intensive smartphones, as customers seek more mobile connectivity to the Internet.

 

·                   Wireless revenue growth resulting from improvements in subscriber loading with continued competitive pressure on blended ARPU.

 

·                   Continued pressure on wireless acquisition and retention expenses, dependent on gross loading and customer renewal volumes, competitive intensity and customer preferences.

 

·                   Continued growth in wireline data revenue, reflecting an increase in high-speed Internet and TELUS TV subscribers, speed upgrades, rate plans with larger data usage and expansion of our broadband infrastructure, as well as growth in customer care and business services, healthcare solutions, and home and business security offerings.

 

·                   Continued erosion of wireline voice revenue, resulting from technological substitution and greater use of inclusive long distance.

 

·                   Continued focus on our customers first initiatives and maintaining our customers’ likelihood-to-recommend scores.

 

·                   Employee defined benefit pension plans: Pension plan expense of approximately $79 million recorded in Employee benefits expense; a rate of 3.90% for discounting the obligation and a rate of 4.00% for current service costs for employee defined benefit pension plan accounting purposes; and defined benefit pension plan funding of approximately $52 million.

 

 

71


 

·                   Restructuring and other costs of approximately $100 million for continuing operational effectiveness initiatives, with margin enhancement initiatives to mitigate pressures related to intense competition, technological substitution, repricing of our services, increasing subscriber growth and retention costs, and integration costs associated with business acquisitions.

 

·                   Income taxes: Income taxes computed at applicable statutory rate of 26.7 to 27.3% and cash income tax payments of approximately $600 million to $680 million (2018 — $197 million).

 

·                   Further investments in broadband infrastructure as we have reached 61% of our broadband footprint at December 31, 2018, including fibre-optic network expansion and 4G LTE capacity and upgrades, as well as investments in network and systems resiliency and reliability.

 

·                   Participation in the ISED wireless spectrum auction for 600 MHz spectrum band, currently expected in March 2019.

 

·                   Stabilization in the average Canadian dollar: U.S. dollar exchange rate (U.S. 77 cents in 2018).

 

·                   Continued deployment of access-agnostic technology in our network.

 

9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings

 

Our telecommunications, broadcasting and radiocommunication services are regulated under federal laws by various authorities, including the Canadian Radio-television and Telecommunications Commission (CRTC), ISED, the Minister of Canadian Heritage and Multiculturalism, and the Competition Bureau.

 

The following is a summary of certain significant regulatory developments and proceedings relevant to our business and our industry. This summary is not intended to be a comprehensive legal analysis and description of all of the specific issues described. Although we have indicated where we do not currently expect the outcome of a development or proceeding to be material to us, there can be no assurance that the expected outcome will occur or that our current assessment of its likely impact on us will be accurate. See Section 10.2 Regulatory matters .

 

Radiocommunication licences and spectrum-related matters

 

ISED regulates, among other matters, the allocation and use of radio spectrum in Canada and licenses radio apparatus, frequency bands and/or radio channels within various frequency bands to service providers and private users. The department also establishes the terms and conditions attaching to such radio authorizations, including restrictions on licence transfers, coverage obligations, research and development obligations, annual reporting, and obligations concerning mandated roaming and antenna site sharing with competitors.

 

600 MHz spectrum repurposing

 

On August 14, 2015, ISED published its Decision on repurposing the 600 MHz Band , SLPB-004-15 . In its decision, ISED announced its intention to jointly repack the 600 MHz band in line with the U.S. and to adopt the 70 MHz mobile band plan arising from the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Incentive Auction. In August 2017, ISED initiated its Consultation on a Technical, Policy and Licensing Framework for Spectrum in the 600 MHz Band and on March 28, 2018, ISED released its Technical, Policy and Licensing Framework for the 600 MHz spectrum auction . ISED announced a 30 MHz set-aside for facilities-based providers who serve less than 10% of the national subscriber share and are actively providing commercial telecommunication services to the general public in the licensed area of interest. The asymmetric design of the auction framework, which sets aside a significant portion of the spectrum under auction exclusively for certain carriers (as defined in the framework), raises the risk that we will not be able to acquire all the spectrum we need in the auction process or that we will be required to pay more than we might otherwise pay. The auction will commence on March 12, 2019.

 

Spectrum Outlook 2018 — 2022

 

On June 6, 2018, ISED published the Spectrum Outlook 2018 — 2022. There is a risk that bands identified as promising for mobile service will not be allocated for mobile service or will be delayed in being allocated or assigned as the Spectrum Outlook is not a binding forecast of future spectrum assignments. However, any such delay or failure to allocate would generally impact all Canadian mobile service providers and not just us specifically.

 

Repurposing the 3500 MHz spectrum to support 5G

 

On December 18, 2014, ISED released its Decisions Regarding Policy Changes in the 3500 MHz Band (3475 — 3650 MHz) and a New Licensing Process noting the band would be fundamentally reallocated for flexible (mobile and fixed) use in the near future. On June 6, 2018, ISED released its Consultation on Revisions to the 3500 MHz Band to Accommodate Flexible Use and Preliminary Consultation on Changes to the 3800 MHz Band , proposing to claw back 56  to 66% of the band from fixed wireless incumbents (predominantly Inukshuk, which is a joint venture owned by Bell and Rogers, and Xplornet) and to auction the amount clawed back in 2020. In our consultation response, we called for a 100% clawback in large population centres. After ISED issues a transition decision, it will then consult on a licensing framework (i.e. auction rules and conditions of licence) for the 3500 MHz band. There is a risk that the transition decision and the auction rules will favour certain carriers over us and impact our ability to acquire 3500 MHz band spectrum.

 

 

72


 

Repurposing mmWave spectrum to support 5G

 

On June 5, 2017, ISED issued a Consultation on Releasing Millimetre Wave Spectrum to Support 5G, proposing to release 3.25 GHz of millimetre wave (mmWave) spectrum for licensed use and 7 GHz for licence-exempt use largely in line with recent U.S. mmWave developments. On June 6, 2018, ISED released an Addendum to the Consultation on Releasing Millimetre Wave Spectrum to Support 5G, proposing to release an additional 1 GHz of spectrum in the 26.5 — 27.5 GHz range. After issuing a repurposing decision, ISED will then consult on a licensing framework (i.e. auction rules and conditions of licence) for the mmWave bands. There is a risk that the repurposing decisions and the auction rules will favour certain carriers over us and impact our ability to acquire mmWave band spectrum.

 

Regulatory and federal government reviews

 

The CRTC and the federal government have initiated public proceedings to review various matters. They are discussed below.

 

Wireline wholesale services follow-up

 

On July 22, 2015, the CRTC released Review of wholesale wireline services and associated policies, Telecom Regulatory Policy CRTC 2015-326 . The major component of this decision was that the CRTC ordered the introduction of a disaggregated wholesale high-speed Internet access service for Internet service provider (ISP) competitors. This will include access to FTTP facilities. This requirement is being phased in geographically beginning in the largest markets in Ontario and Quebec (i.e. in the serving territories of Bell, Cogeco, Rogers and Videotron). The CRTC initiated a follow-up proceeding to determine the technical configurations, appropriate costs and wholesale cost-based rates in those regions.

 

The FTTP follow-up activities directed in Telecom Policy CRTC 2015-326 remain ongoing. For the second phase, which involves FTTP wholesale services for the rest of Canada (including our serving territories), a proceeding on technical configurations commenced in 2017 and the associated cost study and tariff review will follow. The timing of the FTTP follow-up activities will also be affected by the recent application filed by the Canadian Network Operators Consortium Inc. (CNOC) to review the wholesale high-speed Internet access services framework. The CRTC has conducted a process to examine CNOC’s proposed interim relief, and a decision on this is pending. The CRTC has also asked parties to comment on the substantive elements of CNOC’s application. In any event, we anticipate no material adverse impact in the short term from the CRTC’s decision. Given the phased implementation of the mandated provision of wholesale access to our FTTP network, it is too early to determine the impact this decision will have on us in the longer term. The provision of access to unbundled local loops (ULLs) to competitors had not been mandated as of July 22, 2018, subject to the approval of an application setting out a test for ULL forbearance, which addresses areas where forbearance for retail voice service was predicated on the availability of ULLs. We filed such an application on January 19, 2018, and on September 11, 2018, the CRTC approved our application, which means that our provision of ULLs is based on commercial arrangements rather than a CRTC-approved tariff.

 

CRTC report on sales practices of large telecommunications carriers

 

On June 14, 2018, the Governor in Council directed the CRTC, pursuant to section 14 of the  Telecommunications Act , to provide a report, by no later than February 28, 2019, regarding the retail sales practices of Canada’s large telecommunications carriers. The CRTC was directed to examine claims of aggressive or misleading sales practices concerning telecommunications services, the prevalence and impact on consumers, and potential solutions. On July 16, 2018, the CRTC issued a notice of consultation commencing its inquiry. We participated actively in this proceeding, highlighted the customer service successes associated with our customers first journey, and proposed a code of conduct consolidating existing regulations with no further substantive regulation. The CRTC received written submissions from parties and intervenors in August and September 2018, an oral hearing was held in October 2018, and parties and intervenors made final written submissions on November 9, 2018. While we feel that the CRTC’s current regulations allow the CRTC to adequately regulate sales practices, until the CRTC releases its report in 2019, it is too early to determine any new potential impacts on us.

 

Competition Bureau market study on competition in broadband services

 

On May 10, 2018, the Competition Bureau commenced a market study to better understand the competitive dynamics of Canada’s broadband Internet services industry. The Bureau states that the purpose of the study is to better understand these market outcomes and the competitive dynamics of Canadian broadband markets more generally, including whether resellers are fulfilling their role in placing increased competitive discipline on traditional telephone and cable companies. The Bureau expects to publish the results of the study in a public report, which may include recommendations to relevant government authorities, as appropriate. The Bureau states that the study will enable it to, among other things: make informed regulatory interventions regarding steps that regulators or policymakers could take to further support competition in the broadband industry; and increase its knowledge and understanding of the competitive dynamics of the broadband industry, and the telecommunications industry more generally, to inform the Bureau’s future work. We are participating in this proceeding and filed our initial submissions with the Bureau on August 31, 2018. It is undertaking further stakeholder engagement and research, as well as information analysis. The Bureau intends to publish a draft report in spring 2019, at which point it will hold public consultations and then publish a final report.

 

 

73


 

Phase-out of the local service subsidy regime

 

On June 26, 2018, the CRTC issued Phase-out of the local service subsidy regime, Telecom Regulatory Policy CRTC 2018-213 . In this decision, the CRTC determined that it would phase out the existing local service subsidy over three years, from January 1, 2019 to December 31, 2021. In September 2018, the Independent Telecommunications Providers Association (ITPA), which represents small ILECs, brought an application to the CRTC to review and vary this decision. In its application, the ITPA seeks to keep the existing local service subsidy regime in place. If upheld, the impact of this decision is not expected to be material .

 

Review of the price cap and local forbearance regimes

 

Simultaneously with the release of the Phase-out of the local service subsidy regime decision noted above, the CRTC issued Review of the price cap and local forbearance regimes, Telecom Notice of Consultation CRTC 2018-214 . In this proceeding, the CRTC intends to review, among other things: pricing constraints for residential local exchange services; whether compensation to ILECs is required given that the local service subsidy is being eliminated further to the Phase-out of the local service subsidy regime decision; whether there is still a need for an exogenous factor mechanism in the price cap regimes; and whether changes are necessary to test for local forbearance. It is too early to determine the impact of this proceeding. Initial submissions were filed on October 10, 2018.

 

Code of conduct for retail Internet services

 

On November 9, 2018, the CRTC issued Call for comments — Proceeding to establish a mandatory code for Internet services, Telecom Notice of Consultation CRTC 2018-422 . In this proceeding, the CRTC is considering establishing a mandatory code of conduct to address the clarity of contracts for retail fixed access Internet services and related issues. Among other things, the CRTC is proposing mandating the provision of a critical information summary, limiting early cancellation fees, and requiring that ISPs offer a cooling-off period for customers who sign term contracts. In our written submissions filed December 19, 2018, we stressed that TELUS already undertakes many of these initiatives as part of our customers first initiatives, but argued that certain proposals should not be adopted, including, among other things, certain restrictions, early cancellation fees and the CRTC’s proposal to give a new code retrospective effect. The proceeding remains ongoing, with a decision anticipated by the end of 2019. It is too early to determine the impact of this proceeding on us.

 

Broadcasting-related issues

 

Broadcasting licences held by TELUS

 

Our regional licences to operate broadcasting distribution undertakings in B.C. and Alberta have been granted renewals in Broadcasting Decision CRTC 2018-267, which extend the licence terms to August 31, 2023. Our regional broadcasting distribution licence to serve Quebec has also been granted an additional administrative renewal, which has extended the current licence terms to March 31, 2019. A renewal of our regional licence to operate broadcasting distribution undertakings in Quebec is expected by the end of the first quarter of 2019. Our licence to operate a national video-on-demand service was renewed to August 31, 2023, as part of Broadcasting Decision CRTC 2018-20.

 

CRTC ordered to report back to federal government on distribution models of the future

 

On September 22, 2017, the Governor in Council issued an Order in Council pursuant to section 15 of the Broadcasting Act to request that the CRTC hold hearings and report on distribution models of the future and how Canadians will access programming. On May 31, 2018, the CRTC issued its report, titled Harnessing Change: The Future of Programming Distribution in Canada, which provides an overview of the state of programming content distribution in Canada and sets out some options for change to the policy framework for consideration. This report will likely form part of the record for the joint review of the Broadcasting Act and Telecommunications Act by a panel of experts as described below. The CRTC has also announced in its forecast of activities for 2019 to 2020 that it intends to implement some of the new initiatives discussed in its report. Further consultations are anticipated but the outcomes are not expected to have any negative material impact on us.

 

Review of the Telecommunications Act and the Broadcasting Act

 

On June 5, 2018, the federal government announced a joint review of the Telecommunications Act and the Broadcasting Act to be conducted by a panel of seven experts, which will have until January 31, 2020 to provide its final recommendations. Written submissions in response to the panel’s call for comments were filed by January 11, 2019, and the panel expects to issue an interim report in the spring of 2019 on what it has heard during this consultation process. At this time, we do not know the impact of the review and any resulting amendments to the Telecommunications Act , the Broadcasting Act or the Radiocommunication Act (all three of which form the main legislative framework for communications).

 

Review of the Copyright Act and Copyright Board

 

The Copyright Act ’s mandated five-year review was due in 2017 and the process for review via parliamentary committee was announced in December 2017. Both the Standing Committee on Industry, Science and Technology and the Standing Committee on Canadian Heritage are engaged in reviewing aspects of the Copyright Act and its policy

 

 

74


 

framework. The expected completion timeline for this review is early 2019.  The policy approach for copyright has traditionally been based on a balance of interests of creators and consumers, and as a result, changes to the Copyright Act are not expected to have a negative material impact on us.

 

10.        Risks and risk management

 

10.1 Overview

 

Our business activities expose us to both risks and opportunities. Risk oversight and management processes are integral elements of our risk governance and strategic planning efforts.

 

 

Board risk governance and oversight

 

We maintain strong risk governance and oversight practices, with risk oversight responsibilities outlined in the Board’s and the Board committees’ terms of reference. The Board is responsible for ensuring the identification of material risks to our business and overseeing the implementation of appropriate systems and processes to identify, monitor and manage material risks.

 

In addition:

 

·                   Risks on the enterprise key risk profile are assigned for Board or committee oversight

 

·                   Board committees provide updates to the Board on the risks they oversee based on their respective terms of reference

 

·                   Board or Board committees may request risk briefings by our executive risk owners. The Vice-President, Risk Management and Chief Internal Auditor attends and/or receives a summary of these briefings.

 

Risk governance and culture

 

We have a strong risk governance culture across TELUS that starts with clear risk management leadership and transparent communications, supported by our Board and Executive Leadership Team. In our approach to risk governance, accountability for the management of risks and reporting of risk information is clearly defined. Training and awareness programs, appropriate resources and risk champions help to ensure we have the risk management competencies necessary to support effective decision-making across the organization. Ethics are integral to our risk governance culture, and our code of ethics and conduct directs team members to meet the highest standards of integrity in all business decisions and actions.

 

Responsibilities for risk management

 

We take a multi-step approach to managing risks, with responsibility shared across the organization. The first line of assurance is executive and operating management, and its members are expected to integrate risk management into core decision-making processes (including strategic planning processes) and day-to-day operations. We have risk management and compliance functions across the organization, in areas including Finance, Legal, Data and Trust (which includes Privacy), Security and other business operational areas, which form the second line of assurance. These functions establish policies, provide guidance and expertise, and work collaboratively with management to monitor the design and operation of controls. Internal Audit is the third line of assurance, providing independent assurance regarding the effectiveness and efficiency of risk management and controls across all areas of our business.

 

Definition of business risk

 

We define business risk by the degree of exposure associated with the achievement of key strategic, financial, organizational and process objectives in relation to the effectiveness and efficiency of operations, the reliability and

 

 

75


 

integrity of financial reporting, compliance with laws, regulations, policies, procedures and contracts, and safeguarding of assets within an ethical organizational culture.

 

Our enterprise risks arise primarily from our business environment and are fundamentally linked to our strategies and business objectives. We strive to proactively mitigate our risk exposures through performance planning, business operational management and risk response strategies, which can include mitigating, transferring, retaining and/or avoiding risks. For example, residual exposure for certain risks is mitigated through insurance coverage, if we judge this to be efficient and commercially viable. We also mitigate risks through contract terms, as well as through contingency planning and other risk response strategies, as appropriate.

 

Events outside and within TELUS present us with both risks and opportunities. We strive to avoid taking on undue risk, and we work to ensure alignment of risks with business strategies, objectives, values and risk tolerances; in turn, we also aim to take advantage of opportunities that may emerge.

 

Risk and control assessment process

 

We have in place multi-level enterprise risk and control assessment processes that solicit and incorporate insights of leaders from all areas of TELUS and enable us to track multi-year trends in key risks and the control environment across the organization.

 

Multi-level enterprise risk and control assessment processes

 

Annual risk and control assessment

 

We conduct a comprehensive annual review that includes:

 

·            Interviews with executive leaders

 

·            Information from our ongoing strategic planning process

 

·           Consideration of recent internal and external audits, SOX ( Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002) compliance and risk management activities

 

·            An extensive enterprise-wide risk and control environment assessment aligned with the COSO (Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission) enterprise risk management and internal control integrated frameworks.

 

Board members complete an annual assessment providing perspectives on our key risks, risk appetite, and approach to enterprise risk management.

 

Key enterprise risks are identified, defined and prioritized. Risk appetite and effectiveness of risk management integration are evaluated by risk category and fraud risks are considered.

 

Results of the assessments are shared with senior management, our Board of Directors and the Audit Committee, and inform the development of our risk-focused internal audit program. They are also incorporated into our strategic planning, operational risk management and performance management processes.

 

Quarterly risk assessment

 

We conduct quarterly risk assessment reviews with our executive-level risk owners and designated risk primes across all business units to capture and communicate changing business risks, assess perceptions of inherent and residual risk, identify key risk mitigation activities, and provide quarterly key risk updates and assurance to the Audit Committee and other Board committees.

 

Other specific risk assessments

 

We conduct ongoing and/or detailed risk assessments for various risk management, strategic and operational initiatives (e.g. strategic planning, project and environmental management, safety, business continuity planning, network and IT vulnerability, and fraud and ethics) and for specific audit engagements. Results of risk assessments are evaluated, prioritized, updated and integrated into decision-making, policies and processes, as well as the key risk profile, throughout the year.

 

Principal risks and uncertainties

 

The following subsections describe our principal risks and uncertainties and associated risk mitigation activities. The significance of these risks is such that they alone or in combination may have material impacts on our business operations, results, reputation and brand, as well as the valuation approaches taken by investment analysts when they evaluate TELUS.

 

Although we believe the measures taken to mitigate risks described below are reasonable, there can be no expectation or assurance that they will effectively mitigate or fully address the risks described or that new developments and risks will not materially affect our operations or financial results. Forward-looking statements in this section and elsewhere in this MD&A are based on the assumption that our risk mitigation measures will be effective. See Caution regarding forward-looking statements .

 

10.2 Regulatory matters

 

The regulatory regime under which we operate, including the laws, regulations, and decisions in regulatory proceedings and court cases, reviews, appeals, policy announcements, and other developments, such as those described in Section 9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings , imposes conditions on the products

 

 

76


 

and services that we provide and the ways in which we provide them. The regulatory regime sets forth, among other matters, rates, terms and conditions for the provision of telecommunications services, licensing of broadcast services, licensing of spectrum and radio apparatus, and restrictions on ownership and control by non-Canadians.

 

Changes to our regulatory regime

 

Changes to the regulatory regime under which we operate, including changes to laws and regulations, could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations, operating procedures and profitability. Such changes may not be anticipated or, where they are anticipated, our assessment of their impact on us and our business may not be accurate. While we are involved or intervene in proceedings, court cases or inquiries related to the application of the regulatory regime, such as those described in Section 9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings, there is no certainty that the positions we advocate in such proceedings will be adopted or that our prediction of the likely outcomes of such proceedings will be accurate. Changes to our regulatory regime could increase our costs, restrict or impede the way we provide our services, what services we provide or manage our network, or alter customer perceptions of our operations. The further regulation of our broadband, wireless and other activities and any related regulatory decisions could also restrict our ability to compete in the marketplace and limit the return we can expect to achieve on past and future investments in our network. Through TELUS Health, we are entering into new areas such as virtual care and electronic prescriptions, which are less predictable from a regulatory regime perspective, can be subject to different regulations in certain provinces, and can be subject to political intervention. See also Legal and ethical compliance in Section 10.9 Litigation and legal matters .

 

Government or regulatory actions with respect to certain countries or suppliers may impact us and other Canadian telecommunications carriers. The Government of Canada is currently conducting a cybersecurity review of international suppliers of next-generation network equipment and technologies, focused on Huawei Technologies, to evaluate potential risks to the development of 5G networks in Canada. A decision on 5G technology in Canada is expected in the coming months. Over the last decade, our partnership with Huawei has allowed us to utilize the most advanced technology in a cost-effective manner in our advanced 3G and 4G networks without any security incidents. In building our 3G and 4G national networks, we have collaborated closely with the Government of Canada for many years to ensure robust protections across all equipment used. This has included complying with a series of security protocols that effectively ban Chinese equipment from our core networks and limit such equipment to the less sensitive radio and antenna portions. We are continuing to work with the government as it conducts this cybersecurity review and we have yet to select a vendor for our 5G network. Given the range of potential outcomes of the cybersecurity review, the impact on Canadian wireless service providers cannot currently be predicted. A decision prohibiting the deployment of Huawei technology without compensation or other accommodations being made by the Government of Canada could have a material, non-recurring, incremental increase in the cost of TELUS’ 5G network deployment and, potentially, the timing of such deployment. In the case of a ban, there is a risk that the Canadian telecom market would undergo a structural change, as a reduction to an only two global supplier environment could permanently affect the cost structure of 5G equipment for all operators. See Section 10.4 Supplier risks .

 

Risk mitigation: We attempt to mitigate regulatory risks through our advocacy at all levels of government, including our participation in CRTC and federal government proceedings, studies, reviews and other consultations; representations before provincial and municipal governments pertaining to telecommunications issues; legal proceedings impacting our operations at all levels of the courts; and other relevant inquiries (such as those relating to the exclusive federal jurisdiction over telecommunications), as described in Section 9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings . See also Vertical integration into broadcast content ownership by competitors in Section 10.3 Competitive environment.

 

Spectrum and compliance with licences

 

We require access to radio spectrum in order to operate our wireless business. The allocation and use of spectrum in Canada are governed by Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada (ISED), which establishes spectrum policies, determines spectrum auction frameworks, issues licences and sets radio authorization conditions. While we believe that we are substantially in compliance with our radio authorization conditions, there can be no assurance that we will be found to comply with all radio authorization conditions, or if we are found not to be compliant, that a waiver will be granted or that the costs to be incurred to achieve compliance will not be significant. Any failure to comply with the radio authorization conditions could result in the revocation of our licences and/or the imposition of fines. Our ability to provide competitive services, including our ability to improve our current services and offer new services on a timely basis, is also dependent on our ability to obtain access to new spectrum licences at a reasonable cost as they are made available. The revocation of, or a material limitation on, certain of our spectrum licences, or our failure to obtain access to new spectrum as it becomes available, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition by, among other things, negatively affecting both the quality and reliability of our network and service offering, and our brand, and thereby impeding our ability to attract or retain our customers.

 

Risk mitigation: We continue to strive to comply with all radio authorization and spectrum licence and renewal conditions and plan to participate in future wireless spectrum auctions. We continue to advocate with the federal government for fair spectrum auction rules, so that mobile wireless companies like TELUS can bid on an equal footing with other competitors for spectrum blocks available at auction and can purchase spectrum licences available for sale from competitors. We continue to strongly advocate that preferential treatment is not required for advanced wireless services (AWS) entrants, including for 5G services, most notably for entrants that are now part of established, sophisticated and well-financed cable companies.

 

Restrictions on non-Canadian ownership and control

 

We are subject to Canadian ownership and control restrictions, including restrictions on the ownership of our Common Shares by non-Canadians, imposed by the Canadian Telecommunications Common Carrier Ownership and Control Regulations under the Telecommunications Act (collectively, the Telecommunications Regulations) and the Direction to the CRTC (Ineligibility of Non-Canadians) , as ordered by the Governor in Council pursuant to the Broadcasting Act (the Broadcasting Direction). Although we believe that we are in compliance with the relevant legislation, future CRTC or Canadian Heritage determinations, or events beyond our control, could result in us ceasing to be in compliance with the relevant legislation. If such a development were to occur, the ability of our subsidiaries to operate as Canadian carriers under the Telecommunications Act or to maintain, renew or secure licences under the Radiocommunication Act and the Broadcasting Act could be jeopardized and our business could be materially adversely affected.

 

 

77


 

Under the Telecommunications Regulations, in order to maintain our eligibility to operate certain of our subsidiaries that are deemed to be Canadian carriers by law, among other requirements, the level of non-Canadian ownership of TELUS Common Shares cannot exceed 33 1 / 3 % and we must not otherwise be controlled by non-Canadians. The Broadcasting Direction further provides for a qualified corporation, which can be a subsidiary corporation whose parent corporation or its directors do not exercise control or influence over any programming decisions of the subsidiary corporation where:

 

(a)          Canadians beneficially own and control less than 80% of the issued and outstanding voting shares of the parent corporation and less than 80% of the votes

 

(b)          The chief executive officer is a non-Canadian or

 

(c)           Less than 80% of the directors of the parent corporation are Canadian.

 

Risk mitigation: As we are a holding corporation of Canadian carriers, the Telecommunications Regulations give us certain powers to monitor and control the level of non-Canadian ownership of our Common Shares. These powers have been incorporated into our Articles and extended to ensure compliance under both the Broadcasting Act and the Radiocommunication Act (under which the requirements for Canadian ownership and control were subsequently cross-referenced to the Telecommunications Act ). These powers include the right to: (i) refuse to register a transfer of Common Shares to a non-Canadian; (ii) require a non-Canadian to sell any Common Shares; and (iii) suspend the voting rights attached to the Common Shares held by non-Canadians in inverse order of registration. We have reasonable controls in place to monitor foreign ownership levels through a reservation and declaration system. On August 10, 2017, in response to levels of foreign ownership of shares exceeding 20% and in accordance with the Broadcasting Direction, the TELUS Board of Directors appointed an independent programming committee to make all programming decisions relating to its licensed broadcasting undertakings.

 

10.3 Competitive environment

 

Customer experience

 

Our customers’ loyalty and their likelihood to recommend TELUS are both dependent upon our ability to provide a service experience that meets or exceeds their expectations. Consequently, if our service experience or sales practices do not meet or exceed customer expectations, our reputation and brand could suffer, potentially resulting in higher rates of customer churn. Meanwhile, our profitability could be negatively impacted should customer net additions decrease and/or the costs to acquire and retain customers increase.

 

Risk mitigation: Our top corporate priority is putting customers first and earning our way to industry leadership in the likelihood to recommend from our clients. In fact, 55% of the scorecard we use internally to measure our corporate performance is weighted to team member engagement and customer experience. Effective and fair compensation plans are part of achieving high team member engagement and include measures on how well we serve the customer — through the eyes of the customer. To enhance the customer experience, we continue to invest in our products and services, system and network reliability, team members, and system and process improvements. Additionally, we endeavour to introduce innovative products and services, enhance our current services with integrated bundled offers and invest in customer-focused initiatives to bring greater transparency and simplicity to our customers, all in order to help differentiate our services from those of our competitors. With respect to sales practices, our primary performance objective for our call centre team members in sales functions is customer satisfaction.

 

Intense wireless competition is expected to continue

 

At the end of 2018, there were nine facilities-based wireless competitors operating in Canada: three national carriers, (TELUS, Rogers and Bell) and six regional carriers. (See Competition overview in Section 4.1.) In addition, the national carriers each operate three distinct brands to better compete across various customer segments. In late 2018, Quebecor’s Videotron launched Fizz, its second wireless brand, to target the prepaid segment, while in Manitoba, Xplornet launched Xplore Mobile.

 

All wireless competitors use various promotional offers to attract customers, including price discounting on both handsets and rate plans, large allotments of data, flat-rate pricing for voice and data, and bundling with wireline services. Such promotional activity, as well as the sustained consumer appetite for higher-value smartphones, combined with the effect of the ongoing Canadian dollar to U.S. dollar exchange rate implications, may continue to lead to higher costs of acquisition and retention. Meanwhile, more inclusive rate plans, including international roaming and larger allotments of data for data sharing, and substitution by increasingly available Wi-Fi networks could lead to a reduction in chargeable data usage, resulting in pressure on average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU) and customer churn. (See Wireless trends and seasonality in Section 5.4 .)

 

We also expect increased competition based on the use of unlicensed spectrum to deliver higher-speed data services, such as the use of Wi-Fi networks to deliver entertainment to customers beyond the home. In addition, satellite

 

 

78


 

operators such as Xplornet are augmenting their existing high-speed Internet access (HSIA) services by launching high-throughput satellites. See also Section 9.4 Communications industry regulatory developments and proceedings .

 

Risk mitigation : Our 4G wireless technology covers approximately 99% of Canada’s population, facilitated by network access agreements with Bell Canada and SaskTel. Wireless 4G technologies have enabled us to establish and maintain a strong position in smartphone and data device selection and expand roaming capability to more than 225 destinations. Faster data download speeds provided by these technologies enable delivery of our Optik ®  on the go service to mobile devices when customers are beyond the reach of Wi-Fi.

 

To compete more effectively in a variety of customer segments, in addition to our full-service TELUS brand, we also offer two flanker brands — Koodo Mobile and Public Mobile. We believe that by leveraging our three brands through uniquely targeted value propositions and, distinct distribution and web-based channels, as well as by bundling wireless services with our home services in our incumbent markets, we are well positioned to compete with other wireless service providers.

 

We continue our disciplined long-term strategy of investing in our growth areas and executing upon our customers first priority. We intend to continue to market and distribute innovative and differentiated wireless services; offer bundled wireless services (e.g. voice, text and data), including data sharing plans; invest in our extensive network and systems to support customer service; evolve technologies; invest in our distribution channels; and acquire the use of spectrum to facilitate service development and the expansion of our subscriber base, as well as to address the accelerating growth in demand for data usage. Our investments in our fibre-optic network are supporting our small-cell technology strategy to improve coverage, capacity and back-haul while preparing for a more efficient and timely evolution to a converged 5G network. In addition, we continue to implement operational effectiveness initiatives to drive improvements in EBITDA. (See Reorganizations and integration of acquisitions in Section 10.5. )

 

Wireline voice and data competition

 

We expect competition to remain intense from traditional telephony, data, IP and information technology (IT) service providers, as well as from VoIP-focused competitors in both consumer and business markets. This competitive intensity, including the use of various promotional offers, also places pressures on ARPU, churn and costs of acquisition and retention.

 

The industry continues to transition from legacy voice infrastructure to IP telephony and Unified Communications, and from legacy data platforms to mature data platforms such as Ethernet, IP virtual private networks, multi-protocol label switching IP platforms and emerging software-defined networking solutions. These transitions continue to create both uncertainties and opportunities. Legacy data revenues and margins continue to decline, and this has been only partially offset by growth in demand and/or migration of customers to IP-based platforms. IP-based solutions are also subject to downward pricing pressure, lower margins and technological evolution.

 

Business

 

In the business wireline market, traditional facilities-based competitors continue to compete based on network footprint and reliability, while over-the-top (OTT) providers emphasize price, flexibility and convenience. Having made significant investments in voice over IP (VoIP), security and IT services for business, cable-based competitors are using price discounting to drive new customer acquisition and retention. In addition, larger cloud service providers, such as Amazon and Microsoft, leverage global scale to offer low-cost data storage and cloud computing services. Rapidly advancing technologies, such as software-defined networks and virtualized network functions, enable the layering of new services in cloud-centric solutions. Evolving customer needs represent both a growth opportunity and a risk to our legacy voice and data revenue, as businesses seek to shift fixed local line, long distance and/or voicemail services to the new lower-priced cloud-centric market paradigm.

 

Consumer

 

In the consumer wireline market, cable-TV companies and other competitors continue to combine a mix of residential local VoIP, long distance, HSIA and, in some cases, wireless services under one bundled and/or discounted monthly rate, along with their existing broadcast or satellite-based TV services. In addition, Canadian cable competitors are investing in next-generation TV platforms. In 2017, Shaw Communications, our primary cable competitor in Alberta and B.C., launched BlueSky TV, licensing the X1 platform developed by Comcast, a U.S.-based cable company. In 2018, Rogers launched Ignite TV in Ontario, based on the same Comcast X1 platform, and Quebecor has announced its intention to unveil Helix, a TV offering also based on the Comcast X1 TV platform, in 2019 in Quebec. Meanwhile, Cogeco Communications, which provides cable services in part of our incumbent footprint in Quebec, announced it is partnering with MediaKind to offer its customers the MediaFirst platform. The MediaFirst platform is the same IP TV platform used to deliver TELUS TV. At the same time, Canadian cable competitors continue to increase the speed of their HSIA offerings and their rollout of Wi-Fi services in metropolitan areas. To a lesser extent, other non-facilities-based competitors offer local and long distance VoIP services over the Internet and resell HSIA solutions. Technological innovation has resulted in an improvement in the performance and speed of satellite-based Internet access services and

 

 

79


 

enhanced their competiveness. Erosion of our residential network access lines (NALs) is expected to continue due to this competition and ongoing technological substitution by wireless and VoIP. Legacy voice revenues are also expected to continue to decline. It is expected that competition in the consumer space will remain intense. In our TELUS Health business, we compete with other providers of electronic medical records and pharmacy management products, systems integrators and health service providers including those that own a vertically integrated mix of health services delivery, IT solutions, and related services, and global providers that could achieve expanded Canadian footprints.

 

Risk mitigation: We are making significant investments in our broadband infrastructure, including connecting more homes and businesses directly to our gigabit-capable fibre-optic network. These investments meet customer demand for faster Internet service, including symmetrical download and upload speeds, expand the coverage of our high-speed Internet service, and extend the coverage, capability and content lineup of our IP-based TV services, including Optik TV in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec and Pik TV in Western Canada (see Broadcasting below). Additionally, we offer customers in underserved communities a fixed wireless Internet service over our LTE access technology, further expanding our broadband reach. Our broadband investments extend the reach and functionality of our business and healthcare solutions and will support a more efficient and timely evolution to a converged 5G network.

 

The provision of our IP TV services and service bundles helps us attract and pull through Internet subscriptions and mitigate residential NAL losses. We are continuing to evolve IP TV services by enabling ultra-high definition 4K HDR content, integrating our services with conversational interfaces, and increasing our focus on and investment in growing multicultural segments. Meanwhile, customers can now stream live TV on their laptop, tablet or smartphone with the Pik TV app, as well as through Apple TV. We also continue to invest in other product and service development initiatives, including smart home and connected home capabilities, home security and monitoring, and consumer health solutions. We continue to enhance our TV content capabilities with greater choice and flexibility of channels in theme packs and on an individual basis, a wider variety of multicultural content, OTT solutions that can be streamed or accessed directly through a set-top box and enabling ultra-high definition 4K HDR content.

 

We continue to add to our capabilities in the business market through prudent product development initiatives, including new advanced cloud-based solutions such as Network as a Service (NaaS), a combination of acquisitions and partnerships, a focus on key vertical markets (public sector, healthcare, financial services, energy, agriculture and telecommunications wholesale) and expansion of solution sets in the enterprise market, as well as our modular approach in the small and medium-sized business (SMB) market (including services such as TELUS Business Connect ® ) and Internet of Things (IoT) solutions. In addition, we also have retention plans in place to mitigate the loss of business customers as their needs evolve. Through TELUS Health, we have leveraged our systems, proprietary solutions and third-party solutions to extend our footprint in healthcare and benefit from the investments in eHealth being made by governments. Additionally, through our customer care, CCBS and our multi-site customer service centres, we enable experiences that realize efficiencies, cost savings and business growth for our customers.

 

Technological substitution may adversely affect market share, volume and pricing

 

We face technological substitution across all key business lines and market segments, including the consumer, SMB and large enterprise markets, TELUS Health and TI.

 

Technological advances have blurred the boundaries between broadcasting, Internet and telecommunications. (See Section 10.4 Technology. ) Wireless carriers and cable-TV companies continue to expand their offerings and launch next-generation TV platforms, resulting in intensified competition for high-speed Internet services in residential and certain SMB markets, as well as for TV services and local access and long distance. OTT services, such as Netflix, Amazon Prime Video and YouTube compete for share of viewership, which may accelerate the disconnection of TV services or affect subscriber and revenue growth in our TV and entertainment services. Wireless voice ARPU continues to decline as a result of, among other factors, switching to messaging and OTT applications. We expect pressure from customer acquisition efforts and content distribution, costs and pricing to continue across most product and service categories and market segments in the industry.

 

Risk mitigation: Our IP TV and OTT multimedia initiatives provide the next generation of IP TV and, importantly, tie our OTT environment to one platform, enabling us to be agile in the delivery of OTT services, such as Netflix and YouTube. They also facilitate cloud-based media delivery and ultimately everything on demand, on any device, on any network. Active monitoring of competitive developments and internal prototyping in product and geographic markets enable us to respond rapidly to competitor offers and leverage our full suite of integrated wireless and wireline solutions and national reach, and we also monitor global telecom carriers for their next-generation OTT offers. To mitigate losses in legacy services in our incumbent areas of B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec, investments are being made in our broadband network, including our fibre-optic technology, in order to increase speeds, improve network reliability, expand our reach and provide an industry-leading customer experience. We also continue to introduce and enhance innovative products and services such as Pik TV, enable ultra-high definition 4K HDR content, include integrated bundled offers across our services, and invest in customer-focused initiatives to improve our customers’ experience. The adoption of new technologies and products is pursued to improve the efficiency of our service offerings.

 

 

80


 

Broadcasting

 

We offer IP TV services to more than three million households and businesses in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec, and we continue targeted rollouts in new areas. Our TV services provide numerous interactivity and customization advantages over those of our primary cable-TV competitor. In 2018, we added 63,000 TV subscribers, ending the year with a total of 1.1 million TV subscribers. In 2019 and beyond, there can be no assurance that subscriber growth rates will be maintained or that we will achieve planned revenue growth and greater operating efficiency in the context of a high level of industry market penetration, a declining overall market for retail TV services, and actions by our competitors and content suppliers. In addition, competition from OTT services, content piracy and signal theft could also affect subscriber and revenue growth by accelerating the disconnection of TV services or reducing spending on those services.

 

Risk mitigation: We have broadened the addressable market for our IP TV services through the deployment of advanced broadband technologies, including the continued expansion of our fibre-optic network to homes and businesses in communities across B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec. We continue to introduce new features and capabilities to our TV services, including OTT offerings such as Netflix and YouTube, and strengthen our leadership position in Western Canada in the number of high-definition linear channels, video-on-demand services and ultra-high definition 4K HDR content.

 

Vertical integration into broadcast content ownership by competitors

 

We are not currently seeking to be a broadcast content owner, but some of our competitors own and continue to acquire broadcast content assets, which could result in content being withheld from us or being made available to us at inflated prices or on unattractive terms.

 

Risk mitigation: Our strategy is to aggregate, integrate and make accessible content and applications for our customers’ enjoyment, on a timely basis across multiple devices. We have demonstrated that it is not necessary to own content in order to make it accessible to customers on an economically attractive basis, provided there is timely and strict enforcement of the CRTC’s regulatory safeguards to prevent abusive practices by vertically integrated competitors.

 

We support a regime under the Broadcasting Act that ensures all Canadian consumers continue to have equitable access to broadcast content irrespective of the distributor or platform they choose. We continue to advocate for the timely and strict enforcement of the CRTC vertical integration safeguards and for further meaningful safeguards, as required. We also actively intervene in broadcast licence renewals of vertically integrated competitors.

 

10.4 Technology

 

Technology is a key enabler of our business, however, its evolution brings risks and uncertainties, as well as opportunities. We maintain short-term and long-term strategies to optimize our selection and timely use of technology while minimizing the associated costs, risks and uncertainties. Following are our main technology risks and uncertainties and a description of how we proactively address them.

 

High demand for data challenges wireless networks and may be accompanied by increases in delivery cost

 

The demand for wireless data services continues to grow rapidly, driven by ongoing broadband penetration, growing personal connectivity and networking, improvements in the affordability and selection of smartphones and high-usage data devices, richer multimedia services and applications, IoT services (including machine-to-machine data applications and other wearable technology), growth in cloud-based services and changes arising from wireless price competition, including larger allotments of data in rate plans. For example, according to the CRTC Communications Monitoring Report 2018, the average data usage per subscriber over mobile wireless networks increased by 30% in 2017, while the total measure of retail wireless data revenue increased by 7.8% over the same period. Rising data traffic levels and the fast pace of data device innovation present challenges to providing adequate capacity and maintaining high service levels at competitive cost structures.

 

Risk mitigation : Our ongoing investments in our 4G LTE technology, including LTE advanced (LTE-A) technology, as well as foundational investments in early 5G capabilities, allow us to manage data capacity demands by more effectively utilizing the spectrum we hold. We intend to deploy newer standards-based technologies that are ready for commercial implementation to the network in order to provide higher-performance connectivity solutions. In addition, the evolution to LTE-A technologies is supported by our investments in IP network, IP/fibre back-haul to cell sites, including our small cells, and a software-upgradeable radio infrastructure. The LTE-A expansion is expected to further increase network capacity and speed, reduce delivery costs per megabyte, enable richer multimedia applications and services, and deliver a superior subscriber experience. Our 4G LTE access technology covers 99% of Canada’s population, while our LTE-A access technology covers 93% of the Canadian population, up from 88% at the end of 2017.

 

Mobile network infrastructure investment will increasingly be directed to systems based on network function virtualization (NFV) that offer greater capacity for computing and storage, higher resiliency, and more flexible software design. Our large-scale move to national, geographically distributed data centres that use generalized commercial off-

 

 

81


 

the-shelf computing and storage solutions enables the utilization of broad-scale NFV and software-defined network technologies, which will allow us to virtualize much of our infrastructure and will also facilitate a common control plane for coordination of our virtualized and non-virtualized network assets. The architecture of our intelligence and content capabilities is located at the edge of our mobility network, close to our customers. The distributed smaller-scale computing power and storage deliver services faster while managing the ongoing need to continually scale the IP/fibre core network infrastructure.

 

Rapid growth of wireless data volumes requires optimal and efficient utilization of our spectrum holdings, which have more than doubled through our 2014 and 2015 purchases of 700 MHz, AWS-3 and 2500 MHz spectrum licences. We are now deploying those licences as required to provide added capacity to mitigate risks from growing data traffic. We also plan to combine our licensed spectrum with unlicensed supplementary spectrum, as network and device ecosystems evolve to support licensed assisted access (LAA) technology. The spectrum licences previously used for our CDMA access technology have been repurposed for use with LTE technology. Our public Wi-Fi service increasingly integrates seamlessly with our 4G access technology and offloads data traffic from our wireless spectrum to a continually growing number of available Wi-Fi hotspots. Our deployment of small-cell technology, coupled with both licensed and licence-exempt spectrum technologies, helps us achieve a more efficient utilization of our spectrum holdings.

 

Roll-out and evolution of wireless broadband technologies and systems

 

As part of a natural 4G access technology progression, we are committed to LTE-A and LTE technology to support the medium-term and long-term growth of our mobile broadband services. Our business depends on the deployment of wireless technology. The repurposing of spectrum holdings must be managed appropriately to ensure optimal use of capital and resources. Overall, as wireless broadband technologies and systems evolve, there is the risk that our future capital expenditures may be higher, as our ongoing technology investments could involve costs higher than those historically recorded. See also Supplier risks .

 

Meanwhile, 5G technology is evolving rapidly and the world’s first standards-based commercial launches are expected in 2019, while smartphones are generally expected to support 5G technology by late 2019 or 2020. It is expected that early 5G ecosystems will operate on three distinct spectrum bands: 3.5 GHz, millimetre wave (mmWave) spectrum (28 GHz and 37-40 GHz) and 600 MHz. Globally, 3.5 GHz spectrum is becoming the primary band for 5G mobile coverage. In Canada, 3.5 GHz spectrum was auctioned for fixed wireless access (FWA) between 2004 and 2009; it is currently not licensed for mobile applications and is largely held by Inukshuk (a joint venture owned by Bell and Rogers) in most urban markets. ISED is expected to claw back a portion of Inukshuk’s 3.5 GHz spectrum holdings and re-auction it for flexible use (permitting the deployment for mobile applications, such as 5G). Depending on the amount of 3.5 GHz spectrum clawed back and re-auctioned, there is a risk that we and the other regional operators could end up with less 3.5 GHz spectrum and would not be able to compete equally in the provision of higher network speeds and 5G capacity. Meanwhile, if ISED releases 3.5 GHz spectrum for mobile use before the 3.5 GHz auction concludes, current holders would have access to 5G spectrum before us and could gain a competitive time to market advantage.

 

With regard to the other spectrum bands, mmWave is expected to be used for very high data demand locations in which customers are not only very close to the antenna but also have an unobstructed view of the transmitting site, as traffic on this spectrum is limited in propagation to hundreds of metres and cannot cover large areas or penetrate obstacles or buildings. Services using this particular spectrum are expected to be an alternative to fibre-to-the-home (FTTH) deployments. The 600 MHz spectrum band is being targeted for 5G in the United States, particularly by T-Mobile USA. In Canada, the 600 MHz auction will commence in March 2019 with ISED auctioning a total of 70 MHz, including a set-aside of 30 MHz for regional service providers. There is a risk that we may not be able to provide 5G services on 600 MHz at the same level of capability as regional wireless carriers. Furthermore, as a result of the government set-aside, there is no guarantee that rural Canada, which 600 MHz propagation is best suited for, will realize the full potential of 5G networks since 30 MHz will be set aside for smaller carriers and possibly only deployed in urban centres.

 

Risk mitigation : Our practice is to continually optimize capital investments in order to ensure reasonable payback periods for generating positive cash flows from investments and flexibility in considering future technology evolutions. Some capital investments, such as wireless towers, leasehold improvements and power systems, are technology-neutral.

 

Our wireless access technologies evolve through software upgrades to support enhancements in systems based on the third-generation partnership project (which unites seven telecommunications standards development organizations and provides their members with a stable environment to produce the reports and specifications that define third-generation partnership technologies) and the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers that improve performance, capacity and speed. We expect to be able to leverage the economies of scale and handset variety of the North American and global ecosystems.

 

Reciprocal network access agreements, principally with Bell Canada, have facilitated our deployment of wireless technologies for the benefit of our customers and provided the means for us to better manage our capital expenditures.

 

 

82


 

These agreements are expected to provide ongoing cost savings, as well as the flexibility to invest in service differentiation and support systems.

 

We maintain close co-operation with our network technology suppliers and operator partners in order to influence and benefit from developments in 5G, LTE-A, LTE and Wi-Fi technologies.

 

In order to influence the timing, rules and policy regarding 3.5 GHz spectrum, we have emphasized to ISED the need for early, fair and timely access to 3.5 GHz spectrum for all operators in order to ensure that Canada continues to lead all G7 countries in terms of wireless speeds and capabilities. We are arguing for a fair treatment of this spectrum band and for ISED to accelerate its release for mobile use to all industry players while avoiding a head start for specific operators. (Refer to Section 10.2 Regulatory matters .) ISED is currently expected to auction the spectrum in late 2020, and assuming successful participation in the auction, operationalizing the spectrum will commence in 2021.

 

In order to prepare for the future deployment of mmWave spectrum, we continue to conduct 5G trials in the mmWave spectrum bands. Our trials have established a platform that will form the basis for evaluating our future 5G use cases and will help us prepare for network planning in the mmWave bands. Additionally, we continue to collaborate with ISED, sharing trial results in discussions to help guide the regulator as it finalizes its decisions on establishing the policy and timing for the release of mmWave spectrum for 5G. The auction for mmWave spectrum is expected to occur in 2021. Furthermore, our investment in small cells will help us densify our network and mitigate potential speed and capacity disadvantages created by 3.5 GHz availability, as well as improve future mmWave deployment feasibility, cost and time to market.

 

Disruptive technology

 

A paradigm shift with the consumer adoption of alternative technologies, such as video and voice OTT offerings (e.g. Netflix, FaceTime) and increasingly available Wi-Fi networks, has the potential to negatively affect our revenue streams. For example, Wi-Fi networks are being used to deliver various entertainment services to customers beyond the home. OTT content providers are competing for a share of entertainment viewership. OTT may also impact business segment services by enabling capabilities, that in the past were associated with telecommunications service providers (e.g. Skype, cloud-based services, roaming). On the other hand, the proliferation of low-power wide-area (LPWA) IoT networks opens up new revenue opportunities, combined with the challenges of very low bandwidth usage. These factors, including the growing customer demand for access to Wi-Fi outside the home and OTT services on demand on any device, may drive increased churn rates for our wireless, TELUS TV and high-speed Internet services, and add further pressure on our revenue streams. (See  Intense wireless competition is expected to continue in Section 10.3 Competitive environment and OTT services present challenges to network capacity and conventional business models below.) Advanced self-learning technologies and automation (e.g. artificial intelligence and robotic process automation) will change the way we manage our operations and support customer experience innovation.

 

Risk mitigation : Since early 2014, we have worked with thousands of businesses and many major sports and entertainment venues as we continue to expand our public Wi-Fi infrastructure. This public Wi-Fi service is part of our network strategy of deploying small cells that integrate seamlessly with our 4G wireless access technology, automatically shifting our smartphone customers to Wi-Fi and offloading data traffic from our wireless spectrum. Integrated public Wi-Fi infrastructure build activity naturally extends service and channel opportunities with small and medium-sized enterprises and improves customers’ likelihood-to-recommend. Integration of home Wi-Fi increases the propensity for higher data usage on smartphones within and outside the home, helping to drive the uptake of our Internet service. In addition to the availability of our Wi-Fi service, we have unified communications offerings, including Business Connect with Ring Central and TC2 with Cisco. Our IoT portfolio is also growing, with the addition of services such as Connected Vehicle, GEOTrac, TELUS Alert and Assist and a number of others. Our customer service delivery sites experiment with different automation and self-learning tools to assess the impact such technology may have on customer experiences and operating efficiencies.

 

Supplier risks

 

Supplier limitations or disruption, restructuring of vendors or discontinuance of products may affect our network and services

 

We have relationships with multiple vendors, including large cloud service providers such as Amazon and Microsoft, which are important in supporting network and service evolution plans and delivery of services to our customers. Our vendors may experience business difficulties, privacy and/or security incidents, and government or regulatory pressures. They may restructure their operations, be consolidated with other suppliers, discontinue products or sell their operations or products to other vendors. Government or regulatory actions with respect to certain countries or suppliers may also affect our ability to use the products or technology of certain vendors that we use or that we currently plan to use. Any of these events could affect the future development and support of products or services we use, and ultimately, the success of upgrades and evolution of technology that we offer our customers, such as our IP TV solutions and the roll-out and evolution of our wireless broadband technologies and systems. There can be no guarantee that the outcome of any particular vendor strategy including a decision or requirement to discontinue use of a supplier’s products or technology will not affect the services that we provide to our customers, or that we will not incur additional costs or delays in continuing to provide services or deploying our technologies and systems. We may not be able to replace a supplier or vendor on a timely basis or without incurring additional cost. Certain customer needs and preferences may not be aligned with our vendor selection or product and service offering, which may result in limitations on growth or loss of existing business.

 

 

83


 

Supplier concentration and market power

 

In certain cases the number of suppliers of a product, service or technology that we use is limited. The popularity of certain models of smartphones and tablets has led us to rely on certain manufacturers, which may increase their market power and adversely affect our ability to purchase certain products at an affordable cost. In addition, owners of popular broadcasting content may raise their distribution charges and attempt to renegotiate the broadcasting distribution agreements we have with them, which could adversely affect our entertainment service offerings and/or profitability. See also Wireline in Section 9.2, Broadcasting-related issues in Section 9.4 and Vertical integration into broadcast content ownership by competitors in Section 10.3 . An increase in supplier concentration affecting products, technology and equipment or services that we use or offer to our customers may adversely affect our business, operations or financial results, including by increasing the cost of acquisition or the time required to deploy technology and systems.

 

Risk mitigation : As a leading network aggregator, we partner with several network equipment suppliers and work with numerous international and domestic vendors to deliver the best possible experience for our customers. We consider possible vendor strategies and/or restructuring outcomes when planning for our future growth, as well as the maintenance and support of existing equipment and services. We have reasonable contingency plans for different scenarios, including working with multiple vendors, maintaining ongoing strong vendor relations with periodic reviews of vendor performance and working closely with other product and service users to influence vendors’ product or service development plans. In addition, we regularly monitor the risk profile of our key vendors and review the applicable terms and conditions of our agreements to determine whether additional contractual safeguards are required, and we promote our Supplier Code of Conduct based upon generally accepted standards of ethical business conduct.

 

In respect of supplier market power, we offer and promote alternative devices or programming content to provide greater choice for consumers and to help limit our reliance on a few key suppliers.

 

Support systems will be increasingly critical to operational efficiency

 

We have a large number of interconnected operational and business support systems, and their complexity has been continually increasing, which can affect system stability and availability. The development and launch of a new service typically requires significant systems development and integration efforts. Effective management of all associated development and ongoing operational costs is a significant factor in maintaining a competitive position and profit margins. As next-generation services are introduced, they must work with next-generation systems, frameworks and IT infrastructures, while being compatible with legacy services and support systems. There can be no assurance that any of our proposed IT systems or process change initiatives will be implemented successfully, that they will be implemented in accordance with anticipated timelines, or that sufficiently skilled personnel will be available to complete such initiatives. If we fail to implement and maintain appropriate IT systems on a timely basis, fail to create and maintain an effective governance and operating framework to support the management of staff, or fail to understand and streamline our significant number of legacy systems and proactively meet constantly evolving business requirements, any such failure could have an adverse effect on our business and financial performance.

 

Risk mitigation: In line with industry best practice, our approach is to separate business support systems (BSS) from operational support systems (OSS) and underlying network technology. Our aim is to decouple the introduction of new network technologies from the services we sell to customers so that both can evolve independently. This allows us to optimize network investments while limiting the impact on customer services, and also facilitates the introduction of new services. In addition, due to the maturing nature of telecommunications vendor software, we adopt industry standard software for BSS/OSS functions and avoid custom development where possible. This enables us to leverage vendor knowledge and industry practices acquired through the installation of those platforms at numerous global telecommunications companies. We have established a next-generation BSS/OSS framework to ensure that, as new services and technologies are developed, they are part of the next-generation framework that will ease the retirement of legacy systems in accordance with TeleManagement Forum’s next-generation operations systems and software program. As part of our fibre rollout, we have invested in new operational support systems that are consolidating our legacy systems and simplifying our current environment. This will improve our ability to support and maintain our systems with newer, more resilient technology. We also continue to make significant investments in system resiliency and reliability in support of our ongoing customer first initiatives.

 

IP-based telephony as a replacement for legacy analogue telephony is evolving and cost savings are uncertain

 

We continue to monitor the evolution of IP-based telephony technologies and service offerings, and we have developed a consumer solution for IP-based telephony involving access to our broadband infrastructure. This solution is being deployed and is replacing legacy analogue telephone service in areas that are served by our fibre-based facilities. The solution can be expanded to provide additional telephone services over the existing analogue service infrastructure and is designed to replace the platform currently in use. We are also in the process of deploying our next-generation IP telephony solution for business users, which is intended to replace existing business VoIP platforms, as well as addressing areas that are served by fibre-based facilities. We are deploying converged IP solutions in the consumer segment that deliver telephony, video and Internet access on the same broadband infrastructure. However, the exchange of information between service providers with different broadband infrastructures is still at an early stage.

 

Digital-only broadband access may not be feasible or financially viable in many areas for some time, particularly in rural and remote areas. Accordingly, we expect to support both legacy and IP-based voice systems for some time and incur

 

 

84


 

costs to maintain both systems. There is a risk that investments in IP-based voice systems may not be accompanied by a reduction in the costs of maintaining legacy voice systems. There is also a risk that IP-based access infrastructure and corresponding IP-based telephony platforms may not be in place in time to avoid the need for some reinvestment in our current switching platforms to support the legacy public switched telephone network access base in certain areas, which could result in some investment in line adaptation in non-broadband central offices.

 

Risk mitigation: We continue to deploy residential IP-based voice technologies in communities served by our fibre-based facilities, and we work with vendors and the industry to assess the technical applicability and evolving cost profiles of proactively migrating legacy customers onto IP-based platforms while striving to meet CRTC commitments and customer expectations. Our ongoing investments in advanced broadband network technologies, including fibre-to-the-premises (FTTP), should enable a smoother future evolution of IP-based telephony. We are also working with manufacturers to optimize the operations, cost structure and life expectancy of analogue systems and solutions so that some of this infrastructure can be adapted for integration into the overall evolution towards IP. Additionally, IP-based solutions that we are currently deploying are capable of supporting a wide range of customers and services, which helps limit our exposure to any one market segment. Going forward, as our wireless services evolve, we will continue to assess the opportunity to further consolidate separate technologies within a single voice service environment. One example is the integration of our new IP-based consumer VoIP solution into the same platform that supports wireless telephony. We are looking at opportunities to rationalize our existing legacy voice infrastructure in order to manage costs. We are also working with our vendors and partners to reduce the cost structure of VoIP deployments.

 

Convergence in a common IP-based application environment for telephony, Internet and video is complex

 

The convergence of wireless and wireline services in a common IP-based application environment, delivered over a common IP-based network, provides opportunities for cost savings and for the rapid development of more advanced services that are also more flexible and convenient. However, the transformation from separate systems to a common environment is very complex and could be accompanied by implementation errors, design issues and system instability.

 

Risk mitigation: We mitigate implementation risk through modular architectures, lab investments, employee trials, partnering with system integrators where appropriate, purchasing hardware that is common to most other North American IP-based technology deployments and introducing virtualization technologies, where feasible. We are also active in a number of standards bodies, such as the Metro Ethernet Forum and IP Sphere, in order to help influence a new IP infrastructure strategy that leverages standards-based functionality, which could further simplify our network.

 

Delivery of fibre-based facilities leveraged by IP telephony solutions is expensive and complex, with long implementation schedules

 

The deployment of fibre-based facilities in new communities and regions requires significant investment and planning, as well as long implementation schedules. This may rule it out as a viable alternative for communities in which the legacy voice equipment requires immediate replacement. It may not be cost-effective to deliver fibre-optic network access to customers who subscribe only to home phone services, which would prevent full migration away from legacy technologies.

 

Risk mitigation: We mitigate schedule risk by continuing to maintain our legacy switching environments and striving to maintain the necessary technological expertise, access to replacement hardware and regular maintenance programs. We support delivery of IP telephony through a copper-based access facility by deploying line access gateway technology that connects our customers’ generic equipment with the IP telephony platforms, which gives us a more cost-effective way to provide those customers with the reliability and enhanced capabilities of these solutions.

 

OTT services present challenges to network capacity and conventional business models

 

OTT services compete directly with pay-TV, video and wireless and wireline voice and messaging services. OTT video services, in particular, have rapidly become the largest source of traffic on the North American Internet backbone. OTT service providers do not invest in, or own, networks and growth in their services presents Internet service providers (ISPs) and network owners with the challenge of preventing network congestion. While we have designed an IP-based network that has not experienced significant congestion problems through 2018, there can be no assurance that we will not experience such congestion in the future.

 

Risk mitigation: As more OTT service providers launch services and offer higher-resolution video over the Internet, we continue to make investments in our network to support greater capacity. We are also developing new responses and service offerings, such as more flexible data plans, for the challenges posed by OTT service providers. These investments include the ongoing build-out of our fibre-optic infrastructure, including multi-year investments to connect homes and businesses in B.C., Alberta and Eastern Quebec to our gigabit-capable network.

 

In addition, our IP TV offerings, including Optik TV and Pik TV, make popular OTT services easy to access by including them as selections that are available directly through each of our TV offerings. For further discussion of our IP TV offerings, see  Wireline voice and data competition, Technological substitution may adversely affect market share, volume and pricing and Broadcasting in Section 10.3 Competitive environment .

 

 

85


 

Capital expenditure levels and potential future outlays for spectrum licences may be impacted by our operating and financial results, as well as our ability to carry out financing activities

 

Our capital expenditure levels are affected by our network initiatives, including the ongoing connection of more homes and businesses directly to our fibre-optic infrastructure; our ongoing deployment of newer technologies such as 5G; the deployment of newly acquired spectrum; investments in network resiliency and reliability; growing subscriber demand for data; evolving systems and business processes; implementation of efficiency initiatives; support for large complex deals; and participation in future wireless spectrum auctions held by ISED. There can be no assurance that investments in capital assets and wireless spectrum licences will not be affected by future operating and financial results.

 

Risk mitigation : We carry out a number of unique initiatives each year that are intended to improve our productivity and competitiveness. See Reorganizations and integration of acquisitions and Implementation of large enterprise deals in Section 10.5. For a discussion of financing risks and risk mitigation activities, see Section 10.7 Financing, debt requirements and returning cash to shareholders.

 

10.5 Operational performance

 

Systems and processes

 

We routinely have numerous complex systems and process change initiatives underway. There can be no assurance that the full complement of our various systems and process change initiatives, including those required to improve delivery of customer services and support management decision-making, will be successfully implemented or that funding and sufficiently skilled resources will be available to complete all key initiatives planned. There is a risk that certain projects may be deferred or cancelled and the expected benefits of such projects may be deferred or unrealized. Moreover, any ineffectiveness in the change management required to protect our complex systems and limit service disruptions could adversely impact our customer service, operating performance and financial results. Additionally, the ongoing acquisition and post-merger integration of various Health, international and other operations may carry short-term risks from operational continuity, competition and process governance perspectives.

 

Risk mitigation: We have change management policies, processes and controls in place, based upon industry best practices. In general, we strive to ensure that system development and process change are prioritized, and we apply a project management approach to such initiatives that includes reasonable risk identification and contingency planning, scope and change control, and resource and quality management. We generally also complete reasonable functional, performance and revenue assurance testing, as well as capturing and applying any lessons learned. Where a change involves major system and process conversions, we often move our business continuity planning and emergency management operations centre to a heightened state of readiness in advance of the change.

 

Data protection

 

We operate data centres and collect and manage data in our business and on behalf of our customers (including, in the case of TELUS Health, sensitive health information). Some of our efficiency initiatives rely on the offshoring of internal functions to our personnel in other countries or outsourcing to partners located in Canada and abroad. To be effective, these arrangements require us to allow personnel in other countries and domestic and foreign partners to have access to this data.

 

We or our partners may be subject to software, equipment or other system malfunctions, or thefts or other unlawful acts that result in the unauthorized access to, or change, loss or destruction of, our data. There is a risk that such malfunctions or unlawful acts may compromise the privacy of individuals, including our customers, employees and suppliers, or may compromise other sensitive information. Despite our efforts to implement controls in domestic and offshore operations and at our partners’ operations, unauthorized access to data could lead to data being lost, compromised or used for inappropriate purposes that could, in turn, result in financial loss (loss of subscribers or damage to our ability to attract new ones), harm our reputation and brand, expose us to claims of damages by customers and employees, and impact our customers’ ability to maintain normal business operations and deliver critical services. Also see Legal and ethical compliance in Section 10.9 Litigation and legal matters and Security discussed below.

 

Risk mitigation: Certain new IT systems undergo a security and privacy assessment early in their development life cycle, pursuant to which data that is to be used and/or collected is reviewed and classified, and design features such as audit, logging, encryption and access control restrictions are recommended, when appropriate and possible. As part of our systems and software development life cycle and quality assurance processes, privacy and security controls are also tested before new systems are fully deployed.

 

Our Internet data centres have security threat detection and mitigation capabilities, and certain data centres and networks undergo yearly external independent third-party audits that include assessment of our logical, physical and policy-based security and privacy controls. We have a vulnerability management program in place that monitors both our Internet-facing and internal network and systems in order to track and address vulnerabilities that may be detected.

 

 

86


 

To support the security of our customers’ credit card transactions, we use security technologies such as encryption and segmentation, and we adhere to the principle of least privilege. We maintain these practices and review their effectiveness on a regular basis, considering industry standards and changes in the constantly evolving threat landscape.

 

Another component of our strategy is the stipulation that data generally resides in our facilities in Canada, with the deployment of infrastructure that supports partner connectivity to view our systems. We require partners and service providers to comply with privacy and security measures, including the reporting of any possible data-related threats. Personnel in other countries are provided with remote views of authorized data only and, where applicable, without the data being stored on local systems. These personnel are also required to comply with physical and process restrictions and participate in training designed to help prevent and detect unauthorized access to, or use of, our data.

 

Our strategy also includes reactive planning and business continuity planning processes that would be invoked in the event of a breach.

 

There can be no assurance that our controls will prove effective in all instances.

 

Security

 

We have a number of assets that are subject to intentional threats. These include physical assets that are subject to security risks such as vandalism and/or theft, including (but not limited to) distributive copper cable, corporate stores, network and telephone switch centres, and elements of corporate infrastructure, as well as IT systems and networks that we operate. The latter are subject to cyberattacks, which are intentional attempts to disrupt our business or gain unauthorized access to our information systems and network for unlawful, unethical or improper purposes. Attacks may use a variety of techniques that include the targeting of individuals and the use of sophisticated malicious software and hardware or a combination of both to evade the technical and administrative safeguards that are in place (including firewalls, intrusion prevention systems, active monitoring, etc.). The risk and consequences of cyberattacks on our assets could surpass physical security risks and consequences because of the rapidly evolving nature and sophistication of these threats .

 

A successful disruption of our systems, network and infrastructure, or those of our third parties, vendors and partners, may prevent us from providing reliable service, impact the operations of our network or allow for the unauthorized interception, destruction, use or dissemination of our information or our customers’ information. Such disruption or unauthorized access to information could cause us to lose customers or revenue, incur expenses, and experience reputational and goodwill damages. It could also subject us to litigation or governmental investigation and sanction. The costs of such events may include liability for information loss, as well as the costs of repairs to infrastructure and systems and any retention incentives offered to customers and business partners. Our insurance may not cover, or fully reimburse us for, these costs and losses . See also Data protection above.

 

Risk mitigation: We have implemented technical and administrative measures to mitigate the risk of threats, attacks and other disruptive events. Our security program addresses risk through a number of mechanisms, including the implementation of controls based on policies, standards and methodologies that are aligned with recognized industry frameworks and practices, the monitoring of external activities by potential attackers, regular evaluations of our most important assets through our Crown Jewels program, the identification and regular re-evaluation of our known security risks, regular reviews of our standards and policies to ensure they address current needs and threats, and business continuity and recovery planning processes that would be invoked in the event of a disruption.

 

We incorporate security provisions into new initiatives through a standard secure-by-design process, and methodology and re-assess our security posture over the life cycle of our systems. Our technical capabilities help us identify security-related events, respond to possible threats and adjust our security posture appropriately. Additionally, our approach to cyber hygiene includes regular vulnerability assessments and the prioritization and remediation of any identified exposure through patching or other mechanisms. Our security office works with law enforcement and other agencies to address the ongoing threat of cyberattacks and disruptions. While we have reasonable physical security and cybersecurity programs in place, there can be no assurance that specific security-related incidents will not materially affect our operations and financial results.

 

Reorganizations and integration of acquisitions

 

We carry out a number of unique operational consolidation, cost reduction and rationalization initiatives each year that are intended to improve our productivity and competitiveness. Examples of these initiatives include operational effectiveness programs to drive improvements in EBITDA, including business integrations; business process outsourcing; offshoring and reorganizations, including full-time equivalent (FTE) employee reduction programs; procurement initiatives; and real estate rationalization. We may record significant cash and non-cash restructuring charges and other costs for such initiatives, which could adversely impact our operating results. There can be no assurance that all planned initiatives will be completed, or that such initiatives will provide the expected benefits or will not

 

 

87


 

have a negative impact on our customer service, work processes, employee engagement, operating performance and financial results. Additional revenue and operational effectiveness initiatives will continue to be assessed and implemented, as required.

 

Post-acquisition activities include the review and alignment of accounting policies and other corporate policies, such as ethics and privacy policies, employee transfers and moves, information systems integration, optimization of service offerings and the establishment of control over new operations. Such activities may not be conducted efficiently and effectively, which may negatively impact our service levels, competitive position and financial results. There can be no assurance that we will be able to successfully and efficiently integrate acquisitions, complete divestitures or establish partnerships in a timely manner, and realize expected strategic benefits.

 

Risk mitigation: We focus on and manage organizational change through a formalized business transformation function by leveraging the expertise, key learnings and effective practices developed in recent years during the implementation of mergers, business integrations and efficiency-related reorganizations. We also have formal senior executive level reviews of major competitive enhancement programs, with monthly updates from key business units and a comprehensive tracking program to ensure all initiatives are tracked and properly governed.

 

We have a post-merger integration team that works with our business units and the operations they acquire, applying an integration model based on learnings from previous integrations, which enhances and accelerates the standardization of our business processes and is intended to preserve the unique qualities of each acquired operation.

 

For further details of our acquisitions made during the year ended December 31, 2018, see Highlights of 2018 in Section 1.3 .

 

Implementation of large enterprise deals

 

Large enterprise deals may be characterized by the need to anticipate, understand and respond to complex and multi-faceted customer-specific enterprise requirements, including customized systems and reporting requirements, service credits that lower revenues, and significant upfront expenses and capital expenditures involved in implementing the contracts. There can be no assurance that service implementation will proceed as planned and expected efficiencies will be achieved, which may impact return on investment or projected margins. We may also be constrained by limits on available staff and system resources or by the level of co-operation from other service providers, which may in turn limit the number of large contracts that can be implemented concurrently in a given period and/or increase our costs related to such implementations.

 

Risk mitigation: We expect to continue being selective as to which new large contracts we bid on, and we continue to focus our efforts on the SMB market and mid-market. We have a sales and bid governance process in place, which involves the preparation, review and sign-off of bids, as well as all related due diligence and authorizations. For each new large enterprise deal, we look to leverage systems and processes developed in previous contract wins while incorporating others as required, using a controlled methodology to form a new custom solution.

 

We also follow standard industry practices for project management, including executive and senior level governance and project oversight, commitment of appropriate project resources, tools and supporting processes, and proactive project-specific risk assessments and risk mitigation planning. As well, we conduct independent project reviews and internal audits of previous contract work to identify areas that may require additional focus and to document any systemic issues and learnings in project implementations that could be relevant for other future large enterprise deals.

 

Foreign operations

 

Our international operations present certain risks, which include: competition in foreign markets and industries such as business process and IT outsourcing; customer rights to terminate contracts with notice; infrastructure and security challenges; employee recruitment and retention; customer concentration; technological advances in robotic process automation (RPA) and artificial intelligence; country-specific risks (such as differences in and changes to political, economic and social systems, including changes to legal and regulatory regimes); different taxation regimes; differences in type, exposure to, and frequency of, natural disasters; and foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations. There can be no assurance that international initiatives and risk mitigation efforts will provide the benefits and efficiencies expected, or that there will not be significant difficulties in combining different management structures and cultures, which could have a negative impact on operating and financial results. See also Legal and ethical compliance in Section 10.9 Litigation and legal matters and Business continuity below, which may apply to our international operations.

 

Risk mitigation: We invest in service development and process improvements, and we regularly survey customers for feedback and monitor quality of service metrics so that we can proactively address our customers’ concerns and exceed their expectations. Our sales focus on winning new clients, as well as our strategic business acquisitions, limit our customer concentration risk on an ongoing basis and add to our RPA and digital service capabilities. In 2016, we entered an agreement with Baring Private Equity Asia to acquire a 35% non-controlling interest in TELUS International (TI), which positions TI well to leverage Baring Private Equity Asia’s deep Asian markets presence and worldwide experience, and

 

 

88


 

to tap into its global network in order to further expand TI’s operations. Our IT systems undergo security and privacy assessments (see Data protection and Security above). We make significant investments in support of our team members, including high-end workplace facilities, competitive benefits, ongoing training and development, and recurring surveys to identify and address areas of concern. We maintain a diverse base of operations, with facilities located in the North America, Asia, Europe and Central America, which helps minimize country-specific risks, gives us the ability to serve customers in multiple languages and in multiple time zones, and provides network redundancy and contingency planning opportunities. International operational practices are monitored for alignment with changes in regulation, best practices and customer expectations, as well as the privacy, integrity, anti-bribery and procurement policies of our domestic Canadian operations, as appropriate. We also utilize foreign currency forward contracts to mitigate currency risks (see Currency risk in Section 7.9 Financial instruments, commitments and contingent liabilities ).

 

Business continuity

 

We are a key provider of essential telecommunications infrastructure in Canada, along with operations and infrastructure in North America, Asia, Europe and Central America. Our network, information technology, physical assets, team members, business functions, supply chain and business results may be materially impacted by exogenous threats, including:

 

·                   Natural hazards, such as forest fires, severe weather, earthquakes and other natural disasters

 

·                   Disruptions of critical infrastructure, such as power and telecommunications

 

·                   Human-caused threats, such as cyberattacks, labour disputes, theft, vandalism, sabotage, and political and civil unrest

 

·                   Public health threats, such as pandemics.

 

See Concerns related to the environment in Section 10.10 .

 

Risk mitigation: We have an enterprise-wide business continuity program that is aligned with our corporate priorities, which include ensuring the safety of our team members, minimizing the impacts of threats to our facilities and business operations, maintaining service to our customers and keeping our communities connected. These priorities have been demonstrated in a number of disruptive events in 2018, such as the wildfires in British Columbia and the spring flooding in British Columbia, Ontario and Quebec.

 

Mitigation initiatives to address severe weather threats have been an increasing focus and we have operationalized enhanced severe weather monitoring, notification of key stakeholders, incident management processes and climate incident playbooks that leverage learnings from prior events.

 

Our business continuity program aligns with the current standards and business practices, and encompasses provisions for mitigation, preparedness, response, recovery and ongoing program improvements. The program focuses on mitigating the impacts of a disruption to our facilities, workforce, technology and supply chain. Although we have business continuity planning processes in place, there can be no assurance that specific events or a combination of events will not disrupt our operations or materially affect our financial results.

 

Ongoing risk-based optimization of our disaster recovery capabilities for our IT and telecommunications network assets is a key focus for preventing outages and limiting their impact on our operations and customers. We are focused on driving closer alignment of IT and network recovery capabilities with business requirements. However, while disaster recovery is a focus for us, not all of our systems have recovery and continuity capabilities.

 

Real estate joint venture (TELUS Sky)

 

We have entered into joint ventures to develop real estate projects including the TELUS Sky project in Calgary. Risks associated with our real estate joint ventures include possible construction-related cost overruns, financing risks, reputational risks and the uncertainty of future demand, especially during market downturns. There can be no assurance that the real estate project will be completed on budget or on time, or will obtain lease commitments as planned. Accordingly, we are exposed to the risk of loss on our investment and loan amounts, and a potential inability to service debt payments should a project’s business plan not be successfully realized. Additionally, reputational risks arise from the possibility that we may be unable to meet our stated commitments and/or that the quality of the development may not be consistent with our brand expectations.

 

Risk mitigation: To develop TELUS Sky in Calgary, w e have established a joint venture with partners experienced in large commercial and residential real estate projects — Westbank and Allied REIT.

 

For projects in progress, budget-overrun risks have been mitigated through fixed-price supply contracts, expert project management oversight and insurance for certain risks. Construction costs for TELUS Sky continue to be consistent with the approved budget plan and we are applying the knowledge and experience gained on the TELUS Garden project in Vancouver to streamline and improve the cost-effectiveness of TELUS Sky. Additionally, we have retained independent third-party consultants to assist in identifying other potential cost and time savings, and we continue to monitor economic conditions which may have impacts on the TELUS Sky real estate joint venture and consider mitigation strategies as required.

 

 

89


 

10.6 Human resources

 

Employee retention, recruitment and engagement

 

Our success depends on the abilities, experience and engagement of our team members. The loss of key employees through attrition and retirement, the inability to attract and retain employees with essential or evolving skills, or any deterioration in overall employee morale and engagement resulting from organizational changes, unresolved collective agreements or ongoing cost reduction initiatives, could have an adverse impact on our growth, business and profitability and our efforts to enhance the customer experience. Changes in technology are also shifting the set of skills needed by our team, and we face competition from other global players for these same skills.

 

Risk mitigation : We aim to attract and retain key employees through both monetary and non-monetary approaches. Our compensation and benefits program is designed to support our high-performance culture and is both market-driven and performance-based. Where required, we implement targeted retention solutions for employees with critical skills or talents that are scarce in the marketplace.

 

We have a succession planning process to identify top talent for key management positions.

 

Additionally, we work continuously to raise the level of our employee engagement. We believe that our strong employee engagement continues to be supported by our focus on the customer and team member experience, our success in the marketplace and our social purpose. We plan to continue our focus on other non-monetary factors that are clearly aligned with employee engagement, including performance development, career opportunities, learning and development, recognition, diversity and inclusiveness, health and wellness programs, our Work Styles ®  program (e.g. facilitating working remotely from home or other alternative work locations), and our community volunteerism. The level of our employee engagement continues to place our organization within the top 10% of all employers surveyed. See also Section 10.10 Team member health, wellness and safety .

 

10.7 Financing, debt requirements and returning cash to shareholders

 

Our business plans and growth could be negatively affected if existing financing is not sufficient to cover funding requirements

 

Risk factors, such as disruptions in capital markets, regulatory requirements for an increase in bank capitalization, a reduction in lending activity in general, or a reduction in the number of Canadian chartered banks as a result of reduced activity or consolidation, could reduce the availability of capital or increase the cost of such capital for investment grade corporate issuers, including us. External capital market conditions could potentially affect our ability to make strategic investments and meet ongoing capital funding requirements.

 

Risk mitigation: We may finance future capital funding requirements with internally generated funds, borrowings under the unutilized portion of our bank credit facilities, use of securitized trade receivables, use of commercial paper and/or the issuance of debt or equity securities. We have a shelf prospectus in effect until June 2020, under which we can offer up to $2.5 billion of debt or equity securities as of the date of this MD&A. We believe that our investment grade credit ratings, coupled with our efforts to maintain a constructive relationship with banks, investors and credit rating agencies, continue to provide reasonable access to capital markets.

 

To enable us to meet our financial objective of generally maintaining $1 billion of available liquidity, we have a $2.25 billion credit facility that expires on May 31, 2023 ($1.5 billion available at December 31, 2018), as well as availability under other bank credit facilities (see Section 7.6 Credit facilities ). In addition, TELUS Communications Inc. (TCI) has an agreement with an arm’s-length securitization trust until December 31, 2021, under which it is able to sell an interest in certain of its trade receivables up to a maximum of $500 million, of which $400 million was available at December 31, 2018 (see Section 7.7 Sale of trade receivables ).

 

Ability to refinance maturing debt

 

At December 31, 2018, our long-term debt was approximately $14.2 billion, with maturities in certain years from 2019 to 2048 (see the Long-term debt principal maturities chart in Section 4.3 ). We operate a commercial paper program (maximum of $1.4 billion) that currently permits access to low-cost funding. At December 31, 2018, we had $774 million of commercial paper outstanding, all of which was denominated in U.S. dollars (US$569 million). When we issue commercial paper, it must be refinanced on an ongoing basis in order to realize the cost savings relative to borrowing on the $2.25 billion credit facility. Capital market conditions may prohibit the roll-over of commercial paper at low rates.

 

Risk mitigation: We successfully completed a number of debt transactions in 2017 and 2018 (see Section 7.4 ). As a result, the average term to maturity of our long-term debt (excluding commercial paper, the revolving component of the TELUS International credit facility and finance leases) was 12.2 years at December 31, 2018 (as compared to 10.7 years at December 31, 2017). Foreign currency forward contracts are used to manage currency risk arising from issuing commercial paper and long-term debt denominated in U.S. dollars (excluding the TELUS International credit facility). Our commercial paper program is fully backstopped by our $2.25 billion credit facility.

 

 

90


 

A reduction in credit ratings could affect our cost of capital and access to capital

 

There can be no assurance that we will maintain or improve current credit ratings. Our cost of capital could increase and our access to capital could be affected by a reduction in the credit ratings of TELUS and/or TCI. A reduction in our ratings, from the current BBB+ or equivalent, could result in an increase to our cost of capital.

 

Risk mitigation: We manage our capital structure and adjust it in light of changes in economic conditions and the risk characteristics of our telecommunications infrastructure. We have financial policies in place that are reviewed annually and are intended to help maintain our existing investment grade credit ratings in the range of BBB+ or the equivalent. Four credit rating agencies currently have ratings that are in line with this target. Access to our $2.25 billion credit facility would be maintained, even if our ratings were reduced to below BBB+.

 

Lower than planned free cash flow could constrain our ability to invest in operations, reduce debt or return capital to shareholders

 

While future free cash flow and sources of capital are expected to be sufficient to meet current requirements, our current intention to return capital to shareholders could constrain our ability to invest in our operations for future growth. Funding of future spectrum licence purchases, funding of defined benefit pension plans and any increases in corporate income tax rates will reduce the after-tax cash flow otherwise available to return as capital to our shareholders. Should actual results differ from our expectations, there can be no assurance that we will not change our financing plans, including our intention to pay dividends according to our payout policy guideline and to maintain our multi-year dividend growth program. Shares may be purchased under our normal course issuer bid (NCIB) when and if we consider it advantageous, based on our financial position and outlook, and the market price of our Common Shares. For further detail on our multi-year dividend growth program and 2019 NCIB program, see Section 4.3 Liquidity and capital resources .

 

Risk mitigation: Our Board of Directors reviews and approves the declaration of a dividend each quarter, and the amount of the dividend, based on a number of factors, including our financial position and outlook. This assessment is subject to various assumptions and the impact of various risks and uncertainties including those described in this Section 10.

 

Financial instruments

 

Our financial instruments, and the nature of credit risks, liquidity risks and market risks to which they may be subject, are described in Section 7.9 Financial instruments, commitments and contingent liabilities .

 

10.8 Taxation matters

 

We are subject to the risk that income and commodity tax amounts, including tax expense, may be materially different than anticipated, and that a general tendency by domestic and foreign tax collection authorities to adopt more interpretations and aggressive auditing practices could adversely affect our financial condition and operating results

 

We collect and pay significant amounts of indirect taxes, such as goods and services taxes, harmonized sales taxes, provincial sales taxes, sales and use taxes and value-added taxes, to various tax authorities. As our operations are complex and the related tax interpretations, regulations, legislation and jurisprudence that pertain to our activities are subject to continual change and evolving interpretation, the final determination of the taxation of many transactions is uncertain. Moreover, the implementation of new legislation in itself has its own complexities, including those of execution where multiple systems are involved, and the interpretation of new rules as they apply to specific transactions, products and services.

 

We have significant current and deferred income tax assets and liabilities, income tax expenses and cash tax payments. Income tax amounts are based on our estimates, applying accounting principles that recognize the benefit of income tax positions only when it is more likely than not that the ultimate determination of the tax treatment of a position will result in the related benefit being realized. The assessment of the likelihood and amount of income tax benefits, as well as the timing of realization of such amounts, can materially affect the determination of Net income or cash flows. We expect the income taxes calculated at applicable statutory rates to range between 26.7% and 27.3% in 2019. These expectations can change as a result of changes in interpretations, regulations, legislation or jurisprudence.

 

The timing of the monetization of deferred income tax accounts is uncertain, as it is dependent on our future earnings and other events. The amounts of deferred income tax liabilities are also uncertain, as the amounts are based upon substantively enacted future income tax rates that were in effect at the time of deferral, which can be changed by tax authorities. As well, the amounts of cash tax payments and current and deferred income tax liabilities are also based upon our anticipated mix of revenues among the jurisdictions in which we operate, which is also subject to change.

 

The audit and review activities of tax authorities affect the ultimate determination of the actual amounts of indirect taxes payable or receivable, income taxes payable or receivable, deferred income tax liabilities, taxes on certain items

 

 

91


 

included within capital and income tax expense. Therefore, there can be no assurance that taxes will be payable as anticipated and/or that the amount and timing of receipt or use of the tax-related assets will be as currently expected.

 

TELUS International operates in a number of foreign jurisdictions, including Barbados, Bulgaria, El Salvador, Guatemala, India, Ireland, Philippines, Romania, the United Kingdom and the United States, which increases our exposure to multiple forms of taxation.

 

Generally, each jurisdiction has taxation peculiarities in the forms of taxation imposed (e.g. value-added tax, gross receipts tax, stamp and transfer tax, and income tax), and differences in the applicable tax base and tax rates, legislation and tax treaties, where applicable, as well as currency and language differences. In addition, the telecommunications industry faces unique issues that lead to uncertainty in the application of tax laws and the division of tax between domestic and foreign jurisdictions. Furthermore, there has been a more intense focus by the media and by political and tax authorities on taxation, both domestically and internationally, with an intent to enhance tax transparency and to address perceived tax abuses. Accordingly, our activities may increase our exposure to tax risks, from both a financial and a reputational perspective.

 

Risk mitigation: We follow a comprehensive tax conduct and risk management policy that was adopted by our Board. This policy outlines the principles underlying and guiding the roles of team members, their responsibilities and personal conduct, the method of conducting business in relation to tax law and the approaches to working relationships with external tax authorities and external advisors. This policy recognizes the requirement to comply with all relevant tax laws. The components necessary for the effective control and mitigation of tax risk are outlined in the policy, as is the delegation of authority to management for addressing tax matters in accordance with Board and Audit Committee communication guidelines.

 

In giving effect to this policy, we maintain an internal Taxation department comprised of professionals who stay current on domestic and foreign tax obligations, supplemented where appropriate with external advisors. This team reviews systems and process changes for compliance with applicable domestic and international taxation laws and regulations. Its members are also responsible for the specialized accounting required for income taxes.

 

Material transactions are reviewed by our Taxation department so that transactions of an unusual or non-recurring nature are assessed from multiple risk-based perspectives. Tax-related transaction risks are regularly communicated to, and re-assessed by, our Taxation department as a check to initial exposure assessments. As a matter of regular practice, large transactions are reviewed by external tax advisors, while other third-party advisors may also be engaged to express their views as to the potential for tax liability. We continue to review and monitor our activities so that we can take action to comply with any related regulatory, legal and tax obligations. In some cases, we also engage external advisors to review our systems and processes for tax-related compliance. The advice provided and tax returns prepared by such advisors and counsel are reviewed for reasonableness by our internal Taxation department.

 

10.9 Litigation and legal matters

 

Investigations, claims and lawsuits

 

Given the size of our organization, investigations, claims and lawsuits seeking damages and other relief are regularly threatened or pending against us. The growing diversity of our service offerings, which now includes communication, health, and security services, may increase these risks. It is not currently possible for us to predict the outcome of such matters due to various factors, including: the preliminary nature of some claims; uncertain damage theories and demands; incomplete factual records; the uncertain nature of legal theories and procedures and their resolution by the courts, at both the trial and the appellate levels; and the unpredictable nature of opposing parties and their demands. There can be no assurance that financial or operating results will not be negatively impacted by any of these factors.

 

Subject to the foregoing limitations, management is of the opinion, based upon legal assessments and the information presently available, that it is unlikely that any liability relating to existing investigations, claims and lawsuits, to the extent not provided for through insurance or otherwise, would have a material effect on our financial position and the results of our operations, excepting the items disclosed herein and in Note 29(a)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Risk mitigation: We believe that we have in place reasonable policies and processes designed to enable compliance with legal and contractual obligations and reduce our exposure to, and the effect on us of, legal claims. We also maintain a team of legal professionals who advise on and manage risks related to claims and possible claims. See other risk mitigation steps discussed below.

 

Class actions

 

We are a defendant in a number of certified and uncertified class actions. Over the past decade or more, we have observed a willingness on the part of claimants to launch class actions whereby a representative plaintiff seeks to pursue a legal claim on behalf of a large group of persons. The number of class actions filed against us has varied from year to

 

 

92


 

year, with claimants continually looking to expand the matters in respect of which they file class actions. The adoption by governments of increasingly stringent consumer protection and privacy legislation may increase the number of class actions by creating new causes of action, or may decrease the number of class actions by improving clarity in the areas of consumer marketing and contracting and the protection of privacy. A successful class action lawsuit, by its nature, could result in a sizable damage award that could negatively affect a defendant’s financial or operating results. Certified and uncertified class actions against us are detailed in Note 29(a)  of the Consolidated financial statements.

 

Assessment of class actions

 

We believe that we have good defences to each of these certified and uncertified class actions. Should the ultimate resolution of these actions differ from management’s assessments and assumptions, a material adjustment to our financial position and the results of our operations could result. Management’s assessments and assumptions include that reliable estimates of the exposure cannot be made for the majority of these class actions, considering continued uncertainty relating to the causes of action that may ultimately be pursued by the plaintiffs and certified by the courts and the nature of the damages that may be sought by the plaintiffs.

 

Risk mitigation: We are vigorously defending each of the class actions brought against us, including opposing certification of uncertified class actions. Certification is a procedural step that determines whether a particular lawsuit may be prosecuted by a representative plaintiff on behalf of a class of individuals. Certification of a class action does not determine the merits of the claim, so that, if we were unsuccessful in defeating certification, the plaintiffs would still be required to prove the merits of their claims. In appropriate cases, we are pursuing settlements that we consider to be in our best interests. We regularly assess our business practices and actively monitor class action developments in Canada and the United States in order to identify and minimize the risk of further class actions against us.

 

Civil liability in the secondary market

 

Like other public companies, we are subject to civil liability for misrepresentations in written disclosure and oral statements, and liability for fraud and market manipulation.

 

Risk mitigation: We continually monitor legal developments and annually re-evaluate our disclosure practices and procedures. In addition, we periodically consult external advisors to review our disclosure practices and procedures and the extent to which they are documented. We have a corporate disclosure policy that restricts the role of Company spokesperson to specifically designated members of senior management, provides a protocol for communicating with investment analysts and investors, as well as oral presentations, and outlines the communication approach to issues. Our Disclosure Committee reviews key disclosure documents.

 

Legal and ethical compliance

 

We rely on our employees, officers, Board of Directors, key suppliers and other business partners to demonstrate behaviour consistent with applicable legal and ethical standards in all jurisdictions within which we operate, including, but not limited to, anti-bribery laws and regulations. Situations might occur where individuals intentionally or inadvertently do not adhere to our policies, applicable laws and regulations or contractual obligations. For instance, there could be cases in which the personal information of a customer or employee is collected, retained, used or disclosed in a manner that is not fully compliant with legislation, contractual obligations or our policies. In the case of TELUS Health and our recently acquired medical clinics, personal information includes sensitive health information about individuals who are our customers or healthcare providers’ end customers. In addition, there could be situations in which compliance programs may not be fully adhered to, or in which parties may have a different interpretation of the requirements of particular legislative provisions. As our TELUS Health team and recently acquired medical clinics offer new services (such as virtual care and electronic prescription), including in some cases to consumers and in other cases through third-party partnerships, new risks arise across parameters such as dependence on third-party suppliers for legal compliance and/or compliance with medical professional standards, as well as a heightened possibility of political intervention. The acquisition of medical clinics in 2018 and resulting direct participation in providing healthcare services increases our exposure to the risks of non-compliance and political intervention. These various situations expose us to the risk of litigation and the possibility of damages, sanctions and fines, or of being disqualified from bidding on contracts, and may negatively affect our financial or operating results, reputation and brand.

 

We continue to expand our activities into the United States and other countries. When operating in foreign jurisdictions, we are required to comply with local laws and regulations, which may differ substantially from Canadian laws and add to the regulatory, legal and tax exposures that we face. In certain cases, foreign laws with extra-territorial application may also impose obligations on us. For example, the EU’s General Data Protection Regulation (GDPR) came into force in May 2018, and applies to many of our business customers who, in turn, pass those obligations on to us as their service provider. When we acquire companies, they could have past records of non-compliance with laws and regulations and/or may have taken actions that could give rise to litigation.

 

Risk mitigation: Although we cannot predict outcomes with certainty, we believe we have reasonable policies, controls and processes in place, and levels of awareness sufficient for proper compliance, and that these are having a positive

 

 

93


 

effect on limiting risks. We have an anti-bribery and corruption policy, a comprehensive code of ethics and conduct for our employees, officers and Board of Directors, and mandatory annual integrity training for employees, officers and identified contractors. We also have a supplier code of conduct and a toll-free EthicsLine for anonymous reporting by anyone who may have concerns or complaints to bring forward. We conduct targeted mandatory training on our anti-bribery and corruption policies, as well as on our business sales code of conduct, and we have mandatory annual training on privacy for all of our team members. We have a designated Chief Data and Trust Officer, whose role is to work across the enterprise to ensure that the business has appropriate processes and controls in place in order to facilitate legal compliance and to report on compliance to the Audit Committee.

 

We have an established review process to ensure that regulatory, legal and tax requirements are considered when pursuing opportunities outside of Canada. On an ongoing basis, we review our international structure, systems and processes to ensure that we mitigate regulatory, legal and tax risks as our business activities expand beyond Canada. We also engage external counsel and advisors qualified in the relevant foreign jurisdictions to provide regulatory, legal and tax advice, as appropriate. In advance of the coming into force of the GDPR, we launched a GDPR readiness program to prepare us to review our own direct and indirect compliance obligations and to assist our customers in their compliance efforts.

 

When we acquire a company, we conduct due diligence, obtain standard industry representations and warranties relating to the acquired assets and liabilities, and assess any risks related to litigation disclosed to us.

 

Defects in software and failures in data or transaction processing

 

We provide certain applications and managed services to our customers that involve the management, processing, sharing and/or storing of data, including sensitive personal medical records, and the transfer of funds. Software defects or failures in data or transaction processing could lead to substantial damage claims (including privacy and medical claims). For instance, a defect in a Health application could lead to personal injury or unauthorized access to personal information, while a failure in transaction processing could result in the transfer of funds to the wrong recipient. See Data protection above.

 

Risk mitigation: We believe that we have in place reasonable policies, controls, processes (such as quality assurance programs in software development procedures) and contractual arrangements (such as disclaimers, indemnities and limitations of liability in most cases), as well as insurance coverage, to limit our exposure to these types of legal claims. However, there can be no assurance that all team members will follow our processes at all times or that we have indemnities and limitations of liability covering all cases.

 

Intellectual property and proprietary rights

 

Technology evolution also brings additional legal risks and uncertainties. The intellectual property and proprietary rights of owners and developers of hardware, software, business processes and other technologies may be protected under statute, such as patent, copyright and industrial design legislation, or under common law, such as trade secrets. With the growth and development of technology-based industries, the value of these intellectual property and proprietary rights has increased. Significant damages may be awarded in intellectual property infringement claims advanced by rights holders. In addition, defendants may incur significant costs to defend such claims, and that possibility may prompt defendants to settle claims more readily, in part to limit those costs. Both of these factors may also encourage intellectual property rights holders to pursue infringement claims more aggressively.

 

Given the vast array of technologies and systems that we use to deliver products and services, and the rapid change and complexity of such technologies, the number of disputes over intellectual property and proprietary rights can reasonably be expected to increase. As a user of technology, we receive communications from time to time, ranging from solicitations to demands and legal actions from third parties claiming ownership rights over intellectual property used by us and asking for settlement payments or licensing fees for the continued use of such intellectual property.

 

There can be no assurance that we will not be faced with other significant claims based on the alleged infringement of intellectual property rights, whether such claims are based on a legitimate dispute over the validity of the intellectual property rights or their infringement, or are advanced for the primary purpose of extracting a settlement. We may incur significant costs in defending ourselves against infringement claims, we may suffer significant damages and we could lose the right to use technologies that are essential to our operations should any infringement claim prove successful. As a developer of technology, our TELUS Health team depends on its ability to protect the proprietary aspects of its technology. The failure to adequately do so could materially affect our business. However, policing unauthorized use of our intellectual property may be difficult and costly.

 

Assessment of intellectual property claims

 

We believe that we have good defences to each of the intellectual property claims against us. Should the ultimate resolution of these claims differ from management’s assessments and assumptions, a material adjustment to our financial position and the results of our operations could result. Management’s assessments and assumptions include

 

 

94


 

that reliable estimates of the exposure cannot be made for the majority of these claims, considering the continued uncertainty relating to the validity of the intellectual property at issue, whether or not technology used by us infringes upon that intellectual property, and the nature of the damages that will be sought by the plaintiffs.

 

Risk mitigation: We incorporate many technologies into our products and services. However, we are not primarily in the business of creating or inventing technology. In acquiring products and services from suppliers, it is our practice to seek and obtain contractual protections consistent with standard industry practices to help mitigate the risks of intellectual property infringements. Whenever creating or inventing technology and applications, it is our practice to protect our intellectual property rights through litigation and other means.

 

10.10 Health, safety and environment

 

Team member health, well-being and safety

 

Lost work time resulting from team member illness or injury can negatively affect organizational productivity and employee benefit costs.

 

Risk mitigation: To support team members’ overall well-being and to achieve a positive effect on absenteeism in the workplace, we take a holistic and proactive approach to team members’ health that involves health risk prevention, early intervention, employee and family assistance, assessment and support services, disability management, and accommodation and return to work services. Our health and well-being strategy encourages our team members to develop optimal personal health through five dimensions of well-being: physical, psychological, financial, social and environmental. To promote safe work practices, we offer training and orientation programs for team members and contractors who access our facilities. There can be no assurance that these health, well-being and safety programs and practices will be effective in all situations.

 

Concerns related to radio frequency emissions from mobile phones and wireless towers

 

We understand there are public concerns over potential impacts associated with low levels of non-ionizing radio frequency (RF) emissions from mobile phones and cell towers.

 

To address these concerns, we look to recognized experts with peer-reviewed findings, as well as government agencies, to provide guidance on potential risks. While a small number of epidemiological studies have revealed that exposure to RF fields might be linked to certain cancers, other studies have not supported this association. Furthermore, animal laboratory studies have found no evidence that RF fields are carcinogenic for laboratory rodents or cause damage to DNA.

 

The International Agency for Research on Cancer and Health Canada have advised mobile phone users that they can take practical measures to reduce their exposure to RF emissions, such as limiting the length of cellphone calls, using hands-free devices and replacing cellphone calls with text messages. In addition, Health Canada encourages parents to take these same measures to reduce their children’s RF emission exposure, since children are typically more sensitive to a variety of environmental agents. We also offer information and advice with respect to RF emissions on our website at telus.com/support .

 

There can be no assurance that future studies, government regulations or public concerns about the health effects of RF emissions will not have an adverse effect on our business and prospects. For example, public concerns or government action could reduce subscriber growth and usage, and costs could increase as a result of the need to modify handsets, relocate wireless towers and address any incremental legal requirements and product liability lawsuits that might arise or have arisen. See Class actions in Section 10.9 Litigation and legal matters .

 

Risk mitigation: Canada’s federal government is responsible for establishing safe limits for signal levels of radio devices. We are confident that the mobile handsets and devices we sell, and our cell towers and other associated devices, comply, in all material respects, with all applicable Canadian and U.S. government safety standards. We continue to monitor new published studies, government regulations and public concerns about the health impacts of RF exposure.

 

Concerns related to the environment

 

A detailed report of our environmental risk mitigation activities can be found in our sustainability report at telus.com/sustainability . Environmental issues affecting our business include:

 

Climate-related risk

 

Our operations are exposed to climate-related physical risks such as from the consequences of increasing severity and frequency of extreme weather events and rising global temperatures, as well as transition risks related to climate change, such as the impact of changes in policy or implementation of the lower-emission technology .

 

 

95


 

Waste and waste recycling; water consumption; spills and releases

 

Several areas of our operations are subject to environmental considerations, such as the handling and disposal of waste, electronic waste or other residual materials, the management of our water use, and spills and releases from our operations. Some areas of our operations are subject to evolving and increasingly stringent federal, provincial and local environmental, health and safety laws and regulations. Such laws and regulations impose requirements with respect to matters such as the release of certain substances into the environment, corrective and remedial action concerning such releases, and the proper handling and management of certain substances, including wastes. Evolving public expectations and increasingly stringent laws and regulations could result in increased costs of compliance, while failure to recognize and adequately respond to the same could result in penalties, regulatory scrutiny or damage to our reputation and brand.

 

Risk mitigation: Our approach to climate-related risk consists of a governance component that has Board oversight and a management program with climate change impact assessments; a strategic component that includes energy management programs, business continuity planning and readiness activities; a risk management component that  incorporates a climate-related risk assessment as part of our ongoing enterprise risk management processes, as well as disclosure in our sustainability report of our performance in managing these risks; and the use of metrics to assess climate-related risks and opportunities and of targets for greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, including disclosure of our actions and progress towards these targets in our sustainability report. Our corporate target is a 25% reduction in CO 2 e from 2010 levels by 2020 and a 10% reduction in energy use over the same period. We have also invested in renewable energy solutions and green building technology.

 

We utilize an ISO 14001:2015 certified environmental management system (EMS) to identify and control the environmental impacts associated with our operations. The EMS is audited annually to ensure compliance with standard applicable regulatory requirements. Within the EMS, we have specific programs for the management of waste and waste recycling, water consumption, and spills and releases. Our e-waste management program specifies approved recycling channels for both external and internal electronic products. We regularly examine our waste streams to identify new ways of reducing our impact on the environment through the diversion of waste from landfills, and we have a corporate target of diverting 90% of waste from landfill by the end of 2020. Our waste and recycling strategy is focused on education and awareness programs, as well as the expansion of recycling infrastructure in our administrative buildings. Our spills and releases program includes the tracking and reporting of spills and releases, as well as risk-based assessments of any affected property and implementation of remedial solutions.

 

10.11 Economic growth and fluctuations

 

Slow or uneven economic growth and fluctuating oil prices may adversely affect us

 

We estimate that economic growth in Canada will be approximately 2.0% in 2019 (see Economic growth in Section 1.2 ), but growth may be influenced by developments outside of Canada. In addition, macroeconomic risks in Canada continue to include concerns about fluctuating oil prices and high levels of consumer and mortgage debt, which may cause consumers to reduce discretionary spending, even in a growing economy. Further risks to the Canadian economy include rising interest rates, a weakening housing market, and uncertainty related to trade issues, including the ongoing imposition of tariffs. Meanwhile, trade conflicts between countries as well as other economic and political uncertainties, may also have global implications, as supply chains are increasingly integrated.

 

Economic uncertainty may cause consumers and business customers to delay new service purchases, reduce volumes of use, discontinue use of services or seek lower-priced alternatives from us or our competitors. Weakness in the extractive energy sector that began in 2015 has had a significant impact on Western Canada, which is evident in lower levels of investment and employment , especially in Alberta. A particular risk for Alberta is the spread between global oil prices and Alberta-based oil prices, with Alberta-based oil selling below global prices due to the difficulties of bringing oil to market. As a result, an energy-related recovery has been more muted in Alberta than it would have been if the spread were smaller.This was partially mitigated by declining costs in non-extractive industries, such as manufacturing. The previous lower growth rates in Western Canada continued to reverse through 2018 after a robust economic performance in 2017, with economic growth in 2018 estimated to be 2.5% in Alberta and 2.3% in British Columbia, as compared to 2.2% for Canada.

 

Fluctuating oil prices, along with housing market and consumer debt risks in the Canadian economy, could adversely impact our customer growth, revenue, profitability and free cash flow, and could potentially require us to record impairments in the carrying value of our assets, including, but not limited to, our intangible assets with indefinite lives (spectrum licences and goodwill). Impairments in the carrying value of our assets would result in a charge to earnings and a reduction in owners’ equity, but would not affect cash flow. Furthermore, fluctuating interest rates may have an impact on consumer behaviour, as debt service burdens increase and Canadian households experience a reduction in disposable income.

 

 

96


 

A further risk to Canada is trade with the U.S. While the North American Free Trade Agreement (NAFTA) has been renegotiated as the U.S.-Mexico-Canada Agreement (USMCA), tariffs remain in place and the cost of trade has gone up in certain areas. Further, a trade conflict emerging between the United States and China may have global implications, as supply chains are increasingly integrated.

 

In 2018, the Canadian dollar exchange rate with the U.S. dollar was volatile, with the Canadian dollar generally weakening over the year, from roughly USD:CAD 1.26 to 1.35. Fluctuating oil prices and certain U.S. monetary policy changes may put further downward pressure on the Canadian dollar relative to the U.S. dollar in 2019. This will be particularly pronounced if the Federal Reserve increases overnight rates at a faster pace than the Bank of Canada, as a growing interest rate differential would lift the U.S. dollar. Certain of our revenues, capital asset acquisitions and operating costs are denominated in U.S. dollars. Therefore, a continuing weakness in the Canadian dollar to U.S. dollar exchange rate may negatively impact our financial and operating results. Additionally, certain capital asset acquisitions and inventory purchases from outside Canada, although priced in Canadian dollars, may be negatively impacted by continuing weakness in the Canadian dollar relative to the U.S. dollar.

 

Risk mitigation: While economic risks cannot be completely mitigated, our top priority of putting customers first and pursuing global leadership in the likelihood of our clients to recommend our products, services and people, supports our efforts to acquire and retain customers through the economic fluctuations that affect them and us. We will also support customers negatively affected by fluctuating oil prices with cost-effective solutions that help them realize efficiencies in their operations, and we will continue to pursue cost reduction and efficiency initiatives in our own business (see discussion in Section 3 Corporate priorities ). See Section 4.3 Liquidity and capital resources for our capital structure financial policies and plans. Our foreign currency exchange rate risk management includes the use of foreign currency forward contracts and currency options to fix the exchange rates on U.S. dollar-denominated transactions, commitments, commercial paper and U.S. Dollar Notes, but does not eliminate this risk entirely.

 

Pension funding

 

Economic and capital market fluctuations could adversely affect the investment performance, funding and expense associated with the defined benefit pension plans that we sponsor. Our pension funding obligations are based on certain actuarial assumptions relating to expected plan asset returns, salary escalation, retirement ages, life expectancy, the performance of the financial markets and future interest rates.

 

The employee defined benefit pension plans, in aggregate with the application of the asset ceiling, were in a $57 million surplus position at December 31, 2018 (compared to a $334 million deficit position at the end of 2017). Our solvency position, as determined under the Pension Benefits Standards Act, 1985 , was estimated to be a surplus of $257 million (compared to a $482 million surplus position at the end of 2017). There can be no assurance that our pension expense and funding of our defined benefit pension plans will not increase in the future and thereby negatively impact earnings and/or cash flow. Defined benefit funding risks may arise if total pension liabilities exceed the total value of the respective plan assets in trust funds. Unfunded differences may arise from lower than expected investment returns, changes to mortality and other assumptions, reductions in the discount rate used to value pension liabilities, changes to statutory funding requirements and actuarial losses. While employee defined benefit pension plan re-measurements will cause fluctuations in other comprehensive income, these re-measurements will never be subsequently reclassified to income.

 

Risk mitigation: We seek to mitigate this risk through the application of policies and procedures designed to control investment risk and through ongoing monitoring of our funding position. Our best estimate of cash contributions to our defined benefit pension plans in 2019 is $36 million ($50 million in 2018.)

 

 

97


 

11.        Definitions and reconciliations

 

11.1 Non-GAAP and other financial measures

 

We have issued guidance on and report certain non-GAAP measures that are used to evaluate the performance of TELUS, as well as to determine compliance with debt covenants and to manage our capital structure. As non-GAAP measures generally do not have a standardized meaning, they may not be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers. Securities regulations require such measures to be clearly defined, qualified and reconciled with their nearest GAAP measure.

 

Adjusted Net income and adjusted basic earnings per share: These measures are used to evaluate performance at a consolidated level and exclude items that may obscure the underlying trends in business performance. These measures should not be considered alternatives to Net income and basic earnings per share in measuring TELUS’ performance. Items that may, in management’s view, obscure the underlying trends in business performance include significant gains or losses associated with real estate development partnerships, gains on exchange of wireless spectrum licences, restructuring and other costs, long-term debt prepayment premiums (when applicable), income tax-related adjustments, asset retirements related to restructuring activities and gains arising from business combinations. (See Reconciliation of adjusted Net income and Reconciliation of adjusted basic EPS in Section 1.3. )

 

Capital intensity: This measure is calculated as capital expenditures (excluding spectrum licences) divided by total operating revenues. This measure provides a basis for comparing the level of capital expenditures to those of other companies of varying size within the same industry.

 

Dividend payout ratio: This is a historical measure calculated as the sum of the last four quarterly dividends declared per Common Share, as reported in the financial statements, divided by the sum of basic earnings per share for the most recent four quarters for interim reporting periods. For fiscal years, the denominator is annual basic earnings per share. Our objective range for the annual dividend payout ratio is on a prospective basis, rather than on a trailing basis, and is 65 to 75% of sustainable earnings per share on a prospective basis. (See Section 7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures. )

 

Calculation of Dividend payout ratio

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Numerator — Sum of the last four quarterly dividends declared per Common Share

 

2.10

 

1.97

 

Denominator — Net income per Common Share

 

2.68

 

2.46

 

Ratio (%)

 

78

 

80

 

 

Dividend payout ratio of adjusted net earnings: This ratio is a historical measure calculated as the sum of the last four quarterly dividends declared per Common Share, as reported in the financial statements, divided by adjusted net earnings per share. Adjusted net earnings per share is basic earnings per share, as used in the Dividend payout ratio, adjusted to exclude the gain on the exchange of wireless spectrum licences, gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, provisions related to business combinations, long-term debt prepayment premium (when applicable) and income tax-related adjustments.

 

Calculation of Dividend payout ratio of adjusted net earnings

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Numerator — sum of the last four quarterly dividends declared per Common Share

 

2.10

 

1.97

 

Adjusted net earnings ($ millions):

 

 

 

 

 

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

1,600

 

1,559

 

Deduct non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures, after income taxes

 

(150

)

(1

)

Provisions related to business combinations, after income taxes

 

(17

)

(22

)

(Deduct net favourable) add back net unfavourable income tax-related adjustments

 

(7

)

21

 

Add back long-term debt prepayment premium, after income taxes

 

25

 

 

Add back initial and committed donation to TELUS Friendly Future Foundation, after income taxes

 

90

 

 

 

 

1,541

 

1,557

 

Denominator — Adjusted net earnings per Common Share

 

2.58

 

2.46

 

Adjusted ratio (%)

 

81

 

80

 

 

 

98


 

Earnings coverage: This measure is defined in the Canadian Securities Administrators’ National Instrument 41-101 and related instruments, and is calculated as follows:

 

Calculation of Earnings coverage

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions, except ratio)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Net income attributable to Common Shares

 

1,600

 

1,559

 

Income taxes (attributable to Common Shares)

 

542

 

583

 

Borrowing costs (attributable to Common Shares) 1

 

630

 

562

 

Numerator

 

2,772

 

2,704

 

Denominator — Borrowing costs

 

630

 

562

 

Ratio (times)

 

4.4

 

4.8

 

 


(1)          Interest on Long-term debt plus Interest on short-term borrowings and other plus long-term debt prepayment premium, adding back capitalized interest and deducting borrowing costs attributable to non-controlling interests.

 

EBITDA (earnings before interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization): We have issued guidance on and report EBITDA because it is a key measure used to evaluate performance at a consolidated level. EBITDA is commonly reported and widely used by investors and lending institutions as an indicator of a company’s operating performance and ability to incur and service debt, and as a valuation metric. EBITDA should not be considered an alternative to Net income in measuring TELUS’ performance, nor should it be used as an exclusive measure of cash flow. EBITDA as calculated by TELUS is equivalent to Operating revenues less the total of Goods and services purchased expense and Employee benefits expense.

 

We calculate EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs, as it is a component of the EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage ratio and the Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio.

 

We also calculate Adjusted EBITDA to exclude items of an unusual nature that do not reflect our ongoing operations and should not, in our opinion, be considered in a long-term valuation metric or should not be included in an assessment of our ability to service or incur debt.

 

EBITDA reconciliation

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Net income

 

1,624

 

1,578

 

Financing costs

 

661

 

573

 

Income taxes

 

552

 

590

 

Depreciation

 

1,669

 

1,617

 

Amortization of intangible assets

 

598

 

552

 

EBITDA

 

5,104

 

4,910

 

Add back restructuring and other costs included in EBITDA

 

317

 

117

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs

 

5,421

 

5,027

 

Deduct non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures

 

(171

)

(1

)

Deduct MTS net recovery

 

 

(21

)

Adjusted EBITDA

 

5,250

 

5,005

 

 

EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage: This measure is defined as EBITDA —excluding restructuring and other costs, divided by Net interest cost, calculated on a 12-month trailing basis. This measure is similar to the coverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities, as described in Section 7.6 Credit facilities .

 

 

99


 

Free cash flow: We report this measure as a supplementary indicator of our operating performance. It should not be considered an alternative to the measures in the Consolidated statements of cash flows. Free cash flow excludes certain working capital changes (such as trade receivables and trade payables), proceeds from divested assets and other sources and uses of cash, as found in the Consolidated statements of cash flows. It provides an indication of how much cash generated by operations is available after capital expenditures (excluding purchases of spectrum licences) that may be used to, among other things, pay dividends, repay debt, purchase shares or make other investments. Free cash flow may be supplemented from time to time by proceeds from divested assets or financing activities. The application of IFRS 15 reflects a non-cash accounting change. As such, the underlying economics and free cash flow generated by the business are not impacted by the change.

 

Free cash flow calculation

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

EBITDA

 

5,104

 

4,910

 

Deduct non-cash gains from the sale of property, plant and equipment

 

(49

)

(7

)

Restructuring and other costs, net of disbursements

 

78

 

(22

)

Deduct non-recurring gains and equity income related to real estate joint ventures

 

(171

)

(1

)

Donation to TELUS Friendly Future Foundation in TELUS Common Shares

 

100

 

 

Effects of contract asset, acquisition and fulfilment *

 

(203

)

(135

)

Items from the Consolidated statements of cash flows:

 

 

 

 

 

Share-based compensation, net

 

6

 

17

 

Net employee defined benefit plans expense

 

95

 

82

 

Employer contributions to employee defined benefit plans

 

(53

)

(67

)

Interest paid

 

(608

)

(539

)

Interest received

 

9

 

7

 

Capital expenditures (excluding spectrum licences)

 

(2,914

)

(3,094

)

Other

 

 

6

 

Free cash flow before income taxes

 

1,394

 

1,157

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds

 

(197

)

(191

)

Free cash flow

 

1,197

 

966

 

 


* Reconciliation of effects of contract asset, acquisition and fulfilment

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

From Note 6(c)  of the Consolidated financial statements:

 

 

 

 

 

Net additions arising from operations

 

1,455

 

1,270

 

Amounts billed in period and thus reclassified to accounts receivable

 

(1,284

)

(1,166

)

Change in impairment allowance, net

 

(1

)

(3

)

Other

 

2

 

(3

)

From Note 20 of the Consolidated financial statements:

 

 

 

 

 

Additions — Total

 

321

 

308

 

Amortization — Total

 

(290

)

(271

)

Effects of contract asset, acquisition and fulfilment

 

203

 

135

 

 

Our method of calculating Free cash flow has been revised in 2018 to reflect the discretionary nature of the donation to the TELUS Friendly Future Foundation that fundamentally transformed our operating model in respect of philanthropic giving.

 

The following reconciles our definition of free cash flow with cash provided by operating activities.

 

Free cash flow reconciliation with Cash provided by operating activities

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Free cash flow

 

1,197

 

966

 

Add (deduct):

 

 

 

 

 

Capital expenditures (excluding spectrum licences)

 

2,914

 

3,094

 

Adjustments to reconcile to Cash provided by operating activities

 

(53

)

(113

)

Cash provided by operating activities

 

4,058

 

3,947

 

 

 

100


 

Net debt: We believe that net debt is a useful measure because it represents the amount of Short-term borrowings and long-term debt obligations that are not covered by available Cash and temporary investments. The nearest IFRS measure to net debt is Long-term debt, including Current maturities of Long-term debt. Net debt is a component of the Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs ratio.

 

Calculation of Net debt

 

As at December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Long-term debt including current maturities

 

14,101

 

13,660

 

Debt issuance costs netted against long-term debt

 

93

 

73

 

Derivative (assets) liabilities, net

 

(73

)

93

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income amounts arising from financial instruments used to manage interest rate and currency risks associated with U.S. dollar-denominated long-term debt (excluding tax effects)

 

(37

)

5

 

Cash and temporary investments, net

 

(414

)

(509

)

Short-term borrowings

 

100

 

100

 

Net debt

 

13,770

 

13,422

 

 

Net debt to EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs: This measure is defined as net debt at the end of the period divided by 12-month trailing EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs. Our long-term policy guideline for this ratio is from 2.00 to 2.50 times. (See discussion in Section 7.5 Liquidity and capital resource measures. ) This measure is similar to the leverage ratio covenant in our credit facilities, as described in Section 7.6 Credit facilities .

 

Net interest cost: This measure is the denominator in the calculation of EBITDA — excluding restructuring and other costs interest coverage . Net interest cost is defined as financing costs, excluding capitalized long-term debt interest, employee defined benefit plans net interest and recoveries on redemption and repayment of debt, calculated on a 12-month trailing basis. No recoveries on redemption and repayment of debt were recorded in 2018 and 2017. Expenses recorded for the long-term debt prepayment premium, if any, are included in net interest cost. Net interest cost was $644 million in 2018 and $567 million in 2017.

 

Restructuring and other costs: With the objective of reducing ongoing costs, we incur associated incremental, non-recurring restructuring costs. We may also incur atypical charges, which are included in other costs, when undertaking major or transformational changes to our business or operating models. In addition, we include incremental external costs incurred in connection with business acquisition or disposition activity, as well as litigation costs, in the context of significant losses and settlements, in other costs .

 

Components of restructuring and other costs

 

Years ended December 31

 

2018

 

2017

 

($ millions)

 

Applying IFRS 9 and IFRS 15
(2017 adjusted)

 

Goods and services purchased

 

181

 

81

 

Employee benefits expense

 

136

 

36

 

Restructuring and other costs included in EBITDA

 

317

 

117

 

 

11.2 Operating indicators

 

The following measures are industry metrics that are useful in assessing the operating performance of a wireless and wireline telecommunications entity, but do not have a standardized meaning under IFRS-IASB.

 

Average billing per subscriber unit per month (ABPU) for wireless subscribers is calculated as network revenue derived from monthly service plan, roaming and usage charges, as well as monthly re-payments of the outstanding device balance owing from customers on contract; divided by the average number of subscriber units on the network during the period and is expressed as a rate per month.

 

Average revenue per subscriber unit per month (ARPU) for wireless subscribers is calculated as network revenue derived from monthly service plan, roaming and usage charges; divided by the average number of subscriber units on the network during the period and is expressed as a rate per month.

 

Churn per month (or churn) is calculated as the number of subscriber units deactivated during a given period divided by the average number of subscriber units on the network during the period, and is expressed as a rate per month. Blended churn refers to the aggregate average of both prepaid and postpaid churn. A TELUS, Koodo or Public Mobile brand prepaid wireless subscriber is deactivated when the subscriber has no usage for 90 days following expiry of the prepaid credits.

 

 

101


 

Wireless subscriber unit (subscriber) is defined as an active mobile recurring revenue-generating unit (e.g. mobile phone, tablet or mobile Internet key) with a unique subscriber identifier (SIM or IMEI number). In addition, TELUS has a direct billing or support relationship with the user of each device. Subscriber units exclude machine-to-machine devices (a subset of the Internet of Things), such as those used for asset tracking, remote control monitoring and meter readings, vending machines and wireless automated teller machines.

 

Wireline subscriber connection is defined as an active recurring revenue-generating unit that has access to stand-alone services, including fixed Internet access, TELUS TV and residential network access lines (NALs). In addition, TELUS has a direct billing or support relationship with the user of each service. Reported subscriber units exclude business NALs, as the impact of migrating from voice lines to IP services has led to business NAL losses without a similar decline in revenue, thus diminishing its relevance as a key performance indicator.

 

 

102


Exhibit 99.5:

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Statement No. 333-224895 on Form F-10, Registration Statement No. 333-186874 on Form F-3 and Registration Statement Nos. 333-125486 and 333-181463 on Form S-8 and to the use of our reports dated February 14, 2019 relating to the consolidated financial statements of TELUS Corporation and subsidiaries and the effectiveness of TELUS Corporation and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting, appearing in this Annual Report on Form 40-F of TELUS Corporation for the year ended December 31, 2018.

 

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

 

Chartered Professional Accountants

 

Vancouver, Canada

 

February 14, 2019

 

 


Exhibit 99.6:

 

Amended 2019 Code of Ethics and Conduct

 


 

 

TELUS Code of
Ethics & Conduct

 

February 2019

 

Question or Concern? Log on to EthicsLine at www.telus.ethicspoint.com

 

1


 

TELUS Code of Ethics & Conduct

 

Introduction

4

Responsibilities

5

All TELUS Team Members

5

Leaders

5

Team members with internal controls over financial reporting and disclosure control roles

5

Members of the TELUS Board of Directors

6

Team Members and Board Members who represent TELUS as directors on the boards of other organizations

6

Ethics Office

6

Integrity Work Group

6

Compliance/Exceptions

6

Waivers

7

Ethical Decision Making

7

1. Questions to Ask Yourself

7

2. Talk to Your Leader

8

3. Expert Assistance

8

4. TELUS EthicsLine

8

5. Last Resort Resolution

10

Guidelines

11

Privacy and Confidentiality of Information

11

Personal Integrity

12

Fraud

12

Travel & Expenses

12

Compliance with Domestic and Foreign Laws

12

Competing Ethically/Lawfully/Fairly

13

Bribes and Facilitation Payments

13

Lawful Competition

14

Dealing with Governments

15

Political Activities

15

Proprietary Rights and Assets of Others

15

Involvement in a legal matter

16

Respectful Workplace / Human Rights

16

Valuing Diversity and Inclusion

16

Health and Safety

17

Environment & Sustainability

17

Company Assets and Information

18

Company Information

18

Public Disclosure

18

Business Records

19

Financial Transactions

19

Safeguarding Assets

19

Intellectual Property

20

Personal Use of Communication Devices

20

Use of Social Media

21

Conflict of Interest

22

Personal Gain

23

Ethical Sales Practices

24

Outside employment and other non-TELUS activities

24

Future TELUS Business

24

Insider Trading

24

Gifts and Benefits

25

Dealing with Suppliers

27

electing Suppliers

27

Adherence to applicable TELUS policies

27

Supplier-funded incentive programs

27

Review Guidelines and Policies

28

Appendix Situational Examples

28

 

2


 

All TELUS team members:

 

At TELUS, we are committed to creating a culture of ethical behaviour with our team members, as well as our suppliers, vendors, community partners and Board of Directors. This is, perhaps, more important than ever, given the current social landscape where unacceptable, unethical behaviour is being rightfully scrutinized. Indeed, we value integrity and transparency, which ultimately shape the decisions we make as an organization, guided by our clearly defined Code of Ethics & Conduct. Our Code addresses a wide range of critical topics, including but not limited to: avoiding conflict of interest; accepting gifts and benefits; safeguarding our brand and reputation as well as our company’s assets, information and intellectual property; and protecting our customers’ data and privacy.

 

Importantly, integrity is an essential element of our Customers First priority. As our most authentic and passionate brand ambassadors, we ask that you familiarize yourself with our Code and ensure that your everyday decisions and actions are informed by its policies, procedures and standards. Developing and sustaining an ethical culture is a shared responsibility, and our leaders must set the standard for our entire team to emulate.

 

As a leading social purpose company, we are passionate about creating a friendlier future by improving the lives of our fellow citizens. Indeed, when we act with personal and professional integrity and transparency, we further differentiate our organization versus our peers in our highly competitive industry, while demonstrating how much our team truly cares about our customers and our communities.

 

Thank you for leveraging our Code of Ethics & Conduct to further elevate your actions, thus ensuring we can continue to create positive outcomes for our team members, our customers, our shareholders and our communities.

 

With appreciation,

 

Sandy McIntosh Executive Vice- president, People & Culture, and Chief Human Resources Officer

Doug French Executive Vice- president, and Chief Financial Officer

Tony Geheran Executive Vice- president, and Chief Customer Officer

Darren Entwistle President and Chief Executive Officer

 

3


 

Introduction

 

Why do we have a Code?

 

TELUS’ Code of Ethics & Conduct (the “Code”) outlines the behaviours that we must exhibit in order to meet and uphold TELUS’ ethical and conduct standards. The Code is intended to set the tone for how we work at TELUS and to help us recognize ethical and compliance issues before they arise and guide how we deal with those issues should they arise.

 

The Code applies to the directors, officers and employees (referred to as “team members” or “TELUS team members”) of the TELUS group of companies (i.e. TELUS Corporation, TELUS International and all of their subsidiaries and affiliates) (“TELUS” or the “Company”) that in each case, are directly or indirectly controlled or managed by TELUS. Team members are required to review this Code at least annually to remain familiar with its terms and to adhere to them.

 

To assist team members in remaining familiar with the Code, they are required to complete the Integrity training course each year. Team members must also complete any other required courses in a timely manner.

 

The Code cannot address every possible ethical scenario we might face, so it is up to team members to use good judgment and seek guidance when they have questions, are not sure about the right course of action, or see something that doesn’t appear to be right. The Code is reviewed annually and revised as necessary.

 

The Code constitutes a term of the employment contract of all TELUS team members.

 

TELUS reserves the right to revoke or amend any term of the Code if required by the needs of the business. TELUS will notify team members of any amendments to the Code prior to the changes becoming effective.

 

The Code is available on the Company’s intranet under Go/Ethics, and is publicly vailable at about.telus.com/governance/ethics.html.

 

4


 

Responsibilities

 

All TELUS Team Members

 

Ethical behavior is an individual responsibility and reflecting high ethical standards is the expectation of all of us. All team members are expected to act honestly in all their dealings, comply with the laws governing our businesses, and maintain an ethical work environment including advising their leaders or the Ethics office if they are aware of unethical behavior occurring in the organization. These standards require that all team members understand and apply the guidelines in this Code to everyday actions and decisions. Failing to read or attest to the standards does not excuse us from these responsibilities.

 

At TELUS, we not only do things right, but we should strive to do the right things.

 

All business activities should be able to stand up to any possible public scrutiny and further investigation if required.

 

The guidelines in this Code are based upon generally accepted standards of ethical business conduct and applicable laws. The absence of a guideline covering a particular situation does not relieve any of us from the responsibility for acting ethically and within the law.

 

Leaders

 

In addition to the aforementioned responsibilities, TELUS managers (referred to as leaders) have responsibility to:

·                   Be familiar with the Code and resolution procedures

·                   Demonstrate leadership by promoting and maintaining a climate in which honest, ethical and legal business conduct is the norm

·                   Ensure that annual Integrity training is completed by all team members and that violations of the Code are appropriately addressed

·                   Identify risks of non-compliance with this Code within their area of responsibility and take appropriate steps to address such risks

·                   Maintain a work environment that encourages open discussion and resolution of all ethical and conduct concerns without the fear of retaliation

·                   Maintain, without compromise, our ethical and other conduct standards in achieving goals, objectives and Customer First priorities

·                   Use our performance review process to evaluate team members not only on the business objectives achieved, but also on how they are achieved

·                   Recognize team members whose behaviour and actions demonstrate strong ethical decision-making and adherence to conduct standards

·                   Ensure the Work Styles Policy and Guidelines are followed for those participating in the program.

 

Team members with internal controls over financial reporting and disclosure control roles

 

In addition to the above responsibilities, team members who have roles related to internal controls over financial reporting and disclosure controls have, as outlined in the Policy on Corporate Disclosure and Confidentiality of Information, the responsibility to make full, fair, accurate, timely and understandable disclosure in reports and documents

 

5


 

that TELUS files with, or submits to, securities commissions and in other public communications made by TELUS.

 

Members of the TELUS Board of Directors

 

TELUS Board members have the responsibility to notify the Chair of the Board of any potential or perceived conflict of interest or other Code issues which arise during the course of their Board service.

 

Team Members and Board Members who represent TELUS as directors on the boards of other organizations

 

In addition to the above responsibilities, TELUS team members and Board members who represent TELUS on the boards of other organizations have the responsibility to notify the Chair of the Board (if they are a Board member) or the TELUS Ethics Office (if they are a team member) of any potential perceived conflict of interest or other Code issues which arise during the course of their service on another organizations’ board. In providing such notice, Board members and team members should exercise due care to ensure that they act in compliance with their fiduciary and other obligations to the other organization and, for example, do not disclose that organization’s confidential information to TELUS, without prior written approval of that organization.

 

Ethics Office

 

The Ethics Office is established to provide team members with a resource regarding ethical and conduct matters. This office oversees the Code, conducts investigations, provides advice on ethical issues and conduct matters and develops and administers training for TELUS’ expected standards of business conduct. The office reports on its activities, including on breaches of the Code, to the President and Chief Executive Officer and financial officers (unless implicated) and to the Human Resources and Compensation Committee and the Audit Committee of the Board on a quarterly basis.

 

Integrity Work Group

 

An Integrity Work Group supports the Ethics Office in overseeing the Code and quarterly reporting to senior leadership and the Human Resources and Compensation Committee and the Audit Committee of the TELUS Board. Members of the Integrity Work Group include representatives from Risk Management, People & Culture, Legal Services, the Data & Trust Office, TELUS International and the TELUS Security Office.

 

Compliance/Exceptions

 

In situations where the right ethical behaviour is unclear, or where there may be the appearance of a contravention of these guidelines, we support each other in seeking advice and clarification. If you are unsure as to the proper course of action to take in a particular situation, you should first discuss the situation with your leaderor the applicable department identified in this Code. Team members should retain all documentation and save a written record of the guidance provided by their leader or members of other departments and any decision made in the event there is a future investigation with respect to a possible violation of the Code.

 

If you become aware of a possible violation of the Code, you are required to report it to the Ethics Office. For more details, please refer to the TELUS EthicsLine section.

 

6


 

Members of the TELUS Board may also advise the Chair of the Board of potential violations. The Chair will refer the matter to the Ethics Office for investigation, resolution and reporting. Possible violation of applicable laws will be directed to Legal Services for review and investigation.

 

Failure to act in accordance with the guidelines outlined in this Code may have consequences for the individual team members, may create potential harm to TELUS’ reputation and brand, and may put TELUS at risk for civil or criminal liability. Individual consequences may include disciplinary action, up to and including dismissal for just cause, as well as civil and criminal penalties. Therefore, please regard the requirement to understand and to act in accordance with the Code as a very serious obligation.

 

Waivers

 

It is not intended that there be any waivers to this Code. In the unlikely event that a waiver is considered and granted for an executive leadership team (“ELT”) member or a member of the Board, it must receive prior written approval by the Board or its delegate. The delegate must be a Board member. In such circumstances, any waivers granted to an ELT member or member of the Board must be disclosed, subject to the TELUS Policy on Corporate Disclosure and Confidentiality of Information.

 

In the unlikely event that a waiver is considered for team members other than an ELT member or a member of the Board, prior written approval must be received by the Chief Legal Officer together with the Vice President Risk Management & Chief Internal Auditor and must be promptly reported to the Audit Committee of the Board.

 

Ethical Decision Making

 

This Code reflects our commitment to high standards of integrity and ethical behaviour in our professional and business dealings. The Code is intended to support open and frank discussion and the satisfactory resolution of ethical dilemmas. We encourage “asking before acting.”

 

Each of us is responsible for striving to ensure our behaviour is ethical and for taking steps to resolve ethical dilemmas. The guidelines in this Code are provided to assist with ethical decision-making. However, as business becomes increasingly complex, the Code cannot provide guidance for every possible situation.

 

If you have an ethical issue with which you would like help, follow the process below, stopping at the point at which your situation has been resolved.

 

1. Questions to Ask Yourself

 

Gather information and then determine if the situation you face is an ethical issue. The questions below may help to clarify your situation and ethical action.

·                   What is my immediate feeling about this?

·                   Does this comply with company policies and procedures?

·                   Is this legal and does it comply with regulatory requirements?

·                   Is this an expected part of my job?

·                   How would others perceive this action?

·                   Would I or TELUS be embarrassed if this situation were discussed in the media?

 

7


 

·                   Would I be putting TELUS or myself at unnecessary risk?

·                  What impact would this have on my or the Company’s reputation?

·                  Is this taking revenue or customers away from TELUS or otherwise negatively affecting TELUS’ interests?

·                  Does this affect my judgment to act in the best interests of TELUS?

·                  Does this benefit me or a person somehow related to me economically?

·                  Does it impact TELUS economically or cost TELUS money?

·                  Would the action bias me or my role and accountability?

 

We rely on all team members to use good judgment to guide behaviour and to ask questions in situations where the proper course of action may be unclear.

 

2.               Talk to Your Leader

 

Often your leader is in the best position to help you work through the issue. Your leader is responsible for supporting open discussion, working through the ethical questions and other issues you have that touch on the Code, and guiding your access to further assistance as required. In situations where you are uncomfortable talking with your leader, or your leader is unable to help, you should refer to the next level of leadership or seek expert assistance as detailed in the next section from the Ethics Office.

 

3.               Expert Assistance

 

If you have tried the above steps but still have questions, assistance is available through designated subject matter experts in People & Culture, Legal Services, the Data & Trust Office, the TELUS Security Office, the Ethics Office, Regulatory Affairs and Corporate Accounting & Financial Reporting. Names and contact telephone numbers are listed on the Company’s internal website, under Ethics. TELUS International team members may contact their Senior Vice President for People & Culture.

 

4.               TELUS EthicsLine

 

You may also contact the TELUS EthicsLine to request ethical guidance or make a good-faith report about harassment, misconduct or a perceived violation of this Code, another Company policy or procedure, a law, questionable business practices, potential fraud or concerns or complaints with respect to any accounting, accounting controls or auditing matter. Reports may be made anonymously.

 

A good-faith report alleging misconduct must be made promptly after the occurrence of a violation or perceived violation, or after a team member becomes aware of it. Failure to file a report promptly may negatively impact TELUS’ ability to evaluate, investigate or resolve the alleged misconduct.

 

The EthicsLine is operated by an independent company and is staffed 24 hours a day, seven days a week, by live operators who are fluent in multiple languages. EthicsLine operators document and forward reports to the Ethics Office for review and handling following each call or web contact. Where the report involves accounting, accounting controls or auditing matters, EthicsLine operators forward the report directly to the Chief Legal Officer, who will, as appropriate, review and assess the seriousness of such report with one or more of:

·                  the Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer,

·                  the Vice President Risk Management & Chief Internal Auditor,

·                  the Chief Data & Trust Officer, who oversees the Data & Trust Office or

 

8


 

·                   the Audit Committee of the TELUS Board.

 

The Ethics Office forwards complaints regarding potential violation of laws to Legal Services for review and handling.

 

Phone toll free: 1-888-265-4112 in North America. See website for other international dialing instructions

Web: link from www.telus.ethicspoint.com or Company intranet

 

How the Ethics Office handles Inquiries:

 

The Ethics Office will assist team members in ethical decision-making by providing guidance concerning the Code. The Ethics Office may also refer to other subject matter experts within TELUS for assistance.

 

How the Ethics Office handles Complaints:

 

a)              Assessment of complaint

 

The Ethics Office will assess the nature of the complaint. The complaint will be reviewed under the direction of Legal Services in appropriate cases. The following matters for which other remedies exist will not be investigated by the Ethics Office and will be redirected as follows:

·                       Labour relations issues — Labour Relations and the immediate leader or other members of leadership

·                       Employment issues such as promotions, remuneration, reprimands, suspensions, dismissals — People & Culture and the immediate leader or other members of leadership

·                       Respectful Workplace issues such as harassment and discrimination — Respectful Workplace Office

·                       Customer service complaints — Customer Care or Client Care

·                       Privacy-related issues — the Data & Trust Office is engaged where a matter involves customer or team member privacy

·                       Health & Safety issues — the Safety & Environment team

·                       Others may be redirected on a one off basis as determined by the Ethics Office.

 

b)              Investigation

 

All complaints to the Ethics Office are taken seriously and investigated, in partnership with TELUS Security where appropriate, in a timely manner. If substantiated, the complaint will be resolved through appropriate corrective action and/or discipline. If you make a complaint and choose to identify yourself, you will be notified when the Ethics Office has completed its review. Every effort will be made to maintain privacy and confidentiality for those who contact the Ethics Office or who are accused of a breach of this Code (although disclosure may be necessary in some cases to effectively conduct an investigation, take corrective action or support legal proceedings or otherwise as required by law). It is expected that all reports to the Ethics Office will be made in good faith. Deliberately or recklessly making false complaints will result in disciplinary action up to and including dismissal for just cause.

 

9


 

c)               Protection for Reporting

 

We support and encourage our team members to come forward in order for the Ethics Office and other subject matter experts to investigate and allow for a proactive response to potential areas of concern. Retaliation or retribution against a team member for contacting the Ethics Office or for assisting or participating in an investigation of a complaint violates our ethical principles and will not be tolerated. If you feel you have been retaliated against, you should contact People & Culture or the Ethics Office immediately.

 

d)              Opportunity to Respond

 

If it has been found that a team member has breached or has likely breached this Code, the team member will be informed of the complaint in due course. He or she will be provided the opportunity to respond and, where appropriate, to contribute to the correction of the breach.

 

e)               Reporting of Breaches

 

Any breach of the Code will be reported to senior leadership with recommendations for action. Ethical issues reported to the Ethics Office will be summarized quarterly and reported to the Human Resources and Compensation Committee and the Audit Committee of the Board, together with results of investigations, recommendations and action. The Chief Legal Officer will report significant complaints regarding accounting, internal accounting controls or auditing matters directly to the Chair of the Audit Committee of the Board.

 

f)                File Documentation

 

Records of the report and investigation, including contents of meetings, interviews, results of investigations and other relevant material, will be maintained by the Ethics Office in a separate file, and managed in accordance with the TELUS Privacy Policies and commitments set out at telus.com/privacy and Record Retention Policy. Disclosure of information internally will be strictly limited to a need-to-know basis.

 

5. Last Resort Resolution

 

If an ethical issue remains unresolved, the Integrity Work Group is available as the body of last resort to discuss the issue and guide the resolution of any ethical issue brought forward. Every ethical issue referred to the Integrity Work Group will first be reviewed by a sub-committee of the Integrity Work Group to assess its merits and relevance. If the sub-committee determines, based upon a review of the evidence submitted, that the issue has not been reported in good faith but is frivolous and / or vexatious, or that it is made in bad faith, it may recommend to the Integrity Work Group that no further action be taken. The Integrity Work Group will review the recommendation from the subcommittee and make a decision whether to assess the merits of the issue or determine that no further action be taken.

 

10


 

Guidelines

 

Privacy and Confidentiality of Information

 

We respect and protect the confidentiality, security and integrity of TELUS information and the information of others whether it belongs to other team members, contractors, suppliers, vendors, community partners, customers or competitors and we earn trust through effective and ethical management of their information.

 

The definition of “customer” includes our direct customers, customers who are also our competitors, a third party’s customers (customers of our customers), and may include team members who are also our customers. All customer and team member personal information is confidential and may not be disclosed except as outlined in the TELUS Privacy Code and as permitted by law.

 

We’re proud of the work we do at TELUS to protect the privacy of our customers and team members, and of the excellent reputation we have built for doing so. In today’s technologically innovative world, protecting privacy is more important than ever and more challenging than ever. We all rely on our customers trusting us with their data and, accordingly, we all need to be constantly alert about how we can continue to earn and maintain that trust.

 

Every team member at TELUS has a responsibility to put privacy first when handling personal information and to understand the privacy commitments we make to both our customers and team members, set out, respectively, at telus.com/privacy.

 

Team members are only permitted to access supplier, partner, customer or team member personal information where they have a legitimate business need to do so and may only use that personal information for that specific business purpose.

 

In order to comply with privacy laws, protect confidential information and maintain a respectful workplace, team members must not record workplace conversations or take photographs or videos in the workplace with a recording device or camera (including, but not limited to, a smartphone) without either obtaining prior consent from all parties included in the recording, photograph or video or prior authorization from their leader or other TELUS management. Team members should contact their leader or the Ethics Office for further information on recording workplace conversations.

 

The privacy policies and commitments found at telus.com/privacy set out guidelines and related practices for managing customer, supplier and team member personal information. Various areas of the Company may have additional supporting management practices in place. Refer to your leader for more information.

( See Situational Examples under Appendix “A” )

 

11


 

Personal Integrity

 

Individually and collectively, our personal integrity supports the honest use of Company resources such as time, funds and property in dealings with co-workers and others and in delivering on our Customer First priorities. Business needs must take priority in the allocation of our time at work. Company time and resources, irrespective of where we work (our declared “Work Style”) are to be used for business purposes unless otherwise authorized by the appropriate leadership. While we respect the privacy and autonomy of our team members in their personal lives, their actions, both in the workplace and outside it, have the potential to negatively impact the reputation of our company.

 

Fraud

 

We have a zero tolerance stance with regards to instances of confirmed fraud. Fraud can be simply defined as any intentional act, omission, deception, falsification or misrepresentation designed to deceive others, resulting in the victim suffering a loss and/or the perpetrator achieving a gain. As team members we will not engage directly or indirectly in fraud, including account falsification, abusive sales practices, expense fraud, time fraud, or any other fraudulent practices or reporting. If you are approached by anyone who you feel is or may be suggesting engagement in fraudulent activities, or if you are aware of situations which may involve fraud, you must report the incident to your leader or contact the Ethics Office. Examples of fraudulent or otherwise improper activity include:

·                   Altering sales agreements or creating fictitious accounts to meet objectives / earn sales incentive payments

·                   Adding or modifying products or services on a customer’s account without their knowledge, understanding or authorization

·                   Presenting false medical information for sick leave or disability benefits or participating in any activities, including travel, that are inconsistent with your medical restrictions and limitationsFalsely reporting time worked to earn more pay or to avoid discipline for being late or absent from work

·                   Submitting fraudulent benefits claims to TELUS’ service providers

·                   Working a second job while on sick leave without authorization from your leader.

 

Travel & Expenses

 

TELUS funds may only be used for legitimate business purposes. We must follow Company policies regarding allowable expenses, expense limits, the use of corporate credit cards, preferred travel vendors, management approvals, receipts, expense reports and other travel-related matters and we are expected to truthfully, accurately and completely record our travel expenses. See Employee Expense Policy and the TELUS Business Travel Policy for more information about the rules and guidelines regarding reimbursable expenses.

 

Compliance with Domestic and Foreign Laws

 

We comply with all applicable laws of the countries where we conduct business. Team members should understand and comply with the laws that relate to their work. It is the responsibility of leaders to ensure that members of their team are aware of their responsibilities in this regard and to seek advice from Legal Services, People & Culture, Regulatory Affairs or Taxation if they are unsure, especially for transactions that cross international borders or involve foreign laws.

 

12


 

Team members should be aware that many countries have laws that regulate the import and export of goods, services, software and technology for a variety of reasons, including national security and foreign policy.

 

Contributing to our Communities

 

We are committed to supporting the communities where our team members live and work. We encourage team members to support our communities by volunteering and participating in charitable activities, such as the TELUS Days of Giving.

 

While representing TELUS and contributing to our communities, we must:

 

·                   Adhere to the TELUS values and uphold the standards in this Code to ensure we always represent TELUS in an ethical manner

·                   Ensure that these outside activities do not interfere with our job performance or create a conflict of interest

·                   Obtain proper approval through the Community Investment team before donating TELUS funds or making contributions in TELUS’ name

·                   Make it clear that the views expressed through our participation in community activities are our own personal views, not those of TELUS.

 

Competing Ethically/Lawfully/Fairly

 

We consciously and purposely apply high standards of courtesy, professionalism, fairness and honesty when dealing with partners, suppliers, customers and competitors. We will report unethical practices by any other party to our leader or the TELUS EthicsLine.

 

Bribes and Facilitation Payments

 

We do not support any form of dishonesty, including facilitation payments or other types of bribery, gifts and benefits outside the guidelines, kickbacks and extortion, either directly or indirectly through an agent or third party. Local customs do not provide an exception to this requirement. Team members should be aware there are national and international laws regarding bribery and corruption that apply to TELUS and that have significant potential civil and criminal penalties for violations. Team members should refer to the Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy for further details.

 

Facilitation payments are typically small, unofficial payments demanded by lower level and lower-income government officials or individuals in exchange for providing or “expediting” routine, non-discretionary government services or actions to which one is legally entitled without such payments. For example, a team member might be asked for a facilitation payment in order to obtain routine permits to do business, to process visas and work orders, to obtain mail or telephone services, or to expedite shipments through customs. Another example could be a team member asking a third party to make a payment to carry out an activity which does not require a fee to be paid, such as booking an appointment. Facilitation payments are bribes and are strictly prohibited, even where they may not be illegal in a particular jurisdiction. By contrast, paying government taxes, fees and other legally required charges would not be considered a facilitation payment. A simple way to determine whether a payment being requested is lawful is to request an official receipt by the government office.

 

A bribe is a payment or other benefit that is intended to influence the judgment or conduct of a person in a position of power, authority or trust for the purposes of securing

 

13


 

the improper performance or non-performance of an activity; or an improper business advantage; or rewarding a person for a business advantage that has already been given.

 

A bribe is not limited to money and can include anything of value. Anything of value means anything that has value to the recipient and can also include things that benefit the recipient’s family members or friends. For example, paying for travel expenses of a public official’s relative would be of value to that official.

 

A kickback is also a form of bribery. A kickback is negotiated bribery in which an agreed upon commission or payment is paid to the bribe-taker in exchange for services rendered, such as ensuring that a particular contract is awarded to the organization that pays the kickback.

 

Further guidance on bribes may be found in the Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy.

 

Other Parties’ Confidential Information

 

We do not improperly seek corporate trade secrets or confidential information belonging to others. If we receive unsolicited information that appears to be another party’s corporate trade secrets or confidential information without the owner’s consent, we will immediately inform our leader and not copy, distribute, or use it until we have obtained guidance from our leadership and/or Legal Services. Team members or contractors who have worked for a partner, supplier, customer or competitor will not be requested to provide confidential information about that party. This does not preclude gathering information with the owner’s consent or from the public domain. Team members should refer to the TELUS Code of Conduct for Business Sales Activities for further details.

 

Lawful Competition

 

We are fair in what we say about others’ products and services and we are committed to lawful competition based upon the merits of our products and services and do not support any agreements or actions that restrict or impede fair competition in contravention of applicable law. Competition (anti-trust) law is complex, and global in reach, and its application depends on the facts of a particular case. Team members with sales, marketing and pricing responsibilities, as well as senior leadership, function in areas that tend to involve risks for violating competition laws, particularly matters that include:

·                   establishing terms and conditions as well as pricing and promotional strategies for TELUS products and services

·                   developing advertising materials for TELUS products and services

·                   negotiating, communicating or interacting with competitors

·                   handling or using data about competitors

·                   participating in trade associations that include competitors as participants, or

·                   selecting or negotiating with vendors.

 

Team members performing these functions should consult with Legal Services to ensure they are appropriately educated and trained with respect to competition law, and that they receive appropriate advice and specific guidelines to address relevant competition law issues that are applicable to their situation. Team members are also required to report to Legal Services any contravention or suspected breach of competition law requirements. In addition, it is often essential to involve legal counsel early in the process of developing new commercial initiatives given the many uncertainties that can arise in the application of this area of law.

 

14


 

Dealing with Governments

 

TELUS values its relationships with governments at all levels. Team members dealing with governments must be aware of legal, regulatory and policy requirements in such areas as lobbying, gifts and benefits, conflict of interest, bribery and corruption, hiring ex- government employees and procurement processes. Team members should also refer to the TELUS Code of Conduct for Business Sales Activities and the Anti-Bribery and  Corruption Policy for further details.

 

TELUS actively and openly communicates with all levels of governments and legislators, expressing views that affect our business and our industry. Team members or consultants/contractors acting on behalf of TELUS will not engage in lobbying activity unless they are registered as lobbyists and authorized to do so by TELUS’ Government Relations. Team members having contact with elected officials, their staff, and government employees (including those of Crown Corporations) should consult with the Regulatory Affairs team to ensure compliance with the appropriate lobbying regulations.

 

Team members should be aware of laws and regulations restricting or prohibiting government officials from accepting gifts or entertainment or from placing those officials in an actual or perceived conflict of interest with regard to their employer.

 

Team members hiring former government employees should be aware of restrictions placed by governments on their former employees from accepting employment or work, or advising or accepting appointment to a board of directors of entities with which they had significant official dealings for a specified period of time after leaving government employment.

( See Situational Examples under Appendix “B”)

 

Political Activities

 

As private citizens, we are free to engage in political activities and support causes, candidates or political parties of our choice. Unless expressly approved by TELUS, we will not, however, associate TELUS with our personal political activities. TELUS will not reimburse personal political donations in any form. As a responsible corporate citizen, TELUS will occasionally make contributions to a political party, campaign or candidate in Canada, as a means of supporting the democratic process, but only where legally permitted and not to secure favours or preferential treatment. All political contributions, whether direct, sponsorship or in-kind, must be made through the Government Relations team. No political contributions are permitted in countries other than Canada.

 

Proprietary Rights and Assets of Others

 

We respect the proprietary rights and assets of others. These include both tangible properties and intangible assets such as those protected by intellectual property rights. Intellectual property rights include trademarks, copyrights, patents, industrial designs, confidential information, know-how and trade secrets. Examples of assets containing intellectual property rights that we may come across in our work include, but are not limited to, written materials, logos, creative suggestions, pictures, audio and video products and computer software. We respect licenses and conditions of use that apply to the intellectual property of others. Copyright materials are not copied in whole or in part, or used in violation of any law or agreement with vendors, licensors or any other party. Software license conditions may be included in instruction manuals, in separate documents, or on the disk itself, and breaking the seal on a disk package may constitute acceptance of the stated agreement.

 

15


 

Involvement in a legal matter

 

If you are involved in a legal matter, whether of a civil, criminal or regulatory nature, that has the potential to affect your ability to perform your job or harm the reputation or interests of TELUS, you must immediately inform your leader.

 

If a team member comes across a suspected illegal activity or material (e.g. child pornography) in the course of their work, they should report it immediately to the TELUS  Security Office which will determine the appropriate course of action such as reporting to the appropriate authorities.

 

Improper Influence on the Conduct of Audits

 

Team members, or any person acting under the direction of a team member, are prohibited from directly or indirectly taking any action to improperly influence, coerce, manipulate or mislead the Company’s external or internal auditors or their representatives.

 

Respectful Workplace / Human Rights

 

We are committed to treating all current, potential and past team members, as well as all partners, suppliers, shareholders, and customers (and others stakeholders) with dignity, respect and fairness and in a non-discriminatory and harassment free manner.

 

Every team member has the right to a workplace that is free of unacceptable behaviours and has the obligation to treat others in the same manner. Unacceptable behaviours include discrimination based on a prohibited ground (race, national or ethnic origin, colour, religion, age, sex, gender identity or expression, sexual orientation, marital status, family status, genetic characteristics, disability or conviction for an offence for which a pardon has been granted or in respect of which a record suspension has been ordered) bullying, harassment and violence.

 

Workplace sexual harassment is a form of discrimination and a violation of the Respectful Workplace policy. Sexual harassment includes any conduct, comment, gesture, or contact of a sexual nature that is likely to cause offence or humiliation or that might reasonably be perceived as placing a condition of a sexual nature on any employment opportunity.

 

For the purpose of this section, TELUS “work environment” and “workplace” is not limited to TELUS’ business premises and is not limited to normal business hours. These terms also encompass any activities or events that happen outside of normal business hours or outside of TELUS business premises, but are linked to the TELUS workplace and the team member’s involvement with TELUS.

 

Though the spirit of the law is the same, the human rights legislation that TELUS companies are subject to may differ slightly, depending on which TELUS company is involved and which jurisdiction it is operating in. For example, some of the grounds for discrimination and harassment may differ slightly. Details are provided in the Respectful Workplace Policy to which team members are referred for more information.

 

Valuing Diversity and Inclusion

 

We believe the diversity of our team is a significant competitive advantage and we believe diversity thrives when we respect the traditions, beliefs, lifestyles, abilities and perspectives of all members of our team.

 

16


 

Our commitment to inclusiveness includes the provision of workplace accommodation related to protected human rights grounds in accordance with the law to permit qualified persons to do their jobs. Examples of accommodation may include physical or technical changes to work stations and changes to work duties. Details are provided in the Workplace Accommodation Policy to which Canadian team members are referred for more information. Team members are also referred to the Accessibility Policy for more  information.

 

Health and Safety

 

We are committed to having healthy and safe operations in all our locations to protect the lives and health of our team members, to protect our assets, to ensure business continuity and to engender public trust. When working on customer premises and public thoroughfares, we safeguard the rights and safety of the customer, the public and ourselves as outlined in the Health and Safety Policy.

 

We monitor progress towards our objective of preventing injuries, illnesses and incidents and continually assess and improve, where appropriate, our health and safety technologies and programs. We provide training to team members to help them understand and incorporate safe behaviour in their daily business activities. We have operating standards, practices, systems and resources to implement the Health and  Safety Policy.

 

We are expected to report to, and to remain fit for work, without any limitation due to the effects of alcohol, cannabis or other drugs, including prescription or over-the-counter medication, or any other mood altering substance, so that our ability to perform our job is not weakened, diminished, or adversely affected in any way. Our actions with respect to the use of drugs, alcohol, and other mood altering substances not only reflect on us as individuals, but on TELUS as a whole. Team members are referred to the TELUS  Corporate Alcohol and Drug Policy for further details.

 

TELUS is committed to providing a safe and violence-free workplace for all team members. Workplace violence may include conduct such as bullying, cyberbullying, teasing, abusive and other aggressive behaviours. Workplace violence is not only an employee health and safety issue, but also may be a criminal law issue. Consequently, workplace violence will not be tolerated and every incident will be investigated. Team members are referred to the Violence Prevention in the Workplace: Investigation and  Reporting Policy for further details.

 

Environment & Sustainability

 

TELUS’ values are demonstrated by our compliance with applicable environmental legal requirements, our actions to continually improve our environmental performance and build a sustainability culture. Team members are encouraged to consider economic,

 

17


 

social and environmental factors in their day-to-day strategic planning, decision making and operations.

 

Detailed information on our commitment to the environment can be found in our Environmental Policy and the Company’s intranet at go/green, where team members will find guidance on our ISO 14001:2015 certified environmental management system and other important resources. Detailed information on our Sustainability strategy and progress can be found in our Sustainability Report.

(See Situational Examples under Appendix “C”)

 

Company Assets and Information

 

Company assets are both physical (e.g. equipment, supplies, tools, funds, communications networks, real estate) and non-physical (e.g. software, non-public information, electronic records, intellectual property, brand, goodwill, reputation). We take appropriate care to protect Company assets against undue risks, exposures and liabilities.

 

Company Information

 

As team members of TELUS, we have access to information about our company that belongs to TELUS and is used by the Company for its business. Unless specifically published for external use and public dissemination has occurred, all Company records, information, reports, data, plans, processes and methods, including information posted on internal websites, are considered Company information and should not be disclosed without proper authorization. Access should be limited to those team members with a legitimate business reason to know the information. Team members are referred to the Security Policies for further details on the classification and safeguarding of TELUS’ information assets.

 

Team members and past team members must not use or disclose Company trade secrets, competitive information or other confidential and/or proprietary information to benefit themselves or others. In situations where we would be willing to share confidential information, Legal Services can assist in preparing a confidentiality agreement or license agreement to protect TELUS.

 

To protect the safety and integrity of our networks, only approved software is to be used on TELUS equipment. No team member should knowingly install or use a software program or code that could damage TELUS’ information assets. All team members are responsible for taking reasonable measures to ensure that software and data is clear of malicious code and safe for use in TELUS’ electronic data processing environment.

 

Public Disclosure

 

TELUS is subject to strict securities rules regarding disclosure of financial and other material information to the public. Selective disclosure of confidential information by any team member can create liabilities for TELUS and for that team member. All discussions about TELUS in a public environment should comply with the Policy on Corporate  Disclosure and Confidentiality of Information, to which team members should refer to for further details.

 

Examples of situations that may lead to inappropriate public disclosure include:

·                   Participating in an investment-related discussion forum, social networking site, chat room, blog or bulletin board on the Internet. The team member must not

 

18


 

discuss any confidential information about TELUS when participating in these activities.

·                   Discussion regarding TELUS with a member of the investment community or the media. All inquiries from these groups must be referred to those team members specifically trained and authorized to communicate on behalf of TELUS. For further information, contact Investor Relations or Corporate Communications.

·                   Presentations to business, educational or community groups. Team members invited to make such presentations should receive approval from the Vice President Investor Relations prior to accepting the invitation. In addition, all such public speeches and presentations must be provided in advance to Investor Relations for review where requested by them.

·                   For presentations to internal TELUS audiences, team members should confirm with their leader if such presentations include confidential or sensitive information.

 

Business Records

 

Accurate and reliable records are essential to enable us to meet our business, legal and financial obligations. We strive to ensure all reports (whether for external or internal use), records and other data are factual, complete, timely and understandable. Restricted and confidential information should be properly identified and respected as such as outlined in our Security Policies.

 

TELUS has defined processes for retaining and disposing of records and documents in order to comply with legal and regulatory requirements. Team members are referred to the Records Retention Policy for guidance on minimum and maximum retention periods, storage of records, and suspension of records destruction due to a potential or on-going litigation matter or investigation and where to obtain further information.

 

It is a violation of this Code as well as other TELUS policies to create false or misleading Company records or documents (including, for example, contracts, orders, time sheets, benefit claims, adjustments and expense statements).

 

Financial Transactions

 

All team members are expected to understand their role and responsibility for the Company’s financial transactions and records and follow approved procedures to protect, report, control and accurately reflect these transactions. Team members are referred to the Signing Authority Policy and other Finance policies for further details.

 

It is a violation of the Employee Expense Policy to misuse Company-issued credit cards or make misrepresentations on expense statements.

 

We also do not tamper with the network or systems to bypass billing and we do not make unauthorized charges or credits to customer accounts.

 

Team members whose duties involve authentication and approval are responsible for the close scrutiny and timely verification of all documents upon which monies are paid or received in compliance with TELUS policies.

 

Safeguarding Assets

 

We display pride of ownership on behalf of the TELUS team as we protect Company facilities, information, equipment, tools, supplies, vehicles, funds, communication

 

19


 

networks and information systems against loss, theft, damage, vandalism, neglect, unauthorized use and unauthorized disposal.

 

Team members are the first line of defense in protecting TELUS assets and information. Team members are expected to take reasonable measures to safeguard access controls such as passwords, identification cards, keys, cards and hand-held user authentication devices. It is also important that we not share our company-provided computer or other communication devices or their access passwords. Team members must also ensure they do not compromise security of sites by leaving access doors open and unattended.

 

Intellectual Property

 

Our intellectual property is a valuable TELUS asset and we work together to protect our intellectual property just as we respect the proprietary rights of others as noted above. Intellectual property rights enable TELUS to be known and recognized in the market place and help distinguish our products and services from those of our competitors. Intellectual property rights also protect the valuable intangible assets generated or acquired by the TELUS team

 

Intellectual property rights include trademarks, copyrights, patents, industrial designs, confidential information, know-how and trade secrets. Examples of materials involving intellectual property rights that we may come across in our work include, but are not limited to, branding, logos, creative suggestions and ideas, pictures, audio and video products, written materials, internal communications and computer software. When we create intellectual property individually or as part of a team — this property is owned by TELUS and we work to document the ownership of such intellectual property.

 

Team members should contact Legal Services for further information about intellectual property matters or the Brand Office for information on use of our brand.

 

Personal Use of Communication Devices

 

In our future friendly world, communication equipment and devices (whether the Company’s or our own) are used for both business and personal purposes. Electronic communication may occur via a wide range of devices including, but not limited to, computers, telephones, smartphones, webcams and fax machines. This can take the form of emails, texting, Internet searches, photographs, videos, audio files, blogs, social networking, peer-to-peer file transfers and physical exchange of media (e.g., CD’s, USB storage devices and devices such as iPods). As we communicate in any of these ways, we may identify ourselves as TELUS team members either by naming the Company or by virtue of email or IP addresses.

 

While we permit team members to use TELUS-provided communications equipment and devices for personal purposes, such use should be limited, should not interfere with our duties or negatively impact TELUS in any way. We expect any such personal use to take place on your own personal time, or during reasonable permitted breaks from work, subject to local leadership approval and the needs of the business.

 

Team members must comply with all TELUS policies when using TELUS-provided communication devices for personal use. We are responsible for all of our actions while using such devices. Team members should refer to the Security Acceptable Use Policy for further information.

 

20


 

TELUS uses automated tools to log team member use of its networks (e.g. voice, email, messaging, Intranet and Internet) and related equipment and devices and to monitor traffic (including content) on its networks in order to detect security threats and other problems. While TELUS does not actively monitor employee email, messaging, telephone and internet access, TELUS does reserve the right to do so. Team members are referred to the Security Policies for further details on the acceptable use of company- provided equipment and devices. Note that improper use of the Company’s networks, equipment and devices may result in disciplinary action up to and including dismissal. ( See Situational Examples under Appendix “D” )

 

Use of Social Media

 

Social media includes any digital communication channels that allow individuals to create and share content and post comments. Team members must comply with our Social Media Guidelines, use good judgement and be polite, respectful, and mindful of the content created, shared and posted, remembering that the Internet is a public place.

 

We encourage communication among our team members, customers, and partners, through social networks, blogs, forums, video, and other social-driven platforms. However, as a TELUS team member, you should adhere to the following:

 

·                        Remember that you can often leave a permanent footprint of your online presence and you may be operating in a public space where anyone can view your content

·                        Do not review TELUS products or services on social media, whether you’ve identified yourself as a team member or not. This includes posting reviews in an app store, or on social networks. Doing so can result in legal ramifications for the business

·                        Use common sense when offering personal opinions to avoid subjecting either TELUS or yourself to legal action. To help avoid confusion, and depending on the circumstances, it may be appropriate to add the following statement to your social media bio: “the views expressed on this website/blog/email are mine alone and do not necessarily reflect the views of my employer”

·                        Do not disclose information that is confidential to TELUS or provided in confidence to TELUS, including upcoming promotions or device launches, internal communications, or financial information until the information has been made public

·                        Although sharing information about services or offers is acceptable, do not,claim that you can provide better customer offers than what is available in-store or online, and always disclose your association with TELUS

·                        Show respect towards other persons and organizations and avoid defamatory, discriminatory, harassing or sexual messages

·                        Avoid offensive content of any kind, including pornography and materials promoting violence, discrimination or hatred

·                        Do not display the TELUS logo or brand images in personal communications without written permission from a senior leader or the Brand Office.

 

If you are interested in sharing content or promoting TELUS initiatives, we recommend downloading the Amplify app on your phone, which can be found in the app store, and setting up an account using your TELUS email address. This app features curated feeds of approved TELUS content that can be shared directly with your social networks.

 

21


 

Alternatively, you can visit any of TELUS’ official social media channels and retweet content, or share posts published by the TELUS Social and Media Relations team.

 

For additional information regarding our team member policies, you can visit the Social Media Guidelines.

 

(See Situational Examples under Appendix “E”)

 

Conflict of Interest

 

WHAT it means

 

As team members, our first business loyalty must be to TELUS. We must avoid situations or relationships that conflict with the interests of the Company and our duties to TELUS. A conflict arises whenever we allow, or appear to allow, personal interests or relationships to impair our judgment and ability to make work related decisions with integrity and honesty.

 

WHY it matters

 

By thinking of ourselves first, we may act in a way that is damaging, or potentially damaging, to TELUS. We may also harm our personal reputation. In such circumstances, team members must take action to eliminate the conflict of interest or the perception of a conflict of interest.

 

HOW we do it

 

We make business decisions based on what is in the best interest of TELUS and not our own. As team members, we must disclose actual or potential conflicts of interest to our leader. Each situation must be considered individually based on the parties involved, level of access to business information, decision-making authority, job duties/responsibilities, position within the organization and potential impact on others. If team members find themselves in a conflict or are unsure of whether a situation would be deemed to be a conflict of interest, they should complete a “Conflict of Interest  Disclosure Form” available on the Company intranet and submit it to the Ethics Office. Remember, having a conflict of interest is not necessarily a Code violation, but failing to disclose it is.

 

The following is intended as a guide in those areas in which conflicts of interest often arise. It is not intended to be definitive or all-inclusive, as guidelines cannot cover every situation that could give rise to a conflict of interest.

 

Family Members and Personal Relationships

 

A conflict of interest may occur when a team member has the ability to enhance or promote the interests of a family member.

 

For the purposes of this part of the Code, “Family member” is defined as a spouse (including a common-law spouse and/or same-sex partner), child, stepchild, parent, sibling, niece, nephew, aunt, uncle, cousin, grandparent, grandchild, in-law (including mother-in-law, father-in-law, son-in-law, daughter-in-law, sister-in-law and brother-in- law). It also includes close personal friendships and any person (other than domestic employees) residing in the same household as the TELUS team member.

 

Situations may arise where broader familial relationships, friendships and other close personal associations (e.g. persons residing in same household as the TELUS team member) cause real or perceived conflicts of interest or the possibility of real or perceived improper influence. Team members should be sensitive to these concerns

 

22


 

and demonstrate good business judgment in the best interest of TELUS and in keeping with the spirit and intent of this Code. Any uncertainty should be discussed with the appropriate People & Culture business partner or with the Ethics Office.

 

TELUS Board members must disclose any family or personal relationship with TELUS team members or with TELUS job applicants to the Chair of the Corporate Governance Committee of the Board in order that the Committee may determine whether the relationship impacts the Director’s independent status.

 

Board members, executives and senior leaders have a duty to disclose whether they have a relationship with the Company’s external auditor.

 

Personal Gain

 

Conflict of interest may occur when a team member or family member gains a personal benefit from: (a) a business relationship with TELUS, or (b) an outside business with which TELUS has a relationship such as a partner, supplier, customer, competitor, contractor, consultant, agent, or dealer. This personal benefit may arise from an ownership interest in, or a role as a director, officer or employee of, an entity that is engaged in a business relationship with TELUS.

 

This guideline does not prohibit team members from holding publicly traded shares of an entity with which TELUS has a business relationship or a competitor provided that the team member does not have a significant investment in the entity and does not acquire the shares based on material undisclosed confidential information obtained as a result of employment with TELUS or by being a member of the Board of a TELUS company.

 

To prevent conflicts of interest, Team members may not:

 

·             be involved in any negotiations or transactions on behalf of TELUS with partners, suppliers, customers, contractors, consultants, agents, or outside parties where the team member has a personal, commercial or financial interest in the outcome of the negotiations, or transactions unrelated to their role at TELUS.

·             participate in a decision to hire, transfer or promote a family member, or someone with whom they have a romantic or sexual relationship, or be in a position of direct or indirect influence over a family member who is an employee or contractor of TELUS. Team members recommending the hire of an employee or retainer of a contractor must disclose any current or past relationships, both professional and personal.

·             supervise a family member nor have direct or indirect authority over employment or contract-related decisions that impact a family member or someone with whom they have a romantic or sexual relationship, such as pay, performance ratings, work assignments, discipline, training or termination.

·             access or make adjustments to their own accounts or services of family members, friends, co-workers or acquaintances without authorization from their leader. Team members may only do so if specifically authorized by trouble ticket or customer order and authorization is gained from their leader.

·             Work for, or be contracted to, an independent TELUS dealer or a provincially regulated TELUS entity, such as TELUS Retail Limited and TELUS at the same time.

 

23


 

Ethical Sales Practices

 

Team members share a commitment to delivering on our Customers First priorities, which include being consistently mindful of our professional conduct and ethical sales practices, including our obligations under our Code of Conduct for Business Sales Activities. We need to ensure when selling to a customer, that we provide the customer options that will allow them to make informed choices on the products and services that best meet their needs. We do not direct customers to sales that are not aligned with their requirements and we do not make any changes or modifications to their account without their consent, understanding and permission.

 

Outside employment and other non-TELUS activities

 

As team members, we are free to engage in outside business activities on our own time. However, these activities must not conflict, or have the potential to conflict, with TELUS’ best interests or with our ability to perform our job for TELUS. As a general guideline, team members may not work for, or be engaged in business activities for, enterprises that are competitors or suppliers of TELUS. A conflict may also arise if, for example, we use assets such as time, our corporate phone or laptop, or tools paid for or developed by TELUS, when engaged in such outside business activities. If you are considering starting your own business, accepting a second job, or joining a Board, you are required to advise your leader to ensure there is no conflict of interest.

 

It is a conflict of interest, irrespective of where we work (i.e. our declared “Work Style”) to have outside interests or responsibilities that demands so much time and energy that it interferes with a team member’s ability to complete their TELUS work. This could include any personal, community and charitable activities that require time and effort during normal working hours, except for situations where the individual is acting in a representative capacity at the request of TELUS with the explicit and written permission of their leader.

 

Future TELUS Business

 

Over time, TELUS may expand into new businesses or change its product lines or services. Team members are responsible for re-examining their individual situations on a regular basis to avoid becoming involved in a conflict of interest situation where no such conflict previously existed.

 

Information

 

Team members may not disclose or use for any personal reason, including personal gain, any confidential information (including competitive intelligence) obtained through employment with TELUS or by being a member of the Board of a TELUS company.

 

Insider Trading

 

As detailed in the TELUS Insider Trading Policy and summarized here, team members may not trade in shares or other securities of TELUS or any other company while in possession of undisclosed material information relative to the company whose securities are being traded. Nor may team members inform any other person, including their family, of any undisclosed material information except in very limited circumstances. Please see the TELUS Insider Trading Policy and the TELUS Policy on Disclosure and  Confidentiality of Information for more information.

 

24


 

Material information in respect of a company is information that could reasonably be expected to have a significant effect on the market price or value of any securities of that company.

 

Putting Conflict of Interest Concepts into Practice

 

To determine if you have a conflict of interest that should be disclosed, ask yourself these questions:

·  Do my outside interests influence, or appear to influence, my ability to make sound business decisions for TELUS?

·  Do I stand to improperly benefit from my involvement in this situation? Does a friend or relative of mine stand to improperly benefit?

·  Could my participation in this activity interfere with my ability to do my job at TELUS?

·  Is the situation causing me to put my own interests ahead of TELUS’ interests?

·  If the situation became public knowledge, could it negatively reflect on me or TELUS?

 

If you answered “yes” to any of the above questions, discuss the situation with your leader or the Ethics Office.

(See Situational Examples under Appendix “F”)

 

Gifts and Benefits

 

A gift can be anything of value. A gift may include tangible items, but not limited to, items such as cash, art, jewelry, travel or tickets to an event.

 

A benefit includes intangible items such as discounts, services, loans, favours, special privileges, preferential treatment, advantages, and rights that are not available to the general public. They include invitations to sporting, cultural, charitable or social events, or access to discounts and loyalty programs. While their value may sometimes be difficult to quantify in dollars, they may be highly valued by the intended recipient and therefore used to take advantage or influence their behaviour. Accepting substantial gifts from contractors, suppliers, vendors and/or community partners could be seen as “presumptively fraudulent” because of the potential to create undue influence. If ever unsure of an offering, please contact your leader or the Ethics Office.

 

It is important to remember that “anything of value” can also include things that benefit the recipient’s family members or friends.

 

TELUS team members shall not authorize, offer or accept, directly or indirectly, gifts, or benefits that are intended to influence, or appear to influence to or from any organization or person having business dealings with TELUS other than as described below. These guidelines apply at all times and do not change during traditional giving events or seasons.

 

It is not a conflict of interest to authorize, offer or accept hospitality or entertainment or to offer a discount or gift certificate for TELUS products and services, provided it is reasonable, and is within the limits of responsible and generally accepted business practices.

 

Gifts of cash or cash equivalent (such as a gift card) should not be authorized, offered or accepted, regardless of the amount.

Reasonable gifts and entertainment are courtesies intended to engender goodwill and positive working relationships among business partners. We do not, however, want to

 

25


 

use improper means to obtain business or gain any special advantage in a business relationship or put ourselves in a situation where we feel a sense of obligation created by accepting a gift.

 

Gifts and benefits that are acceptable for TELUS team members to authorize, offer or accept in the normal course of business are typically less than $250 Canadian or the close equivalent in other currencies and include:

·                        Attendance at local sporting or cultural events

·                        Business lunches or dinners

·                        Transportation to or from the customer’s or supplier’s place of business

·                        Hospitality suites or

·                        Small seasonal holiday gifts or prizes to be used in office draws and raffles.

 

Business meals and entertainment provided by external parties must be unsolicited, infrequent with any particular business or person, in good taste, and undertaken for legitimate business reasons, including engendering goodwill. If the provider of the meal or entertainment is not in attendance, it is considered a gift and can only be of nominal value.

 

If you are not sure whether a gift or benefit is acceptable, ask yourself:

·                        Would the gift be considered customary given the nature of your role with TELUS?

·                        If the gift or benefit was reported in the media or to the TELUS President and CEO, would the perception be neutral or positive?

·                        For offers of hospitality or entertainment, is the person extending the offer attending with you?

 

If the answers to these questions are “yes,” based on your good faith assessment, you may accept the gift.

 

If the answers to these questions are “no”, you should politely decline the gifts or entertainment. If that would be difficult or embarrassing to the provider, you may accept the gift, but should ask your leader or contact the Ethics Office who will work with you to either donate the item to an approved charity, or to distribute the item amongst your peers.

 

It may be appropriate to attend third-party paid seminars, conferences or vendor-hosted events if there is a clear benefit to TELUS for attending and the attendance is approved in advance by the team member’s leader. To avoid a real or perceived conflict of interest, team members should consider having TELUS fund incremental expenses (e.g. airfare and hotel) and remember, prizes given out at such events are considered gifts and should follow the same gifts & benefits guidelines as outlined above.

 

Team members with supplier selection, negotiation, purchasing or contract management roles within TELUS are subject to more stringent professional purchasing requirements regarding gifts and benefits and maintaining appropriate relationships with suppliers and should therefore not accept any gifts or benefits from suppliers or potential suppliers without the explicit and written permission of their leader. Where the value of any gift or benefit is $250 or greater, the leader must also provide a copy of their authorization of

 

26


 

that particular gift or benefit to the Ethics Office including a description of the gift or benefit, approximate value, the name of the party conferring the gift or benefit and the reason).

 

Team members with supplier selection, negotiation, purchasing or contract management roles include team members within the Procurement and Supply Chain Management team as well as team members in any area of TELUS that have the ability to either make or influence decisions around matters including:

·                        the selection of suppliers, including service providers such as law firms, accounting firms, IT professionals, consultants, and suppliers of any type of hardware, software, equipment or other tangible items;

·                        the negotiation of contract terms with one or more supplier(s);

·                        the volume of goods or services to be purchased or acquired from one or more supplier(s); or

·                        the ongoing management of the relationship with one or more supplier(s), including decisions whether to renew or terminate any such relationship.

 

(See Situational Examples under Appendix “G”)

 

Dealing with Suppliers

 

We value our relationship with suppliers (including contractors and consultants) and those acting on behalf of TELUS because they contribute to our overall success. We strive to ensure our business dealings with them are ethical and that they understand our expectations of them as outlined in our Supplier Code of Conduct.

 

electing Suppliers

 

·                        We strive to award business to suppliers who are in compliance with applicable laws in their business operations, including in their relationships with their employees, their communities and TELUS.

·                        We strive to select our suppliers based upon objective and fair criteria including, but not necessarily limited to, business need, price, service, quality, reputation for ethical conduct and health, safety and environmental business considerations.

 

Adherence to applicable TELUS policies

 

·                        We expect the suppliers with whom we do business to demonstrate values and standards similar to those in the applicable TELUS policies.

·                        We strive to ensure that our suppliers are made aware of TELUS policies that are applicable to the work for which they are being engaged.

 

Supplier-funded incentive programs

 

·                        Supplier-funded incentive programs, often offered to our sales team by suppliers seeking to sell their products and services, must be approved in advance by an authorized program administrator who does not work with the eligible team members.

 

27


 

Review Guidelines and Policies

 

If you need further assistance, consider the following additional policies as they may apply to your situation.

 

Accessibility Policy

Acceptable Use Policy

Alcohol and Drug Corporate Policy

Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy

Attendance Policy

Code of Conduct for Business Sales Activities

Policy on Corporate Disclosure and Confidentiality of Information

Corporate Security Policies and Corporate Security Manual

Employee Expense Policy

Environmental Policy

Hiring Processes & Guidelines 

Insider Trading Policy

Policy on TELUS and the Charter of the French Language

Procurement Policies

Records Retention Policy

Respectful Workplace Policy

Signing Authority Policy

Social Media Guidelines

Supplier Code of Conduct

TELUS Health and Safety Policy

TELUS Health Privacy Policy

TELUS Health Privacy Commitment

TELUS Privacy Commitment

Team Member Privacy Commitment

TELUS Business Travel Policy

Violence Prevention in the Workplace: Investigation and Reporting Policy

Workplace Accommodation Policy

Work Styles Policy

 

Appendix Situational Examples

 

A) Privacy and Confidentiality of Information

 

Problem

My friend calls me at work in the Call Centre to ask me to look up the address and phone number of a TV personality since this information is not listed in the public directory. Should I look this up and provide the information?

 

28


 

Action

No. Unless you have a legitimate business reason to look up the information, you must not even access this customer’s account and should certainly not provide the requested information to your friend.

 

Problem

My next-door neighbour is a good friend of the family of one of my former team members who now works for a different leader. My neighbour asks me how this team member is doing. I explain that he no longer works on my team and is away from the office on stress leave. Should I have discussed my former team member’s status with a close family friend?

 

Action

No. It is not appropriate for you to discuss the status of your former team member even though you know your neighbour is a close family friend. Team members are reminded that it is inappropriate to disclose personal information of our team members for non-work related purposes. Of particular concern is sensitive personal information such as health or financial information and information about disciplinary action. This is contrary to our TELUS Privacy Policies and commitments set out at telus.com/privacy.

 

Problem

Today I had a challenging experience with a customer and I could not make them happy. I have my own blog on our intranet and would like to post my experience so that I can get suggestions from my team members on how to handle similar situations. Should I post this?

 

Action

Soliciting feedback from your team members is an excellent idea; however, you should act cautiously. Even though you are posting this internally, you must protect the privacy of your customer. Review what you intend to post to ensure you are not inappropriately identifying your customer and, discuss with your leader before posting.

 

Problem

My sister is in a marital dispute with her spouse. Is it acceptable to help her by looking up the calling and account details of her spouse?

 

Action

No. Unless you have a business reason to look up the information, you must not access this customer’s account and should certainly not provide the requested information to your sister. Doing so would constitute a breach of privacy and would be considered a conflict of interest.

 

Problem

I have a friend who is starting a new business and has asked me for a list of TELUS customers who might be interested in her services. Is it ok to provide a list of potential customers?

 

29


 

Action

No. Customer information is private and should never be shared with anyone outside TELUS (or with anyone inside TELUS who does not need the information to do their job).

 

B) Competing Ethically/Lawfully/Fairly

 

Problem

We recently hired someone who held an executive position with one of our competitors. This person was deeply involved in planning the competitor’s expansion strategy and has information that would be very valuable to us. Can we ask her to disclose confidential aspects of this information?

 

Action

No. The new team member has an obligation to protect her former company’s confidential or proprietary information, just as you would be obliged to protect the confidential or proprietary information of TELUS if you were to leave the company. You must respect the team member’s personal integrity as well as her obligation to her former employer.

 

Problem

I become aware that a team member is disclosing third party (competitors, suppliers, customers, etc.) confidential information to other TELUS team members. What should I do?

 

Action

Report this to your leader and the EthicsLine immediately. TELUS’ reputation could be significantly harmed by such disclosure, and this could also expose TELUS to potential legal action. Taking immediate steps to contain the confidential information is critical.

 

Problem

I am travelling abroad later this month and need to get a work visa quickly. The person processing my request at the embassy has said that they can speed up the process if I pay a small fee in cash. Is this okay?

 

Action

It depends. If it is an official fee that the embassy charges for published “fast-track” services, payment of this fee would be O.K. However, if it is a payment to the person processing the request, then it is a bribe and prohibited. You must ask for a receipt or other official documentation as proof that the fee is legitimate. If the person will not provide any official documentation for the payment and you are uncertain whether it is legitimate, you should first consult with your leader or the Data & Trust Office.

 

Problem

I am a member of a team working on a part of the quarterly financial results. In the course of my work, I regularly see the draft package of all the results before they are approved for release. One evening, my neighbor asks me, “How is TELUS doing these days?” In this casual conversation, is it acceptable if I answer, ‘Well, I can tell you one thing: the results are really good this quarter.”

 

30


 

Action

No, this is not acceptable. This information is not yet public and therefore it should be regarded as confidential and/or proprietary company information. In addition, if this information is material (i.e. would reasonably be expected to have a significant effect on the value or price of TELUS shares), you would be engaging in “tipping” in violation of securities law and the Policy on Corporate  Disclosure and Confidentiality of Information.

 

C) Respectful Workplace and Human Rights

 

Problem

A co-worker and I had a disagreement in the workplace. We are Facebook friends, as are several of our peers, and I began seeing posts where they are making negative comments about me and calling me a loser. Could this be seen as cyberbullying?

 

Action

Yes. Comments such as these are considered cyberbullying, and are unacceptable. Cyberbullying can be in the form of, but not limited to, offensive email, email threats, posts, comments or spreading gossip on Social Media or work chat platforms. If you are experiencing or witnessing such behavior, you should speak to the Respectful Workplace Office in People & Culture or your leader.

 

Problem

You receive a text from your leader after working hours complimenting you on how attractive you are and asking about the qualities you look for in a companion. You are very uncomfortable with the content of the text but you worry there may be retaliation or a negative impact on your career if you tell your leader the text is inappropriate and unwanted. What should you do?

 

Action

The leader’s actions are unacceptable and fall within the definition of workplace sexual harassment. The Respectful Workplace Policy applies to all activities both during and outside business hours that could have an adverse impact on the TELUS work environment. All team members have the right to a safe and harassment free work environment. Regardless of the level or job title of the person engaging in harassment, you should contact the Respectful Workplace Office or the Ethics Office for guidance. Retaliation against a team member who makes a complaint or reports an alleged policy breach in good faith is strictly prohibited.

 

Problem

You just left a team meeting and are having an informal conversation with a co-worker about a number of action items assigned to each of you. In referring to your openly gay Director, your co-worker says, “John acted like a total princess today.”

 

Action

Your co-worker’s comments are unacceptable and represent a form of sexual harassment. Sexual harassment is not just confined to sexual interest but it also covers more subtle behaviours based on gender, sexual orientation, gender identity or gender expression. The comments are unwelcome, serve no

 

31


 

legitimate business purpose and could cause harm. Although you were not the subject of the comment, all team members have an obligation to report unacceptable behaviours. You should contact the Respectful Workplace Office or the Ethics Office for guidance.

 

Environment & Sustainability

 

Problem

We use a contractor to dispose of hazardous materials such as lead. I know the contractor’s crew chief and I get the feeling that they may not be disposing of the materials correctly, at least not according to the law. Should I care about this? After all, it is not my company and they are probably saving us money.

 

Action

Yes, you should care because what the contractor is doing may expose TELUS to liability. In addition, improper waste disposal is inconsistent with our commitment to sustainable practices and to reduce the environmental impact of our activities. If team members believe someone we work with is doing something wrong they should talk with their leader, the TELUS Environment department or call the EthicsLine.

 

D)       Company Assets & Information

 

Problem

I would like to search for a new car on the Internet and compare notes with friends on a social networking site. Is this allowed from my workstation?

 

Action

It depends. Reasonable personal use of your TELUS-provided communication equipment or device to access the Internet is allowed provided it complies with our policies, is carried out during personal time or permitted breaks, does not interfere with your work or negatively impact TELUS in any way. Remember that business needs must take priority in the allocation of our time at work.

 

E)       Social Media

 

Problem

While browsing Facebook, you come across a thread where people are discussing TELUS products and services. Some comments praise the business for its service and others are criticizing it. What should you do?

 

Action

Unless you are a specifically authorized TELUS spokesperson in this forum, you should not be discussing TELUS products and services online. You may expose

 

32


 

yourself and TELUS to unacceptable risk since you may inadvertently disclose confidential information by defending the Company or be viewed as speaking on behalf of TELUS when you have not been authorized to do so. For more information, see Social Media Guidelines.

 

Problem

You’ve just learned that TELUS is going to be offering a new rate plan in the coming weeks and want to sell it to potential customers online. What do you do?

 

Action

Once the new plan has launched publicly, you are welcome to post about it on your social media channels. However, you must:

·                   ensure the information you’re sharing is accurate

·                   disclose your relationship with TELUS in the post copy

·                   not claim that the offer is exclusive to you or that you can provide a better offer

·                   use TELUS-branded imagery and logos (approval process required by Brand Office and/or your leader)

 

.Problem

Your manager asks you to open a new TELUS Instagram account to highlight your team’s products and services and team culture. What do you do?

 

Action

Any new social media accounts for TELUS must be approved by the Social & Media Relations Team prior to being activated. If your team, however, wants to create a private internal account, they can, so long as no TELUS branding is used and TELUS is not incorporated in the account’s name. In either case, the Social & Media Relations Team needs to be notified first.

 

F) Conflict of Interest

 

Problem

I work in a senior marketing position at TELUS and operate my own business after hours. Though I use my marketing skills, the business in no way competes with TELUS business and does not affect my ability to perform my duties at TELUS. I started small, working out of my basement, but my business is gradually generating more and more revenue. I am considering hiring a part-time manager, as I am not ready to leave my full-time employment. Once my own business can pay me as much as TELUS does, I will devote my full attention to it. I have the best of both worlds - a salary from TELUS and a blossoming business for future security. Is this a conflict of interest?

 

Action

No. Since TELUS is not currently in the same line of business as your company, you are operating ethically, and it is not a conflict of interest as long as it remains an after-hours pursuit and does not interfere with your ability to perform your job for TELUS to the best of your abilities. If, however, TELUS decides in the future to enter the same line of business that your company is in, you will be in a conflict of interest position, even though you were in that business first. You must then decide which of your two interests, your own company or your employer’s, will receive your full attention. Note, as team members we are expected to fulfill our

 

33


 

TELUS job responsibilities during our paid TELUS time, irrespective of where we work (i.e. our declared Work Style location).

 

Problem

I recently married the owner of a local franchise selling a competitor’s cellular phone service. We have agreed not to talk about our days at work. Recently, my leader advised me that I could be in a conflict of interest position. What should I do?

 

Action

You are in a situation that may leave the impression of a conflict of interest. Even though you and your new spouse have decided not to talk about your business lives, people outside the marriage—including your employer—may perceive you are in a conflict of interest position. You should discuss your situation further with your leader and the Ethics Office as necessary and identify the extent to which your access to TELUS’ information could benefit your spouse’s company and develop alternatives to avoid any appearance of a conflict of interest.

 

Problem

I install telecommunications inside wiring for TELUS small and medium-sized business customers. With the growth of communications services, demand for my expertise is booming. Can I take advantage of this opportunity and start up an installation business on my own time?

 

Action

No. You cannot engage in any outside activity that might take business away from TELUS or any of its subsidiaries. This would be considered a conflict of interest.

 

Problem

While at lunch, I overheard a conversation between two other TELUS team members regarding Company plans to make a minority investment in a software company that develops communications software. Can I buy shares in the software company or suggest to my spouse that she do so?

 

Action

No. Although you found out about TELUS’ planned investment by accident, you are prohibited from buying shares by virtue of the fact that you are a member of the TELUS team. Your spouse is also prohibited, because she would be obtaining information about the proposed investment from you, a TELUS team member. However, you and your spouse will be able to buy shares when TELUS’ investment in the software company becomes publicly disclosed.

 

Problem

As an account manager with TELUS, I am responsible for managing several customer accounts. I have known the owner of one of my customer accounts since we were kids and have always maintained a close personal relationship. I have no personal, commercial or financial interest in my customer’s business. Is there still an appearance of conflict?

 

Action

Yes. Although you may not have a personal, commercial or financial interest in the outcome of your customer’s business, there may still be an appearance of

 

34


 

bias or preferential treatment towards their company. You must eliminate the perception of conflict of interest by disclosing the relationship to your leader and removing yourself from managing this account. In addition, this same conflict of interest exists if you are managing an account that a family member may own/operate.

 

Problem

I am a customer service manager with TELUS and my nephew is seeking employment as an engineer with TELUS. Am I able to recommend him for employment?

 

Action

Yes. To avoid a conflict of interest, you should have no involvement in the selection decision. However, you may provide a written personal reference to the appropriate People & Culture recruiter.

 

G) Gifts & Benefits

 

Problem

A vendor has offered me tickets to a local hockey game. Can I accept them?

 

Action

Possibly. If the vendor is inviting you to attend the game with a representative of the vendor, this may be acceptable business entertainment providing that it is:

·    undertaken for business reasons, including engendering goodwill

·    infrequent

·    without intent of influencing business decisions

·    consistent with our Code and values.

 

If the vendor is not attending, then the tickets would be considered a gift and must comply with the Gifts and Benefits guidelines.

 

Problem

Part of my job involves the selection of technology suppliers. One day, a technology supplier phoned me and offered me and my family free use of his luxury vacation condominium. He says he is not using it and it would be a shame to have it sit empty. Can I accept the offer to use the supplier’s condominium?

 

Action

No. The supplier has made a very generous offer which could appear to be offered in exchange for future special treatment from you in your position with TELUS. You should decline the offer.

 

35